rclone/MANUAL.md
Miron Veryanskiy fd94b3a473 docs: replace #file-caching with #vfs-file-caching
The documentation had dead links pointing to #file-caching. They've been
moved to point to #vfs-file-caching.
2021-02-13 12:56:25 +00:00

1.1 MiB
Generated
Raw Blame History

% rclone(1) User Manual
% Nick Craig-Wood
% Feb 02, 2021

Rclone syncs your files to cloud storage

rclone logo

About rclone

Rclone is a command line program to manage files on cloud storage. It
is a feature rich alternative to cloud vendors' web storage
interfaces. Over 40 cloud storage products support
rclone including S3 object stores, business & consumer file storage
services, as well as standard transfer protocols.

Rclone has powerful cloud equivalents to the unix commands rsync, cp,
mv, mount, ls, ncdu, tree, rm, and cat. Rclone's familiar syntax
includes shell pipeline support, and --dry-run protection. It is
used at the command line, in scripts or via its API.

Users call rclone "The Swiss army knife of cloud storage", and
"Technology indistinguishable from magic".

Rclone really looks after your data. It preserves timestamps and
verifies checksums at all times. Transfers over limited bandwidth;
intermittent connections, or subject to quota can be restarted, from
the last good file transferred. You can
check the integrity of your files. Where
possible, rclone employs server-side transfers to minimise local
bandwidth use and transfers from one provider to another without
using local disk.

Virtual backends wrap local and cloud file systems to apply
encryption,
caching,
compression
chunking and
joining.

Rclone mounts any local, cloud or
virtual filesystem as a disk on Windows,
macOS, linux and FreeBSD, and also serves these over
SFTP,
HTTP,
WebDAV,
FTP and
DLNA.

Rclone is mature, open source software originally inspired by rsync
and written in Go. The friendly support
community are familiar with varied use cases. Official Ubuntu, Debian,
Fedora, Brew and Chocolatey repos. include rclone. For the latest
version downloading from rclone.org is recommended.

Rclone is widely used on Linux, Windows and Mac. Third party
developers create innovative backup, restore, GUI and business
process solutions using the rclone command line or API.

Rclone does the heavy lifting of communicating with cloud storage.

What can rclone do for you?

Rclone helps you:

  • Backup (and encrypt) files to cloud storage
  • Restore (and decrypt) files from cloud storage
  • Mirror cloud data to other cloud services or locally
  • Migrate data to cloud, or between cloud storage vendors
  • Mount multiple, encrypted, cached or diverse cloud storage as a disk
  • Analyse and account for data held on cloud storage using lsf, ljson, size, ncdu
  • Union file systems together to present multiple local and/or cloud file systems as one

Features

  • Transfers
    • MD5, SHA1 hashes are checked at all times for file integrity
    • Timestamps are preserved on files
    • Operations can be restarted at any time
    • Can be to and from network, e.g. two different cloud providers
    • Can use multi-threaded downloads to local disk
  • Copy new or changed files to cloud storage
  • Sync (one way) to make a directory identical
  • Move files to cloud storage deleting the local after verification
  • Check hashes and for missing/extra files
  • Mount your cloud storage as a network disk
  • Serve local or remote files over HTTP/WebDav/FTP/SFTP/dlna
  • Experimental Web based GUI

Supported providers

(There are many others, built on standard protocols such as
WebDAV or S3, that work out of the box.)

  • 1Fichier
  • Alibaba Cloud (Aliyun) Object Storage System (OSS)
  • Amazon Drive
  • Amazon S3
  • Backblaze B2
  • Box
  • Ceph
  • Citrix ShareFile
  • C14
  • DigitalOcean Spaces
  • Dreamhost
  • Dropbox
  • Enterprise File Fabric
  • FTP
  • Google Cloud Storage
  • Google Drive
  • Google Photos
  • HDFS
  • HTTP
  • Hubic
  • Jottacloud
  • IBM COS S3
  • Koofr
  • Mail.ru Cloud
  • Memset Memstore
  • Mega
  • Memory
  • Microsoft Azure Blob Storage
  • Microsoft OneDrive
  • Minio
  • Nextcloud
  • OVH
  • OpenDrive
  • OpenStack Swift
  • Oracle Cloud Storage
  • ownCloud
  • pCloud
  • premiumize.me
  • put.io
  • QingStor
  • Rackspace Cloud Files
  • rsync.net
  • Scaleway
  • Seafile
  • SFTP
  • StackPath
  • SugarSync
  • Tardigrade
  • Tencent Cloud Object Storage (COS)
  • Wasabi
  • WebDAV
  • Yandex Disk
  • Zoho WorkDrive
  • The local filesystem

Links

Install

Rclone is a Go program and comes as a single binary file.

Quickstart

  • Download the relevant binary.
  • Extract the rclone or rclone.exe binary from the archive
  • Run rclone config to setup. See rclone config docs for more details.

See below for some expanded Linux / macOS instructions.

See the Usage section of the docs for how to use rclone, or
run rclone -h.

Script installation

To install rclone on Linux/macOS/BSD systems, run:

curl https://rclone.org/install.sh | sudo bash

For beta installation, run:

curl https://rclone.org/install.sh | sudo bash -s beta

Note that this script checks the version of rclone installed first and
won't re-download if not needed.

Linux installation from precompiled binary

Fetch and unpack

curl -O https://downloads.rclone.org/rclone-current-linux-amd64.zip
unzip rclone-current-linux-amd64.zip
cd rclone-*-linux-amd64

Copy binary file

sudo cp rclone /usr/bin/
sudo chown root:root /usr/bin/rclone
sudo chmod 755 /usr/bin/rclone

Install manpage

sudo mkdir -p /usr/local/share/man/man1
sudo cp rclone.1 /usr/local/share/man/man1/
sudo mandb 

Run rclone config to setup. See rclone config docs for more details.

rclone config

macOS installation with brew

brew install rclone

macOS installation from precompiled binary, using curl

To avoid problems with macOS gatekeeper enforcing the binary to be signed and
notarized it is enough to download with curl.

Download the latest version of rclone.

cd && curl -O https://downloads.rclone.org/rclone-current-osx-amd64.zip

Unzip the download and cd to the extracted folder.

unzip -a rclone-current-osx-amd64.zip && cd rclone-*-osx-amd64

Move rclone to your $PATH. You will be prompted for your password.

sudo mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
sudo mv rclone /usr/local/bin/

(the mkdir command is safe to run, even if the directory already exists).

Remove the leftover files.

cd .. && rm -rf rclone-*-osx-amd64 rclone-current-osx-amd64.zip

Run rclone config to setup. See rclone config docs for more details.

rclone config

macOS installation from precompiled binary, using a web browser

When downloading a binary with a web browser, the browser will set the macOS
gatekeeper quarantine attribute. Starting from Catalina, when attempting to run
rclone, a pop-up will appear saying:

“rclone” cannot be opened because the developer cannot be verified.
macOS cannot verify that this app is free from malware.

The simplest fix is to run

xattr -d com.apple.quarantine rclone

Install with docker

The rclone maintains a docker image for rclone.
These images are autobuilt by docker hub from the rclone source based
on a minimal Alpine linux image.

The :latest tag will always point to the latest stable release. You
can use the :beta tag to get the latest build from master. You can
also use version tags, e.g. :1.49.1, :1.49 or :1.

$ docker pull rclone/rclone:latest
latest: Pulling from rclone/rclone
Digest: sha256:0e0ced72671989bb837fea8e88578b3fc48371aa45d209663683e24cfdaa0e11
...
$ docker run --rm rclone/rclone:latest version
rclone v1.49.1
- os/arch: linux/amd64
- go version: go1.12.9

There are a few command line options to consider when starting an rclone Docker container
from the rclone image.

  • You need to mount the host rclone config dir at /config/rclone into the Docker
    container. Due to the fact that rclone updates tokens inside its config file, and that
    the update process involves a file rename, you need to mount the whole host rclone
    config dir, not just the single host rclone config file.

  • You need to mount a host data dir at /data into the Docker container.

  • By default, the rclone binary inside a Docker container runs with UID=0 (root).
    As a result, all files created in a run will have UID=0. If your config and data files
    reside on the host with a non-root UID:GID, you need to pass these on the container
    start command line.

  • If you want to access the RC interface (either via the API or the Web UI), it is
    required to set the --rc-addr to :5572 in order to connect to it from outside
    the container. An explanation about why this is necessary is present here.

    • NOTE: Users running this container with the docker network set to host should
      probably set it to listen to localhost only, with 127.0.0.1:5572 as the value for
      --rc-addr
  • It is possible to use rclone mount inside a userspace Docker container, and expose
    the resulting fuse mount to the host. The exact docker run options to do that might
    vary slightly between hosts. See, e.g. the discussion in this
    thread.

    You also need to mount the host /etc/passwd and /etc/group for fuse to work inside
    the container.

Here are some commands tested on an Ubuntu 18.04.3 host:

# config on host at ~/.config/rclone/rclone.conf
# data on host at ~/data

# make sure the config is ok by listing the remotes
docker run --rm \
    --volume ~/.config/rclone:/config/rclone \
    --volume ~/data:/data:shared \
    --user $(id -u):$(id -g) \
    rclone/rclone \
    listremotes

# perform mount inside Docker container, expose result to host
mkdir -p ~/data/mount
docker run --rm \
    --volume ~/.config/rclone:/config/rclone \
    --volume ~/data:/data:shared \
    --user $(id -u):$(id -g) \
    --volume /etc/passwd:/etc/passwd:ro --volume /etc/group:/etc/group:ro \
    --device /dev/fuse --cap-add SYS_ADMIN --security-opt apparmor:unconfined \
    rclone/rclone \
    mount dropbox:Photos /data/mount &
ls ~/data/mount
kill %1

Install from source

Make sure you have at least Go 1.12
installed. Download go if necessary. The
latest release is recommended. Then

git clone https://github.com/rclone/rclone.git
cd rclone
go build
./rclone version

This will leave you a checked out version of rclone you can modify and
send pull requests with. If you use make instead of go build then
the rclone build will have the correct version information in it.

You can also build the latest stable rclone with:

go get github.com/rclone/rclone

or the latest version (equivalent to the beta) with

go get github.com/rclone/rclone@master

These will build the binary in $(go env GOPATH)/bin
(~/go/bin/rclone by default) after downloading the source to the go
module cache. Note - do not use the -u flag here. This causes go
to try to update the dependencies that rclone uses and sometimes these
don't work with the current version of rclone.

Installation with Ansible

This can be done with Stefan Weichinger's ansible
role
.

Instructions

  1. git clone https://github.com/stefangweichinger/ansible-rclone.git into your local roles-directory
  2. add the role to the hosts you want rclone installed to:
    - hosts: rclone-hosts
      roles:
          - rclone

Configure

First, you'll need to configure rclone. As the object storage systems
have quite complicated authentication these are kept in a config file.
(See the --config entry for how to find the config file and choose
its location.)

The easiest way to make the config is to run rclone with the config
option:

rclone config

See the following for detailed instructions for

Usage

Rclone syncs a directory tree from one storage system to another.

Its syntax is like this

Syntax: [options] subcommand <parameters> <parameters...>

Source and destination paths are specified by the name you gave the
storage system in the config file then the sub path, e.g.
"drive:myfolder" to look at "myfolder" in Google drive.

You can define as many storage paths as you like in the config file.

Please use the -i / --interactive flag while
learning rclone to avoid accidental data loss.

Subcommands

rclone uses a system of subcommands. For example

rclone ls remote:path # lists a remote
rclone copy /local/path remote:path # copies /local/path to the remote
rclone sync -i /local/path remote:path # syncs /local/path to the remote

rclone config

Enter an interactive configuration session.

Synopsis

Enter an interactive configuration session where you can setup new
remotes and manage existing ones. You may also set or remove a
password to protect your configuration.

rclone config [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for config

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone copy

Copy files from source to dest, skipping already copied.

Synopsis

Copy the source to the destination. Doesn't transfer
unchanged files, testing by size and modification time or
MD5SUM. Doesn't delete files from the destination.

Note that it is always the contents of the directory that is synced,
not the directory so when source:path is a directory, it's the
contents of source:path that are copied, not the directory name and
contents.

If dest:path doesn't exist, it is created and the source:path contents
go there.

For example

rclone copy source:sourcepath dest:destpath

Let's say there are two files in sourcepath

sourcepath/one.txt
sourcepath/two.txt

This copies them to

destpath/one.txt
destpath/two.txt

Not to

destpath/sourcepath/one.txt
destpath/sourcepath/two.txt

If you are familiar with rsync, rclone always works as if you had
written a trailing / - meaning "copy the contents of this directory".
This applies to all commands and whether you are talking about the
source or destination.

See the --no-traverse option for controlling
whether rclone lists the destination directory or not. Supplying this
option when copying a small number of files into a large destination
can speed transfers up greatly.

For example, if you have many files in /path/to/src but only a few of
them change every day, you can copy all the files which have changed
recently very efficiently like this:

rclone copy --max-age 24h --no-traverse /path/to/src remote:

Note: Use the -P/--progress flag to view real-time transfer statistics.

Note: Use the --dry-run or the --interactive/-i flag to test without copying anything.

rclone copy source:path dest:path [flags]

Options

      --create-empty-src-dirs   Create empty source dirs on destination after copy
  -h, --help                    help for copy

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone sync

Make source and dest identical, modifying destination only.

Synopsis

Sync the source to the destination, changing the destination
only. Doesn't transfer unchanged files, testing by size and
modification time or MD5SUM. Destination is updated to match
source, including deleting files if necessary.

Important: Since this can cause data loss, test first with the
--dry-run or the --interactive/-i flag.

rclone sync -i SOURCE remote:DESTINATION

Note that files in the destination won't be deleted if there were any
errors at any point.

It is always the contents of the directory that is synced, not the
directory so when source:path is a directory, it's the contents of
source:path that are copied, not the directory name and contents. See
extended explanation in the copy command above if unsure.

If dest:path doesn't exist, it is created and the source:path contents
go there.

Note: Use the -P/--progress flag to view real-time transfer statistics

rclone sync source:path dest:path [flags]

Options

      --create-empty-src-dirs   Create empty source dirs on destination after sync
  -h, --help                    help for sync

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone move

Move files from source to dest.

Synopsis

Moves the contents of the source directory to the destination
directory. Rclone will error if the source and destination overlap and
the remote does not support a server-side directory move operation.

If no filters are in use and if possible this will server-side move
source:path into dest:path. After this source:path will no
longer exist.

Otherwise for each file in source:path selected by the filters (if
any) this will move it into dest:path. If possible a server-side
move will be used, otherwise it will copy it (server-side if possible)
into dest:path then delete the original (if no errors on copy) in
source:path.

If you want to delete empty source directories after move, use the --delete-empty-src-dirs flag.

See the --no-traverse option for controlling
whether rclone lists the destination directory or not. Supplying this
option when moving a small number of files into a large destination
can speed transfers up greatly.

Important: Since this can cause data loss, test first with the
--dry-run or the --interactive/-i flag.

Note: Use the -P/--progress flag to view real-time transfer statistics.

rclone move source:path dest:path [flags]

Options

      --create-empty-src-dirs   Create empty source dirs on destination after move
      --delete-empty-src-dirs   Delete empty source dirs after move
  -h, --help                    help for move

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone delete

Remove the files in path.

Synopsis

Remove the files in path. Unlike purge it obeys include/exclude
filters so can be used to selectively delete files.

rclone delete only deletes files but leaves the directory structure
alone. If you want to delete a directory and all of its contents use
the purge command.

If you supply the --rmdirs flag, it will remove all empty directories along with it.
You can also use the separate command rmdir or rmdirs to
delete empty directories only.

For example, to delete all files bigger than 100MBytes, you may first want to check what
would be deleted (use either):

rclone --min-size 100M lsl remote:path
rclone --dry-run --min-size 100M delete remote:path

Then proceed with the actual delete:

rclone --min-size 100M delete remote:path

That reads "delete everything with a minimum size of 100 MB", hence
delete all files bigger than 100MBytes.

Important: Since this can cause data loss, test first with the
--dry-run or the --interactive/-i flag.

rclone delete remote:path [flags]

Options

  -h, --help     help for delete
      --rmdirs   rmdirs removes empty directories but leaves root intact

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone purge

Remove the path and all of its contents.

Synopsis

Remove the path and all of its contents. Note that this does not obey
include/exclude filters - everything will be removed. Use the delete
command if you want to selectively delete files. To delete empty directories only,
use command rmdir or rmdirs.

Important: Since this can cause data loss, test first with the
--dry-run or the --interactive/-i flag.

rclone purge remote:path [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for purge

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone mkdir

Make the path if it doesn't already exist.

rclone mkdir remote:path [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for mkdir

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone rmdir

Remove the empty directory at path.

Synopsis

This removes empty directory given by path. Will not remove the path if it
has any objects in it, not even empty subdirectories. Use
command rmdirs (or delete with option --rmdirs)
to do that.

To delete a path and any objects in it, use purge command.

rclone rmdir remote:path [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for rmdir

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone check

Checks the files in the source and destination match.

Synopsis

Checks the files in the source and destination match. It compares
sizes and hashes (MD5 or SHA1) and logs a report of files which don't
match. It doesn't alter the source or destination.

If you supply the --size-only flag, it will only compare the sizes not
the hashes as well. Use this for a quick check.

If you supply the --download flag, it will download the data from
both remotes and check them against each other on the fly. This can
be useful for remotes that don't support hashes or if you really want
to check all the data.

If you supply the --one-way flag, it will only check that files in
the source match the files in the destination, not the other way
around. This means that extra files in the destination that are not in
the source will not be detected.

The --differ, --missing-on-dst, --missing-on-src, --match
and --error flags write paths, one per line, to the file name (or
stdout if it is -) supplied. What they write is described in the
help below. For example --differ will write all paths which are
present on both the source and destination but different.

The --combined flag will write a file (or stdout) which contains all
file paths with a symbol and then a space and then the path to tell
you what happened to it. These are reminiscent of diff files.

  • = path means path was found in source and destination and was identical
  • - path means path was missing on the source, so only in the destination
  • + path means path was missing on the destination, so only in the source
  • * path means path was present in source and destination but different.
  • ! path means there was an error reading or hashing the source or dest.
rclone check source:path dest:path [flags]

Options

      --combined string         Make a combined report of changes to this file
      --differ string           Report all non-matching files to this file
      --download                Check by downloading rather than with hash.
      --error string            Report all files with errors (hashing or reading) to this file
  -h, --help                    help for check
      --match string            Report all matching files to this file
      --missing-on-dst string   Report all files missing from the destination to this file
      --missing-on-src string   Report all files missing from the source to this file
      --one-way                 Check one way only, source files must exist on remote

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone ls

List the objects in the path with size and path.

Synopsis

Lists the objects in the source path to standard output in a human
readable format with size and path. Recurses by default.

Eg

$ rclone ls swift:bucket
    60295 bevajer5jef
    90613 canole
    94467 diwogej7
    37600 fubuwic

Any of the filtering options can be applied to this command.

There are several related list commands

  • ls to list size and path of objects only
  • lsl to list modification time, size and path of objects only
  • lsd to list directories only
  • lsf to list objects and directories in easy to parse format
  • lsjson to list objects and directories in JSON format

ls,lsl,lsd are designed to be human readable.
lsf is designed to be human and machine readable.
lsjson is designed to be machine readable.

Note that ls and lsl recurse by default - use --max-depth 1 to stop the recursion.

The other list commands lsd,lsf,lsjson do not recurse by default - use -R to make them recurse.

Listing a non existent directory will produce an error except for
remotes which can't have empty directories (e.g. s3, swift, or gcs -
the bucket based remotes).

rclone ls remote:path [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for ls

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone lsd

List all directories/containers/buckets in the path.

Synopsis

Lists the directories in the source path to standard output. Does not
recurse by default. Use the -R flag to recurse.

This command lists the total size of the directory (if known, -1 if
not), the modification time (if known, the current time if not), the
number of objects in the directory (if known, -1 if not) and the name
of the directory, Eg

$ rclone lsd swift:
      494000 2018-04-26 08:43:20     10000 10000files
          65 2018-04-26 08:43:20         1 1File

Or

$ rclone lsd drive:test
          -1 2016-10-17 17:41:53        -1 1000files
          -1 2017-01-03 14:40:54        -1 2500files
          -1 2017-07-08 14:39:28        -1 4000files

If you just want the directory names use "rclone lsf --dirs-only".

Any of the filtering options can be applied to this command.

There are several related list commands

  • ls to list size and path of objects only
  • lsl to list modification time, size and path of objects only
  • lsd to list directories only
  • lsf to list objects and directories in easy to parse format
  • lsjson to list objects and directories in JSON format

ls,lsl,lsd are designed to be human readable.
lsf is designed to be human and machine readable.
lsjson is designed to be machine readable.

Note that ls and lsl recurse by default - use --max-depth 1 to stop the recursion.

The other list commands lsd,lsf,lsjson do not recurse by default - use -R to make them recurse.

Listing a non existent directory will produce an error except for
remotes which can't have empty directories (e.g. s3, swift, or gcs -
the bucket based remotes).

rclone lsd remote:path [flags]

Options

  -h, --help        help for lsd
  -R, --recursive   Recurse into the listing.

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone lsl

List the objects in path with modification time, size and path.

Synopsis

Lists the objects in the source path to standard output in a human
readable format with modification time, size and path. Recurses by default.

Eg

$ rclone lsl swift:bucket
    60295 2016-06-25 18:55:41.062626927 bevajer5jef
    90613 2016-06-25 18:55:43.302607074 canole
    94467 2016-06-25 18:55:43.046609333 diwogej7
    37600 2016-06-25 18:55:40.814629136 fubuwic

Any of the filtering options can be applied to this command.

There are several related list commands

  • ls to list size and path of objects only
  • lsl to list modification time, size and path of objects only
  • lsd to list directories only
  • lsf to list objects and directories in easy to parse format
  • lsjson to list objects and directories in JSON format

ls,lsl,lsd are designed to be human readable.
lsf is designed to be human and machine readable.
lsjson is designed to be machine readable.

Note that ls and lsl recurse by default - use --max-depth 1 to stop the recursion.

The other list commands lsd,lsf,lsjson do not recurse by default - use -R to make them recurse.

Listing a non existent directory will produce an error except for
remotes which can't have empty directories (e.g. s3, swift, or gcs -
the bucket based remotes).

rclone lsl remote:path [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for lsl

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone md5sum

Produces an md5sum file for all the objects in the path.

Synopsis

Produces an md5sum file for all the objects in the path. This
is in the same format as the standard md5sum tool produces.

By default, the hash is requested from the remote. If MD5 is
not supported by the remote, no hash will be returned. With the
download flag, the file will be downloaded from the remote and
hashed locally enabling MD5 for any remote.

rclone md5sum remote:path [flags]

Options

      --base64               Output base64 encoded hashsum
      --download             Download the file and hash it locally; if this flag is not specified, the hash is requested from the remote
  -h, --help                 help for md5sum
      --output-file string   Output hashsums to a file rather than the terminal

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone sha1sum

Produces an sha1sum file for all the objects in the path.

Synopsis

Produces an sha1sum file for all the objects in the path. This
is in the same format as the standard sha1sum tool produces.

By default, the hash is requested from the remote. If SHA-1 is
not supported by the remote, no hash will be returned. With the
download flag, the file will be downloaded from the remote and
hashed locally enabling SHA-1 for any remote.

rclone sha1sum remote:path [flags]

Options

      --base64               Output base64 encoded hashsum
      --download             Download the file and hash it locally; if this flag is not specified, the hash is requested from the remote
  -h, --help                 help for sha1sum
      --output-file string   Output hashsums to a file rather than the terminal

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone size

Prints the total size and number of objects in remote:path.

rclone size remote:path [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for size
      --json   format output as JSON

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone version

Show the version number.

Synopsis

Show the version number, the go version and the architecture.

Eg

$ rclone version
rclone v1.41
- os/arch: linux/amd64
- go version: go1.10

If you supply the --check flag, then it will do an online check to
compare your version with the latest release and the latest beta.

$ rclone version --check
yours:  1.42.0.6
latest: 1.42          (released 2018-06-16)
beta:   1.42.0.5      (released 2018-06-17)

Or

$ rclone version --check
yours:  1.41
latest: 1.42          (released 2018-06-16)
  upgrade: https://downloads.rclone.org/v1.42
beta:   1.42.0.5      (released 2018-06-17)
  upgrade: https://beta.rclone.org/v1.42-005-g56e1e820
rclone version [flags]

Options

      --check   Check for new version.
  -h, --help    help for version

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone cleanup

Clean up the remote if possible.

Synopsis

Clean up the remote if possible. Empty the trash or delete old file
versions. Not supported by all remotes.

rclone cleanup remote:path [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for cleanup

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone dedupe

Interactively find duplicate filenames and delete/rename them.

Synopsis

By default dedupe interactively finds files with duplicate
names and offers to delete all but one or rename them to be
different. This is known as deduping by name.

Deduping by name is only useful with backends like Google Drive which
can have duplicate file names. It can be run on wrapping backends
(e.g. crypt) if they wrap a backend which supports duplicate file
names.

However if --by-hash is passed in then dedupe will find files with
duplicate hashes instead which will work on any backend which supports
at least one hash. This can be used to find files with duplicate
content. This is known as deduping by hash.

If deduping by name, first rclone will merge directories with the same
name. It will do this iteratively until all the identically named
directories have been merged.

Next, if deduping by name, for every group of duplicate file names /
hashes, it will delete all but one identical files it finds without
confirmation. This means that for most duplicated files the dedupe command will not be interactive.

dedupe considers files to be identical if they have the
same file path and the same hash. If the backend does not support hashes (e.g. crypt wrapping
Google Drive) then they will never be found to be identical. If you
use the --size-only flag then files will be considered
identical if they have the same size (any hash will be ignored). This
can be useful on crypt backends which do not support hashes.

Next rclone will resolve the remaining duplicates. Exactly which
action is taken depends on the dedupe mode. By default rclone will
interactively query the user for each one.

Important: Since this can cause data loss, test first with the
--dry-run or the --interactive/-i flag.

Here is an example run.

Before - with duplicates

$ rclone lsl drive:dupes
  6048320 2016-03-05 16:23:16.798000000 one.txt
  6048320 2016-03-05 16:23:11.775000000 one.txt
   564374 2016-03-05 16:23:06.731000000 one.txt
  6048320 2016-03-05 16:18:26.092000000 one.txt
  6048320 2016-03-05 16:22:46.185000000 two.txt
  1744073 2016-03-05 16:22:38.104000000 two.txt
   564374 2016-03-05 16:22:52.118000000 two.txt

Now the dedupe session

$ rclone dedupe drive:dupes
2016/03/05 16:24:37 Google drive root 'dupes': Looking for duplicates using interactive mode.
one.txt: Found 4 files with duplicate names
one.txt: Deleting 2/3 identical duplicates (MD5 "1eedaa9fe86fd4b8632e2ac549403b36")
one.txt: 2 duplicates remain
  1:      6048320 bytes, 2016-03-05 16:23:16.798000000, MD5 1eedaa9fe86fd4b8632e2ac549403b36
  2:       564374 bytes, 2016-03-05 16:23:06.731000000, MD5 7594e7dc9fc28f727c42ee3e0749de81
s) Skip and do nothing
k) Keep just one (choose which in next step)
r) Rename all to be different (by changing file.jpg to file-1.jpg)
s/k/r> k
Enter the number of the file to keep> 1
one.txt: Deleted 1 extra copies
two.txt: Found 3 files with duplicate names
two.txt: 3 duplicates remain
  1:       564374 bytes, 2016-03-05 16:22:52.118000000, MD5 7594e7dc9fc28f727c42ee3e0749de81
  2:      6048320 bytes, 2016-03-05 16:22:46.185000000, MD5 1eedaa9fe86fd4b8632e2ac549403b36
  3:      1744073 bytes, 2016-03-05 16:22:38.104000000, MD5 851957f7fb6f0bc4ce76be966d336802
s) Skip and do nothing
k) Keep just one (choose which in next step)
r) Rename all to be different (by changing file.jpg to file-1.jpg)
s/k/r> r
two-1.txt: renamed from: two.txt
two-2.txt: renamed from: two.txt
two-3.txt: renamed from: two.txt

The result being

$ rclone lsl drive:dupes
  6048320 2016-03-05 16:23:16.798000000 one.txt
   564374 2016-03-05 16:22:52.118000000 two-1.txt
  6048320 2016-03-05 16:22:46.185000000 two-2.txt
  1744073 2016-03-05 16:22:38.104000000 two-3.txt

Dedupe can be run non interactively using the --dedupe-mode flag or by using an extra parameter with the same value

  • --dedupe-mode interactive - interactive as above.
  • --dedupe-mode skip - removes identical files then skips anything left.
  • --dedupe-mode first - removes identical files then keeps the first one.
  • --dedupe-mode newest - removes identical files then keeps the newest one.
  • --dedupe-mode oldest - removes identical files then keeps the oldest one.
  • --dedupe-mode largest - removes identical files then keeps the largest one.
  • --dedupe-mode smallest - removes identical files then keeps the smallest one.
  • --dedupe-mode rename - removes identical files then renames the rest to be different.
  • --dedupe-mode list - lists duplicate dirs and files only and changes nothing.

For example to rename all the identically named photos in your Google Photos directory, do

rclone dedupe --dedupe-mode rename "drive:Google Photos"

Or

rclone dedupe rename "drive:Google Photos"
rclone dedupe [mode] remote:path [flags]

Options

      --by-hash              Find indentical hashes rather than names
      --dedupe-mode string   Dedupe mode interactive|skip|first|newest|oldest|largest|smallest|rename. (default "interactive")
  -h, --help                 help for dedupe

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone about

Get quota information from the remote.

Synopsis

rclone aboutprints quota information about a remote to standard
output. The output is typically used, free, quota and trash contents.

E.g. Typical output fromrclone about remote:is:

Total:   17G
Used:    7.444G
Free:    1.315G
Trashed: 100.000M
Other:   8.241G

Where the fields are:

  • Total: total size available.
  • Used: total size used
  • Free: total space available to this user.
  • Trashed: total space used by trash
  • Other: total amount in other storage (e.g. Gmail, Google Photos)
  • Objects: total number of objects in the storage

Not all backends print all fields. Information is not included if it is not
provided by a backend. Where the value is unlimited it is omitted.

Applying a --full flag to the command prints the bytes in full, e.g.

Total:   18253611008
Used:    7993453766
Free:    1411001220
Trashed: 104857602
Other:   8849156022

A --jsonflag generates conveniently computer readable output, e.g.

{
    "total": 18253611008,
    "used": 7993453766,
    "trashed": 104857602,
    "other": 8849156022,
    "free": 1411001220
}

Not all backends support the rclone about command.

See List of backends that do not support about

rclone about remote: [flags]

Options

      --full   Full numbers instead of SI units
  -h, --help   help for about
      --json   Format output as JSON

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone authorize

Remote authorization.

Synopsis

Remote authorization. Used to authorize a remote or headless
rclone from a machine with a browser - use as instructed by
rclone config.

Use the --auth-no-open-browser to prevent rclone to open auth
link in default browser automatically.

rclone authorize [flags]

Options

      --auth-no-open-browser   Do not automatically open auth link in default browser
  -h, --help                   help for authorize

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone backend

Run a backend specific command.

Synopsis

This runs a backend specific command. The commands themselves (except
for "help" and "features") are defined by the backends and you should
see the backend docs for definitions.

You can discover what commands a backend implements by using

rclone backend help remote:
rclone backend help <backendname>

You can also discover information about the backend using (see
operations/fsinfo in the remote control docs
for more info).

rclone backend features remote:

Pass options to the backend command with -o. This should be key=value or key, e.g.:

rclone backend stats remote:path stats -o format=json -o long

Pass arguments to the backend by placing them on the end of the line

rclone backend cleanup remote:path file1 file2 file3

Note to run these commands on a running backend then see
backend/command in the rc docs.

rclone backend <command> remote:path [opts] <args> [flags]

Options

  -h, --help                 help for backend
      --json                 Always output in JSON format.
  -o, --option stringArray   Option in the form name=value or name.

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone cat

Concatenates any files and sends them to stdout.

Synopsis

rclone cat sends any files to standard output.

You can use it like this to output a single file

rclone cat remote:path/to/file

Or like this to output any file in dir or its subdirectories.

rclone cat remote:path/to/dir

Or like this to output any .txt files in dir or its subdirectories.

rclone --include "*.txt" cat remote:path/to/dir

Use the --head flag to print characters only at the start, --tail for
the end and --offset and --count to print a section in the middle.
Note that if offset is negative it will count from the end, so
--offset -1 --count 1 is equivalent to --tail 1.

rclone cat remote:path [flags]

Options

      --count int    Only print N characters. (default -1)
      --discard      Discard the output instead of printing.
      --head int     Only print the first N characters.
  -h, --help         help for cat
      --offset int   Start printing at offset N (or from end if -ve).
      --tail int     Only print the last N characters.

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone config create

Create a new remote with name, type and options.

Synopsis

Create a new remote of name with type and options. The options
should be passed in pairs of key value.

For example to make a swift remote of name myremote using auto config
you would do:

rclone config create myremote swift env_auth true

Note that if the config process would normally ask a question the
default is taken. Each time that happens rclone will print a message
saying how to affect the value taken.

If any of the parameters passed is a password field, then rclone will
automatically obscure them if they aren't already obscured before
putting them in the config file.

NB If the password parameter is 22 characters or longer and
consists only of base64 characters then rclone can get confused about
whether the password is already obscured or not and put unobscured
passwords into the config file. If you want to be 100% certain that
the passwords get obscured then use the "--obscure" flag, or if you
are 100% certain you are already passing obscured passwords then use
"--no-obscure". You can also set obscured passwords using the
"rclone config password" command.

So for example if you wanted to configure a Google Drive remote but
using remote authorization you would do this:

rclone config create mydrive drive config_is_local false
rclone config create `name` `type` [`key` `value`]* [flags]

Options

  -h, --help         help for create
      --no-obscure   Force any passwords not to be obscured.
      --obscure      Force any passwords to be obscured.

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone config delete

Delete an existing remote name.

rclone config delete `name` [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for delete

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone config disconnect

Disconnects user from remote

Synopsis

This disconnects the remote: passed in to the cloud storage system.

This normally means revoking the oauth token.

To reconnect use "rclone config reconnect".

rclone config disconnect remote: [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for disconnect

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone config dump

Dump the config file as JSON.

rclone config dump [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for dump

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone config edit

Enter an interactive configuration session.

Synopsis

Enter an interactive configuration session where you can setup new
remotes and manage existing ones. You may also set or remove a
password to protect your configuration.

rclone config edit [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for edit

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone config file

Show path of configuration file in use.

rclone config file [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for file

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone config password

Update password in an existing remote.

Synopsis

Update an existing remote's password. The password
should be passed in pairs of key value.

For example to set password of a remote of name myremote you would do:

rclone config password myremote fieldname mypassword

This command is obsolete now that "config update" and "config create"
both support obscuring passwords directly.

rclone config password `name` [`key` `value`]+ [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for password

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone config providers

List in JSON format all the providers and options.

rclone config providers [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for providers

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone config reconnect

Re-authenticates user with remote.

Synopsis

This reconnects remote: passed in to the cloud storage system.

To disconnect the remote use "rclone config disconnect".

This normally means going through the interactive oauth flow again.

rclone config reconnect remote: [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for reconnect

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone config show

Print (decrypted) config file, or the config for a single remote.

rclone config show [<remote>] [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for show

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone config update

Update options in an existing remote.

Synopsis

Update an existing remote's options. The options should be passed in
in pairs of key value.

For example to update the env_auth field of a remote of name myremote
you would do:

rclone config update myremote swift env_auth true

If any of the parameters passed is a password field, then rclone will
automatically obscure them if they aren't already obscured before
putting them in the config file.

NB If the password parameter is 22 characters or longer and
consists only of base64 characters then rclone can get confused about
whether the password is already obscured or not and put unobscured
passwords into the config file. If you want to be 100% certain that
the passwords get obscured then use the "--obscure" flag, or if you
are 100% certain you are already passing obscured passwords then use
"--no-obscure". You can also set obscured passwords using the
"rclone config password" command.

If the remote uses OAuth the token will be updated, if you don't
require this add an extra parameter thus:

rclone config update myremote swift env_auth true config_refresh_token false
rclone config update `name` [`key` `value`]+ [flags]

Options

  -h, --help         help for update
      --no-obscure   Force any passwords not to be obscured.
      --obscure      Force any passwords to be obscured.

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone config userinfo

Prints info about logged in user of remote.

Synopsis

This prints the details of the person logged in to the cloud storage
system.

rclone config userinfo remote: [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for userinfo
      --json   Format output as JSON

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone copyto

Copy files from source to dest, skipping already copied.

Synopsis

If source:path is a file or directory then it copies it to a file or
directory named dest:path.

This can be used to upload single files to other than their current
name. If the source is a directory then it acts exactly like the copy
command.

So

rclone copyto src dst

where src and dst are rclone paths, either remote:path or
/path/to/local or C:\windows\path\if\on\windows.

This will:

if src is file
    copy it to dst, overwriting an existing file if it exists
if src is directory
    copy it to dst, overwriting existing files if they exist
    see copy command for full details

This doesn't transfer unchanged files, testing by size and
modification time or MD5SUM. It doesn't delete files from the
destination.

Note: Use the -P/--progress flag to view real-time transfer statistics

rclone copyto source:path dest:path [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for copyto

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone copyurl

Copy url content to dest.

Synopsis

Download a URL's content and copy it to the destination without saving
it in temporary storage.

Setting --auto-filename will cause the file name to be retrieved from
the from URL (after any redirections) and used in the destination
path.

Setting --no-clobber will prevent overwriting file on the
destination if there is one with the same name.

Setting --stdout or making the output file name "-" will cause the
output to be written to standard output.

rclone copyurl https://example.com dest:path [flags]

Options

  -a, --auto-filename   Get the file name from the URL and use it for destination file path
  -h, --help            help for copyurl
      --no-clobber      Prevent overwriting file with same name
      --stdout          Write the output to stdout rather than a file

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone cryptcheck

Cryptcheck checks the integrity of a crypted remote.

Synopsis

rclone cryptcheck checks a remote against a crypted remote. This is
the equivalent of running rclone check, but able to check the
checksums of the crypted remote.

For it to work the underlying remote of the cryptedremote must support
some kind of checksum.

It works by reading the nonce from each file on the cryptedremote: and
using that to encrypt each file on the remote:. It then checks the
checksum of the underlying file on the cryptedremote: against the
checksum of the file it has just encrypted.

Use it like this

rclone cryptcheck /path/to/files encryptedremote:path

You can use it like this also, but that will involve downloading all
the files in remote:path.

rclone cryptcheck remote:path encryptedremote:path

After it has run it will log the status of the encryptedremote:.

If you supply the --one-way flag, it will only check that files in
the source match the files in the destination, not the other way
around. This means that extra files in the destination that are not in
the source will not be detected.

The --differ, --missing-on-dst, --missing-on-src, --match
and --error flags write paths, one per line, to the file name (or
stdout if it is -) supplied. What they write is described in the
help below. For example --differ will write all paths which are
present on both the source and destination but different.

The --combined flag will write a file (or stdout) which contains all
file paths with a symbol and then a space and then the path to tell
you what happened to it. These are reminiscent of diff files.

  • = path means path was found in source and destination and was identical
  • - path means path was missing on the source, so only in the destination
  • + path means path was missing on the destination, so only in the source
  • * path means path was present in source and destination but different.
  • ! path means there was an error reading or hashing the source or dest.
rclone cryptcheck remote:path cryptedremote:path [flags]

Options

      --combined string         Make a combined report of changes to this file
      --differ string           Report all non-matching files to this file
      --error string            Report all files with errors (hashing or reading) to this file
  -h, --help                    help for cryptcheck
      --match string            Report all matching files to this file
      --missing-on-dst string   Report all files missing from the destination to this file
      --missing-on-src string   Report all files missing from the source to this file
      --one-way                 Check one way only, source files must exist on remote

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone cryptdecode

Cryptdecode returns unencrypted file names.

Synopsis

rclone cryptdecode returns unencrypted file names when provided with
a list of encrypted file names. List limit is 10 items.

If you supply the --reverse flag, it will return encrypted file names.

use it like this

rclone cryptdecode encryptedremote: encryptedfilename1 encryptedfilename2

rclone cryptdecode --reverse encryptedremote: filename1 filename2

Another way to accomplish this is by using the rclone backend encode (or decode)command.
See the documentation on the crypt overlay for more info.

rclone cryptdecode encryptedremote: encryptedfilename [flags]

Options

  -h, --help      help for cryptdecode
      --reverse   Reverse cryptdecode, encrypts filenames

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone deletefile

Remove a single file from remote.

Synopsis

Remove a single file from remote. Unlike delete it cannot be used to
remove a directory and it doesn't obey include/exclude filters - if the specified file exists,
it will always be removed.

rclone deletefile remote:path [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for deletefile

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone genautocomplete

Output completion script for a given shell.

Synopsis

Generates a shell completion script for rclone.
Run with --help to list the supported shells.

Options

  -h, --help   help for genautocomplete

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone genautocomplete bash

Output bash completion script for rclone.

Synopsis

Generates a bash shell autocompletion script for rclone.

This writes to /etc/bash_completion.d/rclone by default so will
probably need to be run with sudo or as root, e.g.

sudo rclone genautocomplete bash

Logout and login again to use the autocompletion scripts, or source
them directly

. /etc/bash_completion

If you supply a command line argument the script will be written
there.

If output_file is "-", then the output will be written to stdout.

rclone genautocomplete bash [output_file] [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for bash

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone genautocomplete fish

Output fish completion script for rclone.

Synopsis

Generates a fish autocompletion script for rclone.

This writes to /etc/fish/completions/rclone.fish by default so will
probably need to be run with sudo or as root, e.g.

sudo rclone genautocomplete fish

Logout and login again to use the autocompletion scripts, or source
them directly

. /etc/fish/completions/rclone.fish

If you supply a command line argument the script will be written
there.

If output_file is "-", then the output will be written to stdout.

rclone genautocomplete fish [output_file] [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for fish

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone genautocomplete zsh

Output zsh completion script for rclone.

Synopsis

Generates a zsh autocompletion script for rclone.

This writes to /usr/share/zsh/vendor-completions/_rclone by default so will
probably need to be run with sudo or as root, e.g.

sudo rclone genautocomplete zsh

Logout and login again to use the autocompletion scripts, or source
them directly

autoload -U compinit && compinit

If you supply a command line argument the script will be written
there.

If output_file is "-", then the output will be written to stdout.

rclone genautocomplete zsh [output_file] [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for zsh

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone gendocs

Output markdown docs for rclone to the directory supplied.

Synopsis

This produces markdown docs for the rclone commands to the directory
supplied. These are in a format suitable for hugo to render into the
rclone.org website.

rclone gendocs output_directory [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for gendocs

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone hashsum

Produces a hashsum file for all the objects in the path.

Synopsis

Produces a hash file for all the objects in the path using the hash
named. The output is in the same format as the standard
md5sum/sha1sum tool.

By default, the hash is requested from the remote. If the hash is
not supported by the remote, no hash will be returned. With the
download flag, the file will be downloaded from the remote and
hashed locally enabling any hash for any remote.

Run without a hash to see the list of all supported hashes, e.g.

$ rclone hashsum
Supported hashes are:
  * MD5
  * SHA-1
  * DropboxHash
  * QuickXorHash

Then

$ rclone hashsum MD5 remote:path
rclone hashsum <hash> remote:path [flags]

Options

      --base64               Output base64 encoded hashsum
      --download             Download the file and hash it locally; if this flag is not specified, the hash is requested from the remote
  -h, --help                 help for hashsum
      --output-file string   Output hashsums to a file rather than the terminal

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone link

Generate public link to file/folder.

Synopsis

rclone link will create, retrieve or remove a public link to the given
file or folder.

rclone link remote:path/to/file
rclone link remote:path/to/folder/
rclone link --unlink remote:path/to/folder/
rclone link --expire 1d remote:path/to/file

If you supply the --expire flag, it will set the expiration time
otherwise it will use the default (100 years). Note not all
backends support the --expire flag - if the backend doesn't support it
then the link returned won't expire.

Use the --unlink flag to remove existing public links to the file or
folder. Note not all backends support "--unlink" flag - those that
don't will just ignore it.

If successful, the last line of the output will contain the
link. Exact capabilities depend on the remote, but the link will
always by default be created with the least constraints e.g. no
expiry, no password protection, accessible without account.

rclone link remote:path [flags]

Options

      --expire Duration   The amount of time that the link will be valid (default 100y)
  -h, --help              help for link
      --unlink            Remove existing public link to file/folder

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone listremotes

List all the remotes in the config file.

Synopsis

rclone listremotes lists all the available remotes from the config file.

When uses with the -l flag it lists the types too.

rclone listremotes [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for listremotes
      --long   Show the type as well as names.

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone lsf

List directories and objects in remote:path formatted for parsing.

Synopsis

List the contents of the source path (directories and objects) to
standard output in a form which is easy to parse by scripts. By
default this will just be the names of the objects and directories,
one per line. The directories will have a / suffix.

Eg

$ rclone lsf swift:bucket
bevajer5jef
canole
diwogej7
ferejej3gux/
fubuwic

Use the --format option to control what gets listed. By default this
is just the path, but you can use these parameters to control the
output:

p - path
s - size
t - modification time
h - hash
i - ID of object
o - Original ID of underlying object
m - MimeType of object if known
e - encrypted name
T - tier of storage if known, e.g. "Hot" or "Cool"

So if you wanted the path, size and modification time, you would use
--format "pst", or maybe --format "tsp" to put the path last.

Eg

$ rclone lsf  --format "tsp" swift:bucket
2016-06-25 18:55:41;60295;bevajer5jef
2016-06-25 18:55:43;90613;canole
2016-06-25 18:55:43;94467;diwogej7
2018-04-26 08:50:45;0;ferejej3gux/
2016-06-25 18:55:40;37600;fubuwic

If you specify "h" in the format you will get the MD5 hash by default,
use the "--hash" flag to change which hash you want. Note that this
can be returned as an empty string if it isn't available on the object
(and for directories), "ERROR" if there was an error reading it from
the object and "UNSUPPORTED" if that object does not support that hash
type.

For example to emulate the md5sum command you can use

rclone lsf -R --hash MD5 --format hp --separator "  " --files-only .

Eg

$ rclone lsf -R --hash MD5 --format hp --separator "  " --files-only swift:bucket 
7908e352297f0f530b84a756f188baa3  bevajer5jef
cd65ac234e6fea5925974a51cdd865cc  canole
03b5341b4f234b9d984d03ad076bae91  diwogej7
8fd37c3810dd660778137ac3a66cc06d  fubuwic
99713e14a4c4ff553acaf1930fad985b  gixacuh7ku

(Though "rclone md5sum ." is an easier way of typing this.)

By default the separator is ";" this can be changed with the
--separator flag. Note that separators aren't escaped in the path so
putting it last is a good strategy.

Eg

$ rclone lsf  --separator "," --format "tshp" swift:bucket
2016-06-25 18:55:41,60295,7908e352297f0f530b84a756f188baa3,bevajer5jef
2016-06-25 18:55:43,90613,cd65ac234e6fea5925974a51cdd865cc,canole
2016-06-25 18:55:43,94467,03b5341b4f234b9d984d03ad076bae91,diwogej7
2018-04-26 08:52:53,0,,ferejej3gux/
2016-06-25 18:55:40,37600,8fd37c3810dd660778137ac3a66cc06d,fubuwic

You can output in CSV standard format. This will escape things in "
if they contain ,

Eg

$ rclone lsf --csv --files-only --format ps remote:path
test.log,22355
test.sh,449
"this file contains a comma, in the file name.txt",6

Note that the --absolute parameter is useful for making lists of files
to pass to an rclone copy with the --files-from-raw flag.

For example to find all the files modified within one day and copy
those only (without traversing the whole directory structure):

rclone lsf --absolute --files-only --max-age 1d /path/to/local > new_files
rclone copy --files-from-raw new_files /path/to/local remote:path

Any of the filtering options can be applied to this command.

There are several related list commands

  • ls to list size and path of objects only
  • lsl to list modification time, size and path of objects only
  • lsd to list directories only
  • lsf to list objects and directories in easy to parse format
  • lsjson to list objects and directories in JSON format

ls,lsl,lsd are designed to be human readable.
lsf is designed to be human and machine readable.
lsjson is designed to be machine readable.

Note that ls and lsl recurse by default - use --max-depth 1 to stop the recursion.

The other list commands lsd,lsf,lsjson do not recurse by default - use -R to make them recurse.

Listing a non existent directory will produce an error except for
remotes which can't have empty directories (e.g. s3, swift, or gcs -
the bucket based remotes).

rclone lsf remote:path [flags]

Options

      --absolute           Put a leading / in front of path names.
      --csv                Output in CSV format.
  -d, --dir-slash          Append a slash to directory names. (default true)
      --dirs-only          Only list directories.
      --files-only         Only list files.
  -F, --format string      Output format - see  help for details (default "p")
      --hash h             Use this hash when h is used in the format MD5|SHA-1|DropboxHash (default "MD5")
  -h, --help               help for lsf
  -R, --recursive          Recurse into the listing.
  -s, --separator string   Separator for the items in the format. (default ";")

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone lsjson

List directories and objects in the path in JSON format.

Synopsis

List directories and objects in the path in JSON format.

The output is an array of Items, where each Item looks like this

{
"Hashes" : {
"SHA-1" : "f572d396fae9206628714fb2ce00f72e94f2258f",
"MD5" : "b1946ac92492d2347c6235b4d2611184",
"DropboxHash" : "ecb65bb98f9d905b70458986c39fcbad7715e5f2fcc3b1f07767d7c83e2438cc"
},
"ID": "y2djkhiujf83u33",
"OrigID": "UYOJVTUW00Q1RzTDA",
"IsBucket" : false,
"IsDir" : false,
"MimeType" : "application/octet-stream",
"ModTime" : "2017-05-31T16:15:57.034468261+01:00",
"Name" : "file.txt",
"Encrypted" : "v0qpsdq8anpci8n929v3uu9338",
"EncryptedPath" : "kja9098349023498/v0qpsdq8anpci8n929v3uu9338",
"Path" : "full/path/goes/here/file.txt",
"Size" : 6,
"Tier" : "hot",
}

If --hash is not specified the Hashes property won't be emitted. The
types of hash can be specified with the --hash-type parameter (which
may be repeated). If --hash-type is set then it implies --hash.

If --no-modtime is specified then ModTime will be blank. This can
speed things up on remotes where reading the ModTime takes an extra
request (e.g. s3, swift).

If --no-mimetype is specified then MimeType will be blank. This can
speed things up on remotes where reading the MimeType takes an extra
request (e.g. s3, swift).

If --encrypted is not specified the Encrypted won't be emitted.

If --dirs-only is not specified files in addition to directories are
returned

If --files-only is not specified directories in addition to the files
will be returned.

The Path field will only show folders below the remote path being listed.
If "remote:path" contains the file "subfolder/file.txt", the Path for "file.txt"
will be "subfolder/file.txt", not "remote:path/subfolder/file.txt".
When used without --recursive the Path will always be the same as Name.

If the directory is a bucket in a bucket based backend, then
"IsBucket" will be set to true. This key won't be present unless it is
"true".

The time is in RFC3339 format with up to nanosecond precision. The
number of decimal digits in the seconds will depend on the precision
that the remote can hold the times, so if times are accurate to the
nearest millisecond (e.g. Google Drive) then 3 digits will always be
shown ("2017-05-31T16:15:57.034+01:00") whereas if the times are
accurate to the nearest second (Dropbox, Box, WebDav, etc.) no digits
will be shown ("2017-05-31T16:15:57+01:00").

The whole output can be processed as a JSON blob, or alternatively it
can be processed line by line as each item is written one to a line.

Any of the filtering options can be applied to this command.

There are several related list commands

  • ls to list size and path of objects only
  • lsl to list modification time, size and path of objects only
  • lsd to list directories only
  • lsf to list objects and directories in easy to parse format
  • lsjson to list objects and directories in JSON format

ls,lsl,lsd are designed to be human readable.
lsf is designed to be human and machine readable.
lsjson is designed to be machine readable.

Note that ls and lsl recurse by default - use --max-depth 1 to stop the recursion.

The other list commands lsd,lsf,lsjson do not recurse by default - use -R to make them recurse.

Listing a non existent directory will produce an error except for
remotes which can't have empty directories (e.g. s3, swift, or gcs -
the bucket based remotes).

rclone lsjson remote:path [flags]

Options

      --dirs-only               Show only directories in the listing.
  -M, --encrypted               Show the encrypted names.
      --files-only              Show only files in the listing.
      --hash                    Include hashes in the output (may take longer).
      --hash-type stringArray   Show only this hash type (may be repeated).
  -h, --help                    help for lsjson
      --no-mimetype             Don't read the mime type (can speed things up).
      --no-modtime              Don't read the modification time (can speed things up).
      --original                Show the ID of the underlying Object.
  -R, --recursive               Recurse into the listing.

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone mount

Mount the remote as file system on a mountpoint.

Synopsis

rclone mount allows Linux, FreeBSD, macOS and Windows to
mount any of Rclone's cloud storage systems as a file system with
FUSE.

First set up your remote using rclone config. Check it works with rclone ls etc.

On Linux and OSX, you can either run mount in foreground mode or background (daemon) mode.
Mount runs in foreground mode by default, use the --daemon flag to specify background mode.
You can only run mount in foreground mode on Windows.

On Linux/macOS/FreeBSD start the mount like this, where /path/to/local/mount
is an empty existing directory:

rclone mount remote:path/to/files /path/to/local/mount

On Windows you can start a mount in different ways. See below
for details. The following examples will mount to an automatically assigned drive,
to specific drive letter X:, to path C:\path\to\nonexistent\directory
(which must be non-existent subdirectory of an existing parent directory or drive,
and is not supported when mounting as a network drive), and
the last example will mount as network share \\cloud\remote and map it to an
automatically assigned drive:

rclone mount remote:path/to/files *
rclone mount remote:path/to/files X:
rclone mount remote:path/to/files C:\path\to\nonexistent\directory
rclone mount remote:path/to/files \\cloud\remote

When the program ends while in foreground mode, either via Ctrl+C or receiving
a SIGINT or SIGTERM signal, the mount should be automatically stopped.

When running in background mode the user will have to stop the mount manually:

# Linux
fusermount -u /path/to/local/mount
# OS X
umount /path/to/local/mount

The umount operation can fail, for example when the mountpoint is busy.
When that happens, it is the user's responsibility to stop the mount manually.

The size of the mounted file system will be set according to information retrieved
from the remote, the same as returned by the rclone about
command. Remotes with unlimited storage may report the used size only,
then an additional 1PB of free space is assumed. If the remote does not
support the about feature
at all, then 1PB is set as both the total and the free size.

Note: As of rclone 1.52.2, rclone mount now requires Go version 1.13
or newer on some platforms depending on the underlying FUSE library in use.

Installing on Windows

To run rclone mount on Windows, you will need to
download and install WinFsp.

WinFsp is an open source
Windows File System Proxy which makes it easy to write user space file
systems for Windows. It provides a FUSE emulation layer which rclone
uses combination with cgofuse.
Both of these packages are by Bill Zissimopoulos who was very helpful
during the implementation of rclone mount for Windows.

Mounting modes on windows

Unlike other operating systems, Microsoft Windows provides a different filesystem
type for network and fixed drives. It optimises access on the assumption fixed
disk drives are fast and reliable, while network drives have relatively high latency
and less reliability. Some settings can also be differentiated between the two types,
for example that Windows Explorer should just display icons and not create preview
thumbnails for image and video files on network drives.

In most cases, rclone will mount the remote as a normal, fixed disk drive by default.
However, you can also choose to mount it as a remote network drive, often described
as a network share. If you mount an rclone remote using the default, fixed drive mode
and experience unexpected program errors, freezes or other issues, consider mounting
as a network drive instead.

When mounting as a fixed disk drive you can either mount to an unused drive letter,
or to a path - which must be non-existent subdirectory of an existing parent
directory or drive. Using the special value * will tell rclone to
automatically assign the next available drive letter, starting with Z: and moving backward.
Examples:

rclone mount remote:path/to/files *
rclone mount remote:path/to/files X:
rclone mount remote:path/to/files C:\path\to\nonexistent\directory
rclone mount remote:path/to/files X:

Option --volname can be used to set a custom volume name for the mounted
file system. The default is to use the remote name and path.

To mount as network drive, you can add option --network-mode
to your mount command. Mounting to a directory path is not supported in
this mode, it is a limitation Windows imposes on junctions, so the remote must always
be mounted to a drive letter.

rclone mount remote:path/to/files X: --network-mode

A volume name specified with --volname will be used to create the network share path.
A complete UNC path, such as \\cloud\remote, optionally with path
\\cloud\remote\madeup\path, will be used as is. Any other
string will be used as the share part, after a default prefix \\server\.
If no volume name is specified then \\server\share will be used.
You must make sure the volume name is unique when you are mounting more than one drive,
or else the mount command will fail. The share name will treated as the volume label for
the mapped drive, shown in Windows Explorer etc, while the complete
\\server\share will be reported as the remote UNC path by
net use etc, just like a normal network drive mapping.

If you specify a full network share UNC path with --volname, this will implicitely
set the --network-mode option, so the following two examples have same result:

rclone mount remote:path/to/files X: --network-mode
rclone mount remote:path/to/files X: --volname \\server\share

You may also specify the network share UNC path as the mountpoint itself. Then rclone
will automatically assign a drive letter, same as with * and use that as
mountpoint, and instead use the UNC path specified as the volume name, as if it were
specified with the --volname option. This will also implicitely set
the --network-mode option. This means the following two examples have same result:

rclone mount remote:path/to/files \\cloud\remote
rclone mount remote:path/to/files * --volname \\cloud\remote

There is yet another way to enable network mode, and to set the share path,
and that is to pass the "native" libfuse/WinFsp option directly:
--fuse-flag --VolumePrefix=\server\share. Note that the path
must be with just a single backslash prefix in this case.

Note: In previous versions of rclone this was the only supported method.

Read more about drive mapping

See also Limitations section below.

Windows filesystem permissions

The FUSE emulation layer on Windows must convert between the POSIX-based
permission model used in FUSE, and the permission model used in Windows,
based on access-control lists (ACL).

The mounted filesystem will normally get three entries in its access-control list (ACL),
representing permissions for the POSIX permission scopes: Owner, group and others.
By default, the owner and group will be taken from the current user, and the built-in
group "Everyone" will be used to represent others. The user/group can be customized
with FUSE options "UserName" and "GroupName",
e.g. -o UserName=user123 -o GroupName="Authenticated Users".

The permissions on each entry will be set according to
options --dir-perms and --file-perms,
which takes a value in traditional numeric notation,
where the default corresponds to --file-perms 0666 --dir-perms 0777.

Note that the mapping of permissions is not always trivial, and the result
you see in Windows Explorer may not be exactly like you expected.
For example, when setting a value that includes write access, this will be
mapped to individual permissions "write attributes", "write data" and "append data",
but not "write extended attributes" (WinFsp does not support extended attributes,
see this).
Windows will then show this as basic permission "Special" instead of "Write",
because "Write" includes the "write extended attributes" permission.

Windows caveats

Note that drives created as Administrator are not visible by other
accounts (including the account that was elevated as
Administrator). So if you start a Windows drive from an Administrative
Command Prompt and then try to access the same drive from Explorer
(which does not run as Administrator), you will not be able to see the
new drive.

The easiest way around this is to start the drive from a normal
command prompt. It is also possible to start a drive from the SYSTEM
account (using the WinFsp.Launcher
infrastructure
)
which creates drives accessible for everyone on the system or
alternatively using the nssm service manager.

Limitations

Without the use of --vfs-cache-mode this can only write files
sequentially, it can only seek when reading. This means that many
applications won't work with their files on an rclone mount without
--vfs-cache-mode writes or --vfs-cache-mode full.
See the VFS File Caching section for more info.

The bucket based remotes (e.g. Swift, S3, Google Compute Storage, B2,
Hubic) do not support the concept of empty directories, so empty
directories will have a tendency to disappear once they fall out of
the directory cache.

Only supported on Linux, FreeBSD, OS X and Windows at the moment.

rclone mount vs rclone sync/copy

File systems expect things to be 100% reliable, whereas cloud storage
systems are a long way from 100% reliable. The rclone sync/copy
commands cope with this with lots of retries. However rclone mount
can't use retries in the same way without making local copies of the
uploads. Look at the VFS File Caching
for solutions to make mount more reliable.

Attribute caching

You can use the flag --attr-timeout to set the time the kernel caches
the attributes (size, modification time, etc.) for directory entries.

The default is 1s which caches files just long enough to avoid
too many callbacks to rclone from the kernel.

In theory 0s should be the correct value for filesystems which can
change outside the control of the kernel. However this causes quite a
few problems such as
rclone using too much memory,
rclone not serving files to samba
and excessive time listing directories.

The kernel can cache the info about a file for the time given by
--attr-timeout. You may see corruption if the remote file changes
length during this window. It will show up as either a truncated file
or a file with garbage on the end. With --attr-timeout 1s this is
very unlikely but not impossible. The higher you set --attr-timeout
the more likely it is. The default setting of "1s" is the lowest
setting which mitigates the problems above.

If you set it higher (10s or 1m say) then the kernel will call
back to rclone less often making it more efficient, however there is
more chance of the corruption issue above.

If files don't change on the remote outside of the control of rclone
then there is no chance of corruption.

This is the same as setting the attr_timeout option in mount.fuse.

Filters

Note that all the rclone filters can be used to select a subset of the
files to be visible in the mount.

systemd

When running rclone mount as a systemd service, it is possible
to use Type=notify. In this case the service will enter the started state
after the mountpoint has been successfully set up.
Units having the rclone mount service specified as a requirement
will see all files and folders immediately in this mode.

chunked reading

--vfs-read-chunk-size will enable reading the source objects in parts.
This can reduce the used download quota for some remotes by requesting only chunks
from the remote that are actually read at the cost of an increased number of requests.

When --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit is also specified and greater than
--vfs-read-chunk-size, the chunk size for each open file will get doubled
for each chunk read, until the specified value is reached. A value of -1 will disable
the limit and the chunk size will grow indefinitely.

With --vfs-read-chunk-size 100M and --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 0
the following parts will be downloaded: 0-100M, 100M-200M, 200M-300M, 300M-400M and so on.
When --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit 500M is specified, the result would be
0-100M, 100M-300M, 300M-700M, 700M-1200M, 1200M-1700M and so on.

VFS - Virtual File System

This command uses the VFS layer. This adapts the cloud storage objects
that rclone uses into something which looks much more like a disk
filing system.

Cloud storage objects have lots of properties which aren't like disk
files - you can't extend them or write to the middle of them, so the
VFS layer has to deal with that. Because there is no one right way of
doing this there are various options explained below.

The VFS layer also implements a directory cache - this caches info
about files and directories (but not the data) in memory.

VFS Directory Cache

Using the --dir-cache-time flag, you can control how long a
directory should be considered up to date and not refreshed from the
backend. Changes made through the mount will appear immediately or
invalidate the cache.

--dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for. (default 5m0s)
--poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes.

However, changes made directly on the cloud storage by the web
interface or a different copy of rclone will only be picked up once
the directory cache expires if the backend configured does not support
polling for changes. If the backend supports polling, changes will be
picked up within the polling interval.

You can send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all
directory caches, regardless of how old they are. Assuming only one
rclone instance is running, you can reset the cache like this:

kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

If you configure rclone with a remote control then you can use
rclone rc to flush the whole directory cache:

rclone rc vfs/forget

Or individual files or directories:

rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

VFS File Buffering

The --buffer-size flag determines the amount of memory,
that will be used to buffer data in advance.

Each open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory
at all times. The buffered data is bound to one open file and won't be
shared.

This flag is a upper limit for the used memory per open file. The
buffer will only use memory for data that is downloaded but not not
yet read. If the buffer is empty, only a small amount of memory will
be used.

The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to
--buffer-size * open files.

VFS File Caching

These flags control the VFS file caching options. File caching is
necessary to make the VFS layer appear compatible with a normal file
system. It can be disabled at the cost of some compatibility.

For example you'll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and
write simultaneously to a file. See below for more details.

Note that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may
find that you need one or the other or both.

--cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
--vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
--vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache. (default 1h0m0s)
--vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache. (default off)
--vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects. (default 1m0s)
--vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache. (default 5s)

If run with -vv rclone will print the location of the file cache. The
files are stored in the user cache file area which is OS dependent but
can be controlled with --cache-dir or setting the appropriate
environment variable.

The cache has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.
The higher the cache mode the more compatible rclone becomes at the
cost of using disk space.

Note that files are written back to the remote only when they are
closed and if they haven't been accessed for --vfs-write-back
second. If rclone is quit or dies with files that haven't been
uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with the same
flags.

If using --vfs-cache-max-size note that the cache may exceed this size
for two reasons. Firstly because it is only checked every
--vfs-cache-poll-interval. Secondly because open files cannot be
evicted from the cache.

--vfs-cache-mode off

In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write
directly to the remote without caching anything on disk.

This will mean some operations are not possible

  • Files can't be opened for both read AND write
  • Files opened for write can't be seeked
  • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set
  • Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only
  • Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied
  • Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored
  • If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode minimal

This is very similar to "off" except that files opened for read AND
write will be buffered to disk. This means that files opened for
write will be a lot more compatible, but uses the minimal disk space.

These operations are not possible

  • Files opened for write only can't be seeked
  • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set
  • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC
  • If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode writes

In this mode files opened for read only are still read directly from
the remote, write only and read/write files are buffered to disk
first.

This mode should support all normal file system operations.

If an upload fails it will be retried at exponentially increasing
intervals up to 1 minute.

--vfs-cache-mode full

In this mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk. When
data is read from the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

In this mode the files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone
will keep track of which bits of the files it has downloaded.

So if an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone
will only buffer the start of the file. These files will appear to be
their full size in the cache, but they will be sparse files with only
the data that has been downloaded present in them.

This mode should support all normal file system operations and is
otherwise identical to --vfs-cache-mode writes.

When reading a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus
--vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead. The --buffer-size is buffered in memory
whereas the --vfs-read-ahead is buffered on disk.

When using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set
too big and --vfs-read-ahead is set large if required.

IMPORTANT not all file systems support sparse files. In particular
FAT/exFAT do not. Rclone will perform very badly if the cache
directory is on a filesystem which doesn't support sparse files and it
will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

VFS Performance

These flags may be used to enable/disable features of the VFS for
performance or other reasons.

In particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag
(or use --use-server-modtime for a slightly different effect) as each
read of the modification time takes a transaction.

--no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
--no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
--no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
--read-only       Mount read-only.

When rclone reads files from a remote it reads them in chunks. This
means that rather than requesting the whole file rclone reads the
chunk specified. This is advantageous because some cloud providers
account for reads being all the data requested, not all the data
delivered.

Rclone will keep doubling the chunk size requested starting at
--vfs-read-chunk-size with a maximum of --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit
unless it is set to "off" in which case there will be no limit.

--vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks. (default 128M)
--vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default "off")

Sometimes rclone is delivered reads or writes out of order. Rather
than seeking rclone will wait a short time for the in sequence read or
write to come in. These flags only come into effect when not using an
on disk cache file.

--vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking. (default 20ms)
--vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error. (default 1s)

When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full),
the global flag --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of
modified files from cache (the related global flag --checkers have no effect on mount).

--transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel. (default 4)

VFS Case Sensitivity

Linux file systems are case-sensitive: two files can differ only
by case, and the exact case must be used when opening a file.

File systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving:
although existing files can be opened using any case, the exact case used
to create the file is preserved and available for programs to query.
It is not allowed for two files in the same directory to differ only by case.

Usually file systems on macOS are case-insensitive. It is possible to make macOS
file systems case-sensitive but that is not the default

The --vfs-case-insensitive mount flag controls how rclone handles these
two cases. If its value is "false", rclone passes file names to the mounted
file system as-is. If the flag is "true" (or appears without a value on
command line), rclone may perform a "fixup" as explained below.

The user may specify a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case
different than what is stored on mounted file system. If an argument refers
to an existing file with exactly the same name, then the case of the existing
file on the disk will be used. However, if a file name with exactly the same
name is not found but a name differing only by case exists, rclone will
transparently fixup the name. This fixup happens only when an existing file
is requested. Case sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is
controlled by an underlying mounted file system.

Note that case sensitivity of the operating system running rclone (the target)
may differ from case sensitivity of a file system mounted by rclone (the source).
The flag controls whether "fixup" is performed to satisfy the target.

If the flag is not provided on the command line, then its default value depends
on the operating system where rclone runs: "true" on Windows and macOS, "false"
otherwise. If the flag is provided without a value, then it is "true".

rclone mount remote:path /path/to/mountpoint [flags]

Options

      --allow-non-empty                        Allow mounting over a non-empty directory. Not supported on Windows.
      --allow-other                            Allow access to other users. Not supported on Windows.
      --allow-root                             Allow access to root user. Not supported on Windows.
      --async-read                             Use asynchronous reads. Not supported on Windows. (default true)
      --attr-timeout duration                  Time for which file/directory attributes are cached. (default 1s)
      --daemon                                 Run mount as a daemon (background mode). Not supported on Windows.
      --daemon-timeout duration                Time limit for rclone to respond to kernel. Not supported on Windows.
      --debug-fuse                             Debug the FUSE internals - needs -v.
      --default-permissions                    Makes kernel enforce access control based on the file mode. Not supported on Windows.
      --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for. (default 5m0s)
      --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
      --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
      --fuse-flag stringArray                  Flags or arguments to be passed direct to libfuse/WinFsp. Repeat if required.
      --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem. Not supported on Windows. (default 1000)
  -h, --help                                   help for mount
      --max-read-ahead SizeSuffix              The number of bytes that can be prefetched for sequential reads. Not supported on Windows. (default 128k)
      --network-mode                           Mount as remote network drive, instead of fixed disk drive. Supported on Windows only
      --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download.
      --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
      --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files.
      --noappledouble                          Ignore Apple Double (._) and .DS_Store files. Supported on OSX only. (default true)
      --noapplexattr                           Ignore all "com.apple.*" extended attributes. Supported on OSX only.
  -o, --option stringArray                     Option for libfuse/WinFsp. Repeat if required.
      --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable. (default 1m0s)
      --read-only                              Mount read-only.
      --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem. Not supported on Windows. (default 1000)
      --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem. Not supported on Windows.
      --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache. (default 1h0m0s)
      --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache. (default off)
      --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
      --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects. (default 1m0s)
      --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match.
      --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full.
      --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks. (default 128M)
      --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached. 'off' is unlimited. (default off)
      --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking. (default 20ms)
      --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache. (default 5s)
      --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error. (default 1s)
      --volname string                         Set the volume name. Supported on Windows and OSX only.
      --write-back-cache                       Makes kernel buffer writes before sending them to rclone. Without this, writethrough caching is used. Not supported on Windows.

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone moveto

Move file or directory from source to dest.

Synopsis

If source:path is a file or directory then it moves it to a file or
directory named dest:path.

This can be used to rename files or upload single files to other than
their existing name. If the source is a directory then it acts exactly
like the move command.

So

rclone moveto src dst

where src and dst are rclone paths, either remote:path or
/path/to/local or C:\windows\path\if\on\windows.

This will:

if src is file
    move it to dst, overwriting an existing file if it exists
if src is directory
    move it to dst, overwriting existing files if they exist
    see move command for full details

This doesn't transfer unchanged files, testing by size and
modification time or MD5SUM. src will be deleted on successful
transfer.

Important: Since this can cause data loss, test first with the
--dry-run or the --interactive/-i flag.

Note: Use the -P/--progress flag to view real-time transfer statistics.

rclone moveto source:path dest:path [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for moveto

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone ncdu

Explore a remote with a text based user interface.

Synopsis

This displays a text based user interface allowing the navigation of a
remote. It is most useful for answering the question - "What is using
all my disk space?".

To make the user interface it first scans the entire remote given and
builds an in memory representation. rclone ncdu can be used during
this scanning phase and you will see it building up the directory
structure as it goes along.

Here are the keys - press '?' to toggle the help on and off

 ↑,↓ or k,j to Move
 →,l to enter
 ←,h to return
 c toggle counts
 g toggle graph
 a toggle average size in directory
 n,s,C,A sort by name,size,count,average size
 d delete file/directory
 y copy current path to clipboard
 Y display current path
 ^L refresh screen
 ? to toggle help on and off
 q/ESC/c-C to quit

This an homage to the ncdu tool but for
rclone remotes. It is missing lots of features at the moment
but is useful as it stands.

Note that it might take some time to delete big files/folders. The
UI won't respond in the meantime since the deletion is done synchronously.

rclone ncdu remote:path [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for ncdu

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone obscure

Obscure password for use in the rclone config file.

Synopsis

In the rclone config file, human readable passwords are
obscured. Obscuring them is done by encrypting them and writing them
out in base64. This is not a secure way of encrypting these
passwords as rclone can decrypt them - it is to prevent "eyedropping"

  • namely someone seeing a password in the rclone config file by
    accident.

Many equally important things (like access tokens) are not obscured in
the config file. However it is very hard to shoulder surf a 64
character hex token.

This command can also accept a password through STDIN instead of an
argument by passing a hyphen as an argument. This will use the first
line of STDIN as the password not including the trailing newline.

echo "secretpassword" | rclone obscure -

If there is no data on STDIN to read, rclone obscure will default to
obfuscating the hyphen itself.

If you want to encrypt the config file then please use config file
encryption - see rclone config for more
info.

rclone obscure password [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for obscure

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone rc

Run a command against a running rclone.

Synopsis

This runs a command against a running rclone. Use the --url flag to
specify an non default URL to connect on. This can be either a
":port" which is taken to mean "http://localhost:port" or a
"host:port" which is taken to mean "http://host:port"

A username and password can be passed in with --user and --pass.

Note that --rc-addr, --rc-user, --rc-pass will be read also for --url,
--user, --pass.

Arguments should be passed in as parameter=value.

The result will be returned as a JSON object by default.

The --json parameter can be used to pass in a JSON blob as an input
instead of key=value arguments. This is the only way of passing in
more complicated values.

The -o/--opt option can be used to set a key "opt" with key, value
options in the form "-o key=value" or "-o key". It can be repeated as
many times as required. This is useful for rc commands which take the
"opt" parameter which by convention is a dictionary of strings.

-o key=value -o key2

Will place this in the "opt" value

{"key":"value", "key2","")

The -a/--arg option can be used to set strings in the "arg" value. It
can be repeated as many times as required. This is useful for rc
commands which take the "arg" parameter which by convention is a list
of strings.

-a value -a value2

Will place this in the "arg" value

["value", "value2"]

Use --loopback to connect to the rclone instance running "rclone rc".
This is very useful for testing commands without having to run an
rclone rc server, e.g.:

rclone rc --loopback operations/about fs=/

Use "rclone rc" to see a list of all possible commands.

rclone rc commands parameter [flags]

Options

  -a, --arg stringArray   Argument placed in the "arg" array.
  -h, --help              help for rc
      --json string       Input JSON - use instead of key=value args.
      --loopback          If set connect to this rclone instance not via HTTP.
      --no-output         If set, don't output the JSON result.
  -o, --opt stringArray   Option in the form name=value or name placed in the "opt" array.
      --pass string       Password to use to connect to rclone remote control.
      --url string        URL to connect to rclone remote control. (default "http://localhost:5572/")
      --user string       Username to use to rclone remote control.

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone rcat

Copies standard input to file on remote.

Synopsis

rclone rcat reads from standard input (stdin) and copies it to a
single remote file.

echo "hello world" | rclone rcat remote:path/to/file
ffmpeg - | rclone rcat remote:path/to/file

If the remote file already exists, it will be overwritten.

rcat will try to upload small files in a single request, which is
usually more efficient than the streaming/chunked upload endpoints,
which use multiple requests. Exact behaviour depends on the remote.
What is considered a small file may be set through
--streaming-upload-cutoff. Uploading only starts after
the cutoff is reached or if the file ends before that. The data
must fit into RAM. The cutoff needs to be small enough to adhere
the limits of your remote, please see there. Generally speaking,
setting this cutoff too high will decrease your performance.

Note that the upload can also not be retried because the data is
not kept around until the upload succeeds. If you need to transfer
a lot of data, you're better off caching locally and then
rclone move it to the destination.

rclone rcat remote:path [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for rcat

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone rcd

Run rclone listening to remote control commands only.

Synopsis

This runs rclone so that it only listens to remote control commands.

This is useful if you are controlling rclone via the rc API.

If you pass in a path to a directory, rclone will serve that directory
for GET requests on the URL passed in. It will also open the URL in
the browser when rclone is run.

See the rc documentation for more info on the rc flags.

rclone rcd <path to files to serve>* [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for rcd

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone rmdirs

Remove empty directories under the path.

Synopsis

This recursively removes any empty directories (including directories
that only contain empty directories), that it finds under the path.
The root path itself will also be removed if it is empty, unless
you supply the --leave-root flag.

Use command rmdir to delete just the empty directory
given by path, not recurse.

This is useful for tidying up remotes that rclone has left a lot of
empty directories in. For example the delete command will
delete files but leave the directory structure (unless used with
option --rmdirs).

To delete a path and any objects in it, use purge command.

rclone rmdirs remote:path [flags]

Options

  -h, --help         help for rmdirs
      --leave-root   Do not remove root directory if empty

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone serve

Serve a remote over a protocol.

Synopsis

rclone serve is used to serve a remote over a given protocol. This
command requires the use of a subcommand to specify the protocol, e.g.

rclone serve http remote:

Each subcommand has its own options which you can see in their help.

rclone serve <protocol> [opts] <remote> [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for serve

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone serve dlna

Serve remote:path over DLNA

Synopsis

rclone serve dlna is a DLNA media server for media stored in an rclone remote. Many
devices, such as the Xbox and PlayStation, can automatically discover this server in the LAN
and play audio/video from it. VLC is also supported. Service discovery uses UDP multicast
packets (SSDP) and will thus only work on LANs.

Rclone will list all files present in the remote, without filtering based on media formats or
file extensions. Additionally, there is no media transcoding support. This means that some
players might show files that they are not able to play back correctly.

Server options

Use --addr to specify which IP address and port the server should
listen on, e.g. --addr 1.2.3.4:8000 or --addr :8080 to listen to all
IPs.

Use --name to choose the friendly server name, which is by
default "rclone (hostname)".

Use --log-trace in conjunction with -vv to enable additional debug
logging of all UPNP traffic.

VFS - Virtual File System

This command uses the VFS layer. This adapts the cloud storage objects
that rclone uses into something which looks much more like a disk
filing system.

Cloud storage objects have lots of properties which aren't like disk
files - you can't extend them or write to the middle of them, so the
VFS layer has to deal with that. Because there is no one right way of
doing this there are various options explained below.

The VFS layer also implements a directory cache - this caches info
about files and directories (but not the data) in memory.

VFS Directory Cache

Using the --dir-cache-time flag, you can control how long a
directory should be considered up to date and not refreshed from the
backend. Changes made through the mount will appear immediately or
invalidate the cache.

--dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for. (default 5m0s)
--poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes.

However, changes made directly on the cloud storage by the web
interface or a different copy of rclone will only be picked up once
the directory cache expires if the backend configured does not support
polling for changes. If the backend supports polling, changes will be
picked up within the polling interval.

You can send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all
directory caches, regardless of how old they are. Assuming only one
rclone instance is running, you can reset the cache like this:

kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

If you configure rclone with a remote control then you can use
rclone rc to flush the whole directory cache:

rclone rc vfs/forget

Or individual files or directories:

rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

VFS File Buffering

The --buffer-size flag determines the amount of memory,
that will be used to buffer data in advance.

Each open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory
at all times. The buffered data is bound to one open file and won't be
shared.

This flag is a upper limit for the used memory per open file. The
buffer will only use memory for data that is downloaded but not not
yet read. If the buffer is empty, only a small amount of memory will
be used.

The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to
--buffer-size * open files.

VFS File Caching

These flags control the VFS file caching options. File caching is
necessary to make the VFS layer appear compatible with a normal file
system. It can be disabled at the cost of some compatibility.

For example you'll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and
write simultaneously to a file. See below for more details.

Note that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may
find that you need one or the other or both.

--cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
--vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
--vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache. (default 1h0m0s)
--vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache. (default off)
--vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects. (default 1m0s)
--vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache. (default 5s)

If run with -vv rclone will print the location of the file cache. The
files are stored in the user cache file area which is OS dependent but
can be controlled with --cache-dir or setting the appropriate
environment variable.

The cache has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.
The higher the cache mode the more compatible rclone becomes at the
cost of using disk space.

Note that files are written back to the remote only when they are
closed and if they haven't been accessed for --vfs-write-back
second. If rclone is quit or dies with files that haven't been
uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with the same
flags.

If using --vfs-cache-max-size note that the cache may exceed this size
for two reasons. Firstly because it is only checked every
--vfs-cache-poll-interval. Secondly because open files cannot be
evicted from the cache.

--vfs-cache-mode off

In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write
directly to the remote without caching anything on disk.

This will mean some operations are not possible

  • Files can't be opened for both read AND write
  • Files opened for write can't be seeked
  • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set
  • Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only
  • Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied
  • Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored
  • If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode minimal

This is very similar to "off" except that files opened for read AND
write will be buffered to disk. This means that files opened for
write will be a lot more compatible, but uses the minimal disk space.

These operations are not possible

  • Files opened for write only can't be seeked
  • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set
  • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC
  • If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode writes

In this mode files opened for read only are still read directly from
the remote, write only and read/write files are buffered to disk
first.

This mode should support all normal file system operations.

If an upload fails it will be retried at exponentially increasing
intervals up to 1 minute.

--vfs-cache-mode full

In this mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk. When
data is read from the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

In this mode the files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone
will keep track of which bits of the files it has downloaded.

So if an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone
will only buffer the start of the file. These files will appear to be
their full size in the cache, but they will be sparse files with only
the data that has been downloaded present in them.

This mode should support all normal file system operations and is
otherwise identical to --vfs-cache-mode writes.

When reading a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus
--vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead. The --buffer-size is buffered in memory
whereas the --vfs-read-ahead is buffered on disk.

When using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set
too big and --vfs-read-ahead is set large if required.

IMPORTANT not all file systems support sparse files. In particular
FAT/exFAT do not. Rclone will perform very badly if the cache
directory is on a filesystem which doesn't support sparse files and it
will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

VFS Performance

These flags may be used to enable/disable features of the VFS for
performance or other reasons.

In particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag
(or use --use-server-modtime for a slightly different effect) as each
read of the modification time takes a transaction.

--no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
--no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
--no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
--read-only       Mount read-only.

When rclone reads files from a remote it reads them in chunks. This
means that rather than requesting the whole file rclone reads the
chunk specified. This is advantageous because some cloud providers
account for reads being all the data requested, not all the data
delivered.

Rclone will keep doubling the chunk size requested starting at
--vfs-read-chunk-size with a maximum of --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit
unless it is set to "off" in which case there will be no limit.

--vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks. (default 128M)
--vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default "off")

Sometimes rclone is delivered reads or writes out of order. Rather
than seeking rclone will wait a short time for the in sequence read or
write to come in. These flags only come into effect when not using an
on disk cache file.

--vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking. (default 20ms)
--vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error. (default 1s)

When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full),
the global flag --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of
modified files from cache (the related global flag --checkers have no effect on mount).

--transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel. (default 4)

VFS Case Sensitivity

Linux file systems are case-sensitive: two files can differ only
by case, and the exact case must be used when opening a file.

File systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving:
although existing files can be opened using any case, the exact case used
to create the file is preserved and available for programs to query.
It is not allowed for two files in the same directory to differ only by case.

Usually file systems on macOS are case-insensitive. It is possible to make macOS
file systems case-sensitive but that is not the default

The --vfs-case-insensitive mount flag controls how rclone handles these
two cases. If its value is "false", rclone passes file names to the mounted
file system as-is. If the flag is "true" (or appears without a value on
command line), rclone may perform a "fixup" as explained below.

The user may specify a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case
different than what is stored on mounted file system. If an argument refers
to an existing file with exactly the same name, then the case of the existing
file on the disk will be used. However, if a file name with exactly the same
name is not found but a name differing only by case exists, rclone will
transparently fixup the name. This fixup happens only when an existing file
is requested. Case sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is
controlled by an underlying mounted file system.

Note that case sensitivity of the operating system running rclone (the target)
may differ from case sensitivity of a file system mounted by rclone (the source).
The flag controls whether "fixup" is performed to satisfy the target.

If the flag is not provided on the command line, then its default value depends
on the operating system where rclone runs: "true" on Windows and macOS, "false"
otherwise. If the flag is provided without a value, then it is "true".

rclone serve dlna remote:path [flags]

Options

      --addr string                            ip:port or :port to bind the DLNA http server to. (default ":7879")
      --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for. (default 5m0s)
      --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
      --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
      --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem. Not supported on Windows. (default 1000)
  -h, --help                                   help for dlna
      --log-trace                              enable trace logging of SOAP traffic
      --name string                            name of DLNA server
      --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download.
      --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
      --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files.
      --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable. (default 1m0s)
      --read-only                              Mount read-only.
      --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem. Not supported on Windows. (default 1000)
      --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem. Not supported on Windows. (default 2)
      --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache. (default 1h0m0s)
      --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache. (default off)
      --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
      --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects. (default 1m0s)
      --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match.
      --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full.
      --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks. (default 128M)
      --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached. 'off' is unlimited. (default off)
      --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking. (default 20ms)
      --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache. (default 5s)
      --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error. (default 1s)

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone serve ftp

Serve remote:path over FTP.

Synopsis

rclone serve ftp implements a basic ftp server to serve the
remote over FTP protocol. This can be viewed with a ftp client
or you can make a remote of type ftp to read and write it.

Server options

Use --addr to specify which IP address and port the server should
listen on, e.g. --addr 1.2.3.4:8000 or --addr :8080 to listen to all
IPs. By default it only listens on localhost. You can use port
:0 to let the OS choose an available port.

If you set --addr to listen on a public or LAN accessible IP address
then using Authentication is advised - see the next section for info.

Authentication

By default this will serve files without needing a login.

You can set a single username and password with the --user and --pass flags.

VFS - Virtual File System

This command uses the VFS layer. This adapts the cloud storage objects
that rclone uses into something which looks much more like a disk
filing system.

Cloud storage objects have lots of properties which aren't like disk
files - you can't extend them or write to the middle of them, so the
VFS layer has to deal with that. Because there is no one right way of
doing this there are various options explained below.

The VFS layer also implements a directory cache - this caches info
about files and directories (but not the data) in memory.

VFS Directory Cache

Using the --dir-cache-time flag, you can control how long a
directory should be considered up to date and not refreshed from the
backend. Changes made through the mount will appear immediately or
invalidate the cache.

--dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for. (default 5m0s)
--poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes.

However, changes made directly on the cloud storage by the web
interface or a different copy of rclone will only be picked up once
the directory cache expires if the backend configured does not support
polling for changes. If the backend supports polling, changes will be
picked up within the polling interval.

You can send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all
directory caches, regardless of how old they are. Assuming only one
rclone instance is running, you can reset the cache like this:

kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

If you configure rclone with a remote control then you can use
rclone rc to flush the whole directory cache:

rclone rc vfs/forget

Or individual files or directories:

rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

VFS File Buffering

The --buffer-size flag determines the amount of memory,
that will be used to buffer data in advance.

Each open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory
at all times. The buffered data is bound to one open file and won't be
shared.

This flag is a upper limit for the used memory per open file. The
buffer will only use memory for data that is downloaded but not not
yet read. If the buffer is empty, only a small amount of memory will
be used.

The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to
--buffer-size * open files.

VFS File Caching

These flags control the VFS file caching options. File caching is
necessary to make the VFS layer appear compatible with a normal file
system. It can be disabled at the cost of some compatibility.

For example you'll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and
write simultaneously to a file. See below for more details.

Note that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may
find that you need one or the other or both.

--cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
--vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
--vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache. (default 1h0m0s)
--vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache. (default off)
--vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects. (default 1m0s)
--vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache. (default 5s)

If run with -vv rclone will print the location of the file cache. The
files are stored in the user cache file area which is OS dependent but
can be controlled with --cache-dir or setting the appropriate
environment variable.

The cache has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.
The higher the cache mode the more compatible rclone becomes at the
cost of using disk space.

Note that files are written back to the remote only when they are
closed and if they haven't been accessed for --vfs-write-back
second. If rclone is quit or dies with files that haven't been
uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with the same
flags.

If using --vfs-cache-max-size note that the cache may exceed this size
for two reasons. Firstly because it is only checked every
--vfs-cache-poll-interval. Secondly because open files cannot be
evicted from the cache.

--vfs-cache-mode off

In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write
directly to the remote without caching anything on disk.

This will mean some operations are not possible

  • Files can't be opened for both read AND write
  • Files opened for write can't be seeked
  • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set
  • Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only
  • Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied
  • Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored
  • If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode minimal

This is very similar to "off" except that files opened for read AND
write will be buffered to disk. This means that files opened for
write will be a lot more compatible, but uses the minimal disk space.

These operations are not possible

  • Files opened for write only can't be seeked
  • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set
  • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC
  • If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode writes

In this mode files opened for read only are still read directly from
the remote, write only and read/write files are buffered to disk
first.

This mode should support all normal file system operations.

If an upload fails it will be retried at exponentially increasing
intervals up to 1 minute.

--vfs-cache-mode full

In this mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk. When
data is read from the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

In this mode the files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone
will keep track of which bits of the files it has downloaded.

So if an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone
will only buffer the start of the file. These files will appear to be
their full size in the cache, but they will be sparse files with only
the data that has been downloaded present in them.

This mode should support all normal file system operations and is
otherwise identical to --vfs-cache-mode writes.

When reading a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus
--vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead. The --buffer-size is buffered in memory
whereas the --vfs-read-ahead is buffered on disk.

When using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set
too big and --vfs-read-ahead is set large if required.

IMPORTANT not all file systems support sparse files. In particular
FAT/exFAT do not. Rclone will perform very badly if the cache
directory is on a filesystem which doesn't support sparse files and it
will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

VFS Performance

These flags may be used to enable/disable features of the VFS for
performance or other reasons.

In particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag
(or use --use-server-modtime for a slightly different effect) as each
read of the modification time takes a transaction.

--no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
--no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
--no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
--read-only       Mount read-only.

When rclone reads files from a remote it reads them in chunks. This
means that rather than requesting the whole file rclone reads the
chunk specified. This is advantageous because some cloud providers
account for reads being all the data requested, not all the data
delivered.

Rclone will keep doubling the chunk size requested starting at
--vfs-read-chunk-size with a maximum of --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit
unless it is set to "off" in which case there will be no limit.

--vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks. (default 128M)
--vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default "off")

Sometimes rclone is delivered reads or writes out of order. Rather
than seeking rclone will wait a short time for the in sequence read or
write to come in. These flags only come into effect when not using an
on disk cache file.

--vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking. (default 20ms)
--vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error. (default 1s)

When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full),
the global flag --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of
modified files from cache (the related global flag --checkers have no effect on mount).

--transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel. (default 4)

VFS Case Sensitivity

Linux file systems are case-sensitive: two files can differ only
by case, and the exact case must be used when opening a file.

File systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving:
although existing files can be opened using any case, the exact case used
to create the file is preserved and available for programs to query.
It is not allowed for two files in the same directory to differ only by case.

Usually file systems on macOS are case-insensitive. It is possible to make macOS
file systems case-sensitive but that is not the default

The --vfs-case-insensitive mount flag controls how rclone handles these
two cases. If its value is "false", rclone passes file names to the mounted
file system as-is. If the flag is "true" (or appears without a value on
command line), rclone may perform a "fixup" as explained below.

The user may specify a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case
different than what is stored on mounted file system. If an argument refers
to an existing file with exactly the same name, then the case of the existing
file on the disk will be used. However, if a file name with exactly the same
name is not found but a name differing only by case exists, rclone will
transparently fixup the name. This fixup happens only when an existing file
is requested. Case sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is
controlled by an underlying mounted file system.

Note that case sensitivity of the operating system running rclone (the target)
may differ from case sensitivity of a file system mounted by rclone (the source).
The flag controls whether "fixup" is performed to satisfy the target.

If the flag is not provided on the command line, then its default value depends
on the operating system where rclone runs: "true" on Windows and macOS, "false"
otherwise. If the flag is provided without a value, then it is "true".

Auth Proxy

If you supply the parameter --auth-proxy /path/to/program then
rclone will use that program to generate backends on the fly which
then are used to authenticate incoming requests. This uses a simple
JSON based protocol with input on STDIN and output on STDOUT.

PLEASE NOTE: --auth-proxy and --authorized-keys cannot be used
together, if --auth-proxy is set the authorized keys option will be
ignored.

There is an example program
bin/test_proxy.py
in the rclone source code.

The program's job is to take a user and pass on the input and turn
those into the config for a backend on STDOUT in JSON format. This
config will have any default parameters for the backend added, but it
won't use configuration from environment variables or command line
options - it is the job of the proxy program to make a complete
config.

This config generated must have this extra parameter

  • _root - root to use for the backend

And it may have this parameter

  • _obscure - comma separated strings for parameters to obscure

If password authentication was used by the client, input to the proxy
process (on STDIN) would look similar to this:

{
	"user": "me",
	"pass": "mypassword"
}

If public-key authentication was used by the client, input to the
proxy process (on STDIN) would look similar to this:

{
	"user": "me",
	"public_key": "AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAADAQABAAABAQDuwESFdAe14hVS6omeyX7edc...JQdf"
}

And as an example return this on STDOUT

{
	"type": "sftp",
	"_root": "",
	"_obscure": "pass",
	"user": "me",
	"pass": "mypassword",
	"host": "sftp.example.com"
}

This would mean that an SFTP backend would be created on the fly for
the user and pass/public_key returned in the output to the host given. Note
that since _obscure is set to pass, rclone will obscure the pass
parameter before creating the backend (which is required for sftp
backends).

The program can manipulate the supplied user in any way, for example
to make proxy to many different sftp backends, you could make the
user be user@example.com and then set the host to example.com
in the output and the user to user. For security you'd probably want
to restrict the host to a limited list.

Note that an internal cache is keyed on user so only use that for
configuration, don't use pass or public_key. This also means that if a user's
password or public-key is changed the cache will need to expire (which takes 5 mins)
before it takes effect.

This can be used to build general purpose proxies to any kind of
backend that rclone supports.

rclone serve ftp remote:path [flags]

Options

      --addr string                            IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to. (default "localhost:2121")
      --auth-proxy string                      A program to use to create the backend from the auth.
      --cert string                            TLS PEM key (concatenation of certificate and CA certificate)
      --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for. (default 5m0s)
      --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
      --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
      --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem. Not supported on Windows. (default 1000)
  -h, --help                                   help for ftp
      --key string                             TLS PEM Private key
      --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download.
      --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
      --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files.
      --pass string                            Password for authentication. (empty value allow every password)
      --passive-port string                    Passive port range to use. (default "30000-32000")
      --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable. (default 1m0s)
      --public-ip string                       Public IP address to advertise for passive connections.
      --read-only                              Mount read-only.
      --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem. Not supported on Windows. (default 1000)
      --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem. Not supported on Windows. (default 2)
      --user string                            User name for authentication. (default "anonymous")
      --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache. (default 1h0m0s)
      --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache. (default off)
      --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
      --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects. (default 1m0s)
      --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match.
      --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full.
      --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks. (default 128M)
      --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached. 'off' is unlimited. (default off)
      --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking. (default 20ms)
      --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache. (default 5s)
      --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error. (default 1s)

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone serve http

Serve the remote over HTTP.

Synopsis

rclone serve http implements a basic web server to serve the remote
over HTTP. This can be viewed in a web browser or you can make a
remote of type http read from it.

You can use the filter flags (e.g. --include, --exclude) to control what
is served.

The server will log errors. Use -v to see access logs.

--bwlimit will be respected for file transfers. Use --stats to
control the stats printing.

Server options

Use --addr to specify which IP address and port the server should
listen on, e.g. --addr 1.2.3.4:8000 or --addr :8080 to listen to all
IPs. By default it only listens on localhost. You can use port
:0 to let the OS choose an available port.

If you set --addr to listen on a public or LAN accessible IP address
then using Authentication is advised - see the next section for info.

--server-read-timeout and --server-write-timeout can be used to
control the timeouts on the server. Note that this is the total time
for a transfer.

--max-header-bytes controls the maximum number of bytes the server will
accept in the HTTP header.

--baseurl controls the URL prefix that rclone serves from. By default
rclone will serve from the root. If you used --baseurl "/rclone" then
rclone would serve from a URL starting with "/rclone/". This is
useful if you wish to proxy rclone serve. Rclone automatically
inserts leading and trailing "/" on --baseurl, so --baseurl "rclone",
--baseurl "/rclone" and --baseurl "/rclone/" are all treated
identically.

--template allows a user to specify a custom markup template for http
and webdav serve functions. The server exports the following markup
to be used within the template to server pages:

Parameter Description
.Name The full path of a file/directory.
.Title Directory listing of .Name
.Sort The current sort used. This is changeable via ?sort= parameter
Sort Options: namedirfirst,name,size,time (default namedirfirst)
.Order The current ordering used. This is changeable via ?order= parameter
Order Options: asc,desc (default asc)
.Query Currently unused.
.Breadcrumb Allows for creating a relative navigation
-- .Link The relative to the root link of the Text.
-- .Text The Name of the directory.
.Entries Information about a specific file/directory.
-- .URL The 'url' of an entry.
-- .Leaf Currently same as 'URL' but intended to be 'just' the name.
-- .IsDir Boolean for if an entry is a directory or not.
-- .Size Size in Bytes of the entry.
-- .ModTime The UTC timestamp of an entry.

Authentication

By default this will serve files without needing a login.

You can either use an htpasswd file which can take lots of users, or
set a single username and password with the --user and --pass flags.

Use --htpasswd /path/to/htpasswd to provide an htpasswd file. This is
in standard apache format and supports MD5, SHA1 and BCrypt for basic
authentication. Bcrypt is recommended.

To create an htpasswd file:

touch htpasswd
htpasswd -B htpasswd user
htpasswd -B htpasswd anotherUser

The password file can be updated while rclone is running.

Use --realm to set the authentication realm.

SSL/TLS

By default this will serve over http. If you want you can serve over
https. You will need to supply the --cert and --key flags. If you
wish to do client side certificate validation then you will need to
supply --client-ca also.

--cert should be either a PEM encoded certificate or a concatenation
of that with the CA certificate. --key should be the PEM encoded
private key and --client-ca should be the PEM encoded client
certificate authority certificate.

VFS - Virtual File System

This command uses the VFS layer. This adapts the cloud storage objects
that rclone uses into something which looks much more like a disk
filing system.

Cloud storage objects have lots of properties which aren't like disk
files - you can't extend them or write to the middle of them, so the
VFS layer has to deal with that. Because there is no one right way of
doing this there are various options explained below.

The VFS layer also implements a directory cache - this caches info
about files and directories (but not the data) in memory.

VFS Directory Cache

Using the --dir-cache-time flag, you can control how long a
directory should be considered up to date and not refreshed from the
backend. Changes made through the mount will appear immediately or
invalidate the cache.

--dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for. (default 5m0s)
--poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes.

However, changes made directly on the cloud storage by the web
interface or a different copy of rclone will only be picked up once
the directory cache expires if the backend configured does not support
polling for changes. If the backend supports polling, changes will be
picked up within the polling interval.

You can send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all
directory caches, regardless of how old they are. Assuming only one
rclone instance is running, you can reset the cache like this:

kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

If you configure rclone with a remote control then you can use
rclone rc to flush the whole directory cache:

rclone rc vfs/forget

Or individual files or directories:

rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

VFS File Buffering

The --buffer-size flag determines the amount of memory,
that will be used to buffer data in advance.

Each open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory
at all times. The buffered data is bound to one open file and won't be
shared.

This flag is a upper limit for the used memory per open file. The
buffer will only use memory for data that is downloaded but not not
yet read. If the buffer is empty, only a small amount of memory will
be used.

The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to
--buffer-size * open files.

VFS File Caching

These flags control the VFS file caching options. File caching is
necessary to make the VFS layer appear compatible with a normal file
system. It can be disabled at the cost of some compatibility.

For example you'll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and
write simultaneously to a file. See below for more details.

Note that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may
find that you need one or the other or both.

--cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
--vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
--vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache. (default 1h0m0s)
--vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache. (default off)
--vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects. (default 1m0s)
--vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache. (default 5s)

If run with -vv rclone will print the location of the file cache. The
files are stored in the user cache file area which is OS dependent but
can be controlled with --cache-dir or setting the appropriate
environment variable.

The cache has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.
The higher the cache mode the more compatible rclone becomes at the
cost of using disk space.

Note that files are written back to the remote only when they are
closed and if they haven't been accessed for --vfs-write-back
second. If rclone is quit or dies with files that haven't been
uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with the same
flags.

If using --vfs-cache-max-size note that the cache may exceed this size
for two reasons. Firstly because it is only checked every
--vfs-cache-poll-interval. Secondly because open files cannot be
evicted from the cache.

--vfs-cache-mode off

In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write
directly to the remote without caching anything on disk.

This will mean some operations are not possible

  • Files can't be opened for both read AND write
  • Files opened for write can't be seeked
  • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set
  • Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only
  • Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied
  • Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored
  • If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode minimal

This is very similar to "off" except that files opened for read AND
write will be buffered to disk. This means that files opened for
write will be a lot more compatible, but uses the minimal disk space.

These operations are not possible

  • Files opened for write only can't be seeked
  • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set
  • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC
  • If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode writes

In this mode files opened for read only are still read directly from
the remote, write only and read/write files are buffered to disk
first.

This mode should support all normal file system operations.

If an upload fails it will be retried at exponentially increasing
intervals up to 1 minute.

--vfs-cache-mode full

In this mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk. When
data is read from the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

In this mode the files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone
will keep track of which bits of the files it has downloaded.

So if an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone
will only buffer the start of the file. These files will appear to be
their full size in the cache, but they will be sparse files with only
the data that has been downloaded present in them.

This mode should support all normal file system operations and is
otherwise identical to --vfs-cache-mode writes.

When reading a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus
--vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead. The --buffer-size is buffered in memory
whereas the --vfs-read-ahead is buffered on disk.

When using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set
too big and --vfs-read-ahead is set large if required.

IMPORTANT not all file systems support sparse files. In particular
FAT/exFAT do not. Rclone will perform very badly if the cache
directory is on a filesystem which doesn't support sparse files and it
will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

VFS Performance

These flags may be used to enable/disable features of the VFS for
performance or other reasons.

In particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag
(or use --use-server-modtime for a slightly different effect) as each
read of the modification time takes a transaction.

--no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
--no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
--no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
--read-only       Mount read-only.

When rclone reads files from a remote it reads them in chunks. This
means that rather than requesting the whole file rclone reads the
chunk specified. This is advantageous because some cloud providers
account for reads being all the data requested, not all the data
delivered.

Rclone will keep doubling the chunk size requested starting at
--vfs-read-chunk-size with a maximum of --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit
unless it is set to "off" in which case there will be no limit.

--vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks. (default 128M)
--vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default "off")

Sometimes rclone is delivered reads or writes out of order. Rather
than seeking rclone will wait a short time for the in sequence read or
write to come in. These flags only come into effect when not using an
on disk cache file.

--vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking. (default 20ms)
--vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error. (default 1s)

When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full),
the global flag --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of
modified files from cache (the related global flag --checkers have no effect on mount).

--transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel. (default 4)

VFS Case Sensitivity

Linux file systems are case-sensitive: two files can differ only
by case, and the exact case must be used when opening a file.

File systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving:
although existing files can be opened using any case, the exact case used
to create the file is preserved and available for programs to query.
It is not allowed for two files in the same directory to differ only by case.

Usually file systems on macOS are case-insensitive. It is possible to make macOS
file systems case-sensitive but that is not the default

The --vfs-case-insensitive mount flag controls how rclone handles these
two cases. If its value is "false", rclone passes file names to the mounted
file system as-is. If the flag is "true" (or appears without a value on
command line), rclone may perform a "fixup" as explained below.

The user may specify a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case
different than what is stored on mounted file system. If an argument refers
to an existing file with exactly the same name, then the case of the existing
file on the disk will be used. However, if a file name with exactly the same
name is not found but a name differing only by case exists, rclone will
transparently fixup the name. This fixup happens only when an existing file
is requested. Case sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is
controlled by an underlying mounted file system.

Note that case sensitivity of the operating system running rclone (the target)
may differ from case sensitivity of a file system mounted by rclone (the source).
The flag controls whether "fixup" is performed to satisfy the target.

If the flag is not provided on the command line, then its default value depends
on the operating system where rclone runs: "true" on Windows and macOS, "false"
otherwise. If the flag is provided without a value, then it is "true".

rclone serve http remote:path [flags]

Options

      --addr string                            IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to. (default "localhost:8080")
      --baseurl string                         Prefix for URLs - leave blank for root.
      --cert string                            SSL PEM key (concatenation of certificate and CA certificate)
      --client-ca string                       Client certificate authority to verify clients with
      --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for. (default 5m0s)
      --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
      --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
      --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem. Not supported on Windows. (default 1000)
  -h, --help                                   help for http
      --htpasswd string                        htpasswd file - if not provided no authentication is done
      --key string                             SSL PEM Private key
      --max-header-bytes int                   Maximum size of request header (default 4096)
      --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download.
      --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
      --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files.
      --pass string                            Password for authentication.
      --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable. (default 1m0s)
      --read-only                              Mount read-only.
      --realm string                           realm for authentication (default "rclone")
      --server-read-timeout duration           Timeout for server reading data (default 1h0m0s)
      --server-write-timeout duration          Timeout for server writing data (default 1h0m0s)
      --template string                        User Specified Template.
      --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem. Not supported on Windows. (default 1000)
      --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem. Not supported on Windows. (default 2)
      --user string                            User name for authentication.
      --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache. (default 1h0m0s)
      --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache. (default off)
      --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
      --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects. (default 1m0s)
      --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match.
      --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full.
      --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks. (default 128M)
      --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached. 'off' is unlimited. (default off)
      --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking. (default 20ms)
      --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache. (default 5s)
      --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error. (default 1s)

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone serve restic

Serve the remote for restic's REST API.

Synopsis

rclone serve restic implements restic's REST backend API
over HTTP. This allows restic to use rclone as a data storage
mechanism for cloud providers that restic does not support directly.

Restic is a command line program for doing
backups.

The server will log errors. Use -v to see access logs.

--bwlimit will be respected for file transfers. Use --stats to
control the stats printing.

Setting up rclone for use by restic

First set up a remote for your chosen cloud provider.

Once you have set up the remote, check it is working with, for example
"rclone lsd remote:". You may have called the remote something other
than "remote:" - just substitute whatever you called it in the
following instructions.

Now start the rclone restic server

rclone serve restic -v remote:backup

Where you can replace "backup" in the above by whatever path in the
remote you wish to use.

By default this will serve on "localhost:8080" you can change this
with use of the "--addr" flag.

You might wish to start this server on boot.

Adding --cache-objects=false will cause rclone to stop caching objects
returned from the List call. Caching is normally desirable as it speeds
up downloading objects, saves transactions and uses very little memory.

Setting up restic to use rclone

Now you can follow the restic
instructions

on setting up restic.

Note that you will need restic 0.8.2 or later to interoperate with
rclone.

For the example above you will want to use "http://localhost:8080/" as
the URL for the REST server.

For example:

$ export RESTIC_REPOSITORY=rest:http://localhost:8080/
$ export RESTIC_PASSWORD=yourpassword
$ restic init
created restic backend 8b1a4b56ae at rest:http://localhost:8080/

Please note that knowledge of your password is required to access
the repository. Losing your password means that your data is
irrecoverably lost.
$ restic backup /path/to/files/to/backup
scan [/path/to/files/to/backup]
scanned 189 directories, 312 files in 0:00
[0:00] 100.00%  38.128 MiB / 38.128 MiB  501 / 501 items  0 errors  ETA 0:00
duration: 0:00
snapshot 45c8fdd8 saved

Multiple repositories

Note that you can use the endpoint to host multiple repositories. Do
this by adding a directory name or path after the URL. Note that
these must end with /. Eg

$ export RESTIC_REPOSITORY=rest:http://localhost:8080/user1repo/
# backup user1 stuff
$ export RESTIC_REPOSITORY=rest:http://localhost:8080/user2repo/
# backup user2 stuff

Private repositories

The "--private-repos" flag can be used to limit users to repositories starting
with a path of /<username>/.

Server options

Use --addr to specify which IP address and port the server should
listen on, e.g. --addr 1.2.3.4:8000 or --addr :8080 to listen to all
IPs. By default it only listens on localhost. You can use port
:0 to let the OS choose an available port.

If you set --addr to listen on a public or LAN accessible IP address
then using Authentication is advised - see the next section for info.

--server-read-timeout and --server-write-timeout can be used to
control the timeouts on the server. Note that this is the total time
for a transfer.

--max-header-bytes controls the maximum number of bytes the server will
accept in the HTTP header.

--baseurl controls the URL prefix that rclone serves from. By default
rclone will serve from the root. If you used --baseurl "/rclone" then
rclone would serve from a URL starting with "/rclone/". This is
useful if you wish to proxy rclone serve. Rclone automatically
inserts leading and trailing "/" on --baseurl, so --baseurl "rclone",
--baseurl "/rclone" and --baseurl "/rclone/" are all treated
identically.

--template allows a user to specify a custom markup template for http
and webdav serve functions. The server exports the following markup
to be used within the template to server pages:

Parameter Description
.Name The full path of a file/directory.
.Title Directory listing of .Name
.Sort The current sort used. This is changeable via ?sort= parameter
Sort Options: namedirfirst,name,size,time (default namedirfirst)
.Order The current ordering used. This is changeable via ?order= parameter
Order Options: asc,desc (default asc)
.Query Currently unused.
.Breadcrumb Allows for creating a relative navigation
-- .Link The relative to the root link of the Text.
-- .Text The Name of the directory.
.Entries Information about a specific file/directory.
-- .URL The 'url' of an entry.
-- .Leaf Currently same as 'URL' but intended to be 'just' the name.
-- .IsDir Boolean for if an entry is a directory or not.
-- .Size Size in Bytes of the entry.
-- .ModTime The UTC timestamp of an entry.

Authentication

By default this will serve files without needing a login.

You can either use an htpasswd file which can take lots of users, or
set a single username and password with the --user and --pass flags.

Use --htpasswd /path/to/htpasswd to provide an htpasswd file. This is
in standard apache format and supports MD5, SHA1 and BCrypt for basic
authentication. Bcrypt is recommended.

To create an htpasswd file:

touch htpasswd
htpasswd -B htpasswd user
htpasswd -B htpasswd anotherUser

The password file can be updated while rclone is running.

Use --realm to set the authentication realm.

SSL/TLS

By default this will serve over http. If you want you can serve over
https. You will need to supply the --cert and --key flags. If you
wish to do client side certificate validation then you will need to
supply --client-ca also.

--cert should be either a PEM encoded certificate or a concatenation
of that with the CA certificate. --key should be the PEM encoded
private key and --client-ca should be the PEM encoded client
certificate authority certificate.

rclone serve restic remote:path [flags]

Options

      --addr string                     IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to. (default "localhost:8080")
      --append-only                     disallow deletion of repository data
      --baseurl string                  Prefix for URLs - leave blank for root.
      --cache-objects                   cache listed objects (default true)
      --cert string                     SSL PEM key (concatenation of certificate and CA certificate)
      --client-ca string                Client certificate authority to verify clients with
  -h, --help                            help for restic
      --htpasswd string                 htpasswd file - if not provided no authentication is done
      --key string                      SSL PEM Private key
      --max-header-bytes int            Maximum size of request header (default 4096)
      --pass string                     Password for authentication.
      --private-repos                   users can only access their private repo
      --realm string                    realm for authentication (default "rclone")
      --server-read-timeout duration    Timeout for server reading data (default 1h0m0s)
      --server-write-timeout duration   Timeout for server writing data (default 1h0m0s)
      --stdio                           run an HTTP2 server on stdin/stdout
      --template string                 User Specified Template.
      --user string                     User name for authentication.

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone serve sftp

Serve the remote over SFTP.

Synopsis

rclone serve sftp implements an SFTP server to serve the remote
over SFTP. This can be used with an SFTP client or you can make a
remote of type sftp to use with it.

You can use the filter flags (e.g. --include, --exclude) to control what
is served.

The server will log errors. Use -v to see access logs.

--bwlimit will be respected for file transfers. Use --stats to
control the stats printing.

You must provide some means of authentication, either with --user/--pass,
an authorized keys file (specify location with --authorized-keys - the
default is the same as ssh), an --auth-proxy, or set the --no-auth flag for no
authentication when logging in.

Note that this also implements a small number of shell commands so
that it can provide md5sum/sha1sum/df information for the rclone sftp
backend. This means that is can support SHA1SUMs, MD5SUMs and the
about command when paired with the rclone sftp backend.

If you don't supply a --key then rclone will generate one and cache it
for later use.

By default the server binds to localhost:2022 - if you want it to be
reachable externally then supply "--addr :2022" for example.

Note that the default of "--vfs-cache-mode off" is fine for the rclone
sftp backend, but it may not be with other SFTP clients.

VFS - Virtual File System

This command uses the VFS layer. This adapts the cloud storage objects
that rclone uses into something which looks much more like a disk
filing system.

Cloud storage objects have lots of properties which aren't like disk
files - you can't extend them or write to the middle of them, so the
VFS layer has to deal with that. Because there is no one right way of
doing this there are various options explained below.

The VFS layer also implements a directory cache - this caches info
about files and directories (but not the data) in memory.

VFS Directory Cache

Using the --dir-cache-time flag, you can control how long a
directory should be considered up to date and not refreshed from the
backend. Changes made through the mount will appear immediately or
invalidate the cache.

--dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for. (default 5m0s)
--poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes.

However, changes made directly on the cloud storage by the web
interface or a different copy of rclone will only be picked up once
the directory cache expires if the backend configured does not support
polling for changes. If the backend supports polling, changes will be
picked up within the polling interval.

You can send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all
directory caches, regardless of how old they are. Assuming only one
rclone instance is running, you can reset the cache like this:

kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

If you configure rclone with a remote control then you can use
rclone rc to flush the whole directory cache:

rclone rc vfs/forget

Or individual files or directories:

rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

VFS File Buffering

The --buffer-size flag determines the amount of memory,
that will be used to buffer data in advance.

Each open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory
at all times. The buffered data is bound to one open file and won't be
shared.

This flag is a upper limit for the used memory per open file. The
buffer will only use memory for data that is downloaded but not not
yet read. If the buffer is empty, only a small amount of memory will
be used.

The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to
--buffer-size * open files.

VFS File Caching

These flags control the VFS file caching options. File caching is
necessary to make the VFS layer appear compatible with a normal file
system. It can be disabled at the cost of some compatibility.

For example you'll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and
write simultaneously to a file. See below for more details.

Note that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may
find that you need one or the other or both.

--cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
--vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
--vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache. (default 1h0m0s)
--vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache. (default off)
--vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects. (default 1m0s)
--vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache. (default 5s)

If run with -vv rclone will print the location of the file cache. The
files are stored in the user cache file area which is OS dependent but
can be controlled with --cache-dir or setting the appropriate
environment variable.

The cache has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.
The higher the cache mode the more compatible rclone becomes at the
cost of using disk space.

Note that files are written back to the remote only when they are
closed and if they haven't been accessed for --vfs-write-back
second. If rclone is quit or dies with files that haven't been
uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with the same
flags.

If using --vfs-cache-max-size note that the cache may exceed this size
for two reasons. Firstly because it is only checked every
--vfs-cache-poll-interval. Secondly because open files cannot be
evicted from the cache.

--vfs-cache-mode off

In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write
directly to the remote without caching anything on disk.

This will mean some operations are not possible

  • Files can't be opened for both read AND write
  • Files opened for write can't be seeked
  • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set
  • Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only
  • Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied
  • Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored
  • If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode minimal

This is very similar to "off" except that files opened for read AND
write will be buffered to disk. This means that files opened for
write will be a lot more compatible, but uses the minimal disk space.

These operations are not possible

  • Files opened for write only can't be seeked
  • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set
  • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC
  • If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode writes

In this mode files opened for read only are still read directly from
the remote, write only and read/write files are buffered to disk
first.

This mode should support all normal file system operations.

If an upload fails it will be retried at exponentially increasing
intervals up to 1 minute.

--vfs-cache-mode full

In this mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk. When
data is read from the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

In this mode the files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone
will keep track of which bits of the files it has downloaded.

So if an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone
will only buffer the start of the file. These files will appear to be
their full size in the cache, but they will be sparse files with only
the data that has been downloaded present in them.

This mode should support all normal file system operations and is
otherwise identical to --vfs-cache-mode writes.

When reading a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus
--vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead. The --buffer-size is buffered in memory
whereas the --vfs-read-ahead is buffered on disk.

When using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set
too big and --vfs-read-ahead is set large if required.

IMPORTANT not all file systems support sparse files. In particular
FAT/exFAT do not. Rclone will perform very badly if the cache
directory is on a filesystem which doesn't support sparse files and it
will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

VFS Performance

These flags may be used to enable/disable features of the VFS for
performance or other reasons.

In particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag
(or use --use-server-modtime for a slightly different effect) as each
read of the modification time takes a transaction.

--no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
--no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
--no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
--read-only       Mount read-only.

When rclone reads files from a remote it reads them in chunks. This
means that rather than requesting the whole file rclone reads the
chunk specified. This is advantageous because some cloud providers
account for reads being all the data requested, not all the data
delivered.

Rclone will keep doubling the chunk size requested starting at
--vfs-read-chunk-size with a maximum of --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit
unless it is set to "off" in which case there will be no limit.

--vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks. (default 128M)
--vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default "off")

Sometimes rclone is delivered reads or writes out of order. Rather
than seeking rclone will wait a short time for the in sequence read or
write to come in. These flags only come into effect when not using an
on disk cache file.

--vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking. (default 20ms)
--vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error. (default 1s)

When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full),
the global flag --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of
modified files from cache (the related global flag --checkers have no effect on mount).

--transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel. (default 4)

VFS Case Sensitivity

Linux file systems are case-sensitive: two files can differ only
by case, and the exact case must be used when opening a file.

File systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving:
although existing files can be opened using any case, the exact case used
to create the file is preserved and available for programs to query.
It is not allowed for two files in the same directory to differ only by case.

Usually file systems on macOS are case-insensitive. It is possible to make macOS
file systems case-sensitive but that is not the default

The --vfs-case-insensitive mount flag controls how rclone handles these
two cases. If its value is "false", rclone passes file names to the mounted
file system as-is. If the flag is "true" (or appears without a value on
command line), rclone may perform a "fixup" as explained below.

The user may specify a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case
different than what is stored on mounted file system. If an argument refers
to an existing file with exactly the same name, then the case of the existing
file on the disk will be used. However, if a file name with exactly the same
name is not found but a name differing only by case exists, rclone will
transparently fixup the name. This fixup happens only when an existing file
is requested. Case sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is
controlled by an underlying mounted file system.

Note that case sensitivity of the operating system running rclone (the target)
may differ from case sensitivity of a file system mounted by rclone (the source).
The flag controls whether "fixup" is performed to satisfy the target.

If the flag is not provided on the command line, then its default value depends
on the operating system where rclone runs: "true" on Windows and macOS, "false"
otherwise. If the flag is provided without a value, then it is "true".

Auth Proxy

If you supply the parameter --auth-proxy /path/to/program then
rclone will use that program to generate backends on the fly which
then are used to authenticate incoming requests. This uses a simple
JSON based protocol with input on STDIN and output on STDOUT.

PLEASE NOTE: --auth-proxy and --authorized-keys cannot be used
together, if --auth-proxy is set the authorized keys option will be
ignored.

There is an example program
bin/test_proxy.py
in the rclone source code.

The program's job is to take a user and pass on the input and turn
those into the config for a backend on STDOUT in JSON format. This
config will have any default parameters for the backend added, but it
won't use configuration from environment variables or command line
options - it is the job of the proxy program to make a complete
config.

This config generated must have this extra parameter

  • _root - root to use for the backend

And it may have this parameter

  • _obscure - comma separated strings for parameters to obscure

If password authentication was used by the client, input to the proxy
process (on STDIN) would look similar to this:

{
	"user": "me",
	"pass": "mypassword"
}

If public-key authentication was used by the client, input to the
proxy process (on STDIN) would look similar to this:

{
	"user": "me",
	"public_key": "AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAADAQABAAABAQDuwESFdAe14hVS6omeyX7edc...JQdf"
}

And as an example return this on STDOUT

{
	"type": "sftp",
	"_root": "",
	"_obscure": "pass",
	"user": "me",
	"pass": "mypassword",
	"host": "sftp.example.com"
}

This would mean that an SFTP backend would be created on the fly for
the user and pass/public_key returned in the output to the host given. Note
that since _obscure is set to pass, rclone will obscure the pass
parameter before creating the backend (which is required for sftp
backends).

The program can manipulate the supplied user in any way, for example
to make proxy to many different sftp backends, you could make the
user be user@example.com and then set the host to example.com
in the output and the user to user. For security you'd probably want
to restrict the host to a limited list.

Note that an internal cache is keyed on user so only use that for
configuration, don't use pass or public_key. This also means that if a user's
password or public-key is changed the cache will need to expire (which takes 5 mins)
before it takes effect.

This can be used to build general purpose proxies to any kind of
backend that rclone supports.

rclone serve sftp remote:path [flags]

Options

      --addr string                            IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to. (default "localhost:2022")
      --auth-proxy string                      A program to use to create the backend from the auth.
      --authorized-keys string                 Authorized keys file (default "~/.ssh/authorized_keys")
      --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for. (default 5m0s)
      --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
      --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
      --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem. Not supported on Windows. (default 1000)
  -h, --help                                   help for sftp
      --key stringArray                        SSH private host key file (Can be multi-valued, leave blank to auto generate)
      --no-auth                                Allow connections with no authentication if set.
      --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download.
      --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
      --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files.
      --pass string                            Password for authentication.
      --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable. (default 1m0s)
      --read-only                              Mount read-only.
      --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem. Not supported on Windows. (default 1000)
      --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem. Not supported on Windows. (default 2)
      --user string                            User name for authentication.
      --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache. (default 1h0m0s)
      --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache. (default off)
      --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
      --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects. (default 1m0s)
      --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match.
      --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full.
      --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks. (default 128M)
      --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached. 'off' is unlimited. (default off)
      --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking. (default 20ms)
      --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache. (default 5s)
      --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error. (default 1s)

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone serve webdav

Serve remote:path over webdav.

Synopsis

rclone serve webdav implements a basic webdav server to serve the
remote over HTTP via the webdav protocol. This can be viewed with a
webdav client, through a web browser, or you can make a remote of
type webdav to read and write it.

Webdav options

--etag-hash

This controls the ETag header. Without this flag the ETag will be
based on the ModTime and Size of the object.

If this flag is set to "auto" then rclone will choose the first
supported hash on the backend or you can use a named hash such as
"MD5" or "SHA-1".

Use "rclone hashsum" to see the full list.

Server options

Use --addr to specify which IP address and port the server should
listen on, e.g. --addr 1.2.3.4:8000 or --addr :8080 to listen to all
IPs. By default it only listens on localhost. You can use port
:0 to let the OS choose an available port.

If you set --addr to listen on a public or LAN accessible IP address
then using Authentication is advised - see the next section for info.

--server-read-timeout and --server-write-timeout can be used to
control the timeouts on the server. Note that this is the total time
for a transfer.

--max-header-bytes controls the maximum number of bytes the server will
accept in the HTTP header.

--baseurl controls the URL prefix that rclone serves from. By default
rclone will serve from the root. If you used --baseurl "/rclone" then
rclone would serve from a URL starting with "/rclone/". This is
useful if you wish to proxy rclone serve. Rclone automatically
inserts leading and trailing "/" on --baseurl, so --baseurl "rclone",
--baseurl "/rclone" and --baseurl "/rclone/" are all treated
identically.

--template allows a user to specify a custom markup template for http
and webdav serve functions. The server exports the following markup
to be used within the template to server pages:

Parameter Description
.Name The full path of a file/directory.
.Title Directory listing of .Name
.Sort The current sort used. This is changeable via ?sort= parameter
Sort Options: namedirfirst,name,size,time (default namedirfirst)
.Order The current ordering used. This is changeable via ?order= parameter
Order Options: asc,desc (default asc)
.Query Currently unused.
.Breadcrumb Allows for creating a relative navigation
-- .Link The relative to the root link of the Text.
-- .Text The Name of the directory.
.Entries Information about a specific file/directory.
-- .URL The 'url' of an entry.
-- .Leaf Currently same as 'URL' but intended to be 'just' the name.
-- .IsDir Boolean for if an entry is a directory or not.
-- .Size Size in Bytes of the entry.
-- .ModTime The UTC timestamp of an entry.

Authentication

By default this will serve files without needing a login.

You can either use an htpasswd file which can take lots of users, or
set a single username and password with the --user and --pass flags.

Use --htpasswd /path/to/htpasswd to provide an htpasswd file. This is
in standard apache format and supports MD5, SHA1 and BCrypt for basic
authentication. Bcrypt is recommended.

To create an htpasswd file:

touch htpasswd
htpasswd -B htpasswd user
htpasswd -B htpasswd anotherUser

The password file can be updated while rclone is running.

Use --realm to set the authentication realm.

SSL/TLS

By default this will serve over http. If you want you can serve over
https. You will need to supply the --cert and --key flags. If you
wish to do client side certificate validation then you will need to
supply --client-ca also.

--cert should be either a PEM encoded certificate or a concatenation
of that with the CA certificate. --key should be the PEM encoded
private key and --client-ca should be the PEM encoded client
certificate authority certificate.

VFS - Virtual File System

This command uses the VFS layer. This adapts the cloud storage objects
that rclone uses into something which looks much more like a disk
filing system.

Cloud storage objects have lots of properties which aren't like disk
files - you can't extend them or write to the middle of them, so the
VFS layer has to deal with that. Because there is no one right way of
doing this there are various options explained below.

The VFS layer also implements a directory cache - this caches info
about files and directories (but not the data) in memory.

VFS Directory Cache

Using the --dir-cache-time flag, you can control how long a
directory should be considered up to date and not refreshed from the
backend. Changes made through the mount will appear immediately or
invalidate the cache.

--dir-cache-time duration   Time to cache directory entries for. (default 5m0s)
--poll-interval duration    Time to wait between polling for changes.

However, changes made directly on the cloud storage by the web
interface or a different copy of rclone will only be picked up once
the directory cache expires if the backend configured does not support
polling for changes. If the backend supports polling, changes will be
picked up within the polling interval.

You can send a SIGHUP signal to rclone for it to flush all
directory caches, regardless of how old they are. Assuming only one
rclone instance is running, you can reset the cache like this:

kill -SIGHUP $(pidof rclone)

If you configure rclone with a remote control then you can use
rclone rc to flush the whole directory cache:

rclone rc vfs/forget

Or individual files or directories:

rclone rc vfs/forget file=path/to/file dir=path/to/dir

VFS File Buffering

The --buffer-size flag determines the amount of memory,
that will be used to buffer data in advance.

Each open file will try to keep the specified amount of data in memory
at all times. The buffered data is bound to one open file and won't be
shared.

This flag is a upper limit for the used memory per open file. The
buffer will only use memory for data that is downloaded but not not
yet read. If the buffer is empty, only a small amount of memory will
be used.

The maximum memory used by rclone for buffering can be up to
--buffer-size * open files.

VFS File Caching

These flags control the VFS file caching options. File caching is
necessary to make the VFS layer appear compatible with a normal file
system. It can be disabled at the cost of some compatibility.

For example you'll need to enable VFS caching if you want to read and
write simultaneously to a file. See below for more details.

Note that the VFS cache is separate from the cache backend and you may
find that you need one or the other or both.

--cache-dir string                   Directory rclone will use for caching.
--vfs-cache-mode CacheMode           Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
--vfs-cache-max-age duration         Max age of objects in the cache. (default 1h0m0s)
--vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix      Max total size of objects in the cache. (default off)
--vfs-cache-poll-interval duration   Interval to poll the cache for stale objects. (default 1m0s)
--vfs-write-back duration            Time to writeback files after last use when using cache. (default 5s)

If run with -vv rclone will print the location of the file cache. The
files are stored in the user cache file area which is OS dependent but
can be controlled with --cache-dir or setting the appropriate
environment variable.

The cache has 4 different modes selected by --vfs-cache-mode.
The higher the cache mode the more compatible rclone becomes at the
cost of using disk space.

Note that files are written back to the remote only when they are
closed and if they haven't been accessed for --vfs-write-back
second. If rclone is quit or dies with files that haven't been
uploaded, these will be uploaded next time rclone is run with the same
flags.

If using --vfs-cache-max-size note that the cache may exceed this size
for two reasons. Firstly because it is only checked every
--vfs-cache-poll-interval. Secondly because open files cannot be
evicted from the cache.

--vfs-cache-mode off

In this mode (the default) the cache will read directly from the remote and write
directly to the remote without caching anything on disk.

This will mean some operations are not possible

  • Files can't be opened for both read AND write
  • Files opened for write can't be seeked
  • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set
  • Files open for read with O_TRUNC will be opened write only
  • Files open for write only will behave as if O_TRUNC was supplied
  • Open modes O_APPEND, O_TRUNC are ignored
  • If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode minimal

This is very similar to "off" except that files opened for read AND
write will be buffered to disk. This means that files opened for
write will be a lot more compatible, but uses the minimal disk space.

These operations are not possible

  • Files opened for write only can't be seeked
  • Existing files opened for write must have O_TRUNC set
  • Files opened for write only will ignore O_APPEND, O_TRUNC
  • If an upload fails it can't be retried

--vfs-cache-mode writes

In this mode files opened for read only are still read directly from
the remote, write only and read/write files are buffered to disk
first.

This mode should support all normal file system operations.

If an upload fails it will be retried at exponentially increasing
intervals up to 1 minute.

--vfs-cache-mode full

In this mode all reads and writes are buffered to and from disk. When
data is read from the remote this is buffered to disk as well.

In this mode the files in the cache will be sparse files and rclone
will keep track of which bits of the files it has downloaded.

So if an application only reads the starts of each file, then rclone
will only buffer the start of the file. These files will appear to be
their full size in the cache, but they will be sparse files with only
the data that has been downloaded present in them.

This mode should support all normal file system operations and is
otherwise identical to --vfs-cache-mode writes.

When reading a file rclone will read --buffer-size plus
--vfs-read-ahead bytes ahead. The --buffer-size is buffered in memory
whereas the --vfs-read-ahead is buffered on disk.

When using this mode it is recommended that --buffer-size is not set
too big and --vfs-read-ahead is set large if required.

IMPORTANT not all file systems support sparse files. In particular
FAT/exFAT do not. Rclone will perform very badly if the cache
directory is on a filesystem which doesn't support sparse files and it
will log an ERROR message if one is detected.

VFS Performance

These flags may be used to enable/disable features of the VFS for
performance or other reasons.

In particular S3 and Swift benefit hugely from the --no-modtime flag
(or use --use-server-modtime for a slightly different effect) as each
read of the modification time takes a transaction.

--no-checksum     Don't compare checksums on up/download.
--no-modtime      Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
--no-seek         Don't allow seeking in files.
--read-only       Mount read-only.

When rclone reads files from a remote it reads them in chunks. This
means that rather than requesting the whole file rclone reads the
chunk specified. This is advantageous because some cloud providers
account for reads being all the data requested, not all the data
delivered.

Rclone will keep doubling the chunk size requested starting at
--vfs-read-chunk-size with a maximum of --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit
unless it is set to "off" in which case there will be no limit.

--vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix        Read the source objects in chunks. (default 128M)
--vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix  Max chunk doubling size (default "off")

Sometimes rclone is delivered reads or writes out of order. Rather
than seeking rclone will wait a short time for the in sequence read or
write to come in. These flags only come into effect when not using an
on disk cache file.

--vfs-read-wait duration   Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking. (default 20ms)
--vfs-write-wait duration  Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error. (default 1s)

When using VFS write caching (--vfs-cache-mode with value writes or full),
the global flag --transfers can be set to adjust the number of parallel uploads of
modified files from cache (the related global flag --checkers have no effect on mount).

--transfers int  Number of file transfers to run in parallel. (default 4)

VFS Case Sensitivity

Linux file systems are case-sensitive: two files can differ only
by case, and the exact case must be used when opening a file.

File systems in modern Windows are case-insensitive but case-preserving:
although existing files can be opened using any case, the exact case used
to create the file is preserved and available for programs to query.
It is not allowed for two files in the same directory to differ only by case.

Usually file systems on macOS are case-insensitive. It is possible to make macOS
file systems case-sensitive but that is not the default

The --vfs-case-insensitive mount flag controls how rclone handles these
two cases. If its value is "false", rclone passes file names to the mounted
file system as-is. If the flag is "true" (or appears without a value on
command line), rclone may perform a "fixup" as explained below.

The user may specify a file name to open/delete/rename/etc with a case
different than what is stored on mounted file system. If an argument refers
to an existing file with exactly the same name, then the case of the existing
file on the disk will be used. However, if a file name with exactly the same
name is not found but a name differing only by case exists, rclone will
transparently fixup the name. This fixup happens only when an existing file
is requested. Case sensitivity of file names created anew by rclone is
controlled by an underlying mounted file system.

Note that case sensitivity of the operating system running rclone (the target)
may differ from case sensitivity of a file system mounted by rclone (the source).
The flag controls whether "fixup" is performed to satisfy the target.

If the flag is not provided on the command line, then its default value depends
on the operating system where rclone runs: "true" on Windows and macOS, "false"
otherwise. If the flag is provided without a value, then it is "true".

Auth Proxy

If you supply the parameter --auth-proxy /path/to/program then
rclone will use that program to generate backends on the fly which
then are used to authenticate incoming requests. This uses a simple
JSON based protocol with input on STDIN and output on STDOUT.

PLEASE NOTE: --auth-proxy and --authorized-keys cannot be used
together, if --auth-proxy is set the authorized keys option will be
ignored.

There is an example program
bin/test_proxy.py
in the rclone source code.

The program's job is to take a user and pass on the input and turn
those into the config for a backend on STDOUT in JSON format. This
config will have any default parameters for the backend added, but it
won't use configuration from environment variables or command line
options - it is the job of the proxy program to make a complete
config.

This config generated must have this extra parameter

  • _root - root to use for the backend

And it may have this parameter

  • _obscure - comma separated strings for parameters to obscure

If password authentication was used by the client, input to the proxy
process (on STDIN) would look similar to this:

{
	"user": "me",
	"pass": "mypassword"
}

If public-key authentication was used by the client, input to the
proxy process (on STDIN) would look similar to this:

{
	"user": "me",
	"public_key": "AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAADAQABAAABAQDuwESFdAe14hVS6omeyX7edc...JQdf"
}

And as an example return this on STDOUT

{
	"type": "sftp",
	"_root": "",
	"_obscure": "pass",
	"user": "me",
	"pass": "mypassword",
	"host": "sftp.example.com"
}

This would mean that an SFTP backend would be created on the fly for
the user and pass/public_key returned in the output to the host given. Note
that since _obscure is set to pass, rclone will obscure the pass
parameter before creating the backend (which is required for sftp
backends).

The program can manipulate the supplied user in any way, for example
to make proxy to many different sftp backends, you could make the
user be user@example.com and then set the host to example.com
in the output and the user to user. For security you'd probably want
to restrict the host to a limited list.

Note that an internal cache is keyed on user so only use that for
configuration, don't use pass or public_key. This also means that if a user's
password or public-key is changed the cache will need to expire (which takes 5 mins)
before it takes effect.

This can be used to build general purpose proxies to any kind of
backend that rclone supports.

rclone serve webdav remote:path [flags]

Options

      --addr string                            IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to. (default "localhost:8080")
      --auth-proxy string                      A program to use to create the backend from the auth.
      --baseurl string                         Prefix for URLs - leave blank for root.
      --cert string                            SSL PEM key (concatenation of certificate and CA certificate)
      --client-ca string                       Client certificate authority to verify clients with
      --dir-cache-time duration                Time to cache directory entries for. (default 5m0s)
      --dir-perms FileMode                     Directory permissions (default 0777)
      --disable-dir-list                       Disable HTML directory list on GET request for a directory
      --etag-hash string                       Which hash to use for the ETag, or auto or blank for off
      --file-perms FileMode                    File permissions (default 0666)
      --gid uint32                             Override the gid field set by the filesystem. Not supported on Windows. (default 1000)
  -h, --help                                   help for webdav
      --htpasswd string                        htpasswd file - if not provided no authentication is done
      --key string                             SSL PEM Private key
      --max-header-bytes int                   Maximum size of request header (default 4096)
      --no-checksum                            Don't compare checksums on up/download.
      --no-modtime                             Don't read/write the modification time (can speed things up).
      --no-seek                                Don't allow seeking in files.
      --pass string                            Password for authentication.
      --poll-interval duration                 Time to wait between polling for changes. Must be smaller than dir-cache-time. Only on supported remotes. Set to 0 to disable. (default 1m0s)
      --read-only                              Mount read-only.
      --realm string                           realm for authentication (default "rclone")
      --server-read-timeout duration           Timeout for server reading data (default 1h0m0s)
      --server-write-timeout duration          Timeout for server writing data (default 1h0m0s)
      --template string                        User Specified Template.
      --uid uint32                             Override the uid field set by the filesystem. Not supported on Windows. (default 1000)
      --umask int                              Override the permission bits set by the filesystem. Not supported on Windows. (default 2)
      --user string                            User name for authentication.
      --vfs-cache-max-age duration             Max age of objects in the cache. (default 1h0m0s)
      --vfs-cache-max-size SizeSuffix          Max total size of objects in the cache. (default off)
      --vfs-cache-mode CacheMode               Cache mode off|minimal|writes|full (default off)
      --vfs-cache-poll-interval duration       Interval to poll the cache for stale objects. (default 1m0s)
      --vfs-case-insensitive                   If a file name not found, find a case insensitive match.
      --vfs-read-ahead SizeSuffix              Extra read ahead over --buffer-size when using cache-mode full.
      --vfs-read-chunk-size SizeSuffix         Read the source objects in chunks. (default 128M)
      --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit SizeSuffix   If greater than --vfs-read-chunk-size, double the chunk size after each chunk read, until the limit is reached. 'off' is unlimited. (default off)
      --vfs-read-wait duration                 Time to wait for in-sequence read before seeking. (default 20ms)
      --vfs-write-back duration                Time to writeback files after last use when using cache. (default 5s)
      --vfs-write-wait duration                Time to wait for in-sequence write before giving error. (default 1s)

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

rclone settier

Changes storage class/tier of objects in remote.

Synopsis

rclone settier changes storage tier or class at remote if supported.
Few cloud storage services provides different storage classes on objects,
for example AWS S3 and Glacier, Azure Blob storage - Hot, Cool and Archive,
Google Cloud Storage, Regional Storage, Nearline, Coldline etc.

Note that, certain tier changes make objects not available to access immediately.
For example tiering to archive in azure blob storage makes objects in frozen state,
user can restore by setting tier to Hot/Cool, similarly S3 to Glacier makes object
inaccessible.true

You can use it to tier single object

rclone settier Cool remote:path/file

Or use rclone filters to set tier on only specific files

rclone --include "*.txt" settier Hot remote:path/dir

Or just provide remote directory and all files in directory will be tiered

rclone settier tier remote:path/dir
rclone settier tier remote:path [flags]

Options

  -h, --help   help for settier

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone touch

Create new file or change file modification time.

Synopsis

Set the modification time on object(s) as specified by remote:path to
have the current time.

If remote:path does not exist then a zero sized object will be created
unless the --no-create flag is provided.

If --timestamp is used then it will set the modification time to that
time instead of the current time. Times may be specified as one of:

  • 'YYMMDD' - e.g. 17.10.30
  • 'YYYY-MM-DDTHH:MM:SS' - e.g. 2006-01-02T15:04:05
  • 'YYYY-MM-DDTHH:MM:SS.SSS' - e.g. 2006-01-02T15:04:05.123456789

Note that --timestamp is in UTC if you want local time then add the
--localtime flag.

rclone touch remote:path [flags]

Options

  -h, --help               help for touch
      --localtime          Use localtime for timestamp, not UTC.
  -C, --no-create          Do not create the file if it does not exist.
  -t, --timestamp string   Use specified time instead of the current time of day.

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

rclone tree

List the contents of the remote in a tree like fashion.

Synopsis

rclone tree lists the contents of a remote in a similar way to the
unix tree command.

For example

$ rclone tree remote:path
/
├── file1
├── file2
├── file3
└── subdir
    ├── file4
    └── file5

1 directories, 5 files

You can use any of the filtering options with the tree command (e.g.
--include and --exclude). You can also use --fast-list.

The tree command has many options for controlling the listing which
are compatible with the tree command. Note that not all of them have
short options as they conflict with rclone's short options.

rclone tree remote:path [flags]

Options

  -a, --all             All files are listed (list . files too).
  -C, --color           Turn colorization on always.
  -d, --dirs-only       List directories only.
      --dirsfirst       List directories before files (-U disables).
      --full-path       Print the full path prefix for each file.
  -h, --help            help for tree
      --human           Print the size in a more human readable way.
      --level int       Descend only level directories deep.
  -D, --modtime         Print the date of last modification.
      --noindent        Don't print indentation lines.
      --noreport        Turn off file/directory count at end of tree listing.
  -o, --output string   Output to file instead of stdout.
  -p, --protections     Print the protections for each file.
  -Q, --quote           Quote filenames with double quotes.
  -s, --size            Print the size in bytes of each file.
      --sort string     Select sort: name,version,size,mtime,ctime.
      --sort-ctime      Sort files by last status change time.
  -t, --sort-modtime    Sort files by last modification time.
  -r, --sort-reverse    Reverse the order of the sort.
  -U, --unsorted        Leave files unsorted.
      --version         Sort files alphanumerically by version.

See the global flags page for global options not listed here.

SEE ALSO

  • rclone - Show help for rclone commands, flags and backends.

Copying single files

rclone normally syncs or copies directories. However, if the source
remote points to a file, rclone will just copy that file. The
destination remote must point to a directory - rclone will give the
error Failed to create file system for "remote:file": is a file not a directory if it isn't.

For example, suppose you have a remote with a file in called
test.jpg, then you could copy just that file like this

rclone copy remote:test.jpg /tmp/download

The file test.jpg will be placed inside /tmp/download.

This is equivalent to specifying

rclone copy --files-from /tmp/files remote: /tmp/download

Where /tmp/files contains the single line

test.jpg

It is recommended to use copy when copying individual files, not sync.
They have pretty much the same effect but copy will use a lot less
memory.

Syntax of remote paths

The syntax of the paths passed to the rclone command are as follows.

/path/to/dir

This refers to the local file system.

On Windows only \ may be used instead of / in local paths
only, non local paths must use /.

These paths needn't start with a leading / - if they don't then they
will be relative to the current directory.

remote:path/to/dir

This refers to a directory path/to/dir on remote: as defined in
the config file (configured with rclone config).

remote:/path/to/dir

On most backends this is refers to the same directory as
remote:path/to/dir and that format should be preferred. On a very
small number of remotes (FTP, SFTP, Dropbox for business) this will
refer to a different directory. On these, paths without a leading /
will refer to your "home" directory and paths with a leading / will
refer to the root.

:backend:path/to/dir

This is an advanced form for creating remotes on the fly. backend
should be the name or prefix of a backend (the type in the config
file) and all the configuration for the backend should be provided on
the command line (or in environment variables).

Here are some examples:

rclone lsd --http-url https://pub.rclone.org :http:

To list all the directories in the root of https://pub.rclone.org/.

rclone lsf --http-url https://example.com :http:path/to/dir

To list files and directories in https://example.com/path/to/dir/

rclone copy --http-url https://example.com :http:path/to/dir /tmp/dir

To copy files and directories in https://example.com/path/to/dir to /tmp/dir.

rclone copy --sftp-host example.com :sftp:path/to/dir /tmp/dir

To copy files and directories from example.com in the relative
directory path/to/dir to /tmp/dir using sftp.

Valid remote names

  • Remote names may only contain 0-9, A-Z ,a-z ,_ , - and space.
  • Remote names may not start with -.

Quoting and the shell

When you are typing commands to your computer you are using something
called the command line shell. This interprets various characters in
an OS specific way.

Here are some gotchas which may help users unfamiliar with the shell rules

Linux / OSX

If your names have spaces or shell metacharacters (e.g. *, ?, $,
', ", etc.) then you must quote them. Use single quotes ' by default.

rclone copy 'Important files?' remote:backup

If you want to send a ' you will need to use ", e.g.

rclone copy "O'Reilly Reviews" remote:backup

The rules for quoting metacharacters are complicated and if you want
the full details you'll have to consult the manual page for your
shell.

Windows

If your names have spaces in you need to put them in ", e.g.

rclone copy "E:\folder name\folder name\folder name" remote:backup

If you are using the root directory on its own then don't quote it
(see #464 for why), e.g.

rclone copy E:\ remote:backup

Copying files or directories with : in the names

rclone uses : to mark a remote name. This is, however, a valid
filename component in non-Windows OSes. The remote name parser will
only search for a : up to the first / so if you need to act on a
file or directory like this then use the full path starting with a
/, or use ./ as a current directory prefix.

So to sync a directory called sync:me to a remote called remote: use

rclone sync -i ./sync:me remote:path

or

rclone sync -i /full/path/to/sync:me remote:path

Server Side Copy

Most remotes (but not all - see the
overview
) support server-side copy.

This means if you want to copy one folder to another then rclone won't
download all the files and re-upload them; it will instruct the server
to copy them in place.

Eg

rclone copy s3:oldbucket s3:newbucket

Will copy the contents of oldbucket to newbucket without
downloading and re-uploading.

Remotes which don't support server-side copy will download and
re-upload in this case.

Server side copies are used with sync and copy and will be
identified in the log when using the -v flag. The move command
may also use them if remote doesn't support server-side move directly.
This is done by issuing a server-side copy then a delete which is much
quicker than a download and re-upload.

Server side copies will only be attempted if the remote names are the
same.

This can be used when scripting to make aged backups efficiently, e.g.

rclone sync -i remote:current-backup remote:previous-backup
rclone sync -i /path/to/files remote:current-backup

Options

Rclone has a number of options to control its behaviour.

Options that take parameters can have the values passed in two ways,
--option=value or --option value. However boolean (true/false)
options behave slightly differently to the other options in that
--boolean sets the option to true and the absence of the flag sets
it to false. It is also possible to specify --boolean=false or
--boolean=true. Note that --boolean false is not valid - this is
parsed as --boolean and the false is parsed as an extra command
line argument for rclone.

Options which use TIME use the go time parser. A duration string is a
possibly signed sequence of decimal numbers, each with optional
fraction and a unit suffix, such as "300ms", "-1.5h" or "2h45m". Valid
time units are "ns", "us" (or "µs"), "ms", "s", "m", "h".

Options which use SIZE use kByte by default. However, a suffix of b
for bytes, k for kBytes, M for MBytes, G for GBytes, T for
TBytes and P for PBytes may be used. These are the binary units, e.g.
1, 2**10, 2**20, 2**30 respectively.

--backup-dir=DIR

When using sync, copy or move any files which would have been
overwritten or deleted are moved in their original hierarchy into this
directory.

If --suffix is set, then the moved files will have the suffix added
to them. If there is a file with the same path (after the suffix has
been added) in DIR, then it will be overwritten.

The remote in use must support server-side move or copy and you must
use the same remote as the destination of the sync. The backup
directory must not overlap the destination directory.

For example

rclone sync -i /path/to/local remote:current --backup-dir remote:old

will sync /path/to/local to remote:current, but for any files
which would have been updated or deleted will be stored in
remote:old.

If running rclone from a script you might want to use today's date as
the directory name passed to --backup-dir to store the old files, or
you might want to pass --suffix with today's date.

See --compare-dest and --copy-dest.

--bind string

Local address to bind to for outgoing connections. This can be an
IPv4 address (1.2.3.4), an IPv6 address (1234::789A) or host name. If
the host name doesn't resolve or resolves to more than one IP address
it will give an error.

--bwlimit=BANDWIDTH_SPEC

This option controls the bandwidth limit. For example

--bwlimit 10M

would mean limit the upload and download bandwidth to 10 Mbyte/s.
NB this is bytes per second not bits per second. To use a
single limit, specify the desired bandwidth in kBytes/s, or use a
suffix b|k|M|G. The default is 0 which means to not limit bandwidth.

The upload and download bandwidth can be specified seperately, as
--bwlimit UP:DOWN, so

--bwlimit 10M:100k

would mean limit the upload bandwidth to 10 Mbyte/s and the download
bandwidth to 100 kByte/s. Either limit can be "off" meaning no limit, so
to just limit the upload bandwidth you would use

--bwlimit 10M:off

this would limit the upload bandwidth to 10MByte/s but the download
bandwidth would be unlimited.

When specified as above the bandwidth limits last for the duration of
run of the rclone binary.

It is also possible to specify a "timetable" of limits, which will
cause certain limits to be applied at certain times. To specify a
timetable, format your entries as WEEKDAY-HH:MM,BANDWIDTH WEEKDAY-HH:MM,BANDWIDTH... where: WEEKDAY is optional element.

  • BANDWIDTH can be a single number, e.g.100k or a pair of numbers
    for upload:download, e.g.10M:1M.
  • WEEKDAY can be written as the whole word or only using the first 3
    characters. It is optional.
  • HH:MM is an hour from 00:00 to 23:59.

An example of a typical timetable to avoid link saturation during daytime
working hours could be:

--bwlimit "08:00,512k 12:00,10M 13:00,512k 18:00,30M 23:00,off"

In this example, the transfer bandwidth will be set to 512kBytes/sec
at 8am every day. At noon, it will rise to 10Mbytes/s, and drop back
to 512kBytes/sec at 1pm. At 6pm, the bandwidth limit will be set to
30MBytes/s, and at 11pm it will be completely disabled (full speed).
Anything between 11pm and 8am will remain unlimited.

An example of timetable with WEEKDAY could be:

--bwlimit "Mon-00:00,512 Fri-23:59,10M Sat-10:00,1M Sun-20:00,off"

It means that, the transfer bandwidth will be set to 512kBytes/sec on
Monday. It will rise to 10Mbytes/s before the end of Friday. At 10:00
on Saturday it will be set to 1Mbyte/s. From 20:00 on Sunday it will
be unlimited.

Timeslots without WEEKDAY are extended to the whole week. So this
example:

--bwlimit "Mon-00:00,512 12:00,1M Sun-20:00,off"

Is equivalent to this:

--bwlimit "Mon-00:00,512Mon-12:00,1M Tue-12:00,1M Wed-12:00,1M Thu-12:00,1M Fri-12:00,1M Sat-12:00,1M Sun-12:00,1M Sun-20:00,off"

Bandwidth limit apply to the data transfer for all backends. For most
backends the directory listing bandwidth is also included (exceptions
being the non HTTP backends, ftp, sftp and tardigrade).

Note that the units are Bytes/s, not Bits/s. Typically
connections are measured in Bits/s - to convert divide by 8. For
example, let's say you have a 10 Mbit/s connection and you wish rclone
to use half of it - 5 Mbit/s. This is 5/8 = 0.625MByte/s so you would
use a --bwlimit 0.625M parameter for rclone.

On Unix systems (Linux, macOS, …) the bandwidth limiter can be toggled by
sending a SIGUSR2 signal to rclone. This allows to remove the limitations
of a long running rclone transfer and to restore it back to the value specified
with --bwlimit quickly when needed. Assuming there is only one rclone instance
running, you can toggle the limiter like this:

kill -SIGUSR2 $(pidof rclone)

If you configure rclone with a remote control then you can use
change the bwlimit dynamically:

rclone rc core/bwlimit rate=1M

--bwlimit-file=BANDWIDTH_SPEC

This option controls per file bandwidth limit. For the options see the
--bwlimit flag.

For example use this to allow no transfers to be faster than 1MByte/s

--bwlimit-file 1M

This can be used in conjunction with --bwlimit.

Note that if a schedule is provided the file will use the schedule in
effect at the start of the transfer.

--buffer-size=SIZE

Use this sized buffer to speed up file transfers. Each --transfer
will use this much memory for buffering.

When using mount or cmount each open file descriptor will use this much
memory for buffering.
See the mount documentation for more details.

Set to 0 to disable the buffering for the minimum memory usage.

Note that the memory allocation of the buffers is influenced by the
--use-mmap flag.

--check-first

If this flag is set then in a sync, copy or move, rclone will do
all the checks to see whether files need to be transferred before
doing any of the transfers. Normally rclone would start running
transfers as soon as possible.

This flag can be useful on IO limited systems where transfers
interfere with checking.

It can also be useful to ensure perfect ordering when using
--order-by.

Using this flag can use more memory as it effectively sets
--max-backlog to infinite. This means that all the info on the
objects to transfer is held in memory before the transfers start.

--checkers=N

The number of checkers to run in parallel. Checkers do the equality
checking of files during a sync. For some storage systems (e.g. S3,
Swift, Dropbox) this can take a significant amount of time so they are
run in parallel.

The default is to run 8 checkers in parallel.

-c, --checksum

Normally rclone will look at modification time and size of files to
see if they are equal. If you set this flag then rclone will check
the file hash and size to determine if files are equal.

This is useful when the remote doesn't support setting modified time
and a more accurate sync is desired than just checking the file size.

This is very useful when transferring between remotes which store the
same hash type on the object, e.g. Drive and Swift. For details of which
remotes support which hash type see the table in the overview
section
.

Eg rclone --checksum sync s3:/bucket swift:/bucket would run much
quicker than without the --checksum flag.

When using this flag, rclone won't update mtimes of remote files if
they are incorrect as it would normally.

--compare-dest=DIR

When using sync, copy or move DIR is checked in addition to the
destination for files. If a file identical to the source is found that
file is NOT copied from source. This is useful to copy just files that
have changed since the last backup.

You must use the same remote as the destination of the sync. The
compare directory must not overlap the destination directory.

See --copy-dest and --backup-dir.

--config=CONFIG_FILE

Specify the location of the rclone config file.

Normally the config file is in your home directory as a file called
.config/rclone/rclone.conf (or .rclone.conf if created with an
older version). If $XDG_CONFIG_HOME is set it will be at
$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/rclone/rclone.conf.

If there is a file rclone.conf in the same directory as the rclone
executable it will be preferred. This file must be created manually
for Rclone to use it, it will never be created automatically.

If you run rclone config file you will see where the default
location is for you.

Use this flag to override the config location, e.g. rclone --config=".myconfig" .config.

--contimeout=TIME

Set the connection timeout. This should be in go time format which
looks like 5s for 5 seconds, 10m for 10 minutes, or 3h30m.

The connection timeout is the amount of time rclone will wait for a
connection to go through to a remote object storage system. It is
1m by default.

--copy-dest=DIR

When using sync, copy or move DIR is checked in addition to the
destination for files. If a file identical to the source is found that
file is server-side copied from DIR to the destination. This is useful
for incremental backup.

The remote in use must support server-side copy and you must
use the same remote as the destination of the sync. The compare
directory must not overlap the destination directory.

See --compare-dest and --backup-dir.

--dedupe-mode MODE

Mode to run dedupe command in. One of interactive, skip, first, newest, oldest, rename. The default is interactive. See the dedupe command for more information as to what these options mean.

--disable FEATURE,FEATURE,...

This disables a comma separated list of optional features. For example
to disable server-side move and server-side copy use:

--disable move,copy

The features can be put in any case.

To see a list of which features can be disabled use:

--disable help

See the overview features and
optional features to get an idea of
which feature does what.

This flag can be useful for debugging and in exceptional circumstances
(e.g. Google Drive limiting the total volume of Server Side Copies to
100GB/day).

-n, --dry-run

Do a trial run with no permanent changes. Use this to see what rclone
would do without actually doing it. Useful when setting up the sync
command which deletes files in the destination.

--expect-continue-timeout=TIME

This specifies the amount of time to wait for a server's first
response headers after fully writing the request headers if the
request has an "Expect: 100-continue" header. Not all backends support
using this.

Zero means no timeout and causes the body to be sent immediately,
without waiting for the server to approve. This time does not include
the time to send the request header.

The default is 1s. Set to 0 to disable.

--error-on-no-transfer

By default, rclone will exit with return code 0 if there were no errors.

This option allows rclone to return exit code 9 if no files were transferred
between the source and destination. This allows using rclone in scripts, and
triggering follow-on actions if data was copied, or skipping if not.

NB: Enabling this option turns a usually non-fatal error into a potentially
fatal one - please check and adjust your scripts accordingly!

--header

Add an HTTP header for all transactions. The flag can be repeated to
add multiple headers.

If you want to add headers only for uploads use --header-upload and
if you want to add headers only for downloads use --header-download.

This flag is supported for all HTTP based backends even those not
supported by --header-upload and --header-download so may be used
as a workaround for those with care.

rclone ls remote:test --header "X-Rclone: Foo" --header "X-LetMeIn: Yes"

--header-download

Add an HTTP header for all download transactions. The flag can be repeated to
add multiple headers.

rclone sync -i s3:test/src ~/dst --header-download "X-Amz-Meta-Test: Foo" --header-download "X-Amz-Meta-Test2: Bar"

See the GitHub issue here for
currently supported backends.

--header-upload

Add an HTTP header for all upload transactions. The flag can be repeated to add
multiple headers.

rclone sync -i ~/src s3:test/dst --header-upload "Content-Disposition: attachment; filename='cool.html'" --header-upload "X-Amz-Meta-Test: FooBar"

See the GitHub issue here for
currently supported backends.

--ignore-case-sync

Using this option will cause rclone to ignore the case of the files
when synchronizing so files will not be copied/synced when the
existing filenames are the same, even if the casing is different.

--ignore-checksum

Normally rclone will check that the checksums of transferred files
match, and give an error "corrupted on transfer" if they don't.

You can use this option to skip that check. You should only use it if
you have had the "corrupted on transfer" error message and you are
sure you might want to transfer potentially corrupted data.

--ignore-existing

Using this option will make rclone unconditionally skip all files
that exist on the destination, no matter the content of these files.

While this isn't a generally recommended option, it can be useful
in cases where your files change due to encryption. However, it cannot
correct partial transfers in case a transfer was interrupted.

--ignore-size

Normally rclone will look at modification time and size of files to
see if they are equal. If you set this flag then rclone will check
only the modification time. If --checksum is set then it only
checks the checksum.

It will also cause rclone to skip verifying the sizes are the same
after transfer.

This can be useful for transferring files to and from OneDrive which
occasionally misreports the size of image files (see
#399 for more info).

-I, --ignore-times

Using this option will cause rclone to unconditionally upload all
files regardless of the state of files on the destination.

Normally rclone would skip any files that have the same
modification time and are the same size (or have the same checksum if
using --checksum).

--immutable

Treat source and destination files as immutable and disallow
modification.

With this option set, files will be created and deleted as requested,
but existing files will never be updated. If an existing file does
not match between the source and destination, rclone will give the error
Source and destination exist but do not match: immutable file modified.

Note that only commands which transfer files (e.g. sync, copy,
move) are affected by this behavior, and only modification is
disallowed. Files may still be deleted explicitly (e.g. delete,
purge) or implicitly (e.g. sync, move). Use copy --immutable
if it is desired to avoid deletion as well as modification.

This can be useful as an additional layer of protection for immutable
or append-only data sets (notably backup archives), where modification
implies corruption and should not be propagated.

-i / --interactive

This flag can be used to tell rclone that you wish a manual
confirmation before destructive operations.

It is recommended that you use this flag while learning rclone
especially with rclone sync.

For example

$ rclone delete -i /tmp/dir
rclone: delete "important-file.txt"?
y) Yes, this is OK (default)
n) No, skip this
s) Skip all delete operations with no more questions
!) Do all delete operations with no more questions
q) Exit rclone now.
y/n/s/!/q> n

The options mean

  • y: Yes, this operation should go ahead. You can also press Return
    for this to happen. You'll be asked every time unless you choose s
    or !.
  • n: No, do not do this operation. You'll be asked every time unless
    you choose s or !.
  • s: Skip all the following operations of this type with no more
    questions. This takes effect until rclone exits. If there are any
    different kind of operations you'll be prompted for them.
  • !: Do all the following operations with no more
    questions. Useful if you've decided that you don't mind rclone doing
    that kind of operation. This takes effect until rclone exits . If
    there are any different kind of operations you'll be prompted for
    them.
  • q: Quit rclone now, just in case!

--leave-root

During rmdirs it will not remove root directory, even if it's empty.

--log-file=FILE

Log all of rclone's output to FILE. This is not active by default.
This can be useful for tracking down problems with syncs in
combination with the -v flag. See the Logging section
for more info.

If FILE exists then rclone will append to it.

Note that if you are using the logrotate program to manage rclone's
logs, then you should use the copytruncate option as rclone doesn't
have a signal to rotate logs.

--log-format LIST

Comma separated list of log format options. date, time, microseconds, longfile, shortfile, UTC. The default is "date,time".

--log-level LEVEL

This sets the log level for rclone. The default log level is NOTICE.

DEBUG is equivalent to -vv. It outputs lots of debug info - useful
for bug reports and really finding out what rclone is doing.

INFO is equivalent to -v. It outputs information about each transfer
and prints stats once a minute by default.

NOTICE is the default log level if no logging flags are supplied. It
outputs very little when things are working normally. It outputs
warnings and significant events.

ERROR is equivalent to -q. It only outputs error messages.

--use-json-log

This switches the log format to JSON for rclone. The fields of json log
are level, msg, source, time.

--low-level-retries NUMBER

This controls the number of low level retries rclone does.

A low level retry is used to retry a failing operation - typically one
HTTP request. This might be uploading a chunk of a big file for
example. You will see low level retries in the log with the -v
flag.

This shouldn't need to be changed from the default in normal operations.
However, if you get a lot of low level retries you may wish
to reduce the value so rclone moves on to a high level retry (see the
--retries flag) quicker.

Disable low level retries with --low-level-retries 1.

--max-backlog=N

This is the maximum allowable backlog of files in a sync/copy/move
queued for being checked or transferred.

This can be set arbitrarily large. It will only use memory when the
queue is in use. Note that it will use in the order of N kB of memory
when the backlog is in use.

Setting this large allows rclone to calculate how many files are
pending more accurately, give a more accurate estimated finish
time and make --order-by work more accurately.

Setting this small will make rclone more synchronous to the listings
of the remote which may be desirable.

Setting this to a negative number will make the backlog as large as
possible.

--max-delete=N

This tells rclone not to delete more than N files. If that limit is
exceeded then a fatal error will be generated and rclone will stop the
operation in progress.

--max-depth=N

This modifies the recursion depth for all the commands except purge.

So if you do rclone --max-depth 1 ls remote:path you will see only
the files in the top level directory. Using --max-depth 2 means you
will see all the files in first two directory levels and so on.

For historical reasons the lsd command defaults to using a
--max-depth of 1 - you can override this with the command line flag.

You can use this command to disable recursion (with --max-depth 1).

Note that if you use this with sync and --delete-excluded the
files not recursed through are considered excluded and will be deleted
on the destination. Test first with --dry-run if you are not sure
what will happen.

--max-duration=TIME

Rclone will stop scheduling new transfers when it has run for the
duration specified.

Defaults to off.

When the limit is reached any existing transfers will complete.

Rclone won't exit with an error if the transfer limit is reached.

--max-transfer=SIZE

Rclone will stop transferring when it has reached the size specified.
Defaults to off.

When the limit is reached all transfers will stop immediately.

Rclone will exit with exit code 8 if the transfer limit is reached.

--cutoff-mode=hard|soft|cautious

This modifies the behavior of --max-transfer
Defaults to --cutoff-mode=hard.

Specifying --cutoff-mode=hard will stop transferring immediately
when Rclone reaches the limit.

Specifying --cutoff-mode=soft will stop starting new transfers
when Rclone reaches the limit.

Specifying --cutoff-mode=cautious will try to prevent Rclone
from reaching the limit.

--modify-window=TIME

When checking whether a file has been modified, this is the maximum
allowed time difference that a file can have and still be considered
equivalent.

The default is 1ns unless this is overridden by a remote. For
example OS X only stores modification times to the nearest second so
if you are reading and writing to an OS X filing system this will be
1s by default.

This command line flag allows you to override that computed default.

--multi-thread-cutoff=SIZE

When downloading files to the local backend above this size, rclone
will use multiple threads to download the file (default 250M).

Rclone preallocates the file (using fallocate(FALLOC_FL_KEEP_SIZE)
on unix or NTSetInformationFile on Windows both of which takes no
time) then each thread writes directly into the file at the correct
place. This means that rclone won't create fragmented or sparse files
and there won't be any assembly time at the end of the transfer.

The number of threads used to download is controlled by
--multi-thread-streams.

Use -vv if you wish to see info about the threads.

This will work with the sync/copy/move commands and friends
copyto/moveto. Multi thread downloads will be used with rclone mount and rclone serve if --vfs-cache-mode is set to writes or
above.

NB that this only works for a local destination but will work
with any source.

NB that multi thread copies are disabled for local to local copies
as they are faster without unless --multi-thread-streams is set
explicitly.

NB on Windows using multi-thread downloads will cause the
resulting files to be sparse.
Use --local-no-sparse to disable sparse files (which may cause long
delays at the start of downloads) or disable multi-thread downloads
with --multi-thread-streams 0

--multi-thread-streams=N

When using multi thread downloads (see above --multi-thread-cutoff)
this sets the maximum number of streams to use. Set to 0 to disable
multi thread downloads (Default 4).

Exactly how many streams rclone uses for the download depends on the
size of the file. To calculate the number of download streams Rclone
divides the size of the file by the --multi-thread-cutoff and rounds
up, up to the maximum set with --multi-thread-streams.

So if --multi-thread-cutoff 250MB and --multi-thread-streams 4 are
in effect (the defaults):

  • 0MB..250MB files will be downloaded with 1 stream
  • 250MB..500MB files will be downloaded with 2 streams
  • 500MB..750MB files will be downloaded with 3 streams
  • 750MB+ files will be downloaded with 4 streams

--no-check-dest

The --no-check-dest can be used with move or copy and it causes
rclone not to check the destination at all when copying files.

This means that:

  • the destination is not listed minimising the API calls
  • files are always transferred
  • this can cause duplicates on remotes which allow it (e.g. Google Drive)
  • --retries 1 is recommended otherwise you'll transfer everything again on a retry

This flag is useful to minimise the transactions if you know that none
of the files are on the destination.

This is a specialized flag which should be ignored by most users!

--no-gzip-encoding

Don't set Accept-Encoding: gzip. This means that rclone won't ask
the server for compressed files automatically. Useful if you've set
the server to return files with Content-Encoding: gzip but you
uploaded compressed files.

There is no need to set this in normal operation, and doing so will
decrease the network transfer efficiency of rclone.

--no-traverse

The --no-traverse flag controls whether the destination file system
is traversed when using the copy or move commands.
--no-traverse is not compatible with sync and will be ignored if
you supply it with sync.

If you are only copying a small number of files (or are filtering most
of the files) and/or have a large number of files on the destination
then --no-traverse will stop rclone listing the destination and save
time.

However, if you are copying a large number of files, especially if you
are doing a copy where lots of the files under consideration haven't
changed and won't need copying then you shouldn't use --no-traverse.

See rclone copy for an example of how to use it.

--no-unicode-normalization

Don't normalize unicode characters in filenames during the sync routine.

Sometimes, an operating system will store filenames containing unicode
parts in their decomposed form (particularly macOS). Some cloud storage
systems will then recompose the unicode, resulting in duplicate files if
the data is ever copied back to a local filesystem.

Using this flag will disable that functionality, treating each unicode
character as unique. For example, by default é and é will be normalized
into the same character. With --no-unicode-normalization they will be
treated as unique characters.

--no-update-modtime

When using this flag, rclone won't update modification times of remote
files if they are incorrect as it would normally.

This can be used if the remote is being synced with another tool also
(e.g. the Google Drive client).

--order-by string

The --order-by flag controls the order in which files in the backlog
are processed in rclone sync, rclone copy and rclone move.

The order by string is constructed like this. The first part
describes what aspect is being measured:

  • size - order by the size of the files
  • name - order by the full path of the files
  • modtime - order by the modification date of the files

This can have a modifier appended with a comma:

  • ascending or asc - order so that the smallest (or oldest) is processed first
  • descending or desc - order so that the largest (or newest) is processed first
  • mixed - order so that the smallest is processed first for some threads and the largest for others

If the modifier is mixed then it can have an optional percentage
(which defaults to 50), e.g. size,mixed,25 which means that 25% of
the threads should be taking the smallest items and 75% the
largest. The threads which take the smallest first will always take
the smallest first and likewise the largest first threads. The mixed
mode can be useful to minimise the transfer time when you are
transferring a mixture of large and small files - the large files are
guaranteed upload threads and bandwidth and the small files will be
processed continuously.

If no modifier is supplied then the order is ascending.

For example

  • --order-by size,desc - send the largest files first
  • --order-by modtime,ascending - send the oldest files first
  • --order-by name - send the files with alphabetically by path first

If the --order-by flag is not supplied or it is supplied with an
empty string then the default ordering will be used which is as
scanned. With --checkers 1 this is mostly alphabetical, however
with the default --checkers 8 it is somewhat random.

Limitations

The --order-by flag does not do a separate pass over the data. This
means that it may transfer some files out of the order specified if

  • there are no files in the backlog or the source has not been fully scanned yet
  • there are more than --max-backlog files in the backlog

Rclone will do its best to transfer the best file it has so in
practice this should not cause a problem. Think of --order-by as
being more of a best efforts flag rather than a perfect ordering.

If you want perfect ordering then you will need to specify
--check-first which will find all the files which need
transferring first before transferring any.

--password-command SpaceSepList

This flag supplies a program which should supply the config password
when run. This is an alternative to rclone prompting for the password
or setting the RCLONE_CONFIG_PASS variable.

The argument to this should be a command with a space separated list
of arguments. If one of the arguments has a space in then enclose it
in ", if you want a literal " in an argument then enclose the
argument in " and double the ". See CSV encoding
for more info.

Eg

--password-command echo hello
--password-command echo "hello with space"
--password-command echo "hello with ""quotes"" and space"

See the Configuration Encryption for more info.

See a Windows PowerShell example on the Wiki.

-P, --progress

This flag makes rclone update the stats in a static block in the
terminal providing a realtime overview of the transfer.

Any log messages will scroll above the static block. Log messages
will push the static block down to the bottom of the terminal where it
will stay.

Normally this is updated every 500mS but this period can be overridden
with the --stats flag.

This can be used with the --stats-one-line flag for a simpler
display.

Note: On Windows until this bug
is fixed all non-ASCII characters will be replaced with . when
--progress is in use.

--progress-terminal-title

This flag, when used with -P/--progress, will print the string ETA: %s
to the terminal title.

-q, --quiet

This flag will limit rclone's output to error messages only.

--refresh-times

The --refresh-times flag can be used to update modification times of
existing files when they are out of sync on backends which don't
support hashes.

This is useful if you uploaded files with the incorrect timestamps and
you now wish to correct them.

This flag is only useful for destinations which don't support
hashes (e.g. crypt).

This can be used any of the sync commands sync, copy or move.

To use this flag you will need to be doing a modification time sync
(so not using --size-only or --checksum). The flag will have no
effect when using --size-only or --checksum.

If this flag is used when rclone comes to upload a file it will check
to see if there is an existing file on the destination. If this file
matches the source with size (and checksum if available) but has a
differing timestamp then instead of re-uploading it, rclone will
update the timestamp on the destination file. If the checksum does not
match rclone will upload the new file. If the checksum is absent (e.g.
on a crypt backend) then rclone will update the timestamp.

Note that some remotes can't set the modification time without
re-uploading the file so this flag is less useful on them.

Normally if you are doing a modification time sync rclone will update
modification times without --refresh-times provided that the remote
supports checksums and the checksums match on the file. However if the
checksums are absent then rclone will upload the file rather than
setting the timestamp as this is the safe behaviour.

--retries int

Retry the entire sync if it fails this many times it fails (default 3).

Some remotes can be unreliable and a few retries help pick up the
files which didn't get transferred because of errors.

Disable retries with --retries 1.

--retries-sleep=TIME

This sets the interval between each retry specified by --retries

The default is 0. Use 0 to disable.

--size-only

Normally rclone will look at modification time and size of files to
see if they are equal. If you set this flag then rclone will check
only the size.

This can be useful transferring files from Dropbox which have been
modified by the desktop sync client which doesn't set checksums of
modification times in the same way as rclone.

--stats=TIME

Commands which transfer data (sync, copy, copyto, move,
moveto) will print data transfer stats at regular intervals to show
their progress.

This sets the interval.

The default is 1m. Use 0 to disable.

If you set the stats interval then all commands can show stats. This
can be useful when running other commands, check or mount for
example.

Stats are logged at INFO level by default which means they won't
show at default log level NOTICE. Use --stats-log-level NOTICE or
-v to make them show. See the Logging section for more
info on log levels.

Note that on macOS you can send a SIGINFO (which is normally ctrl-T in
the terminal) to make the stats print immediately.

--stats-file-name-length integer

By default, the --stats output will truncate file names and paths longer
than 40 characters. This is equivalent to providing
--stats-file-name-length 40. Use --stats-file-name-length 0 to disable
any truncation of file names printed by stats.

--stats-log-level string

Log level to show --stats output at. This can be DEBUG, INFO,
NOTICE, or ERROR. The default is INFO. This means at the
default level of logging which is NOTICE the stats won't show - if
you want them to then use --stats-log-level NOTICE. See the Logging
section
for more info on log levels.

--stats-one-line

When this is specified, rclone condenses the stats into a single line
showing the most important stats only.

--stats-one-line-date

When this is specified, rclone enables the single-line stats and prepends
the display with a date string. The default is 2006/01/02 15:04:05 -

--stats-one-line-date-format

When this is specified, rclone enables the single-line stats and prepends
the display with a user-supplied date string. The date string MUST be
enclosed in quotes. Follow golang specs for
date formatting syntax.

--stats-unit=bits|bytes

By default, data transfer rates will be printed in bytes/second.

This option allows the data rate to be printed in bits/second.

Data transfer volume will still be reported in bytes.

The rate is reported as a binary unit, not SI unit. So 1 Mbit/s
equals 1,048,576 bits/s and not 1,000,000 bits/s.

The default is bytes.

--suffix=SUFFIX

When using sync, copy or move any files which would have been
overwritten or deleted will have the suffix added to them. If there
is a file with the same path (after the suffix has been added), then
it will be overwritten.

The remote in use must support server-side move or copy and you must
use the same remote as the destination of the sync.

This is for use with files to add the suffix in the current directory
or with --backup-dir. See --backup-dir for more info.

For example

rclone copy -i /path/to/local/file remote:current --suffix .bak

will copy /path/to/local to remote:current, but for any files
which would have been updated or deleted have .bak added.

If using rclone sync with --suffix and without --backup-dir then
it is recommended to put a filter rule in excluding the suffix
otherwise the sync will delete the backup files.

rclone sync -i /path/to/local/file remote:current --suffix .bak --exclude "*.bak"

--suffix-keep-extension

When using --suffix, setting this causes rclone put the SUFFIX
before the extension of the files that it backs up rather than after.

So let's say we had --suffix -2019-01-01, without the flag file.txt
would be backed up to file.txt-2019-01-01 and with the flag it would
be backed up to file-2019-01-01.txt. This can be helpful to make
sure the suffixed files can still be opened.

--syslog

On capable OSes (not Windows or Plan9) send all log output to syslog.

This can be useful for running rclone in a script or rclone mount.

--syslog-facility string

If using --syslog this sets the syslog facility (e.g. KERN, USER).
See man syslog for a list of possible facilities. The default
facility is DAEMON.

--tpslimit float

Limit transactions per second to this number. Default is 0 which is
used to mean unlimited transactions per second.

A transaction is roughly defined as an API call; its exact meaning
will depend on the backend. For HTTP based backends it is an HTTP
PUT/GET/POST/etc and its response. For FTP/SFTP it is a round trip
transaction over TCP.

For example to limit rclone to 10 transactions per second use
--tpslimit 10, or to 1 transaction every 2 seconds use --tpslimit 0.5.

Use this when the number of transactions per second from rclone is
causing a problem with the cloud storage provider (e.g. getting you
banned or rate limited).

This can be very useful for rclone mount to control the behaviour of
applications using it.

This limit applies to all HTTP based backends and to the FTP and SFTP
backends. It does not apply to the local backend or the Tardigrade
backend.

See also --tpslimit-burst.

--tpslimit-burst int

Max burst of transactions for --tpslimit (default 1).

Normally --tpslimit will do exactly the number of transaction per
second specified. However if you supply --tps-burst then rclone can
save up some transactions from when it was idle giving a burst of up
to the parameter supplied.

For example if you provide --tpslimit-burst 10 then if rclone has
been idle for more than 10*--tpslimit then it can do 10 transactions
very quickly before they are limited again.

This may be used to increase performance of --tpslimit without
changing the long term average number of transactions per second.

--track-renames

By default, rclone doesn't keep track of renamed files, so if you
rename a file locally then sync it to a remote, rclone will delete the
old file on the remote and upload a new copy.

If you use this flag, and the remote supports server-side copy or
server-side move, and the source and destination have a compatible
hash, then this will track renames during sync
operations and perform renaming server-side.

Files will be matched by size and hash - if both match then a rename
will be considered.

If the destination does not support server-side copy or move, rclone
will fall back to the default behaviour and log an error level message
to the console.

Encrypted destinations are not currently supported by --track-renames
if --track-renames-strategy includes hash.

Note that --track-renames is incompatible with --no-traverse and
that it uses extra memory to keep track of all the rename candidates.

Note also that --track-renames is incompatible with
--delete-before and will select --delete-after instead of
--delete-during.

--track-renames-strategy (hash,modtime,leaf,size)

This option changes the matching criteria for --track-renames.

The matching is controlled by a comma separated selection of these tokens:

  • modtime - the modification time of the file - not supported on all backends
  • hash - the hash of the file contents - not supported on all backends
  • leaf - the name of the file not including its directory name
  • size - the size of the file (this is always enabled)

So using --track-renames-strategy modtime,leaf would match files
based on modification time, the leaf of the file name and the size
only.

Using --track-renames-strategy modtime or leaf can enable
--track-renames support for encrypted destinations.

If nothing is specified, the default option is matching by hashes.

Note that the hash strategy is not supported with encrypted destinations.

--delete-(before,during,after)

This option allows you to specify when files on your destination are
deleted when you sync folders.

Specifying the value --delete-before will delete all files present
on the destination, but not on the source before starting the
transfer of any new or updated files. This uses two passes through the
file systems, one for the deletions and one for the copies.

Specifying --delete-during will delete files while checking and
uploading files. This is the fastest option and uses the least memory.

Specifying --delete-after (the default value) will delay deletion of
files until all new/updated files have been successfully transferred.
The files to be deleted are collected in the copy pass then deleted
after the copy pass has completed successfully. The files to be
deleted are held in memory so this mode may use more memory. This is
the safest mode as it will only delete files if there have been no
errors subsequent to that. If there have been errors before the
deletions start then you will get the message not deleting files as there were IO errors.

--fast-list

When doing anything which involves a directory listing (e.g. sync,
copy, ls - in fact nearly every command), rclone normally lists a
directory and processes it before using more directory lists to
process any subdirectories. This can be parallelised and works very
quickly using the least amount of memory.

However, some remotes have a way of listing all files beneath a
directory in one (or a small number) of transactions. These tend to
be the bucket based remotes (e.g. S3, B2, GCS, Swift, Hubic).

If you use the --fast-list flag then rclone will use this method for
listing directories. This will have the following consequences for
the listing:

  • It will use fewer transactions (important if you pay for them)
  • It will use more memory. Rclone has to load the whole listing into memory.
  • It may be faster because it uses fewer transactions
  • It may be slower because it can't be parallelized

rclone should always give identical results with and without
--fast-list.

If you pay for transactions and can fit your entire sync listing into
memory then --fast-list is recommended. If you have a very big sync
to do then don't use --fast-list otherwise you will run out of
memory.

If you use --fast-list on a remote which doesn't support it, then
rclone will just ignore it.

--timeout=TIME

This sets the IO idle timeout. If a transfer has started but then
becomes idle for this long it is considered broken and disconnected.

The default is 5m. Set to 0 to disable.

--transfers=N

The number of file transfers to run in parallel. It can sometimes be
useful to set this to a smaller number if the remote is giving a lot
of timeouts or bigger if you have lots of bandwidth and a fast remote.

The default is to run 4 file transfers in parallel.

-u, --update

This forces rclone to skip any files which exist on the destination
and have a modified time that is newer than the source file.

This can be useful when transferring to a remote which doesn't support
mod times directly (or when using --use-server-modtime to avoid extra
API calls) as it is more accurate than a --size-only check and faster
than using --checksum.

If an existing destination file has a modification time equal (within
the computed modify window precision) to the source file's, it will be
updated if the sizes are different. If --checksum is set then
rclone will update the destination if the checksums differ too.

If an existing destination file is older than the source file then
it will be updated if the size or checksum differs from the source file.

On remotes which don't support mod time directly (or when using
--use-server-modtime) the time checked will be the uploaded time.
This means that if uploading to one of these remotes, rclone will skip
any files which exist on the destination and have an uploaded time that
is newer than the modification time of the source file.

--use-mmap

If this flag is set then rclone will use anonymous memory allocated by
mmap on Unix based platforms and VirtualAlloc on Windows for its
transfer buffers (size controlled by --buffer-size). Memory
allocated like this does not go on the Go heap and can be returned to
the OS immediately when it is finished with.

If this flag is not set then rclone will allocate and free the buffers
using the Go memory allocator which may use more memory as memory
pages are returned less aggressively to the OS.

It is possible this does not work well on all platforms so it is
disabled by default; in the future it may be enabled by default.

--use-server-modtime

Some object-store backends (e.g, Swift, S3) do not preserve file modification
times (modtime). On these backends, rclone stores the original modtime as
additional metadata on the object. By default it will make an API call to
retrieve the metadata when the modtime is needed by an operation.

Use this flag to disable the extra API call and rely instead on the server's
modified time. In cases such as a local to remote sync using --update,
knowing the local file is newer than the time it was last uploaded to the
remote is sufficient. In those cases, this flag can speed up the process and
reduce the number of API calls necessary.

Using this flag on a sync operation without also using --update would cause
all files modified at any time other than the last upload time to be uploaded
again, which is probably not what you want.

-v, -vv, --verbose

With -v rclone will tell you about each file that is transferred and
a small number of significant events.

With -vv rclone will become very verbose telling you about every
file it considers and transfers. Please send bug reports with a log
with this setting.

-V, --version

Prints the version number

SSL/TLS options

The outgoing SSL/TLS connections rclone makes can be controlled with
these options. For example this can be very useful with the HTTP or
WebDAV backends. Rclone HTTP servers have their own set of
configuration for SSL/TLS which you can find in their documentation.

--ca-cert string

This loads the PEM encoded certificate authority certificate and uses
it to verify the certificates of the servers rclone connects to.

If you have generated certificates signed with a local CA then you
will need this flag to connect to servers using those certificates.

--client-cert string

This loads the PEM encoded client side certificate.

This is used for mutual TLS authentication.

The --client-key flag is required too when using this.

--client-key string

This loads the PEM encoded client side private key used for mutual TLS
authentication. Used in conjunction with --client-cert.

--no-check-certificate=true/false

--no-check-certificate controls whether a client verifies the
server's certificate chain and host name.
If --no-check-certificate is true, TLS accepts any certificate
presented by the server and any host name in that certificate.
In this mode, TLS is susceptible to man-in-the-middle attacks.

This option defaults to false.

This should be used only for testing.

Configuration Encryption

Your configuration file contains information for logging in to
your cloud services. This means that you should keep your
.rclone.conf file in a secure location.

If you are in an environment where that isn't possible, you can
add a password to your configuration. This means that you will
have to supply the password every time you start rclone.

To add a password to your rclone configuration, execute rclone config.

>rclone config
Current remotes:

e) Edit existing remote
n) New remote
d) Delete remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
e/n/d/s/q>

Go into s, Set configuration password:

e/n/d/s/q> s
Your configuration is not encrypted.
If you add a password, you will protect your login information to cloud services.
a) Add Password
q) Quit to main menu
a/q> a
Enter NEW configuration password:
password:
Confirm NEW password:
password:
Password set
Your configuration is encrypted.
c) Change Password
u) Unencrypt configuration
q) Quit to main menu
c/u/q>

Your configuration is now encrypted, and every time you start rclone
you will have to supply the password. See below for details.
In the same menu, you can change the password or completely remove
encryption from your configuration.

There is no way to recover the configuration if you lose your password.

rclone uses nacl secretbox
which in turn uses XSalsa20 and Poly1305 to encrypt and authenticate
your configuration with secret-key cryptography.
The password is SHA-256 hashed, which produces the key for secretbox.
The hashed password is not stored.

While this provides very good security, we do not recommend storing
your encrypted rclone configuration in public if it contains sensitive
information, maybe except if you use a very strong password.

If it is safe in your environment, you can set the RCLONE_CONFIG_PASS
environment variable to contain your password, in which case it will be
used for decrypting the configuration.

You can set this for a session from a script. For unix like systems
save this to a file called set-rclone-password:

#!/bin/echo Source this file don't run it

read -s RCLONE_CONFIG_PASS
export RCLONE_CONFIG_PASS

Then source the file when you want to use it. From the shell you
would do source set-rclone-password. It will then ask you for the
password and set it in the environment variable.

An alternate means of supplying the password is to provide a script
which will retrieve the password and print on standard output. This
script should have a fully specified path name and not rely on any
environment variables. The script is supplied either via
--password-command="..." command line argument or via the
RCLONE_PASSWORD_COMMAND environment variable.

One useful example of this is using the passwordstore application
to retrieve the password:

export RCLONE_PASSWORD_COMMAND="pass rclone/config"

If the passwordstore password manager holds the password for the
rclone configuration, using the script method means the password
is primarily protected by the passwordstore system, and is never
embedded in the clear in scripts, nor available for examination
using the standard commands available. It is quite possible with
long running rclone sessions for copies of passwords to be innocently
captured in log files or terminal scroll buffers, etc. Using the
script method of supplying the password enhances the security of
the config password considerably.

If you are running rclone inside a script, unless you are using the
--password-command method, you might want to disable
password prompts. To do that, pass the parameter
--ask-password=false to rclone. This will make rclone fail instead
of asking for a password if RCLONE_CONFIG_PASS doesn't contain
a valid password, and --password-command has not been supplied.

Developer options

These options are useful when developing or debugging rclone. There
are also some more remote specific options which aren't documented
here which are used for testing. These start with remote name e.g.
--drive-test-option - see the docs for the remote in question.

--cpuprofile=FILE

Write CPU profile to file. This can be analysed with go tool pprof.

--dump flag,flag,flag

The --dump flag takes a comma separated list of flags to dump info
about.

Note that some headers including Accept-Encoding as shown may not
be correct in the request and the response may not show Content-Encoding
if the go standard libraries auto gzip encoding was in effect. In this case
the body of the request will be gunzipped before showing it.

The available flags are:

--dump headers

Dump HTTP headers with Authorization: lines removed. May still
contain sensitive info. Can be very verbose. Useful for debugging
only.

Use --dump auth if you do want the Authorization: headers.

--dump bodies

Dump HTTP headers and bodies - may contain sensitive info. Can be
very verbose. Useful for debugging only.

Note that the bodies are buffered in memory so don't use this for
enormous files.

--dump requests

Like --dump bodies but dumps the request bodies and the response
headers. Useful for debugging download problems.

--dump responses

Like --dump bodies but dumps the response bodies and the request
headers. Useful for debugging upload problems.

--dump auth

Dump HTTP headers - will contain sensitive info such as
Authorization: headers - use --dump headers to dump without
Authorization: headers. Can be very verbose. Useful for debugging
only.

--dump filters

Dump the filters to the output. Useful to see exactly what include
and exclude options are filtering on.

--dump goroutines

This dumps a list of the running go-routines at the end of the command
to standard output.

--dump openfiles

This dumps a list of the open files at the end of the command. It
uses the lsof command to do that so you'll need that installed to
use it.

--memprofile=FILE

Write memory profile to file. This can be analysed with go tool pprof.

Filtering

For the filtering options

  • --delete-excluded
  • --filter
  • --filter-from
  • --exclude
  • --exclude-from
  • --include
  • --include-from
  • --files-from
  • --files-from-raw
  • --min-size
  • --max-size
  • --min-age
  • --max-age
  • --dump filters

See the filtering section.

Remote control

For the remote control options and for instructions on how to remote control rclone

  • --rc
  • and anything starting with --rc-

See the remote control section.

Logging

rclone has 4 levels of logging, ERROR, NOTICE, INFO and DEBUG.

By default, rclone logs to standard error. This means you can redirect
standard error and still see the normal output of rclone commands (e.g.
rclone ls).

By default, rclone will produce Error and Notice level messages.

If you use the -q flag, rclone will only produce Error messages.

If you use the -v flag, rclone will produce Error, Notice and
Info messages.

If you use the -vv flag, rclone will produce Error, Notice,
Info and Debug messages.

You can also control the log levels with the --log-level flag.

If you use the --log-file=FILE option, rclone will redirect Error,
Info and Debug messages along with standard error to FILE.

If you use the --syslog flag then rclone will log to syslog and the
--syslog-facility control which facility it uses.

Rclone prefixes all log messages with their level in capitals, e.g. INFO
which makes it easy to grep the log file for different kinds of
information.

Exit Code

If any errors occur during the command execution, rclone will exit with a
non-zero exit code. This allows scripts to detect when rclone
operations have failed.

During the startup phase, rclone will exit immediately if an error is
detected in the configuration. There will always be a log message
immediately before exiting.

When rclone is running it will accumulate errors as it goes along, and
only exit with a non-zero exit code if (after retries) there were
still failed transfers. For every error counted there will be a high
priority log message (visible with -q) showing the message and
which file caused the problem. A high priority message is also shown
when starting a retry so the user can see that any previous error
messages may not be valid after the retry. If rclone has done a retry
it will log a high priority message if the retry was successful.

List of exit codes

  • 0 - success
  • 1 - Syntax or usage error
  • 2 - Error not otherwise categorised
  • 3 - Directory not found
  • 4 - File not found
  • 5 - Temporary error (one that more retries might fix) (Retry errors)
  • 6 - Less serious errors (like 461 errors from dropbox) (NoRetry errors)
  • 7 - Fatal error (one that more retries won't fix, like account suspended) (Fatal errors)
  • 8 - Transfer exceeded - limit set by --max-transfer reached
  • 9 - Operation successful, but no files transferred

Environment Variables

Rclone can be configured entirely using environment variables. These
can be used to set defaults for options or config file entries.

Options

Every option in rclone can have its default set by environment
variable.

To find the name of the environment variable, first, take the long
option name, strip the leading --, change - to _, make
upper case and prepend RCLONE_.

For example, to always set --stats 5s, set the environment variable
RCLONE_STATS=5s. If you set stats on the command line this will
override the environment variable setting.

Or to always use the trash in drive --drive-use-trash, set
RCLONE_DRIVE_USE_TRASH=true.

The same parser is used for the options and the environment variables
so they take exactly the same form.

Config file

You can set defaults for values in the config file on an individual
remote basis. If you want to use this feature, you will need to
discover the name of the config items that you want. The easiest way
is to run through rclone config by hand, then look in the config
file to see what the values are (the config file can be found by
looking at the help for --config in rclone help).

To find the name of the environment variable, you need to set, take
RCLONE_CONFIG_ + name of remote + _ + name of config file option
and make it all uppercase.

For example, to configure an S3 remote named mys3: without a config
file (using unix ways of setting environment variables):

$ export RCLONE_CONFIG_MYS3_TYPE=s3
$ export RCLONE_CONFIG_MYS3_ACCESS_KEY_ID=XXX
$ export RCLONE_CONFIG_MYS3_SECRET_ACCESS_KEY=XXX
$ rclone lsd MYS3:
          -1 2016-09-21 12:54:21        -1 my-bucket
$ rclone listremotes | grep mys3
mys3:

Note that if you want to create a remote using environment variables
you must create the ..._TYPE variable as above.

Precedence

The various different methods of backend configuration are read in
this order and the first one with a value is used.

  • Flag values as supplied on the command line, e.g. --drive-use-trash.
  • Remote specific environment vars, e.g. RCLONE_CONFIG_MYREMOTE_USE_TRASH (see above).
  • Backend specific environment vars, e.g. RCLONE_DRIVE_USE_TRASH.
  • Config file, e.g. use_trash = false.
  • Default values, e.g. true - these can't be changed.

So if both --drive-use-trash is supplied on the config line and an
environment variable RCLONE_DRIVE_USE_TRASH is set, the command line
flag will take preference.

For non backend configuration the order is as follows:

  • Flag values as supplied on the command line, e.g. --stats 5s.
  • Environment vars, e.g. RCLONE_STATS=5s.
  • Default values, e.g. 1m - these can't be changed.

Other environment variables

  • RCLONE_CONFIG_PASS set to contain your config file password (see Configuration Encryption section)
  • HTTP_PROXY, HTTPS_PROXY and NO_PROXY (or the lowercase versions thereof).
    • HTTPS_PROXY takes precedence over HTTP_PROXY for https requests.
    • The environment values may be either a complete URL or a "host[:port]" for, in which case the "http" scheme is assumed.
  • RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR - rclone sets this variable for use in config files and sub processes to point to the directory holding the config file.

Configuring rclone on a remote / headless machine

Some of the configurations (those involving oauth2) require an
Internet connected web browser.

If you are trying to set rclone up on a remote or headless box with no
browser available on it (e.g. a NAS or a server in a datacenter) then
you will need to use an alternative means of configuration. There are
two ways of doing it, described below.

Configuring using rclone authorize

On the headless box run rclone config but answer N to the Use auto config? question.

...
Remote config
Use auto config?
 * Say Y if not sure
 * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
y) Yes (default)
n) No
y/n> n
For this to work, you will need rclone available on a machine that has
a web browser available.

For more help and alternate methods see: https://rclone.org/remote_setup/

Execute the following on the machine with the web browser (same rclone
version recommended):

	rclone authorize "amazon cloud drive"

Then paste the result below:
result>

Then on your main desktop machine

rclone authorize "amazon cloud drive"
If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
Log in and authorize rclone for access
Waiting for code...
Got code
Paste the following into your remote machine --->
SECRET_TOKEN
<---End paste

Then back to the headless box, paste in the code

result> SECRET_TOKEN
--------------------
[acd12]
client_id = 
client_secret = 
token = SECRET_TOKEN
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d>

Configuring by copying the config file

Rclone stores all of its config in a single configuration file. This
can easily be copied to configure a remote rclone.

So first configure rclone on your desktop machine with

rclone config

to set up the config file.

Find the config file by running rclone config file, for example

$ rclone config file
Configuration file is stored at:
/home/user/.rclone.conf

Now transfer it to the remote box (scp, cut paste, ftp, sftp, etc.) and
place it in the correct place (use rclone config file on the remote
box to find out where).

Filtering, includes and excludes

Filter flags determine which files rclone sync, move, ls, lsl,
md5sum, sha1sum, size, delete, check and similar commands
apply to.

They are specified in terms of path/file name patterns; path/file
lists; file age and size, or presence of a file in a directory. Bucket
based remotes without the concept of directory apply filters to object
key, age and size in an analogous way.

Rclone purge does not obey filters.

To test filters without risk of damage to data, apply them to rclone ls, or with the --dry-run and -vv flags.

Rclone filter patterns can only be used in filter command line options, not
in the specification of a remote.

E.g. rclone copy "remote:dir*.jpg" /path/to/dir does not have a filter effect.
rclone copy remote:dir /path/to/dir --include "*.jpg" does.

Important Avoid mixing any two of --include..., --exclude... or
--filter... flags in an rclone command. The results may not be what
you expect. Instead use a --filter... flag.

Patterns for matching path/file names

Pattern syntax

Rclone matching rules follow a glob style:

`*`         matches any sequence of non-separator (`/`) characters
`**`        matches any sequence of characters including `/` separators
`?`         matches any single non-separator (`/`) character
`[` [ `!` ] { character-range } `]`
            character class (must be non-empty)
`{` pattern-list `}`
            pattern alternatives
c           matches character c (c != `*`, `**`, `?`, `\`, `[`, `{`, `}`)
`\` c       matches character c

character-range:

c           matches character c (c != `\\`, `-`, `]`)
`\` c       matches character c
lo `-` hi   matches character c for lo <= c <= hi

pattern-list:

pattern { `,` pattern }
            comma-separated (without spaces) patterns

character classes (see Go regular expression reference) include:

Named character classes (e.g. [\d], [^\d], [\D], [^\D])
Perl character classes (e.g. \s, \S, \w, \W)
ASCII character classes (e.g. [[:alnum:]], [[:alpha:]], [[:punct:]], [[:xdigit:]])

If the filter pattern starts with a / then it only matches
at the top level of the directory tree,
relative to the root of the remote (not necessarily the root
of the drive). If it does not start with / then it is matched
starting at the end of the path/file name but it only matches
a complete path element - it must match from a /
separator or the beginning of the path/file.

file.jpg   - matches "file.jpg"
           - matches "directory/file.jpg"
           - doesn't match "afile.jpg"
           - doesn't match "directory/afile.jpg"
/file.jpg  - matches "file.jpg" in the root directory of the remote
           - doesn't match "afile.jpg"
           - doesn't match "directory/file.jpg"

Important Use / in path/file name patterns and not \ even if
running on Microsoft Windows.

Simple patterns are case sensitive unless the --ignore-case flag is used.

Without --ignore-case (default)

potato - matches "potato"
       - doesn't match "POTATO"

With --ignore-case

potato - matches "potato"
       - matches "POTATO"

How filter rules are applied to files

Rclone path / file name filters are made up of one or more of the following flags:

  • --include
  • --include-from
  • --exclude
  • --exclude-from
  • --filter
  • --filter-from

There can be more than one instance of individual flags.

Rclone internally uses a combined list of all the include and exclude
rules. The order in which rules are processed can influence the result
of the filter.

All flags of the same type are processed together in the order
above, regardless of what order the different types of flags are
included on the command line.

Multiple instances of the same flag are processed from left
to right according to their position in the command line.

To mix up the order of processing includes and excludes use --filter...
flags.

Within --include-from, --exclude-from and --filter-from flags
rules are processed from top to bottom of the referenced file..

If there is an --include or --include-from flag specified, rclone
implies a - ** rule which it adds to the bottom of the internal rule
list. Specifying a + rule with a --filter... flag does not imply
that rule.

Each path/file name passed through rclone is matched against the
combined filter list. At first match to a rule the path/file name
is included or excluded and no further filter rules are processed for
that path/file.

If rclone does not find a match, after testing against all rules
(including the implied rule if appropriate), the path/file name
is included.

Any path/file included at that stage is processed by the rclone
command.

--files-from and --files-from-raw flags over-ride and cannot be
combined with other filter options.

To see the internal combined rule list, in regular expression form,
for a command add the --dump filters flag. Running an rclone command
with --dump filters and -vv flags lists the internal filter elements
and shows how they are applied to each source path/file. There is not
currently a means provided to pass regular expression filter options into
rclone directly though character class filter rules contain character
classes. Go regular expression reference

How filter rules are applied to directories

Rclone commands filter, and are applied to, path/file names not
directories. The entire contents of a directory can be matched
to a filter by the pattern directory/* or recursively by
directory/**.

Directory filter rules are defined with a closing / separator.

E.g. /directory/subdirectory/ is an rclone directory filter rule.

Rclone commands can use directory filter rules to determine whether they
recurse into subdirectories. This potentially optimises access to a remote
by avoiding listing unnecessary directories. Whether optimisation is
desirable depends on the specific filter rules and source remote content.

Optimisation occurs if either:

  • A source remote does not support the rclone ListR primitive. local,
    sftp, Microsoft OneDrive and WebDav do not support ListR. Google
    Drive and most bucket type storage do. Full list

  • On other remotes, if the rclone command is not naturally recursive,
    provided it is not run with the --fast-list flag. ls, lsf -R and
    size are recursive but sync, copy and move are not.

  • Whenever the --disable ListR flag is applied to an rclone command.

Rclone commands imply directory filter rules from path/file filter
rules. To view the directory filter rules rclone has implied for a
command specify the --dump filters flag.

E.g. for an include rule

/a/*.jpg

Rclone implies the directory include rule

/a/

Directory filter rules specified in an rclone command can limit
the scope of an rclone command but path/file filters still have
to be specified.

E.g. rclone ls remote: --include /directory/ will not match any
files. Because it is an --include option the --exclude ** rule
is implied, and the \directory\ pattern serves only to optimise
access to the remote by ignoring everything outside of that directory.

E.g. rclone ls remote: --filter-from filter-list.txt with a file
filter-list.txt:

- /dir1/
- /dir2/
+ *.pdf
- **

All files in directories dir1 or dir2 or their subdirectories
are completely excluded from the listing. Only files of suffix
'pdf in the root of remote: or its subdirectories are listed.
The - ** rule prevents listing of any path/files not previously
matched by the rules above.

Option exclude-if-present creates a directory exclude rule based
on the presence of a file in a directory and takes precedence over
other rclone directory filter rules.

--exclude - Exclude files matching pattern

Excludes path/file names from an rclone command based on a single exclude
rule.

This flag can be repeated. See above for the order filter flags are
processed in.

--exclude should not be used with --include, --include-from,
--filter or --filter-from flags.

--exclude has no effect when combined with --files-from or
--files-from-raw flags.

E.g. rclone ls remote: --exclude *.bak excludes all .bak files
from listing.

E.g. rclone size remote: "--exclude /dir/**" returns the total size of
all files on remote: excluding those in root directory dir and sub
directories.

E.g. on Microsoft Windows rclone ls remote: --exclude "*\[{JP,KR,HK}\]*"
lists the files in remote: with [JP] or [KR] or [HK] in
their name. The single quotes prevent the shell from interpreting the \
characters. The \ characters escape the [ and ] so ran clone filter
treats them literally rather than as a character-range. The { and }
define an rclone pattern list. For other operating systems single quotes are
required ie rclone ls remote: --exclude '*\[{JP,KR,HK}\]*'

--exclude-from - Read exclude patterns from file

Excludes path/file names from an rclone command based on rules in a
named file. The file contains a list of remarks and pattern rules.

For an example exclude-file.txt:

# a sample exclude rule file
*.bak
file2.jpg

rclone ls remote: --exclude-from exclude-file.txt lists the files on
remote: except those named file2.jpg or with a suffix .bak. That is
equivalent to rclone ls remote: --exclude file2.jpg --exclude "*.bak".

This flag can be repeated. See above for the order filter flags are
processed in.

The --exclude-from flag is useful where multiple exclude filter rules
are applied to an rclone command.

--exclude-from should not be used with --include, --include-from,
--filter or --filter-from flags.

--exclude-from has no effect when combined with --files-from or
--files-from-raw flags.

--exclude-from followed by - reads filter rules from standard input.

--include - Include files matching pattern

Adds a single include rule based on path/file names to an rclone
command.

This flag can be repeated. See above for the order filter flags are
processed in.

--include has no effect when combined with --files-from or
--files-from-raw flags.

--include implies --exclude ** at the end of an rclone internal
filter list. Therefore if you mix --include and --include-from
flags with --exclude, --exclude-from, --filter or --filter-from,
you must use include rules for all the files you want in the include
statement. For more flexibility use the --filter-from flag.

E.g. rclone ls remote: --include "*.{png,jpg}" lists the files on
remote: with suffix .png and .jpg. All other files are excluded.

E.g. multiple rclone copy commands can be combined with --include and a
pattern-list.

rclone copy /vol1/A remote:A
rclone copy /vol1/B remote:B

is equivalent to:

rclone copy /vol1 remote: --include "{A,B}/**"

E.g. rclone ls remote:/wheat --include "??[^[:punct:]]*" lists the
files remote: directory wheat (and subdirectories) whose third
character is not punctuation. This example uses
an ASCII character class.

--include-from - Read include patterns from file

Adds path/file names to an rclone command based on rules in a
named file. The file contains a list of remarks and pattern rules.

For an example include-file.txt:

# a sample include rule file
*.jpg
file2.avi

rclone ls remote: --include-from include-file.txt lists the files on
remote: with name file2.avi or suffix .jpg. That is equivalent to
rclone ls remote: --include file2.avi --include "*.jpg".

This flag can be repeated. See above for the order filter flags are
processed in.

The --include-from flag is useful where multiple include filter rules
are applied to an rclone command.

--include-from implies --exclude ** at the end of an rclone internal
filter list. Therefore if you mix --include and --include-from
flags with --exclude, --exclude-from, --filter or --filter-from,
you must use include rules for all the files you want in the include
statement. For more flexibility use the --filter-from flag.

--exclude-from has no effect when combined with --files-from or
--files-from-raw flags.

--exclude-from followed by - reads filter rules from standard input.

--filter - Add a file-filtering rule

Specifies path/file names to an rclone command, based on a single
include or exclude rule, in + or - format.

This flag can be repeated. See above for the order filter flags are
processed in.

--filter + differs from --include. In the case of --include rclone
implies an --exclude * rule which it adds to the bottom of the internal rule
list. --filter...+ does not imply
that rule.

--filter has no effect when combined with --files-from or
--files-from-raw flags.

--filter should not be used with --include, --include-from,
--exclude or --exclude-from flags.

E.g. rclone ls remote: --filter "- *.bak" excludes all .bak files
from a list of remote:.

--filter-from - Read filtering patterns from a file

Adds path/file names to an rclone command based on rules in a
named file. The file contains a list of remarks and pattern rules. Include
rules start with + and exclude rules with - . ! clears existing
rules. Rules are processed in the order they are defined.

This flag can be repeated. See above for the order filter flags are
processed in.

Arrange the order of filter rules with the most restrictive first and
work down.

E.g. For filter-file.txt:

# a sample filter rule file
- secret*.jpg
+ *.jpg
+ *.png
+ file2.avi
- /dir/Trash/**
+ /dir/**
# exclude everything else
- *

rclone ls remote: --filter-from filter-file.txt lists the path/files on
remote: including all jpg and png files, excluding any
matching secret*.jpg and including file2.avi. It also includes
everything in the directory dir at the root of remote, except
remote:dir/Trash which it excludes. Everything else is excluded.

E.g. for an alternative filter-file.txt:

- secret*.jpg
+ *.jpg
+ *.png
+ file2.avi
- *

Files file1.jpg, file3.png and file2.avi are listed whilst
secret17.jpg and files without the suffix .jpgor.png` are excluded.

E.g. for an alternative filter-file.txt:

+ *.jpg
+ *.gif
!
+ 42.doc
- *

Only file 42.doc is listed. Prior rules are cleared by the !.

--files-from - Read list of source-file names

Adds path/files to an rclone command from a list in a named file.
Rclone processes the path/file names in the order of the list, and
no others.

Other filter flags (--include, --include-from, --exclude,
--exclude-from, --filter and --filter-from) are ignored when
--files-from is used.

--files-from expects a list of files as its input. Leading or
trailing whitespace is stripped from the input lines. Lines starting
with # or ; are ignored.

Rclone commands with a --files-from flag traverse the remote,
treating the names in --files-from as a set of filters.

If the --no-traverse and --files-from flags are used together
an rclone command does not traverse the remote. Instead it addresses
each path/file named in the file individually. For each path/file name, that
requires typically 1 API call. This can be efficient for a short --files-from
list and a remote containing many files.

Rclone commands do not error if any names in the --files-from file are
missing from the source remote.

The --files-from flag can be repeated in a single rclone command to
read path/file names from more than one file. The files are read from left
to right along the command line.

Paths within the --files-from file are interpreted as starting
with the root specified in the rclone command. Leading / separators are
ignored. See --files-from-raw if
you need the input to be processed in a raw manner.

E.g. for a file files-from.txt:

# comment
file1.jpg
subdir/file2.jpg

rclone copy --files-from files-from.txt /home/me/pics remote:pics
copies the following, if they exist, and only those files.

/home/me/pics/file1.jpg        → remote:pics/file1.jpg
/home/me/pics/subdir/file2.jpg → remote:pics/subdir/file2.jpg

E.g. to copy the following files referenced by their absolute paths:

/home/user1/42
/home/user1/dir/ford
/home/user2/prefect

First find a common subdirectory - in this case /home
and put the remaining files in files-from.txt with or without
leading /, e.g.

user1/42
user1/dir/ford
user2/prefect

Then copy these to a remote:

rclone copy --files-from files-from.txt /home remote:backup

The three files are transferred as follows:

/home/user1/42       → remote:backup/user1/important
/home/user1/dir/ford → remote:backup/user1/dir/file
/home/user2/prefect  → remote:backup/user2/stuff

Alternatively if / is chosen as root files-from.txt would be:

/home/user1/42
/home/user1/dir/ford
/home/user2/prefect

The copy command would be:

rclone copy --files-from files-from.txt / remote:backup

Then there will be an extra home directory on the remote:

/home/user1/42       → remote:backup/home/user1/42
/home/user1/dir/ford → remote:backup/home/user1/dir/ford
/home/user2/prefect  → remote:backup/home/user2/prefect

--files-from-raw - Read list of source-file names without any processing

This flag is the same as --files-from except that input is read in a
raw manner. Lines with leading / trailing whitespace, and lines starting
with ; or # are read without any processing. rclone lsf has
a compatible format that can be used to export file lists from remotes for
input to --files-from-raw.

--ignore-case - make searches case insensitive

By default rclone filter patterns are case sensitive. The --ignore-case
flag makes all of the filters patterns on the command line case
insensitive.

E.g. --include "zaphod.txt" does not match a file Zaphod.txt. With
--ignore-case a match is made.

Quoting shell metacharacters

Rclone commands with filter patterns containing shell metacharacters may
not as work as expected in your shell and may require quoting.

E.g. linux, OSX (* metacharacter)

  • --include \*.jpg
  • --include '*.jpg'
  • --include='*.jpg'

Microsoft Windows expansion is done by the command, not shell, so
--include *.jpg does not require quoting.

If the rclone error
Command .... needs .... arguments maximum: you provided .... non flag arguments:
is encountered, the cause is commonly spaces within the name of a
remote or flag value. The fix then is to quote values containing spaces.

Other filters

--min-size - Don't transfer any file smaller than this

Controls the minimum size file within the scope of an rclone command.
Default units are kBytes but abbreviations k, M, or G are valid.

E.g. rclone ls remote: --min-size 50k lists files on remote: of 50kByte
size or larger.

--max-size - Don't transfer any file larger than this

Controls the maximum size file within the scope of an rclone command.
Default units are kBytes but abbreviations k, M, or G are valid.

E.g. rclone ls remote: --max-size 1G lists files on remote: of 1GByte
size or smaller.

--max-age - Don't transfer any file older than this

Controls the maximum age of files within the scope of an rclone command.
Default units are seconds or the following abbreviations are valid:

  • ms - Milliseconds
  • s - Seconds
  • m - Minutes
  • h - Hours
  • d - Days
  • w - Weeks
  • M - Months
  • y - Years

--max-age can also be specified as an absolute time in the following
formats:

  • RFC3339 - e.g. "2006-01-02T15:04:05Z07:00"
  • ISO8601 Date and time, local timezone - "2006-01-02T15:04:05"
  • ISO8601 Date and time, local timezone - "2006-01-02 15:04:05"
  • ISO8601 Date - "2006-01-02" (YYYY-MM-DD)

--max-age applies only to files and not to directories.

E.g. rclone ls remote: --max-age 2d lists files on remote: of 2 days
old or less.

--min-age - Don't transfer any file younger than this

Controls the minimum age of files within the scope of an rclone command.
(see --max-age for valid formats)

--min-age applies only to files and not to directories.

E.g. rclone ls remote: --min-age 2d lists files on remote: of 2 days
old or more.

Other flags

--delete-excluded - Delete files on dest excluded from sync

Important this flag is dangerous to your data - use with --dry-run
and -v first.

In conjunction with rclone sync the `--delete-excluded deletes any files
on the destination which are excluded from the command.

E.g. the scope of rclone sync -i A: B: can be restricted:

rclone --min-size 50k --delete-excluded sync A: B:

All files on B: which are less than 50 kBytes are deleted
because they are excluded from the rclone sync command.

--dump filters - dump the filters to the output

Dumps the defined filters to standard output in regular expression
format.

Useful for debugging.

Exclude directory based on a file

The --exclude-if-present flag controls whether a directory is
within the scope of an rclone command based on the presence of a
named file within it.

This flag has a priority over other filter flags.

E.g. for the following directory structure:

dir1/file1
dir1/dir2/file2
dir1/dir2/dir3/file3
dir1/dir2/dir3/.ignore

The command rclone ls --exclude-if-present .ignore dir1 does
not list dir3, file3 or .ignore.

--exclude-if-present can only be used once in an rclone command.

Common pitfalls

The most frequent filter support issues on
the rclone forum are:

  • Not using paths relative to the root of the remote
  • Not using / to match from the root of a remote
  • Not using ** to match the contents of a directory

GUI (Experimental)

Rclone can serve a web based GUI (graphical user interface). This is
somewhat experimental at the moment so things may be subject to
change.

Run this command in a terminal and rclone will download and then
display the GUI in a web browser.

rclone rcd --rc-web-gui

This will produce logs like this and rclone needs to continue to run to serve the GUI:

2019/08/25 11:40:14 NOTICE: A new release for gui is present at https://github.com/rclone/rclone-webui-react/releases/download/v0.0.6/currentbuild.zip
2019/08/25 11:40:14 NOTICE: Downloading webgui binary. Please wait. [Size: 3813937, Path :  /home/USER/.cache/rclone/webgui/v0.0.6.zip]
2019/08/25 11:40:16 NOTICE: Unzipping
2019/08/25 11:40:16 NOTICE: Serving remote control on http://127.0.0.1:5572/

This assumes you are running rclone locally on your machine. It is
possible to separate the rclone and the GUI - see below for details.

If you wish to check for updates then you can add --rc-web-gui-update
to the command line.

If you find your GUI broken, you may force it to update by add --rc-web-gui-force-update.

By default, rclone will open your browser. Add --rc-web-gui-no-open-browser
to disable this feature.

Using the GUI

Once the GUI opens, you will be looking at the dashboard which has an overall overview.

On the left hand side you will see a series of view buttons you can click on:

  • Dashboard - main overview
  • Configs - examine and create new configurations
  • Explorer - view, download and upload files to the cloud storage systems
  • Backend - view or alter the backend config
  • Log out

(More docs and walkthrough video to come!)

How it works

When you run the rclone rcd --rc-web-gui this is what happens

  • Rclone starts but only runs the remote control API ("rc").
  • The API is bound to localhost with an auto generated username and password.
  • If the API bundle is missing then rclone will download it.
  • rclone will start serving the files from the API bundle over the same port as the API
  • rclone will open the browser with a login_token so it can log straight in.

Advanced use

The rclone rcd may use any of the flags documented on the rc page.

The flag --rc-web-gui is shorthand for

  • Download the web GUI if necessary
  • Check we are using some authentication
  • --rc-user gui
  • --rc-pass <random password>
  • --rc-serve

These flags can be overridden as desired.

See also the rclone rcd documentation.

Example: Running a public GUI

For example the GUI could be served on a public port over SSL using an htpasswd file using the following flags:

  • --rc-web-gui
  • --rc-addr :443
  • --rc-htpasswd /path/to/htpasswd
  • --rc-cert /path/to/ssl.crt
  • --rc-key /path/to/ssl.key

Example: Running a GUI behind a proxy

If you want to run the GUI behind a proxy at /rclone you could use these flags:

  • --rc-web-gui
  • --rc-baseurl rclone
  • --rc-htpasswd /path/to/htpasswd

Or instead of htpasswd if you just want a single user and password:

  • --rc-user me
  • --rc-pass mypassword

Project

The GUI is being developed in the: rclone/rclone-webui-react repository.

Bug reports and contributions are very welcome :-)

If you have questions then please ask them on the rclone forum.

Remote controlling rclone with its API

If rclone is run with the --rc flag then it starts an HTTP server
which can be used to remote control rclone using its API.

You can either use the rclone rc command to access the API
or use HTTP directly.

If you just want to run a remote control then see the rcd command.

Supported parameters

--rc

Flag to start the http server listen on remote requests

--rc-addr=IP

IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to. (default "localhost:5572")

--rc-cert=KEY

SSL PEM key (concatenation of certificate and CA certificate)

--rc-client-ca=PATH

Client certificate authority to verify clients with

--rc-htpasswd=PATH

htpasswd file - if not provided no authentication is done

--rc-key=PATH

SSL PEM Private key

--rc-max-header-bytes=VALUE

Maximum size of request header (default 4096)

--rc-user=VALUE

User name for authentication.

--rc-pass=VALUE

Password for authentication.

--rc-realm=VALUE

Realm for authentication (default "rclone")

--rc-server-read-timeout=DURATION

Timeout for server reading data (default 1h0m0s)

--rc-server-write-timeout=DURATION

Timeout for server writing data (default 1h0m0s)

--rc-serve

Enable the serving of remote objects via the HTTP interface. This
means objects will be accessible at http://127.0.0.1:5572/ by default,
so you can browse to http://127.0.0.1:5572/ or http://127.0.0.1:5572/*
to see a listing of the remotes. Objects may be requested from
remotes using this syntax http://127.0.0.1:5572/[remote:path]/path/to/object

Default Off.

--rc-files /path/to/directory

Path to local files to serve on the HTTP server.

If this is set then rclone will serve the files in that directory. It
will also open the root in the web browser if specified. This is for
implementing browser based GUIs for rclone functions.

If --rc-user or --rc-pass is set then the URL that is opened will
have the authorization in the URL in the http://user:pass@localhost/
style.

Default Off.

--rc-enable-metrics

Enable OpenMetrics/Prometheus compatible endpoint at /metrics.

Default Off.

--rc-web-gui

Set this flag to serve the default web gui on the same port as rclone.

Default Off.

--rc-allow-origin

Set the allowed Access-Control-Allow-Origin for rc requests.

Can be used with --rc-web-gui if the rclone is running on different IP than the web-gui.

Default is IP address on which rc is running.

--rc-web-fetch-url

Set the URL to fetch the rclone-web-gui files from.

Default https://api.github.com/repos/rclone/rclone-webui-react/releases/latest.

--rc-web-gui-update

Set this flag to check and update rclone-webui-react from the rc-web-fetch-url.

Default Off.

--rc-web-gui-force-update

Set this flag to force update rclone-webui-react from the rc-web-fetch-url.

Default Off.

--rc-web-gui-no-open-browser

Set this flag to disable opening browser automatically when using web-gui.

Default Off.

--rc-job-expire-duration=DURATION

Expire finished async jobs older than DURATION (default 60s).

--rc-job-expire-interval=DURATION

Interval duration to check for expired async jobs (default 10s).

--rc-no-auth

By default rclone will require authorisation to have been set up on
the rc interface in order to use any methods which access any rclone
remotes. Eg operations/list is denied as it involved creating a
remote as is sync/copy.

If this is set then no authorisation will be required on the server to
use these methods. The alternative is to use --rc-user and
--rc-pass and use these credentials in the request.

Default Off.

Accessing the remote control via the rclone rc command

Rclone itself implements the remote control protocol in its rclone rc command.

You can use it like this

$ rclone rc rc/noop param1=one param2=two
{
	"param1": "one",
	"param2": "two"
}

Run rclone rc on its own to see the help for the installed remote
control commands.

JSON input

rclone rc also supports a --json flag which can be used to send
more complicated input parameters.

$ rclone rc --json '{ "p1": [1,"2",null,4], "p2": { "a":1, "b":2 } }' rc/noop
{
	"p1": [
		1,
		"2",
		null,
		4
	],
	"p2": {
		"a": 1,
		"b": 2
	}
}

If the parameter being passed is an object then it can be passed as a
JSON string rather than using the --json flag which simplifies the
command line.

rclone rc operations/list fs=/tmp remote=test opt='{"showHash": true}'

Rather than

rclone rc operations/list --json '{"fs": "/tmp", "remote": "test", "opt": {"showHash": true}}'

Special parameters

The rc interface supports some special parameters which apply to
all commands. These start with _ to show they are different.

Running asynchronous jobs with _async = true

Each rc call is classified as a job and it is assigned its own id. By default
jobs are executed immediately as they are created or synchronously.

If _async has a true value when supplied to an rc call then it will
return immediately with a job id and the task will be run in the
background. The job/status call can be used to get information of
the background job. The job can be queried for up to 1 minute after
it has finished.

It is recommended that potentially long running jobs, e.g. sync/sync,
sync/copy, sync/move, operations/purge are run with the _async
flag to avoid any potential problems with the HTTP request and
response timing out.

Starting a job with the _async flag:

$ rclone rc --json '{ "p1": [1,"2",null,4], "p2": { "a":1, "b":2 }, "_async": true }' rc/noop
{
	"jobid": 2
}

Query the status to see if the job has finished. For more information
on the meaning of these return parameters see the job/status call.

$ rclone rc --json '{ "jobid":2 }' job/status
{
	"duration": 0.000124163,
	"endTime": "2018-10-27T11:38:07.911245881+01:00",
	"error": "",
	"finished": true,
	"id": 2,
	"output": {
		"_async": true,
		"p1": [
			1,
			"2",
			null,
			4
		],
		"p2": {
			"a": 1,
			"b": 2
		}
	},
	"startTime": "2018-10-27T11:38:07.911121728+01:00",
	"success": true
}

job/list can be used to show the running or recently completed jobs

$ rclone rc job/list
{
	"jobids": [
		2
	]
}

Assigning operations to groups with _group = value

Each rc call has its own stats group for tracking its metrics. By default
grouping is done by the composite group name from prefix job/ and id of the
job like so job/1.

If _group has a value then stats for that request will be grouped under that
value. This allows caller to group stats under their own name.

Stats for specific group can be accessed by passing group to core/stats:

$ rclone rc --json '{ "group": "job/1" }' core/stats
{
	"speed": 12345
	...
}

Supported commands

backend/command: Runs a backend command.

This takes the following parameters

  • command - a string with the command name
  • fs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:"
  • arg - a list of arguments for the backend command
  • opt - a map of string to string of options

Returns

  • result - result from the backend command

For example

rclone rc backend/command command=noop fs=. -o echo=yes -o blue -a path1 -a path2

Returns

{
	"result": {
		"arg": [
			"path1",
			"path2"
		],
		"name": "noop",
		"opt": {
			"blue": "",
			"echo": "yes"
		}
	}
}

Note that this is the direct equivalent of using this "backend"
command:

rclone backend noop . -o echo=yes -o blue path1 path2

Note that arguments must be preceded by the "-a" flag

See the backend command for more information.

Authentication is required for this call.

cache/expire: Purge a remote from cache

Purge a remote from the cache backend. Supports either a directory or a file.
Params:

  • remote = path to remote (required)
  • withData = true/false to delete cached data (chunks) as well (optional)

Eg

rclone rc cache/expire remote=path/to/sub/folder/
rclone rc cache/expire remote=/ withData=true

cache/fetch: Fetch file chunks

Ensure the specified file chunks are cached on disk.

The chunks= parameter specifies the file chunks to check.
It takes a comma separated list of array slice indices.
The slice indices are similar to Python slices: start[:end]

start is the 0 based chunk number from the beginning of the file
to fetch inclusive. end is 0 based chunk number from the beginning
of the file to fetch exclusive.
Both values can be negative, in which case they count from the back
of the file. The value "-5:" represents the last 5 chunks of a file.

Some valid examples are:
":5,-5:" -> the first and last five chunks
"0,-2" -> the first and the second last chunk
"0:10" -> the first ten chunks

Any parameter with a key that starts with "file" can be used to
specify files to fetch, e.g.

rclone rc cache/fetch chunks=0 file=hello file2=home/goodbye

File names will automatically be encrypted when the a crypt remote
is used on top of the cache.

cache/stats: Get cache stats

Show statistics for the cache remote.

config/create: create the config for a remote.

This takes the following parameters

  • name - name of remote
  • parameters - a map of { "key": "value" } pairs
  • type - type of the new remote
  • obscure - optional bool - forces obscuring of passwords
  • noObscure - optional bool - forces passwords not to be obscured

See the config create command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

config/delete: Delete a remote in the config file.

Parameters:

  • name - name of remote to delete

See the config delete command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

config/dump: Dumps the config file.

Returns a JSON object:

  • key: value

Where keys are remote names and values are the config parameters.

See the config dump command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

config/get: Get a remote in the config file.

Parameters:

  • name - name of remote to get

See the config dump command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

config/listremotes: Lists the remotes in the config file.

Returns

  • remotes - array of remote names

See the listremotes command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

config/password: password the config for a remote.

This takes the following parameters

  • name - name of remote
  • parameters - a map of { "key": "value" } pairs

See the config password command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

config/providers: Shows how providers are configured in the config file.

Returns a JSON object:

  • providers - array of objects

See the config providers command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

config/update: update the config for a remote.

This takes the following parameters

  • name - name of remote
  • parameters - a map of { "key": "value" } pairs
  • obscure - optional bool - forces obscuring of passwords
  • noObscure - optional bool - forces passwords not to be obscured

See the config update command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

core/bwlimit: Set the bandwidth limit.

This sets the bandwidth limit to the string passed in. This should be
a single bandwidth limit entry or a pair of upload:download bandwidth.

Eg

rclone rc core/bwlimit rate=off
{
    "bytesPerSecond": -1,
    "bytesPerSecondTx": -1,
    "bytesPerSecondRx": -1,
    "rate": "off"
}
rclone rc core/bwlimit rate=1M
{
    "bytesPerSecond": 1048576,
    "bytesPerSecondTx": 1048576,
    "bytesPerSecondRx": 1048576,
    "rate": "1M"
}
rclone rc core/bwlimit rate=1M:100k
{
    "bytesPerSecond": 1048576,
    "bytesPerSecondTx": 1048576,
    "bytesPerSecondRx": 131072,
    "rate": "1M"
}

If the rate parameter is not supplied then the bandwidth is queried

rclone rc core/bwlimit
{
    "bytesPerSecond": 1048576,
    "bytesPerSecondTx": 1048576,
    "bytesPerSecondRx": 1048576,
    "rate": "1M"
}

The format of the parameter is exactly the same as passed to --bwlimit
except only one bandwidth may be specified.

In either case "rate" is returned as a human readable string, and
"bytesPerSecond" is returned as a number.

core/command: Run a rclone terminal command over rc.

This takes the following parameters

  • command - a string with the command name
  • arg - a list of arguments for the backend command
  • opt - a map of string to string of options
  • returnType - one of ("COMBINED_OUTPUT", "STREAM", "STREAM_ONLY_STDOUT", "STREAM_ONLY_STDERR")
    • defaults to "COMBINED_OUTPUT" if not set
    • the STREAM returnTypes will write the output to the body of the HTTP message
    • the COMBINED_OUTPUT will write the output to the "result" parameter

Returns

  • result - result from the backend command
    • only set when using returnType "COMBINED_OUTPUT"
  • error - set if rclone exits with an error code
  • returnType - one of ("COMBINED_OUTPUT", "STREAM", "STREAM_ONLY_STDOUT", "STREAM_ONLY_STDERR")

For example

rclone rc core/command command=ls -a mydrive:/ -o max-depth=1
rclone rc core/command -a ls -a mydrive:/ -o max-depth=1

Returns

{
	"error": false,
	"result": "<Raw command line output>"
}

OR 
{
	"error": true,
	"result": "<Raw command line output>"
}

Authentication is required for this call.

core/gc: Runs a garbage collection.

This tells the go runtime to do a garbage collection run. It isn't
necessary to call this normally, but it can be useful for debugging
memory problems.

core/group-list: Returns list of stats.

This returns list of stats groups currently in memory.

Returns the following values:

{
	"groups":  an array of group names:
		[
			"group1",
			"group2",
			...
		]
}

core/memstats: Returns the memory statistics

This returns the memory statistics of the running program. What the values mean
are explained in the go docs: https://golang.org/pkg/runtime/#MemStats

The most interesting values for most people are:

  • HeapAlloc: This is the amount of memory rclone is actually using
  • HeapSys: This is the amount of memory rclone has obtained from the OS
  • Sys: this is the total amount of memory requested from the OS
    • It is virtual memory so may include unused memory

core/obscure: Obscures a string passed in.

Pass a clear string and rclone will obscure it for the config file:

  • clear - string

Returns

  • obscured - string

core/pid: Return PID of current process

This returns PID of current process.
Useful for stopping rclone process.

core/quit: Terminates the app.

(optional) Pass an exit code to be used for terminating the app:

  • exitCode - int

core/stats: Returns stats about current transfers.

This returns all available stats:

rclone rc core/stats

If group is not provided then summed up stats for all groups will be
returned.

Parameters

  • group - name of the stats group (string)

Returns the following values:

{
	"speed": average speed in bytes/sec since start of the process,
	"bytes": total transferred bytes since the start of the process,
	"errors": number of errors,
	"fatalError": whether there has been at least one FatalError,
	"retryError": whether there has been at least one non-NoRetryError,
	"checks": number of checked files,
	"transfers": number of transferred files,
	"deletes" : number of deleted files,
	"renames" : number of renamed files,
	"transferTime" : total time spent on running jobs,
	"elapsedTime": time in seconds since the start of the process,
	"lastError": last occurred error,
	"transferring": an array of currently active file transfers:
		[
			{
				"bytes": total transferred bytes for this file,
				"eta": estimated time in seconds until file transfer completion
				"name": name of the file,
				"percentage": progress of the file transfer in percent,
				"speed": average speed over the whole transfer in bytes/sec,
				"speedAvg": current speed in bytes/sec as an exponentially weighted moving average,
				"size": size of the file in bytes
			}
		],
	"checking": an array of names of currently active file checks
		[]
}

Values for "transferring", "checking" and "lastError" are only assigned if data is available.
The value for "eta" is null if an eta cannot be determined.

core/stats-delete: Delete stats group.

This deletes entire stats group

Parameters

  • group - name of the stats group (string)

core/stats-reset: Reset stats.

This clears counters, errors and finished transfers for all stats or specific
stats group if group is provided.

Parameters

  • group - name of the stats group (string)

core/transferred: Returns stats about completed transfers.

This returns stats about completed transfers:

rclone rc core/transferred

If group is not provided then completed transfers for all groups will be
returned.

Note only the last 100 completed transfers are returned.

Parameters

  • group - name of the stats group (string)

Returns the following values:

{
	"transferred":  an array of completed transfers (including failed ones):
		[
			{
				"name": name of the file,
				"size": size of the file in bytes,
				"bytes": total transferred bytes for this file,
				"checked": if the transfer is only checked (skipped, deleted),
				"timestamp": integer representing millisecond unix epoch,
				"error": string description of the error (empty if successful),
				"jobid": id of the job that this transfer belongs to
			}
		]
}

core/version: Shows the current version of rclone and the go runtime.

This shows the current version of go and the go runtime

  • version - rclone version, e.g. "v1.53.0"
  • decomposed - version number as [major, minor, patch]
  • isGit - boolean - true if this was compiled from the git version
  • isBeta - boolean - true if this is a beta version
  • os - OS in use as according to Go
  • arch - cpu architecture in use according to Go
  • goVersion - version of Go runtime in use

debug/set-block-profile-rate: Set runtime.SetBlockProfileRate for blocking profiling.

SetBlockProfileRate controls the fraction of goroutine blocking events
that are reported in the blocking profile. The profiler aims to sample
an average of one blocking event per rate nanoseconds spent blocked.

To include every blocking event in the profile, pass rate = 1. To turn
off profiling entirely, pass rate <= 0.

After calling this you can use this to see the blocking profile:

go tool pprof http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/block

Parameters

  • rate - int

debug/set-mutex-profile-fraction: Set runtime.SetMutexProfileFraction for mutex profiling.

SetMutexProfileFraction controls the fraction of mutex contention
events that are reported in the mutex profile. On average 1/rate
events are reported. The previous rate is returned.

To turn off profiling entirely, pass rate 0. To just read the current
rate, pass rate < 0. (For n>1 the details of sampling may change.)

Once this is set you can look use this to profile the mutex contention:

go tool pprof http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/mutex

Parameters

  • rate - int

Results

  • previousRate - int

job/list: Lists the IDs of the running jobs

Parameters - None

Results

  • jobids - array of integer job ids

job/status: Reads the status of the job ID

Parameters

  • jobid - id of the job (integer)

Results

  • finished - boolean
  • duration - time in seconds that the job ran for
  • endTime - time the job finished (e.g. "2018-10-26T18:50:20.528746884+01:00")
  • error - error from the job or empty string for no error
  • finished - boolean whether the job has finished or not
  • id - as passed in above
  • startTime - time the job started (e.g. "2018-10-26T18:50:20.528336039+01:00")
  • success - boolean - true for success false otherwise
  • output - output of the job as would have been returned if called synchronously
  • progress - output of the progress related to the underlying job

job/stop: Stop the running job

Parameters

  • jobid - id of the job (integer)

mount/listmounts: Show current mount points

This shows currently mounted points, which can be used for performing an unmount

This takes no parameters and returns

  • mountPoints: list of current mount points

Eg

rclone rc mount/listmounts

Authentication is required for this call.

mount/mount: Create a new mount point

rclone allows Linux, FreeBSD, macOS and Windows to mount any of
Rclone's cloud storage systems as a file system with FUSE.

If no mountType is provided, the priority is given as follows: 1. mount 2.cmount 3.mount2

This takes the following parameters

  • fs - a remote path to be mounted (required)
  • mountPoint: valid path on the local machine (required)
  • mountType: One of the values (mount, cmount, mount2) specifies the mount implementation to use
  • mountOpt: a JSON object with Mount options in.
  • vfsOpt: a JSON object with VFS options in.

Eg

rclone rc mount/mount fs=mydrive: mountPoint=/home/<user>/mountPoint
rclone rc mount/mount fs=mydrive: mountPoint=/home/<user>/mountPoint mountType=mount
rclone rc mount/mount fs=TestDrive: mountPoint=/mnt/tmp vfsOpt='{"CacheMode": 2}' mountOpt='{"AllowOther": true}'

The vfsOpt are as described in options/get and can be seen in the the
"vfs" section when running and the mountOpt can be seen in the "mount" section.

rclone rc options/get

Authentication is required for this call.

mount/types: Show all possible mount types

This shows all possible mount types and returns them as a list.

This takes no parameters and returns

  • mountTypes: list of mount types

The mount types are strings like "mount", "mount2", "cmount" and can
be passed to mount/mount as the mountType parameter.

Eg

rclone rc mount/types

Authentication is required for this call.

mount/unmount: Unmount selected active mount

rclone allows Linux, FreeBSD, macOS and Windows to
mount any of Rclone's cloud storage systems as a file system with
FUSE.

This takes the following parameters

  • mountPoint: valid path on the local machine where the mount was created (required)

Eg

rclone rc mount/unmount mountPoint=/home/<user>/mountPoint

Authentication is required for this call.

mount/unmountall: Show current mount points

This shows currently mounted points, which can be used for performing an unmount

This takes no parameters and returns error if unmount does not succeed.

Eg

rclone rc mount/unmountall

Authentication is required for this call.

operations/about: Return the space used on the remote

This takes the following parameters

  • fs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:"

The result is as returned from rclone about --json

See the about command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

operations/cleanup: Remove trashed files in the remote or path

This takes the following parameters

  • fs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:"

See the cleanup command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

operations/copyfile: Copy a file from source remote to destination remote

This takes the following parameters

  • srcFs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:" for the source
  • srcRemote - a path within that remote e.g. "file.txt" for the source
  • dstFs - a remote name string e.g. "drive2:" for the destination
  • dstRemote - a path within that remote e.g. "file2.txt" for the destination

Authentication is required for this call.

operations/copyurl: Copy the URL to the object

This takes the following parameters

  • fs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:"
  • remote - a path within that remote e.g. "dir"
  • url - string, URL to read from
  • autoFilename - boolean, set to true to retrieve destination file name from url
    See the copyurl command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

operations/delete: Remove files in the path

This takes the following parameters

  • fs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:"

See the delete command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

operations/deletefile: Remove the single file pointed to

This takes the following parameters

  • fs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:"
  • remote - a path within that remote e.g. "dir"

See the deletefile command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

operations/fsinfo: Return information about the remote

This takes the following parameters

  • fs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:"

This returns info about the remote passed in;

{
	// optional features and whether they are available or not
	"Features": {
		"About": true,
		"BucketBased": false,
		"CanHaveEmptyDirectories": true,
		"CaseInsensitive": false,
		"ChangeNotify": false,
		"CleanUp": false,
		"Copy": false,
		"DirCacheFlush": false,
		"DirMove": true,
		"DuplicateFiles": false,
		"GetTier": false,
		"ListR": false,
		"MergeDirs": false,
		"Move": true,
		"OpenWriterAt": true,
		"PublicLink": false,
		"Purge": true,
		"PutStream": true,
		"PutUnchecked": false,
		"ReadMimeType": false,
		"ServerSideAcrossConfigs": false,
		"SetTier": false,
		"SetWrapper": false,
		"UnWrap": false,
		"WrapFs": false,
		"WriteMimeType": false
	},
	// Names of hashes available
	"Hashes": [
		"MD5",
		"SHA-1",
		"DropboxHash",
		"QuickXorHash"
	],
	"Name": "local",	// Name as created
	"Precision": 1,		// Precision of timestamps in ns
	"Root": "/",		// Path as created
	"String": "Local file system at /" // how the remote will appear in logs
}

This command does not have a command line equivalent so use this instead:

rclone rc --loopback operations/fsinfo fs=remote:

operations/list: List the given remote and path in JSON format

This takes the following parameters

  • fs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:"
  • remote - a path within that remote e.g. "dir"
  • opt - a dictionary of options to control the listing (optional)
    • recurse - If set recurse directories
    • noModTime - If set return modification time
    • showEncrypted - If set show decrypted names
    • showOrigIDs - If set show the IDs for each item if known
    • showHash - If set return a dictionary of hashes

The result is

  • list
    • This is an array of objects as described in the lsjson command

See the lsjson command for more information on the above and examples.

Authentication is required for this call.

operations/mkdir: Make a destination directory or container

This takes the following parameters

  • fs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:"
  • remote - a path within that remote e.g. "dir"

See the mkdir command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

operations/movefile: Move a file from source remote to destination remote

This takes the following parameters

  • srcFs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:" for the source
  • srcRemote - a path within that remote e.g. "file.txt" for the source
  • dstFs - a remote name string e.g. "drive2:" for the destination
  • dstRemote - a path within that remote e.g. "file2.txt" for the destination

Authentication is required for this call.

This takes the following parameters

  • fs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:"
  • remote - a path within that remote e.g. "dir"
  • unlink - boolean - if set removes the link rather than adding it (optional)
  • expire - string - the expiry time of the link e.g. "1d" (optional)

Returns

  • url - URL of the resource

See the link command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

operations/purge: Remove a directory or container and all of its contents

This takes the following parameters

  • fs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:"
  • remote - a path within that remote e.g. "dir"

See the purge command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

operations/rmdir: Remove an empty directory or container

This takes the following parameters

  • fs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:"
  • remote - a path within that remote e.g. "dir"

See the rmdir command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

operations/rmdirs: Remove all the empty directories in the path

This takes the following parameters

  • fs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:"
  • remote - a path within that remote e.g. "dir"
  • leaveRoot - boolean, set to true not to delete the root

See the rmdirs command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

operations/size: Count the number of bytes and files in remote

This takes the following parameters

  • fs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:path/to/dir"

Returns

  • count - number of files
  • bytes - number of bytes in those files

See the size command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

operations/uploadfile: Upload file using multiform/form-data

This takes the following parameters

  • fs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:"
  • remote - a path within that remote e.g. "dir"
  • each part in body represents a file to be uploaded
    See the uploadfile command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

options/blocks: List all the option blocks

Returns

  • options - a list of the options block names

options/get: Get all the options

Returns an object where keys are option block names and values are an
object with the current option values in.

This shows the internal names of the option within rclone which should
map to the external options very easily with a few exceptions.

options/set: Set an option

Parameters

  • option block name containing an object with
    • key: value

Repeated as often as required.

Only supply the options you wish to change. If an option is unknown
it will be silently ignored. Not all options will have an effect when
changed like this.

For example:

This sets DEBUG level logs (-vv)

rclone rc options/set --json '{"main": {"LogLevel": 8}}'

And this sets INFO level logs (-v)

rclone rc options/set --json '{"main": {"LogLevel": 7}}'

And this sets NOTICE level logs (normal without -v)

rclone rc options/set --json '{"main": {"LogLevel": 6}}'

pluginsctl/addPlugin: Add a plugin using url

used for adding a plugin to the webgui

This takes the following parameters

Eg

rclone rc pluginsctl/addPlugin

Authentication is required for this call.

pluginsctl/getPluginsForType: Get plugins with type criteria

This shows all possible plugins by a mime type

This takes the following parameters

  • type: supported mime type by a loaded plugin e.g. (video/mp4, audio/mp3)
  • pluginType: filter plugins based on their type e.g. (DASHBOARD, FILE_HANDLER, TERMINAL)

and returns

  • loadedPlugins: list of current production plugins
  • testPlugins: list of temporarily loaded development plugins, usually running on a different server.

Eg

rclone rc pluginsctl/getPluginsForType type=video/mp4

Authentication is required for this call.

pluginsctl/listPlugins: Get the list of currently loaded plugins

This allows you to get the currently enabled plugins and their details.

This takes no parameters and returns

  • loadedPlugins: list of current production plugins
  • testPlugins: list of temporarily loaded development plugins, usually running on a different server.

Eg

rclone rc pluginsctl/listPlugins

Authentication is required for this call.

pluginsctl/listTestPlugins: Show currently loaded test plugins

allows listing of test plugins with the rclone.test set to true in package.json of the plugin

This takes no parameters and returns

  • loadedTestPlugins: list of currently available test plugins

Eg

rclone rc pluginsctl/listTestPlugins

Authentication is required for this call.

pluginsctl/removePlugin: Remove a loaded plugin

This allows you to remove a plugin using it's name

This takes parameters

  • name: name of the plugin in the format author/plugin_name

Eg

rclone rc pluginsctl/removePlugin name=rclone/video-plugin

Authentication is required for this call.

pluginsctl/removeTestPlugin: Remove a test plugin

This allows you to remove a plugin using it's name

This takes the following parameters

  • name: name of the plugin in the format author/plugin_name

Eg

rclone rc pluginsctl/removeTestPlugin name=rclone/rclone-webui-react

Authentication is required for this call.

rc/error: This returns an error

This returns an error with the input as part of its error string.
Useful for testing error handling.

rc/list: List all the registered remote control commands

This lists all the registered remote control commands as a JSON map in
the commands response.

rc/noop: Echo the input to the output parameters

This echoes the input parameters to the output parameters for testing
purposes. It can be used to check that rclone is still alive and to
check that parameter passing is working properly.

rc/noopauth: Echo the input to the output parameters requiring auth

This echoes the input parameters to the output parameters for testing
purposes. It can be used to check that rclone is still alive and to
check that parameter passing is working properly.

Authentication is required for this call.

sync/copy: copy a directory from source remote to destination remote

This takes the following parameters

  • srcFs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:src" for the source
  • dstFs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:dst" for the destination

See the copy command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

sync/move: move a directory from source remote to destination remote

This takes the following parameters

  • srcFs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:src" for the source
  • dstFs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:dst" for the destination
  • deleteEmptySrcDirs - delete empty src directories if set

See the move command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

sync/sync: sync a directory from source remote to destination remote

This takes the following parameters

  • srcFs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:src" for the source
  • dstFs - a remote name string e.g. "drive:dst" for the destination

See the sync command command for more information on the above.

Authentication is required for this call.

vfs/forget: Forget files or directories in the directory cache.

This forgets the paths in the directory cache causing them to be
re-read from the remote when needed.

If no paths are passed in then it will forget all the paths in the
directory cache.

rclone rc vfs/forget

Otherwise pass files or dirs in as file=path or dir=path. Any
parameter key starting with file will forget that file and any
starting with dir will forget that dir, e.g.

rclone rc vfs/forget file=hello file2=goodbye dir=home/junk

This command takes an "fs" parameter. If this parameter is not
supplied and if there is only one VFS in use then that VFS will be
used. If there is more than one VFS in use then the "fs" parameter
must be supplied.

vfs/list: List active VFSes.

This lists the active VFSes.

It returns a list under the key "vfses" where the values are the VFS
names that could be passed to the other VFS commands in the "fs"
parameter.

vfs/poll-interval: Get the status or update the value of the poll-interval option.

Without any parameter given this returns the current status of the
poll-interval setting.

When the interval=duration parameter is set, the poll-interval value
is updated and the polling function is notified.
Setting interval=0 disables poll-interval.

rclone rc vfs/poll-interval interval=5m

The timeout=duration parameter can be used to specify a time to wait
for the current poll function to apply the new value.
If timeout is less or equal 0, which is the default, wait indefinitely.

The new poll-interval value will only be active when the timeout is
not reached.

If poll-interval is updated or disabled temporarily, some changes
might not get picked up by the polling function, depending on the
used remote.

This command takes an "fs" parameter. If this parameter is not
supplied and if there is only one VFS in use then that VFS will be
used. If there is more than one VFS in use then the "fs" parameter
must be supplied.

vfs/refresh: Refresh the directory cache.

This reads the directories for the specified paths and freshens the
directory cache.

If no paths are passed in then it will refresh the root directory.

rclone rc vfs/refresh

Otherwise pass directories in as dir=path. Any parameter key
starting with dir will refresh that directory, e.g.

rclone rc vfs/refresh dir=home/junk dir2=data/misc

If the parameter recursive=true is given the whole directory tree
will get refreshed. This refresh will use --fast-list if enabled.

This command takes an "fs" parameter. If this parameter is not
supplied and if there is only one VFS in use then that VFS will be
used. If there is more than one VFS in use then the "fs" parameter
must be supplied.

Accessing the remote control via HTTP

Rclone implements a simple HTTP based protocol.

Each endpoint takes an JSON object and returns a JSON object or an
error. The JSON objects are essentially a map of string names to
values.

All calls must made using POST.

The input objects can be supplied using URL parameters, POST
parameters or by supplying "Content-Type: application/json" and a JSON
blob in the body. There are examples of these below using curl.

The response will be a JSON blob in the body of the response. This is
formatted to be reasonably human readable.

Error returns

If an error occurs then there will be an HTTP error status (e.g. 500)
and the body of the response will contain a JSON encoded error object,
e.g.

{
    "error": "Expecting string value for key \"remote\" (was float64)",
    "input": {
        "fs": "/tmp",
        "remote": 3
    },
    "status": 400
    "path": "operations/rmdir",
}

The keys in the error response are

  • error - error string
  • input - the input parameters to the call
  • status - the HTTP status code
  • path - the path of the call

CORS

The sever implements basic CORS support and allows all origins for that.
The response to a preflight OPTIONS request will echo the requested "Access-Control-Request-Headers" back.

Using POST with URL parameters only

curl -X POST 'http://localhost:5572/rc/noop?potato=1&sausage=2'

Response

{
	"potato": "1",
	"sausage": "2"
}

Here is what an error response looks like:

curl -X POST 'http://localhost:5572/rc/error?potato=1&sausage=2'
{
	"error": "arbitrary error on input map[potato:1 sausage:2]",
	"input": {
		"potato": "1",
		"sausage": "2"
	}
}

Note that curl doesn't return errors to the shell unless you use the -f option

$ curl -f -X POST 'http://localhost:5572/rc/error?potato=1&sausage=2'
curl: (22) The requested URL returned error: 400 Bad Request
$ echo $?
22

Using POST with a form

curl --data "potato=1" --data "sausage=2" http://localhost:5572/rc/noop

Response

{
	"potato": "1",
	"sausage": "2"
}

Note that you can combine these with URL parameters too with the POST
parameters taking precedence.

curl --data "potato=1" --data "sausage=2" "http://localhost:5572/rc/noop?rutabaga=3&sausage=4"

Response

{
	"potato": "1",
	"rutabaga": "3",
	"sausage": "4"
}

Using POST with a JSON blob

curl -H "Content-Type: application/json" -X POST -d '{"potato":2,"sausage":1}' http://localhost:5572/rc/noop

response

{
	"password": "xyz",
	"username": "xyz"
}

This can be combined with URL parameters too if required. The JSON
blob takes precedence.

curl -H "Content-Type: application/json" -X POST -d '{"potato":2,"sausage":1}' 'http://localhost:5572/rc/noop?rutabaga=3&potato=4'
{
	"potato": 2,
	"rutabaga": "3",
	"sausage": 1
}

Debugging rclone with pprof

If you use the --rc flag this will also enable the use of the go
profiling tools on the same port.

To use these, first install go.

Debugging memory use

To profile rclone's memory use you can run:

go tool pprof -web http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/heap

This should open a page in your browser showing what is using what
memory.

You can also use the -text flag to produce a textual summary

$ go tool pprof -text http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/heap
Showing nodes accounting for 1537.03kB, 100% of 1537.03kB total
      flat  flat%   sum%        cum   cum%
 1024.03kB 66.62% 66.62%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/vendor/golang.org/x/net/http2/hpack.addDecoderNode
     513kB 33.38%   100%      513kB 33.38%  net/http.newBufioWriterSize
         0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/cmd/all.init
         0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/cmd/serve.init
         0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/cmd/serve/restic.init
         0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/vendor/golang.org/x/net/http2.init
         0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/vendor/golang.org/x/net/http2/hpack.init
         0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  github.com/rclone/rclone/vendor/golang.org/x/net/http2/hpack.init.0
         0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  main.init
         0     0%   100%      513kB 33.38%  net/http.(*conn).readRequest
         0     0%   100%      513kB 33.38%  net/http.(*conn).serve
         0     0%   100%  1024.03kB 66.62%  runtime.main

Debugging go routine leaks

Memory leaks are most often caused by go routine leaks keeping memory
alive which should have been garbage collected.

See all active go routines using

curl http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/goroutine?debug=1

Or go to http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/goroutine?debug=1 in your browser.

Other profiles to look at

You can see a summary of profiles available at http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/

Here is how to use some of them:

  • Memory: go tool pprof http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/heap
  • Go routines: curl http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/goroutine?debug=1
  • 30-second CPU profile: go tool pprof http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/profile
  • 5-second execution trace: wget http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/trace?seconds=5
  • Goroutine blocking profile
    • Enable first with: rclone rc debug/set-block-profile-rate rate=1 (docs)
    • go tool pprof http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/block
  • Contended mutexes:
    • Enable first with: rclone rc debug/set-mutex-profile-fraction rate=1 (docs)
    • go tool pprof http://localhost:5572/debug/pprof/mutex

See the net/http/pprof docs
for more info on how to use the profiling and for a general overview
see the Go team's blog post on profiling go programs.

The profiling hook is zero overhead unless it is used.

Overview of cloud storage systems

Each cloud storage system is slightly different. Rclone attempts to
provide a unified interface to them, but some underlying differences
show through.

Features

Here is an overview of the major features of each cloud storage system.

Name Hash ModTime Case Insensitive Duplicate Files MIME Type
1Fichier Whirlpool No No Yes R
Amazon Drive MD5 No Yes No R
Amazon S3 MD5 Yes No No R/W
Backblaze B2 SHA1 Yes No No R/W
Box SHA1 Yes Yes No -
Citrix ShareFile MD5 Yes Yes No -
Dropbox DBHASH ¹ Yes Yes No -
Enterprise File Fabric - Yes Yes No R/W
FTP - No No No -
Google Cloud Storage MD5 Yes No No R/W
Google Drive MD5 Yes No Yes R/W
Google Photos - No No Yes R
HDFS - Yes No No -
HTTP - No No No R
Hubic MD5 Yes No No R/W
Jottacloud MD5 Yes Yes No R
Koofr MD5 No Yes No -
Mail.ru Cloud Mailru ⁶ Yes Yes No -
Mega - No No Yes -
Memory MD5 Yes No No -
Microsoft Azure Blob Storage MD5 Yes No No R/W
Microsoft OneDrive SHA1 ⁵ Yes Yes No R
OpenDrive MD5 Yes Yes Partial ⁸ -
OpenStack Swift MD5 Yes No No R/W
pCloud MD5, SHA1 ⁷ Yes No No W
premiumize.me - No Yes No R
put.io CRC-32 Yes No Yes R
QingStor MD5 No No No R/W
Seafile - No No No -
SFTP MD5, SHA1 ² Yes Depends No -
SugarSync - No No No -
Tardigrade - Yes No No -
WebDAV MD5, SHA1 ³ Yes ⁴ Depends No -
Yandex Disk MD5 Yes No No R
Zoho WorkDrive - No No No -
The local filesystem All Yes Depends No -

Notes

¹ Dropbox supports its own custom
hash
.
This is an SHA256 sum of all the 4MB block SHA256s.

² SFTP supports checksums if the same login has shell access and
md5sum or sha1sum as well as echo are in the remote's PATH.

³ WebDAV supports hashes when used with Owncloud and Nextcloud only.

⁴ WebDAV supports modtimes when used with Owncloud and Nextcloud only.

⁵ Microsoft OneDrive Personal supports SHA1 hashes, whereas OneDrive
for business and SharePoint server support Microsoft's own
QuickXorHash.

⁶ Mail.ru uses its own modified SHA1 hash

⁷ pCloud only supports SHA1 (not MD5) in its EU region

⁸ Opendrive does not support creation of duplicate files using
their web client interface or other stock clients, but the underlying
storage platform has been determined to allow duplicate files, and it
is possible to create them with rclone. It may be that this is a
mistake or an unsupported feature.

Hash

The cloud storage system supports various hash types of the objects.
The hashes are used when transferring data as an integrity check and
can be specifically used with the --checksum flag in syncs and in
the check command.

To use the verify checksums when transferring between cloud storage
systems they must support a common hash type.

ModTime

The cloud storage system supports setting modification times on
objects. If it does then this enables a using the modification times
as part of the sync. If not then only the size will be checked by
default, though the MD5SUM can be checked with the --checksum flag.

All cloud storage systems support some kind of date on the object and
these will be set when transferring from the cloud storage system.

Case Insensitive

If a cloud storage systems is case sensitive then it is possible to
have two files which differ only in case, e.g. file.txt and
FILE.txt. If a cloud storage system is case insensitive then that
isn't possible.

This can cause problems when syncing between a case insensitive
system and a case sensitive system. The symptom of this is that no
matter how many times you run the sync it never completes fully.

The local filesystem and SFTP may or may not be case sensitive
depending on OS.

  • Windows - usually case insensitive, though case is preserved
  • OSX - usually case insensitive, though it is possible to format case sensitive
  • Linux - usually case sensitive, but there are case insensitive file systems (e.g. FAT formatted USB keys)

Most of the time this doesn't cause any problems as people tend to
avoid files whose name differs only by case even on case sensitive
systems.

Duplicate files

If a cloud storage system allows duplicate files then it can have two
objects with the same name.

This confuses rclone greatly when syncing - use the rclone dedupe
command to rename or remove duplicates.

Restricted filenames

Some cloud storage systems might have restrictions on the characters
that are usable in file or directory names.
When rclone detects such a name during a file upload, it will
transparently replace the restricted characters with similar looking
Unicode characters.

This process is designed to avoid ambiguous file names as much as
possible and allow to move files between many cloud storage systems
transparently.

The name shown by rclone to the user or during log output will only
contain a minimal set of replaced characters
to ensure correct formatting and not necessarily the actual name used
on the cloud storage.

This transformation is reversed when downloading a file or parsing
rclone arguments.
For example, when uploading a file named my file?.txt to Onedrive
will be displayed as my file?.txt on the console, but stored as
my file.txt (the ? gets replaced by the similar looking
character) to Onedrive.
The reverse transformation allows to read a fileunusual/name.txt
from Google Drive, by passing the name unusualname.txt (the / needs
to be replaced by the similar looking character) on the command line.

Default restricted characters

The table below shows the characters that are replaced by default.

When a replacement character is found in a filename, this character
will be escaped with the character to avoid ambiguous file names.
(e.g. a file named ␀.txt would shown as ‛␀.txt)

Each cloud storage backend can use a different set of characters,
which will be specified in the documentation for each backend.

Character Value Replacement
NUL 0x00
SOH 0x01
STX 0x02
ETX 0x03
EOT 0x04
ENQ 0x05
ACK 0x06
BEL 0x07
BS 0x08
HT 0x09
LF 0x0A
VT 0x0B
FF 0x0C
CR 0x0D
SO 0x0E
SI 0x0F
DLE 0x10
DC1 0x11
DC2 0x12
DC3 0x13
DC4 0x14
NAK 0x15
SYN 0x16
ETB 0x17
CAN 0x18
EM 0x19
SUB 0x1A
ESC 0x1B
FS 0x1C
GS 0x1D
RS 0x1E
US 0x1F
/ 0x2F
DEL 0x7F

The default encoding will also encode these file names as they are
problematic with many cloud storage systems.

File name Replacement
.
..

Invalid UTF-8 bytes

Some backends only support a sequence of well formed UTF-8 bytes
as file or directory names.

In this case all invalid UTF-8 bytes will be replaced with a quoted
representation of the byte value to allow uploading a file to such a
backend. For example, the invalid byte 0xFE will be encoded as FE.

A common source of invalid UTF-8 bytes are local filesystems, that store
names in a different encoding than UTF-8 or UTF-16, like latin1. See the
local filenames section for details.

Encoding option

Most backends have an encoding options, specified as a flag
--backend-encoding where backend is the name of the backend, or as
a config parameter encoding (you'll need to select the Advanced
config in rclone config to see it).

This will have default value which encodes and decodes characters in
such a way as to preserve the maximum number of characters (see
above).

However this can be incorrect in some scenarios, for example if you
have a Windows file system with characters such as and that
you want to remain as those characters on the remote rather than being
translated to * and ?.

The --backend-encoding flags allow you to change that. You can
disable the encoding completely with --backend-encoding None or set
encoding = None in the config file.

Encoding takes a comma separated list of encodings. You can see the
list of all available characters by passing an invalid value to this
flag, e.g. --local-encoding "help" and rclone help flags encoding
will show you the defaults for the backends.

Encoding Characters
Asterisk *
BackQuote `
BackSlash \
Colon :
CrLf CR 0x0D, LF 0x0A
Ctl All control characters 0x00-0x1F
Del DEL 0x7F
Dollar $
Dot .
DoubleQuote "
Hash #
InvalidUtf8 An invalid UTF-8 character (e.g. latin1)
LeftCrLfHtVt CR 0x0D, LF 0x0A,HT 0x09, VT 0x0B on the left of a string
LeftPeriod . on the left of a string
LeftSpace SPACE on the left of a string
LeftTilde ~ on the left of a string
LtGt <, >
None No characters are encoded
Percent %
Pipe |
Question ?
RightCrLfHtVt CR 0x0D, LF 0x0A, HT 0x09, VT 0x0B on the right of a string
RightPeriod . on the right of a string
RightSpace SPACE on the right of a string
SingleQuote '
Slash /

To take a specific example, the FTP backend's default encoding is

--ftp-encoding "Slash,Del,Ctl,RightSpace,Dot"

However, let's say the FTP server is running on Windows and can't have
any of the invalid Windows characters in file names. You are backing
up Linux servers to this FTP server which do have those characters in
file names. So you would add the Windows set which are

Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot

to the existing ones, giving:

Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot,Del,RightSpace

This can be specified using the --ftp-encoding flag or using an encoding parameter in the config file.

Or let's say you have a Windows server but you want to preserve
and , you would then have this as the encoding (the Windows
encoding minus Asterisk and Question).

Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot

This can be specified using the --local-encoding flag or using an
encoding parameter in the config file.

MIME Type

MIME types (also known as media types) classify types of documents
using a simple text classification, e.g. text/html or
application/pdf.

Some cloud storage systems support reading (R) the MIME type of
objects and some support writing (W) the MIME type of objects.

The MIME type can be important if you are serving files directly to
HTTP from the storage system.

If you are copying from a remote which supports reading (R) to a
remote which supports writing (W) then rclone will preserve the MIME
types. Otherwise they will be guessed from the extension, or the
remote itself may assign the MIME type.

Optional Features

All rclone remotes support a base command set. Other features depend
upon backend specific capabilities.

Name Purge Copy Move DirMove CleanUp ListR StreamUpload LinkSharing About EmptyDir
1Fichier No No No No No No No No No Yes
Amazon Drive Yes No Yes Yes No #575 No No No #2178 No Yes
Amazon S3 No Yes No No Yes Yes Yes No #2178 No No
Backblaze B2 No Yes No No Yes Yes Yes Yes No No
Box Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes ‡‡ No Yes Yes No Yes
Citrix ShareFile Yes Yes Yes Yes No No Yes No No Yes
Dropbox Yes Yes Yes Yes No #575 No Yes Yes Yes Yes
Enterprise File Fabric Yes Yes Yes Yes No No No No No Yes
FTP No No Yes Yes No No Yes No #2178 No Yes
Google Cloud Storage Yes Yes No No No Yes Yes No #2178 No No
Google Drive Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Google Photos No No No No No No No No No No
HDFS Yes No No No No No Yes No Yes Yes
HTTP No No No No No No No No #2178 No Yes
Hubic Yes † Yes No No No Yes Yes No #2178 Yes No
Jottacloud Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No Yes Yes Yes
Mail.ru Cloud Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No No Yes Yes Yes
Mega Yes No Yes Yes Yes No No No #2178 Yes Yes
Memory No Yes No No No Yes Yes No No No
Microsoft Azure Blob Storage Yes Yes No No No Yes Yes No #2178 No No
Microsoft OneDrive Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No No Yes Yes Yes
OpenDrive Yes Yes Yes Yes No No No No No Yes
OpenStack Swift Yes † Yes No No No Yes Yes No #2178 Yes No
pCloud Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No No Yes Yes Yes
premiumize.me Yes No Yes Yes No No No Yes Yes Yes
put.io Yes No Yes Yes Yes No Yes No #2178 Yes Yes
QingStor No Yes No No Yes Yes No No #2178 No No
Seafile Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
SFTP No No Yes Yes No No Yes No #2178 Yes Yes
SugarSync Yes Yes Yes Yes No No Yes Yes No Yes
Tardigrade Yes † No No No No Yes Yes No No No
WebDAV Yes Yes Yes Yes No No Yes ‡ No #2178 Yes Yes
Yandex Disk Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No Yes Yes Yes Yes
Zoho WorkDrive Yes Yes Yes Yes No No No No Yes Yes
The local filesystem Yes No Yes Yes No No Yes No Yes Yes

Purge

This deletes a directory quicker than just deleting all the files in
the directory.

† Note Swift, Hubic, and Tardigrade implement this in order to delete
directory markers but they don't actually have a quicker way of deleting
files other than deleting them individually.

‡ StreamUpload is not supported with Nextcloud

Copy

Used when copying an object to and from the same remote. This known
as a server-side copy so you can copy a file without downloading it
and uploading it again. It is used if you use rclone copy or
rclone move if the remote doesn't support Move directly.

If the server doesn't support Copy directly then for copy operations
the file is downloaded then re-uploaded.

Move

Used when moving/renaming an object on the same remote. This is known
as a server-side move of a file. This is used in rclone move if the
server doesn't support DirMove.

If the server isn't capable of Move then rclone simulates it with
Copy then delete. If the server doesn't support Copy then rclone
will download the file and re-upload it.

DirMove

This is used to implement rclone move to move a directory if
possible. If it isn't then it will use Move on each file (which
falls back to Copy then download and upload - see Move section).

CleanUp

This is used for emptying the trash for a remote by rclone cleanup.

If the server can't do CleanUp then rclone cleanup will return an
error.

‡‡ Note that while Box implements this it has to delete every file
individually so it will be slower than emptying the trash via the WebUI

ListR

The remote supports a recursive list to list all the contents beneath
a directory quickly. This enables the --fast-list flag to work.
See the rclone docs for more details.

StreamUpload

Some remotes allow files to be uploaded without knowing the file size
in advance. This allows certain operations to work without spooling the
file to local disk first, e.g. rclone rcat.

LinkSharing

Sets the necessary permissions on a file or folder and prints a link
that allows others to access them, even if they don't have an account
on the particular cloud provider.

About

Rclone about prints quota information for a remote. Typical output
includes bytes used, free, quota and in trash.

If a remote lacks about capability rclone about remote:returns
an error.

Backends without about capability cannot determine free space for an
rclone mount, or use policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an
rclone union remote.

See rclone about command

EmptyDir

The remote supports empty directories. See Limitations
for details. Most Object/Bucket based remotes do not support this.

Global Flags

This describes the global flags available to every rclone command
split into two groups, non backend and backend flags.

Non Backend Flags

These flags are available for every command.

      --ask-password                         Allow prompt for password for encrypted configuration. (default true)
      --auto-confirm                         If enabled, do not request console confirmation.
      --backup-dir string                    Make backups into hierarchy based in DIR.
      --bind string                          Local address to bind to for outgoing connections, IPv4, IPv6 or name.
      --buffer-size SizeSuffix               In memory buffer size when reading files for each --transfer. (default 16M)
      --bwlimit BwTimetable                  Bandwidth limit in kBytes/s, or use suffix b|k|M|G or a full timetable.
      --bwlimit-file BwTimetable             Bandwidth limit per file in kBytes/s, or use suffix b|k|M|G or a full timetable.
      --ca-cert string                       CA certificate used to verify servers
      --cache-dir string                     Directory rclone will use for caching. (default "$HOME/.cache/rclone")
      --check-first                          Do all the checks before starting transfers.
      --checkers int                         Number of checkers to run in parallel. (default 8)
  -c, --checksum                             Skip based on checksum (if available) & size, not mod-time & size
      --client-cert string                   Client SSL certificate (PEM) for mutual TLS auth
      --client-key string                    Client SSL private key (PEM) for mutual TLS auth
      --compare-dest string                  Include additional server-side path during comparison.
      --config string                        Config file. (default "$HOME/.config/rclone/rclone.conf")
      --contimeout duration                  Connect timeout (default 1m0s)
      --copy-dest string                     Implies --compare-dest but also copies files from path into destination.
      --cpuprofile string                    Write cpu profile to file
      --cutoff-mode string                   Mode to stop transfers when reaching the max transfer limit HARD|SOFT|CAUTIOUS (default "HARD")
      --delete-after                         When synchronizing, delete files on destination after transferring (default)
      --delete-before                        When synchronizing, delete files on destination before transferring
      --delete-during                        When synchronizing, delete files during transfer
      --delete-excluded                      Delete files on dest excluded from sync
      --disable string                       Disable a comma separated list of features.  Use help to see a list.
  -n, --dry-run                              Do a trial run with no permanent changes
      --dump DumpFlags                       List of items to dump from: headers,bodies,requests,responses,auth,filters,goroutines,openfiles
      --dump-bodies                          Dump HTTP headers and bodies - may contain sensitive info
      --dump-headers                         Dump HTTP headers - may contain sensitive info
      --error-on-no-transfer                 Sets exit code 9 if no files are transferred, useful in scripts
      --exclude stringArray                  Exclude files matching pattern
      --exclude-from stringArray             Read exclude patterns from file (use - to read from stdin)
      --exclude-if-present string            Exclude directories if filename is present
      --expect-continue-timeout duration     Timeout when using expect / 100-continue in HTTP (default 1s)
      --fast-list                            Use recursive list if available. Uses more memory but fewer transactions.
      --files-from stringArray               Read list of source-file names from file (use - to read from stdin)
      --files-from-raw stringArray           Read list of source-file names from file without any processing of lines (use - to read from stdin)
  -f, --filter stringArray                   Add a file-filtering rule
      --filter-from stringArray              Read filtering patterns from a file (use - to read from stdin)
      --header stringArray                   Set HTTP header for all transactions
      --header-download stringArray          Set HTTP header for download transactions
      --header-upload stringArray            Set HTTP header for upload transactions
      --ignore-case                          Ignore case in filters (case insensitive)
      --ignore-case-sync                     Ignore case when synchronizing
      --ignore-checksum                      Skip post copy check of checksums.
      --ignore-errors                        delete even if there are I/O errors
      --ignore-existing                      Skip all files that exist on destination
      --ignore-size                          Ignore size when skipping use mod-time or checksum.
  -I, --ignore-times                         Don't skip files that match size and time - transfer all files
      --immutable                            Do not modify files. Fail if existing files have been modified.
      --include stringArray                  Include files matching pattern
      --include-from stringArray             Read include patterns from file (use - to read from stdin)
  -i, --interactive                          Enable interactive mode
      --log-file string                      Log everything to this file
      --log-format string                    Comma separated list of log format options (default "date,time")
      --log-level string                     Log level DEBUG|INFO|NOTICE|ERROR (default "NOTICE")
      --log-systemd                          Activate systemd integration for the logger.
      --low-level-retries int                Number of low level retries to do. (default 10)
      --max-age Duration                     Only transfer files younger than this in s or suffix ms|s|m|h|d|w|M|y (default off)
      --max-backlog int                      Maximum number of objects in sync or check backlog. (default 10000)
      --max-delete int                       When synchronizing, limit the number of deletes (default -1)
      --max-depth int                        If set limits the recursion depth to this. (default -1)
      --max-duration duration                Maximum duration rclone will transfer data for.
      --max-size SizeSuffix                  Only transfer files smaller than this in k or suffix b|k|M|G (default off)
      --max-stats-groups int                 Maximum number of stats groups to keep in memory. On max oldest is discarded. (default 1000)
      --max-transfer SizeSuffix              Maximum size of data to transfer. (default off)
      --memprofile string                    Write memory profile to file
      --min-age Duration                     Only transfer files older than this in s or suffix ms|s|m|h|d|w|M|y (default off)
      --min-size SizeSuffix                  Only transfer files bigger than this in k or suffix b|k|M|G (default off)
      --modify-window duration               Max time diff to be considered the same (default 1ns)
      --multi-thread-cutoff SizeSuffix       Use multi-thread downloads for files above this size. (default 250M)
      --multi-thread-streams int             Max number of streams to use for multi-thread downloads. (default 4)
      --no-check-certificate                 Do not verify the server SSL certificate. Insecure.
      --no-check-dest                        Don't check the destination, copy regardless.
      --no-console                           Hide console window. Supported on Windows only.
      --no-gzip-encoding                     Don't set Accept-Encoding: gzip.
      --no-traverse                          Don't traverse destination file system on copy.
      --no-unicode-normalization             Don't normalize unicode characters in filenames.
      --no-update-modtime                    Don't update destination mod-time if files identical.
      --order-by string                      Instructions on how to order the transfers, e.g. 'size,descending'
      --password-command SpaceSepList        Command for supplying password for encrypted configuration.
  -P, --progress                             Show progress during transfer.
      --progress-terminal-title              Show progress on the terminal title. Requires -P/--progress.
  -q, --quiet                                Print as little stuff as possible
      --rc                                   Enable the remote control server.
      --rc-addr string                       IPaddress:Port or :Port to bind server to. (default "localhost:5572")
      --rc-allow-origin string               Set the allowed origin for CORS.
      --rc-baseurl string                    Prefix for URLs - leave blank for root.
      --rc-cert string                       SSL PEM key (concatenation of certificate and CA certificate)
      --rc-client-ca string                  Client certificate authority to verify clients with
      --rc-enable-metrics                    Enable prometheus metrics on /metrics
      --rc-files string                      Path to local files to serve on the HTTP server.
      --rc-htpasswd string                   htpasswd file - if not provided no authentication is done
      --rc-job-expire-duration duration      expire finished async jobs older than this value (default 1m0s)
      --rc-job-expire-interval duration      interval to check for expired async jobs (default 10s)
      --rc-key string                        SSL PEM Private key
      --rc-max-header-bytes int              Maximum size of request header (default 4096)
      --rc-no-auth                           Don't require auth for certain methods.
      --rc-pass string                       Password for authentication.
      --rc-realm string                      realm for authentication (default "rclone")
      --rc-serve                             Enable the serving of remote objects.
      --rc-server-read-timeout duration      Timeout for server reading data (default 1h0m0s)
      --rc-server-write-timeout duration     Timeout for server writing data (default 1h0m0s)
      --rc-template string                   User Specified Template.
      --rc-user string                       User name for authentication.
      --rc-web-fetch-url string              URL to fetch the releases for webgui. (default "https://api.github.com/repos/rclone/rclone-webui-react/releases/latest")
      --rc-web-gui                           Launch WebGUI on localhost
      --rc-web-gui-force-update              Force update to latest version of web gui
      --rc-web-gui-no-open-browser           Don't open the browser automatically
      --rc-web-gui-update                    Check and update to latest version of web gui
      --refresh-times                        Refresh the modtime of remote files.
      --retries int                          Retry operations this many times if they fail (default 3)
      --retries-sleep duration               Interval between retrying operations if they fail, e.g 500ms, 60s, 5m. (0 to disable)
      --size-only                            Skip based on size only, not mod-time or checksum
      --stats duration                       Interval between printing stats, e.g 500ms, 60s, 5m. (0 to disable) (default 1m0s)
      --stats-file-name-length int           Max file name length in stats. 0 for no limit (default 45)
      --stats-log-level string               Log level to show --stats output DEBUG|INFO|NOTICE|ERROR (default "INFO")
      --stats-one-line                       Make the stats fit on one line.
      --stats-one-line-date                  Enables --stats-one-line and add current date/time prefix.
      --stats-one-line-date-format string    Enables --stats-one-line-date and uses custom formatted date. Enclose date string in double quotes ("). See https://golang.org/pkg/time/#Time.Format
      --stats-unit string                    Show data rate in stats as either 'bits' or 'bytes'/s (default "bytes")
      --streaming-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix   Cutoff for switching to chunked upload if file size is unknown. Upload starts after reaching cutoff or when file ends. (default 100k)
      --suffix string                        Suffix to add to changed files.
      --suffix-keep-extension                Preserve the extension when using --suffix.
      --syslog                               Use Syslog for logging
      --syslog-facility string               Facility for syslog, e.g. KERN,USER,... (default "DAEMON")
      --timeout duration                     IO idle timeout (default 5m0s)
      --tpslimit float                       Limit HTTP transactions per second to this.
      --tpslimit-burst int                   Max burst of transactions for --tpslimit. (default 1)
      --track-renames                        When synchronizing, track file renames and do a server-side move if possible
      --track-renames-strategy string        Strategies to use when synchronizing using track-renames hash|modtime|leaf (default "hash")
      --transfers int                        Number of file transfers to run in parallel. (default 4)
  -u, --update                               Skip files that are newer on the destination.
      --use-cookies                          Enable session cookiejar.
      --use-json-log                         Use json log format.
      --use-mmap                             Use mmap allocator (see docs).
      --use-server-modtime                   Use server modified time instead of object metadata
      --user-agent string                    Set the user-agent to a specified string. The default is rclone/ version (default "rclone/v1.54.0")
  -v, --verbose count                        Print lots more stuff (repeat for more)

Backend Flags

These flags are available for every command. They control the backends
and may be set in the config file.

      --acd-auth-url string                                      Auth server URL.
      --acd-client-id string                                     OAuth Client Id
      --acd-client-secret string                                 OAuth Client Secret
      --acd-encoding MultiEncoder                                This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --acd-templink-threshold SizeSuffix                        Files >= this size will be downloaded via their tempLink. (default 9G)
      --acd-token string                                         OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.
      --acd-token-url string                                     Token server url.
      --acd-upload-wait-per-gb Duration                          Additional time per GB to wait after a failed complete upload to see if it appears. (default 3m0s)
      --alias-remote string                                      Remote or path to alias.
      --azureblob-access-tier string                             Access tier of blob: hot, cool or archive.
      --azureblob-account string                                 Storage Account Name (leave blank to use SAS URL or Emulator)
      --azureblob-archive-tier-delete                            Delete archive tier blobs before overwriting.
      --azureblob-chunk-size SizeSuffix                          Upload chunk size (<= 100MB). (default 4M)
      --azureblob-disable-checksum                               Don't store MD5 checksum with object metadata.
      --azureblob-encoding MultiEncoder                          This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8)
      --azureblob-endpoint string                                Endpoint for the service
      --azureblob-key string                                     Storage Account Key (leave blank to use SAS URL or Emulator)
      --azureblob-list-chunk int                                 Size of blob list. (default 5000)
      --azureblob-memory-pool-flush-time Duration                How often internal memory buffer pools will be flushed. (default 1m0s)
      --azureblob-memory-pool-use-mmap                           Whether to use mmap buffers in internal memory pool.
      --azureblob-msi-client-id string                           Object ID of the user-assigned MSI to use, if any. Leave blank if msi_object_id or msi_mi_res_id specified.
      --azureblob-msi-mi-res-id string                           Azure resource ID of the user-assigned MSI to use, if any. Leave blank if msi_client_id or msi_object_id specified.
      --azureblob-msi-object-id string                           Object ID of the user-assigned MSI to use, if any. Leave blank if msi_client_id or msi_mi_res_id specified.
      --azureblob-sas-url string                                 SAS URL for container level access only
      --azureblob-service-principal-file string                  Path to file containing credentials for use with a service principal.
      --azureblob-upload-cutoff string                           Cutoff for switching to chunked upload (<= 256MB). (Deprecated)
      --azureblob-use-emulator                                   Uses local storage emulator if provided as 'true' (leave blank if using real azure storage endpoint)
      --azureblob-use-msi                                        Use a managed service identity to authenticate (only works in Azure)
      --b2-account string                                        Account ID or Application Key ID
      --b2-chunk-size SizeSuffix                                 Upload chunk size. Must fit in memory. (default 96M)
      --b2-copy-cutoff SizeSuffix                                Cutoff for switching to multipart copy (default 4G)
      --b2-disable-checksum                                      Disable checksums for large (> upload cutoff) files
      --b2-download-auth-duration Duration                       Time before the authorization token will expire in s or suffix ms|s|m|h|d. (default 1w)
      --b2-download-url string                                   Custom endpoint for downloads.
      --b2-encoding MultiEncoder                                 This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --b2-endpoint string                                       Endpoint for the service.
      --b2-hard-delete                                           Permanently delete files on remote removal, otherwise hide files.
      --b2-key string                                            Application Key
      --b2-memory-pool-flush-time Duration                       How often internal memory buffer pools will be flushed. (default 1m0s)
      --b2-memory-pool-use-mmap                                  Whether to use mmap buffers in internal memory pool.
      --b2-test-mode string                                      A flag string for X-Bz-Test-Mode header for debugging.
      --b2-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix                              Cutoff for switching to chunked upload. (default 200M)
      --b2-versions                                              Include old versions in directory listings.
      --box-access-token string                                  Box App Primary Access Token
      --box-auth-url string                                      Auth server URL.
      --box-box-config-file string                               Box App config.json location
      --box-box-sub-type string                                   (default "user")
      --box-client-id string                                     OAuth Client Id
      --box-client-secret string                                 OAuth Client Secret
      --box-commit-retries int                                   Max number of times to try committing a multipart file. (default 100)
      --box-encoding MultiEncoder                                This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,RightSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --box-root-folder-id string                                Fill in for rclone to use a non root folder as its starting point.
      --box-token string                                         OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.
      --box-token-url string                                     Token server url.
      --box-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix                             Cutoff for switching to multipart upload (>= 50MB). (default 50M)
      --cache-chunk-clean-interval Duration                      How often should the cache perform cleanups of the chunk storage. (default 1m0s)
      --cache-chunk-no-memory                                    Disable the in-memory cache for storing chunks during streaming.
      --cache-chunk-path string                                  Directory to cache chunk files. (default "$HOME/.cache/rclone/cache-backend")
      --cache-chunk-size SizeSuffix                              The size of a chunk (partial file data). (default 5M)
      --cache-chunk-total-size SizeSuffix                        The total size that the chunks can take up on the local disk. (default 10G)
      --cache-db-path string                                     Directory to store file structure metadata DB. (default "$HOME/.cache/rclone/cache-backend")
      --cache-db-purge                                           Clear all the cached data for this remote on start.
      --cache-db-wait-time Duration                              How long to wait for the DB to be available - 0 is unlimited (default 1s)
      --cache-info-age Duration                                  How long to cache file structure information (directory listings, file size, times, etc.). (default 6h0m0s)
      --cache-plex-insecure string                               Skip all certificate verification when connecting to the Plex server
      --cache-plex-password string                               The password of the Plex user (obscured)
      --cache-plex-url string                                    The URL of the Plex server
      --cache-plex-username string                               The username of the Plex user
      --cache-read-retries int                                   How many times to retry a read from a cache storage. (default 10)
      --cache-remote string                                      Remote to cache.
      --cache-rps int                                            Limits the number of requests per second to the source FS (-1 to disable) (default -1)
      --cache-tmp-upload-path string                             Directory to keep temporary files until they are uploaded.
      --cache-tmp-wait-time Duration                             How long should files be stored in local cache before being uploaded (default 15s)
      --cache-workers int                                        How many workers should run in parallel to download chunks. (default 4)
      --cache-writes                                             Cache file data on writes through the FS
      --chunker-chunk-size SizeSuffix                            Files larger than chunk size will be split in chunks. (default 2G)
      --chunker-fail-hard                                        Choose how chunker should handle files with missing or invalid chunks.
      --chunker-hash-type string                                 Choose how chunker handles hash sums. All modes but "none" require metadata. (default "md5")
      --chunker-remote string                                    Remote to chunk/unchunk.
      --compress-level int                                       GZIP compression level (-2 to 9). (default -1)
      --compress-mode string                                     Compression mode. (default "gzip")
      --compress-ram-cache-limit SizeSuffix                      Some remotes don't allow the upload of files with unknown size. (default 20M)
      --compress-remote string                                   Remote to compress.
  -L, --copy-links                                               Follow symlinks and copy the pointed to item.
      --crypt-directory-name-encryption                          Option to either encrypt directory names or leave them intact. (default true)
      --crypt-filename-encryption string                         How to encrypt the filenames. (default "standard")
      --crypt-password string                                    Password or pass phrase for encryption. (obscured)
      --crypt-password2 string                                   Password or pass phrase for salt. Optional but recommended. (obscured)
      --crypt-remote string                                      Remote to encrypt/decrypt.
      --crypt-server-side-across-configs                         Allow server-side operations (e.g. copy) to work across different crypt configs.
      --crypt-show-mapping                                       For all files listed show how the names encrypt.
      --drive-acknowledge-abuse                                  Set to allow files which return cannotDownloadAbusiveFile to be downloaded.
      --drive-allow-import-name-change                           Allow the filetype to change when uploading Google docs (e.g. file.doc to file.docx). This will confuse sync and reupload every time.
      --drive-auth-owner-only                                    Only consider files owned by the authenticated user.
      --drive-auth-url string                                    Auth server URL.
      --drive-chunk-size SizeSuffix                              Upload chunk size. Must a power of 2 >= 256k. (default 8M)
      --drive-client-id string                                   Google Application Client Id
      --drive-client-secret string                               OAuth Client Secret
      --drive-disable-http2                                      Disable drive using http2 (default true)
      --drive-encoding MultiEncoder                              This sets the encoding for the backend. (default InvalidUtf8)
      --drive-export-formats string                              Comma separated list of preferred formats for downloading Google docs. (default "docx,xlsx,pptx,svg")
      --drive-formats string                                     Deprecated: see export_formats
      --drive-impersonate string                                 Impersonate this user when using a service account.
      --drive-import-formats string                              Comma separated list of preferred formats for uploading Google docs.
      --drive-keep-revision-forever                              Keep new head revision of each file forever.
      --drive-list-chunk int                                     Size of listing chunk 100-1000. 0 to disable. (default 1000)
      --drive-pacer-burst int                                    Number of API calls to allow without sleeping. (default 100)
      --drive-pacer-min-sleep Duration                           Minimum time to sleep between API calls. (default 100ms)
      --drive-root-folder-id string                              ID of the root folder
      --drive-scope string                                       Scope that rclone should use when requesting access from drive.
      --drive-server-side-across-configs                         Allow server-side operations (e.g. copy) to work across different drive configs.
      --drive-service-account-credentials string                 Service Account Credentials JSON blob
      --drive-service-account-file string                        Service Account Credentials JSON file path
      --drive-shared-with-me                                     Only show files that are shared with me.
      --drive-size-as-quota                                      Show sizes as storage quota usage, not actual size.
      --drive-skip-checksum-gphotos                              Skip MD5 checksum on Google photos and videos only.
      --drive-skip-gdocs                                         Skip google documents in all listings.
      --drive-skip-shortcuts                                     If set skip shortcut files
      --drive-starred-only                                       Only show files that are starred.
      --drive-stop-on-download-limit                             Make download limit errors be fatal
      --drive-stop-on-upload-limit                               Make upload limit errors be fatal
      --drive-team-drive string                                  ID of the Team Drive
      --drive-token string                                       OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.
      --drive-token-url string                                   Token server url.
      --drive-trashed-only                                       Only show files that are in the trash.
      --drive-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix                           Cutoff for switching to chunked upload (default 8M)
      --drive-use-created-date                                   Use file created date instead of modified date.,
      --drive-use-shared-date                                    Use date file was shared instead of modified date.
      --drive-use-trash                                          Send files to the trash instead of deleting permanently. (default true)
      --drive-v2-download-min-size SizeSuffix                    If Object's are greater, use drive v2 API to download. (default off)
      --dropbox-auth-url string                                  Auth server URL.
      --dropbox-chunk-size SizeSuffix                            Upload chunk size. (< 150M). (default 48M)
      --dropbox-client-id string                                 OAuth Client Id
      --dropbox-client-secret string                             OAuth Client Secret
      --dropbox-encoding MultiEncoder                            This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,RightSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --dropbox-impersonate string                               Impersonate this user when using a business account.
      --dropbox-shared-files                                     Instructs rclone to work on individual shared files.
      --dropbox-shared-folders                                   Instructs rclone to work on shared folders.
      --dropbox-token string                                     OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.
      --dropbox-token-url string                                 Token server url.
      --fichier-api-key string                                   Your API Key, get it from https://1fichier.com/console/params.pl
      --fichier-encoding MultiEncoder                            This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,SingleQuote,BackQuote,Dollar,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,LeftSpace,RightSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --fichier-shared-folder string                             If you want to download a shared folder, add this parameter
      --filefabric-encoding MultiEncoder                         This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --filefabric-permanent-token string                        Permanent Authentication Token
      --filefabric-root-folder-id string                         ID of the root folder
      --filefabric-token string                                  Session Token
      --filefabric-token-expiry string                           Token expiry time
      --filefabric-url string                                    URL of the Enterprise File Fabric to connect to
      --filefabric-version string                                Version read from the file fabric
      --ftp-concurrency int                                      Maximum number of FTP simultaneous connections, 0 for unlimited
      --ftp-disable-epsv                                         Disable using EPSV even if server advertises support
      --ftp-disable-mlsd                                         Disable using MLSD even if server advertises support
      --ftp-encoding MultiEncoder                                This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,Del,Ctl,RightSpace,Dot)
      --ftp-explicit-tls                                         Use Explicit FTPS (FTP over TLS)
      --ftp-host string                                          FTP host to connect to
      --ftp-no-check-certificate                                 Do not verify the TLS certificate of the server
      --ftp-pass string                                          FTP password (obscured)
      --ftp-port string                                          FTP port, leave blank to use default (21)
      --ftp-tls                                                  Use Implicit FTPS (FTP over TLS)
      --ftp-user string                                          FTP username, leave blank for current username, $USER
      --gcs-anonymous                                            Access public buckets and objects without credentials
      --gcs-auth-url string                                      Auth server URL.
      --gcs-bucket-acl string                                    Access Control List for new buckets.
      --gcs-bucket-policy-only                                   Access checks should use bucket-level IAM policies.
      --gcs-client-id string                                     OAuth Client Id
      --gcs-client-secret string                                 OAuth Client Secret
      --gcs-encoding MultiEncoder                                This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,CrLf,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --gcs-location string                                      Location for the newly created buckets.
      --gcs-object-acl string                                    Access Control List for new objects.
      --gcs-project-number string                                Project number.
      --gcs-service-account-file string                          Service Account Credentials JSON file path
      --gcs-storage-class string                                 The storage class to use when storing objects in Google Cloud Storage.
      --gcs-token string                                         OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.
      --gcs-token-url string                                     Token server url.
      --gphotos-auth-url string                                  Auth server URL.
      --gphotos-client-id string                                 OAuth Client Id
      --gphotos-client-secret string                             OAuth Client Secret
      --gphotos-include-archived                                 Also view and download archived media.
      --gphotos-read-only                                        Set to make the Google Photos backend read only.
      --gphotos-read-size                                        Set to read the size of media items.
      --gphotos-start-year int                                   Year limits the photos to be downloaded to those which are uploaded after the given year (default 2000)
      --gphotos-token string                                     OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.
      --gphotos-token-url string                                 Token server url.
      --hdfs-data-transfer-protection string                     Kerberos data transfer protection: authentication|integrity|privacy
      --hdfs-encoding MultiEncoder                               This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,Colon,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --hdfs-namenode string                                     hadoop name node and port
      --hdfs-service-principal-name string                       Kerberos service principal name for the namenode
      --hdfs-username string                                     hadoop user name
      --http-headers CommaSepList                                Set HTTP headers for all transactions
      --http-no-head                                             Don't use HEAD requests to find file sizes in dir listing
      --http-no-slash                                            Set this if the site doesn't end directories with /
      --http-url string                                          URL of http host to connect to
      --hubic-auth-url string                                    Auth server URL.
      --hubic-chunk-size SizeSuffix                              Above this size files will be chunked into a _segments container. (default 5G)
      --hubic-client-id string                                   OAuth Client Id
      --hubic-client-secret string                               OAuth Client Secret
      --hubic-encoding MultiEncoder                              This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,InvalidUtf8)
      --hubic-no-chunk                                           Don't chunk files during streaming upload.
      --hubic-token string                                       OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.
      --hubic-token-url string                                   Token server url.
      --jottacloud-encoding MultiEncoder                         This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --jottacloud-hard-delete                                   Delete files permanently rather than putting them into the trash.
      --jottacloud-md5-memory-limit SizeSuffix                   Files bigger than this will be cached on disk to calculate the MD5 if required. (default 10M)
      --jottacloud-trashed-only                                  Only show files that are in the trash.
      --jottacloud-upload-resume-limit SizeSuffix                Files bigger than this can be resumed if the upload fail's. (default 10M)
      --koofr-encoding MultiEncoder                              This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --koofr-endpoint string                                    The Koofr API endpoint to use (default "https://app.koofr.net")
      --koofr-mountid string                                     Mount ID of the mount to use. If omitted, the primary mount is used.
      --koofr-password string                                    Your Koofr password for rclone (generate one at https://app.koofr.net/app/admin/preferences/password) (obscured)
      --koofr-setmtime                                           Does the backend support setting modification time. Set this to false if you use a mount ID that points to a Dropbox or Amazon Drive backend. (default true)
      --koofr-user string                                        Your Koofr user name
  -l, --links                                                    Translate symlinks to/from regular files with a '.rclonelink' extension
      --local-case-insensitive                                   Force the filesystem to report itself as case insensitive
      --local-case-sensitive                                     Force the filesystem to report itself as case sensitive.
      --local-encoding MultiEncoder                              This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,Dot)
      --local-no-check-updated                                   Don't check to see if the files change during upload
      --local-no-set-modtime                                     Disable setting modtime
      --local-no-sparse                                          Disable sparse files for multi-thread downloads
      --local-no-unicode-normalization                           Don't apply unicode normalization to paths and filenames (Deprecated)
      --local-nounc string                                       Disable UNC (long path names) conversion on Windows
      --local-zero-size-links                                    Assume the Stat size of links is zero (and read them instead)
      --mailru-check-hash                                        What should copy do if file checksum is mismatched or invalid (default true)
      --mailru-encoding MultiEncoder                             This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --mailru-pass string                                       Password (obscured)
      --mailru-speedup-enable                                    Skip full upload if there is another file with same data hash. (default true)
      --mailru-speedup-file-patterns string                      Comma separated list of file name patterns eligible for speedup (put by hash). (default "*.mkv,*.avi,*.mp4,*.mp3,*.zip,*.gz,*.rar,*.pdf")
      --mailru-speedup-max-disk SizeSuffix                       This option allows you to disable speedup (put by hash) for large files (default 3G)
      --mailru-speedup-max-memory SizeSuffix                     Files larger than the size given below will always be hashed on disk. (default 32M)
      --mailru-user string                                       User name (usually email)
      --mega-debug                                               Output more debug from Mega.
      --mega-encoding MultiEncoder                               This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --mega-hard-delete                                         Delete files permanently rather than putting them into the trash.
      --mega-pass string                                         Password. (obscured)
      --mega-user string                                         User name
  -x, --one-file-system                                          Don't cross filesystem boundaries (unix/macOS only).
      --onedrive-auth-url string                                 Auth server URL.
      --onedrive-chunk-size SizeSuffix                           Chunk size to upload files with - must be multiple of 320k (327,680 bytes). (default 10M)
      --onedrive-client-id string                                OAuth Client Id
      --onedrive-client-secret string                            OAuth Client Secret
      --onedrive-drive-id string                                 The ID of the drive to use
      --onedrive-drive-type string                               The type of the drive ( personal | business | documentLibrary )
      --onedrive-encoding MultiEncoder                           This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,LeftSpace,LeftTilde,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --onedrive-expose-onenote-files                            Set to make OneNote files show up in directory listings.
      --onedrive-link-password string                            Set the password for links created by the link command.
      --onedrive-link-scope string                               Set the scope of the links created by the link command. (default "anonymous")
      --onedrive-link-type string                                Set the type of the links created by the link command. (default "view")
      --onedrive-no-versions                                     Remove all versions on modifying operations
      --onedrive-region string                                   Choose national cloud region for OneDrive. (default "global")
      --onedrive-server-side-across-configs                      Allow server-side operations (e.g. copy) to work across different onedrive configs.
      --onedrive-token string                                    OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.
      --onedrive-token-url string                                Token server url.
      --opendrive-chunk-size SizeSuffix                          Files will be uploaded in chunks this size. (default 10M)
      --opendrive-encoding MultiEncoder                          This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,LeftSpace,LeftCrLfHtVt,RightSpace,RightCrLfHtVt,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --opendrive-password string                                Password. (obscured)
      --opendrive-username string                                Username
      --pcloud-auth-url string                                   Auth server URL.
      --pcloud-client-id string                                  OAuth Client Id
      --pcloud-client-secret string                              OAuth Client Secret
      --pcloud-encoding MultiEncoder                             This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --pcloud-hostname string                                   Hostname to connect to. (default "api.pcloud.com")
      --pcloud-root-folder-id string                             Fill in for rclone to use a non root folder as its starting point. (default "d0")
      --pcloud-token string                                      OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.
      --pcloud-token-url string                                  Token server url.
      --premiumizeme-encoding MultiEncoder                       This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,DoubleQuote,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --putio-encoding MultiEncoder                              This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --qingstor-access-key-id string                            QingStor Access Key ID
      --qingstor-chunk-size SizeSuffix                           Chunk size to use for uploading. (default 4M)
      --qingstor-connection-retries int                          Number of connection retries. (default 3)
      --qingstor-encoding MultiEncoder                           This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,Ctl,InvalidUtf8)
      --qingstor-endpoint string                                 Enter an endpoint URL to connection QingStor API.
      --qingstor-env-auth                                        Get QingStor credentials from runtime. Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
      --qingstor-secret-access-key string                        QingStor Secret Access Key (password)
      --qingstor-upload-concurrency int                          Concurrency for multipart uploads. (default 1)
      --qingstor-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix                        Cutoff for switching to chunked upload (default 200M)
      --qingstor-zone string                                     Zone to connect to.
      --s3-access-key-id string                                  AWS Access Key ID.
      --s3-acl string                                            Canned ACL used when creating buckets and storing or copying objects.
      --s3-bucket-acl string                                     Canned ACL used when creating buckets.
      --s3-chunk-size SizeSuffix                                 Chunk size to use for uploading. (default 5M)
      --s3-copy-cutoff SizeSuffix                                Cutoff for switching to multipart copy (default 4.656G)
      --s3-disable-checksum                                      Don't store MD5 checksum with object metadata
      --s3-disable-http2                                         Disable usage of http2 for S3 backends
      --s3-encoding MultiEncoder                                 This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --s3-endpoint string                                       Endpoint for S3 API.
      --s3-env-auth                                              Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
      --s3-force-path-style                                      If true use path style access if false use virtual hosted style. (default true)
      --s3-leave-parts-on-error                                  If true avoid calling abort upload on a failure, leaving all successfully uploaded parts on S3 for manual recovery.
      --s3-list-chunk int                                        Size of listing chunk (response list for each ListObject S3 request). (default 1000)
      --s3-location-constraint string                            Location constraint - must be set to match the Region.
      --s3-max-upload-parts int                                  Maximum number of parts in a multipart upload. (default 10000)
      --s3-memory-pool-flush-time Duration                       How often internal memory buffer pools will be flushed. (default 1m0s)
      --s3-memory-pool-use-mmap                                  Whether to use mmap buffers in internal memory pool.
      --s3-no-check-bucket                                       If set, don't attempt to check the bucket exists or create it
      --s3-no-head                                               If set, don't HEAD uploaded objects to check integrity
      --s3-profile string                                        Profile to use in the shared credentials file
      --s3-provider string                                       Choose your S3 provider.
      --s3-region string                                         Region to connect to.
      --s3-requester-pays                                        Enables requester pays option when interacting with S3 bucket.
      --s3-secret-access-key string                              AWS Secret Access Key (password)
      --s3-server-side-encryption string                         The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3.
      --s3-session-token string                                  An AWS session token
      --s3-shared-credentials-file string                        Path to the shared credentials file
      --s3-sse-customer-algorithm string                         If using SSE-C, the server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3.
      --s3-sse-customer-key string                               If using SSE-C you must provide the secret encryption key used to encrypt/decrypt your data.
      --s3-sse-customer-key-md5 string                           If using SSE-C you may provide the secret encryption key MD5 checksum (optional).
      --s3-sse-kms-key-id string                                 If using KMS ID you must provide the ARN of Key.
      --s3-storage-class string                                  The storage class to use when storing new objects in S3.
      --s3-upload-concurrency int                                Concurrency for multipart uploads. (default 4)
      --s3-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix                              Cutoff for switching to chunked upload (default 200M)
      --s3-use-accelerate-endpoint                               If true use the AWS S3 accelerated endpoint.
      --s3-v2-auth                                               If true use v2 authentication.
      --seafile-2fa                                              Two-factor authentication ('true' if the account has 2FA enabled)
      --seafile-create-library                                   Should rclone create a library if it doesn't exist
      --seafile-encoding MultiEncoder                            This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,DoubleQuote,BackSlash,Ctl,InvalidUtf8)
      --seafile-library string                                   Name of the library. Leave blank to access all non-encrypted libraries.
      --seafile-library-key string                               Library password (for encrypted libraries only). Leave blank if you pass it through the command line. (obscured)
      --seafile-pass string                                      Password (obscured)
      --seafile-url string                                       URL of seafile host to connect to
      --seafile-user string                                      User name (usually email address)
      --sftp-ask-password                                        Allow asking for SFTP password when needed.
      --sftp-disable-hashcheck                                   Disable the execution of SSH commands to determine if remote file hashing is available.
      --sftp-host string                                         SSH host to connect to
      --sftp-key-file string                                     Path to PEM-encoded private key file, leave blank or set key-use-agent to use ssh-agent.
      --sftp-key-file-pass string                                The passphrase to decrypt the PEM-encoded private key file. (obscured)
      --sftp-key-pem string                                      Raw PEM-encoded private key, If specified, will override key_file parameter.
      --sftp-key-use-agent                                       When set forces the usage of the ssh-agent.
      --sftp-known-hosts-file string                             Optional path to known_hosts file.
      --sftp-md5sum-command string                               The command used to read md5 hashes. Leave blank for autodetect.
      --sftp-pass string                                         SSH password, leave blank to use ssh-agent. (obscured)
      --sftp-path-override string                                Override path used by SSH connection.
      --sftp-port string                                         SSH port, leave blank to use default (22)
      --sftp-pubkey-file string                                  Optional path to public key file.
      --sftp-server-command string                               Specifies the path or command to run a sftp server on the remote host.
      --sftp-set-modtime                                         Set the modified time on the remote if set. (default true)
      --sftp-sha1sum-command string                              The command used to read sha1 hashes. Leave blank for autodetect.
      --sftp-skip-links                                          Set to skip any symlinks and any other non regular files.
      --sftp-subsystem string                                    Specifies the SSH2 subsystem on the remote host. (default "sftp")
      --sftp-use-fstat                                           If set use fstat instead of stat
      --sftp-use-insecure-cipher                                 Enable the use of insecure ciphers and key exchange methods.
      --sftp-user string                                         SSH username, leave blank for current username, $USER
      --sharefile-chunk-size SizeSuffix                          Upload chunk size. Must a power of 2 >= 256k. (default 64M)
      --sharefile-encoding MultiEncoder                          This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,LeftSpace,LeftPeriod,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --sharefile-endpoint string                                Endpoint for API calls.
      --sharefile-root-folder-id string                          ID of the root folder
      --sharefile-upload-cutoff SizeSuffix                       Cutoff for switching to multipart upload. (default 128M)
      --skip-links                                               Don't warn about skipped symlinks.
      --sugarsync-access-key-id string                           Sugarsync Access Key ID.
      --sugarsync-app-id string                                  Sugarsync App ID.
      --sugarsync-authorization string                           Sugarsync authorization
      --sugarsync-authorization-expiry string                    Sugarsync authorization expiry
      --sugarsync-deleted-id string                              Sugarsync deleted folder id
      --sugarsync-encoding MultiEncoder                          This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --sugarsync-hard-delete                                    Permanently delete files if true
      --sugarsync-private-access-key string                      Sugarsync Private Access Key
      --sugarsync-refresh-token string                           Sugarsync refresh token
      --sugarsync-root-id string                                 Sugarsync root id
      --sugarsync-user string                                    Sugarsync user
      --swift-application-credential-id string                   Application Credential ID (OS_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_ID)
      --swift-application-credential-name string                 Application Credential Name (OS_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_NAME)
      --swift-application-credential-secret string               Application Credential Secret (OS_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_SECRET)
      --swift-auth string                                        Authentication URL for server (OS_AUTH_URL).
      --swift-auth-token string                                  Auth Token from alternate authentication - optional (OS_AUTH_TOKEN)
      --swift-auth-version int                                   AuthVersion - optional - set to (1,2,3) if your auth URL has no version (ST_AUTH_VERSION)
      --swift-chunk-size SizeSuffix                              Above this size files will be chunked into a _segments container. (default 5G)
      --swift-domain string                                      User domain - optional (v3 auth) (OS_USER_DOMAIN_NAME)
      --swift-encoding MultiEncoder                              This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,InvalidUtf8)
      --swift-endpoint-type string                               Endpoint type to choose from the service catalogue (OS_ENDPOINT_TYPE) (default "public")
      --swift-env-auth                                           Get swift credentials from environment variables in standard OpenStack form.
      --swift-key string                                         API key or password (OS_PASSWORD).
      --swift-leave-parts-on-error                               If true avoid calling abort upload on a failure. It should be set to true for resuming uploads across different sessions.
      --swift-no-chunk                                           Don't chunk files during streaming upload.
      --swift-region string                                      Region name - optional (OS_REGION_NAME)
      --swift-storage-policy string                              The storage policy to use when creating a new container
      --swift-storage-url string                                 Storage URL - optional (OS_STORAGE_URL)
      --swift-tenant string                                      Tenant name - optional for v1 auth, this or tenant_id required otherwise (OS_TENANT_NAME or OS_PROJECT_NAME)
      --swift-tenant-domain string                               Tenant domain - optional (v3 auth) (OS_PROJECT_DOMAIN_NAME)
      --swift-tenant-id string                                   Tenant ID - optional for v1 auth, this or tenant required otherwise (OS_TENANT_ID)
      --swift-user string                                        User name to log in (OS_USERNAME).
      --swift-user-id string                                     User ID to log in - optional - most swift systems use user and leave this blank (v3 auth) (OS_USER_ID).
      --tardigrade-access-grant string                           Access Grant.
      --tardigrade-api-key string                                API Key.
      --tardigrade-passphrase string                             Encryption Passphrase. To access existing objects enter passphrase used for uploading.
      --tardigrade-provider string                               Choose an authentication method. (default "existing")
      --tardigrade-satellite-address <nodeid>@<address>:<port>   Satellite Address. Custom satellite address should match the format: <nodeid>@<address>:<port>. (default "us-central-1.tardigrade.io")
      --union-action-policy string                               Policy to choose upstream on ACTION category. (default "epall")
      --union-cache-time int                                     Cache time of usage and free space (in seconds). This option is only useful when a path preserving policy is used. (default 120)
      --union-create-policy string                               Policy to choose upstream on CREATE category. (default "epmfs")
      --union-search-policy string                               Policy to choose upstream on SEARCH category. (default "ff")
      --union-upstreams string                                   List of space separated upstreams.
      --webdav-bearer-token string                               Bearer token instead of user/pass (e.g. a Macaroon)
      --webdav-bearer-token-command string                       Command to run to get a bearer token
      --webdav-pass string                                       Password. (obscured)
      --webdav-url string                                        URL of http host to connect to
      --webdav-user string                                       User name
      --webdav-vendor string                                     Name of the Webdav site/service/software you are using
      --yandex-auth-url string                                   Auth server URL.
      --yandex-client-id string                                  OAuth Client Id
      --yandex-client-secret string                              OAuth Client Secret
      --yandex-encoding MultiEncoder                             This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Slash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot)
      --yandex-token string                                      OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.
      --yandex-token-url string                                  Token server url.
      --zoho-encoding MultiEncoder                               This sets the encoding for the backend. (default Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8)
      --zoho-region string                                       Zoho region to connect to. You'll have to use the region you organization is registered in.

1Fichier

This is a backend for the 1fichier cloud
storage service. Note that a Premium subscription is required to use
the API.

Paths are specified as remote:path

Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

The initial setup for 1Fichier involves getting the API key from the website which you
need to do in your browser.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / 1Fichier
   \ "fichier"
[snip]
Storage> fichier
** See help for fichier backend at: https://rclone.org/fichier/ **

Your API Key, get it from https://1fichier.com/console/params.pl
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
api_key> example_key

Edit advanced config? (y/n)
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> 
Remote config
--------------------
[remote]
type = fichier
api_key = example_key
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

List directories in top level of your 1Fichier account

rclone lsd remote:

List all the files in your 1Fichier account

rclone ls remote:

To copy a local directory to a 1Fichier directory called backup

rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Modified time and hashes

1Fichier does not support modification times. It supports the Whirlpool hash algorithm.

Duplicated files

1Fichier can have two files with exactly the same name and path (unlike a
normal file system).

Duplicated files cause problems with the syncing and you will see
messages in the log about duplicates.

Restricted filename characters

In addition to the default restricted characters set
the following characters are also replaced:

Character Value Replacement
\ 0x5C
< 0x3C
> 0x3E
" 0x22
$ 0x24
` 0x60
' 0x27

File names can also not start or end with the following characters.
These only get replaced if they are the first or last character in the
name:

Character Value Replacement
SP 0x20

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to fichier (1Fichier).

--fichier-api-key

Your API Key, get it from https://1fichier.com/console/params.pl

  • Config: api_key
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FICHIER_API_KEY
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to fichier (1Fichier).

--fichier-shared-folder

If you want to download a shared folder, add this parameter

  • Config: shared_folder
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FICHIER_SHARED_FOLDER
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--fichier-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FICHIER_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,SingleQuote,BackQuote,Dollar,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,LeftSpace,RightSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

rclone about is not supported by the 1Fichier backend. Backends without
this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or
use policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union
remote.

See List of backends that do not support rclone about
See rclone about

Alias

The alias remote provides a new name for another remote.

Paths may be as deep as required or a local path,
e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory or /directory/subdirectory.

During the initial setup with rclone config you will specify the target
remote. The target remote can either be a local path or another remote.

Subfolders can be used in target remote. Assume an alias remote named backup
with the target mydrive:private/backup. Invoking rclone mkdir backup:desktop
is exactly the same as invoking rclone mkdir mydrive:private/backup/desktop.

There will be no special handling of paths containing .. segments.
Invoking rclone mkdir backup:../desktop is exactly the same as invoking
rclone mkdir mydrive:private/backup/../desktop.
The empty path is not allowed as a remote. To alias the current directory
use . instead.

Here is an example of how to make an alias called remote for local folder.
First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Alias for an existing remote
   \ "alias"
[snip]
Storage> alias
Remote or path to alias.
Can be "myremote:path/to/dir", "myremote:bucket", "myremote:" or "/local/path".
remote> /mnt/storage/backup
Remote config
--------------------
[remote]
remote = /mnt/storage/backup
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y
Current remotes:

Name                 Type
====                 ====
remote               alias

e) Edit existing remote
n) New remote
d) Delete remote
r) Rename remote
c) Copy remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
e/n/d/r/c/s/q> q

Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

List directories in top level in /mnt/storage/backup

rclone lsd remote:

List all the files in /mnt/storage/backup

rclone ls remote:

Copy another local directory to the alias directory called source

rclone copy /home/source remote:source

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to alias (Alias for an existing remote).

--alias-remote

Remote or path to alias.
Can be "myremote:path/to/dir", "myremote:bucket", "myremote:" or "/local/path".

  • Config: remote
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ALIAS_REMOTE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

Amazon Drive

Amazon Drive, formerly known as Amazon Cloud Drive, is a cloud storage
service run by Amazon for consumers.

Status

Important: rclone supports Amazon Drive only if you have your own
set of API keys. Unfortunately the Amazon Drive developer
program
is now closed to
new entries so if you don't already have your own set of keys you will
not be able to use rclone with Amazon Drive.

For the history on why rclone no longer has a set of Amazon Drive API
keys see the forum.

If you happen to know anyone who works at Amazon then please ask them
to re-instate rclone into the Amazon Drive developer program - thanks!

Setup

The initial setup for Amazon Drive involves getting a token from
Amazon which you need to do in your browser. rclone config walks
you through it.

The configuration process for Amazon Drive may involve using an oauth
proxy
. This is used to keep the
Amazon credentials out of the source code. The proxy runs in Google's
very secure App Engine environment and doesn't store any credentials
which pass through it.

Since rclone doesn't currently have its own Amazon Drive credentials
so you will either need to have your own client_id and
client_secret with Amazon Drive, or use a third party oauth proxy
in which case you will need to enter client_id, client_secret,
auth_url and token_url.

Note also if you are not using Amazon's auth_url and token_url,
(ie you filled in something for those) then if setting up on a remote
machine you can only use the copying the config method of
configuration

  • rclone authorize will not work.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
r) Rename remote
c) Copy remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/r/c/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Amazon Drive
   \ "amazon cloud drive"
[snip]
Storage> amazon cloud drive
Amazon Application Client Id - required.
client_id> your client ID goes here
Amazon Application Client Secret - required.
client_secret> your client secret goes here
Auth server URL - leave blank to use Amazon's.
auth_url> Optional auth URL
Token server url - leave blank to use Amazon's.
token_url> Optional token URL
Remote config
Make sure your Redirect URL is set to "http://127.0.0.1:53682/" in your custom config.
Use auto config?
 * Say Y if not sure
 * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> y
If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
Log in and authorize rclone for access
Waiting for code...
Got code
--------------------
[remote]
client_id = your client ID goes here
client_secret = your client secret goes here
auth_url = Optional auth URL
token_url = Optional token URL
token = {"access_token":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","token_type":"bearer","refresh_token":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","expiry":"2015-09-06T16:07:39.658438471+01:00"}
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

See the remote setup docs for how to set it up on a
machine with no Internet browser available.

Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the
token as returned from Amazon. This only runs from the moment it
opens your browser to the moment you get back the verification
code. This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require
you to unblock it temporarily if you are running a host firewall.

Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

List directories in top level of your Amazon Drive

rclone lsd remote:

List all the files in your Amazon Drive

rclone ls remote:

To copy a local directory to an Amazon Drive directory called backup

rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Modified time and MD5SUMs

Amazon Drive doesn't allow modification times to be changed via
the API so these won't be accurate or used for syncing.

It does store MD5SUMs so for a more accurate sync, you can use the
--checksum flag.

Restricted filename characters

Character Value Replacement
NUL 0x00
/ 0x2F

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Deleting files

Any files you delete with rclone will end up in the trash. Amazon
don't provide an API to permanently delete files, nor to empty the
trash, so you will have to do that with one of Amazon's apps or via
the Amazon Drive website. As of November 17, 2016, files are
automatically deleted by Amazon from the trash after 30 days.

Using with non .com Amazon accounts

Let's say you usually use amazon.co.uk. When you authenticate with
rclone it will take you to an amazon.com page to log in. Your
amazon.co.uk email and password should work here just fine.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to amazon cloud drive (Amazon Drive).

--acd-client-id

OAuth Client Id
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: client_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_CLIENT_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--acd-client-secret

OAuth Client Secret
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: client_secret
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_CLIENT_SECRET
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to amazon cloud drive (Amazon Drive).

--acd-token

OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

  • Config: token
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_TOKEN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--acd-auth-url

Auth server URL.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: auth_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_AUTH_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--acd-token-url

Token server url.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: token_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_TOKEN_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--acd-checkpoint

Checkpoint for internal polling (debug).

  • Config: checkpoint
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_CHECKPOINT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--acd-upload-wait-per-gb

Additional time per GB to wait after a failed complete upload to see if it appears.

Sometimes Amazon Drive gives an error when a file has been fully
uploaded but the file appears anyway after a little while. This
happens sometimes for files over 1GB in size and nearly every time for
files bigger than 10GB. This parameter controls the time rclone waits
for the file to appear.

The default value for this parameter is 3 minutes per GB, so by
default it will wait 3 minutes for every GB uploaded to see if the
file appears.

You can disable this feature by setting it to 0. This may cause
conflict errors as rclone retries the failed upload but the file will
most likely appear correctly eventually.

These values were determined empirically by observing lots of uploads
of big files for a range of file sizes.

Upload with the "-v" flag to see more info about what rclone is doing
in this situation.

  • Config: upload_wait_per_gb
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_UPLOAD_WAIT_PER_GB
  • Type: Duration
  • Default: 3m0s

Files >= this size will be downloaded via their tempLink.

Files this size or more will be downloaded via their "tempLink". This
is to work around a problem with Amazon Drive which blocks downloads
of files bigger than about 10GB. The default for this is 9GB which
shouldn't need to be changed.

To download files above this threshold, rclone requests a "tempLink"
which downloads the file through a temporary URL directly from the
underlying S3 storage.

  • Config: templink_threshold
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_TEMPLINK_THRESHOLD
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 9G

--acd-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ACD_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

Note that Amazon Drive is case insensitive so you can't have a
file called "Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

Amazon Drive has rate limiting so you may notice errors in the
sync (429 errors). rclone will automatically retry the sync up to 3
times by default (see --retries flag) which should hopefully work
around this problem.

Amazon Drive has an internal limit of file sizes that can be uploaded
to the service. This limit is not officially published, but all files
larger than this will fail.

At the time of writing (Jan 2016) is in the area of 50GB per file.
This means that larger files are likely to fail.

Unfortunately there is no way for rclone to see that this failure is
because of file size, so it will retry the operation, as any other
failure. To avoid this problem, use --max-size 50000M option to limit
the maximum size of uploaded files. Note that --max-size does not split
files into segments, it only ignores files over this size.

rclone about is not supported by the Amazon Drive backend. Backends without
this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or
use policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union
remote.

See List of backends that do not support rclone about
See rclone about

Amazon S3 Storage Providers

The S3 backend can be used with a number of different providers:

  • AWS S3
  • Alibaba Cloud (Aliyun) Object Storage System (OSS)
  • Ceph
  • DigitalOcean Spaces
  • Dreamhost
  • IBM COS S3
  • Minio
  • Scaleway
  • StackPath
  • Tencent Cloud Object Storage (COS)
  • Wasabi

Paths are specified as remote:bucket (or remote: for the lsd
command.) You may put subdirectories in too, e.g. remote:bucket/path/to/dir.

Once you have made a remote (see the provider specific section above)
you can use it like this:

See all buckets

rclone lsd remote:

Make a new bucket

rclone mkdir remote:bucket

List the contents of a bucket

rclone ls remote:bucket

Sync /home/local/directory to the remote bucket, deleting any excess
files in the bucket.

rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:bucket

AWS S3

Here is an example of making an s3 configuration. First run

rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Ceph, Dreamhost, IBM COS, Minio, and Tencent COS
   \ "s3"
[snip]
Storage> s3
Choose your S3 provider.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Amazon Web Services (AWS) S3
   \ "AWS"
 2 / Ceph Object Storage
   \ "Ceph"
 3 / Digital Ocean Spaces
   \ "DigitalOcean"
 4 / Dreamhost DreamObjects
   \ "Dreamhost"
 5 / IBM COS S3
   \ "IBMCOS"
 6 / Minio Object Storage
   \ "Minio"
 7 / Wasabi Object Storage
   \ "Wasabi"
 8 / Any other S3 compatible provider
   \ "Other"
provider> 1
Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars). Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step
   \ "false"
 2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
   \ "true"
env_auth> 1
AWS Access Key ID - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
access_key_id> XXX
AWS Secret Access Key (password) - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
secret_access_key> YYY
Region to connect to.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
   / The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.
 1 | US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest.
   | Leave location constraint empty.
   \ "us-east-1"
   / US East (Ohio) Region
 2 | Needs location constraint us-east-2.
   \ "us-east-2"
   / US West (Oregon) Region
 3 | Needs location constraint us-west-2.
   \ "us-west-2"
   / US West (Northern California) Region
 4 | Needs location constraint us-west-1.
   \ "us-west-1"
   / Canada (Central) Region
 5 | Needs location constraint ca-central-1.
   \ "ca-central-1"
   / EU (Ireland) Region
 6 | Needs location constraint EU or eu-west-1.
   \ "eu-west-1"
   / EU (London) Region
 7 | Needs location constraint eu-west-2.
   \ "eu-west-2"
   / EU (Frankfurt) Region
 8 | Needs location constraint eu-central-1.
   \ "eu-central-1"
   / Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region
 9 | Needs location constraint ap-southeast-1.
   \ "ap-southeast-1"
   / Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region
10 | Needs location constraint ap-southeast-2.
   \ "ap-southeast-2"
   / Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region
11 | Needs location constraint ap-northeast-1.
   \ "ap-northeast-1"
   / Asia Pacific (Seoul)
12 | Needs location constraint ap-northeast-2.
   \ "ap-northeast-2"
   / Asia Pacific (Mumbai)
13 | Needs location constraint ap-south-1.
   \ "ap-south-1"
   / Asia Pacific (Hong Kong) Region
14 | Needs location constraint ap-east-1.
   \ "ap-east-1"
   / South America (Sao Paulo) Region
15 | Needs location constraint sa-east-1.
   \ "sa-east-1"
region> 1
Endpoint for S3 API.
Leave blank if using AWS to use the default endpoint for the region.
endpoint> 
Location constraint - must be set to match the Region. Used when creating buckets only.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Empty for US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest.
   \ ""
 2 / US East (Ohio) Region.
   \ "us-east-2"
 3 / US West (Oregon) Region.
   \ "us-west-2"
 4 / US West (Northern California) Region.
   \ "us-west-1"
 5 / Canada (Central) Region.
   \ "ca-central-1"
 6 / EU (Ireland) Region.
   \ "eu-west-1"
 7 / EU (London) Region.
   \ "eu-west-2"
 8 / EU Region.
   \ "EU"
 9 / Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region.
   \ "ap-southeast-1"
10 / Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region.
   \ "ap-southeast-2"
11 / Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region.
   \ "ap-northeast-1"
12 / Asia Pacific (Seoul)
   \ "ap-northeast-2"
13 / Asia Pacific (Mumbai)
   \ "ap-south-1"
14 / Asia Pacific (Hong Kong)
   \ "ap-east-1"
15 / South America (Sao Paulo) Region.
   \ "sa-east-1"
location_constraint> 1
Canned ACL used when creating buckets and/or storing objects in S3.
For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default).
   \ "private"
 2 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ access.
   \ "public-read"
   / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access.
 3 | Granting this on a bucket is generally not recommended.
   \ "public-read-write"
 4 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AuthenticatedUsers group gets READ access.
   \ "authenticated-read"
   / Object owner gets FULL_CONTROL. Bucket owner gets READ access.
 5 | If you specify this canned ACL when creating a bucket, Amazon S3 ignores it.
   \ "bucket-owner-read"
   / Both the object owner and the bucket owner get FULL_CONTROL over the object.
 6 | If you specify this canned ACL when creating a bucket, Amazon S3 ignores it.
   \ "bucket-owner-full-control"
acl> 1
The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / None
   \ ""
 2 / AES256
   \ "AES256"
server_side_encryption> 1
The storage class to use when storing objects in S3.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Default
   \ ""
 2 / Standard storage class
   \ "STANDARD"
 3 / Reduced redundancy storage class
   \ "REDUCED_REDUNDANCY"
 4 / Standard Infrequent Access storage class
   \ "STANDARD_IA"
 5 / One Zone Infrequent Access storage class
   \ "ONEZONE_IA"
 6 / Glacier storage class
   \ "GLACIER"
 7 / Glacier Deep Archive storage class
   \ "DEEP_ARCHIVE"
 8 / Intelligent-Tiering storage class
   \ "INTELLIGENT_TIERING"
storage_class> 1
Remote config
--------------------
[remote]
type = s3
provider = AWS
env_auth = false
access_key_id = XXX
secret_access_key = YYY
region = us-east-1
endpoint = 
location_constraint = 
acl = private
server_side_encryption = 
storage_class = 
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> 

Modified time

The modified time is stored as metadata on the object as
X-Amz-Meta-Mtime as floating point since the epoch accurate to 1 ns.

If the modification time needs to be updated rclone will attempt to perform a server
side copy to update the modification if the object can be copied in a single part.
In the case the object is larger than 5Gb or is in Glacier or Glacier Deep Archive
storage the object will be uploaded rather than copied.

Note that reading this from the object takes an additional HEAD
request as the metadata isn't returned in object listings.

Reducing costs

Avoiding HEAD requests to read the modification time

By default rclone will use the modification time of objects stored in
S3 for syncing. This is stored in object metadata which unfortunately
takes an extra HEAD request to read which can be expensive (in time
and money).

The modification time is used by default for all operations that
require checking the time a file was last updated. It allows rclone to
treat the remote more like a true filesystem, but it is inefficient on
S3 because it requires an extra API call to retrieve the metadata.

The extra API calls can be avoided when syncing (using rclone sync
or rclone copy) in a few different ways, each with its own
tradeoffs.

  • --size-only
    • Only checks the size of files.
    • Uses no extra transactions.
    • If the file doesn't change size then rclone won't detect it has
      changed.
    • rclone sync --size-only /path/to/source s3:bucket
  • --checksum
    • Checks the size and MD5 checksum of files.
    • Uses no extra transactions.
    • The most accurate detection of changes possible.
    • Will cause the source to read an MD5 checksum which, if it is a
      local disk, will cause lots of disk activity.
    • If the source and destination are both S3 this is the
      recommended flag to use for maximum efficiency.
    • rclone sync --checksum /path/to/source s3:bucket
  • --update --use-server-modtime
    • Uses no extra transactions.
    • Modification time becomes the time the object was uploaded.
    • For many operations this is sufficient to determine if it needs
      uploading.
    • Using --update along with --use-server-modtime, avoids the
      extra API call and uploads files whose local modification time
      is newer than the time it was last uploaded.
    • Files created with timestamps in the past will be missed by the sync.
    • rclone sync --update --use-server-modtime /path/to/source s3:bucket

These flags can and should be used in combination with --fast-list -
see below.

If using rclone mount or any command using the VFS (eg rclone serve) commands then you might want to consider using the VFS flag
--no-modtime which will stop rclone reading the modification time
for every object. You could also use --use-server-modtime if you are
happy with the modification times of the objects being the time of
upload.

Avoiding GET requests to read directory listings

Rclone's default directory traversal is to process each directory
individually. This takes one API call per directory. Using the
--fast-list flag will read all info about the the objects into
memory first using a smaller number of API calls (one per 1000
objects). See the rclone docs for more details.

rclone sync --fast-list --checksum /path/to/source s3:bucket

--fast-list trades off API transactions for memory use. As a rough
guide rclone uses 1k of memory per object stored, so using
--fast-list on a sync of a million objects will use roughly 1 GB of
RAM.

If you are only copying a small number of files into a big repository
then using --no-traverse is a good idea. This finds objects directly
instead of through directory listings. You can do a "top-up" sync very
cheaply by using --max-age and --no-traverse to copy only recent
files, eg

rclone copy --min-age 24h --no-traverse /path/to/source s3:bucket

You'd then do a full rclone sync less often.

Note that --fast-list isn't required in the top-up sync.

Hashes

For small objects which weren't uploaded as multipart uploads (objects
sized below --s3-upload-cutoff if uploaded with rclone) rclone uses
the ETag: header as an MD5 checksum.

However for objects which were uploaded as multipart uploads or with
server side encryption (SSE-AWS or SSE-C) the ETag header is no
longer the MD5 sum of the data, so rclone adds an additional piece of
metadata X-Amz-Meta-Md5chksum which is a base64 encoded MD5 hash (in
the same format as is required for Content-MD5).

For large objects, calculating this hash can take some time so the
addition of this hash can be disabled with --s3-disable-checksum.
This will mean that these objects do not have an MD5 checksum.

Note that reading this from the object takes an additional HEAD
request as the metadata isn't returned in object listings.

Cleanup

If you run rclone cleanup s3:bucket then it will remove all pending
multipart uploads older than 24 hours. You can use the -i flag to
see exactly what it will do. If you want more control over the expiry
date then run rclone backend cleanup s3:bucket -o max-age=1h to
expire all uploads older than one hour. You can use rclone backend list-multipart-uploads s3:bucket to see the pending multipart
uploads.

Restricted filename characters

S3 allows any valid UTF-8 string as a key.

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will be replaced, as
they can't be used in XML.

The following characters are replaced since these are problematic when
dealing with the REST API:

Character Value Replacement
NUL 0x00
/ 0x2F

The encoding will also encode these file names as they don't seem to
work with the SDK properly:

File name Replacement
.
..

Multipart uploads

rclone supports multipart uploads with S3 which means that it can
upload files bigger than 5GB.

Note that files uploaded both with multipart upload and through
crypt remotes do not have MD5 sums.

rclone switches from single part uploads to multipart uploads at the
point specified by --s3-upload-cutoff. This can be a maximum of 5GB
and a minimum of 0 (ie always upload multipart files).

The chunk sizes used in the multipart upload are specified by
--s3-chunk-size and the number of chunks uploaded concurrently is
specified by --s3-upload-concurrency.

Multipart uploads will use --transfers * --s3-upload-concurrency *
--s3-chunk-size extra memory. Single part uploads to not use extra
memory.

Single part transfers can be faster than multipart transfers or slower
depending on your latency from S3 - the more latency, the more likely
single part transfers will be faster.

Increasing --s3-upload-concurrency will increase throughput (8 would
be a sensible value) and increasing --s3-chunk-size also increases
throughput (16M would be sensible). Increasing either of these will
use more memory. The default values are high enough to gain most of
the possible performance without using too much memory.

Buckets and Regions

With Amazon S3 you can list buckets (rclone lsd) using any region,
but you can only access the content of a bucket from the region it was
created in. If you attempt to access a bucket from the wrong region,
you will get an error, incorrect region, the bucket is not in 'XXX' region.

Authentication

There are a number of ways to supply rclone with a set of AWS
credentials, with and without using the environment.

The different authentication methods are tried in this order:

  • Directly in the rclone configuration file (env_auth = false in the config file):
    • access_key_id and secret_access_key are required.
    • session_token can be optionally set when using AWS STS.
  • Runtime configuration (env_auth = true in the config file):
    • Export the following environment variables before running rclone:
      • Access Key ID: AWS_ACCESS_KEY_ID or AWS_ACCESS_KEY
      • Secret Access Key: AWS_SECRET_ACCESS_KEY or AWS_SECRET_KEY
      • Session Token: AWS_SESSION_TOKEN (optional)
    • Or, use a named profile:
      • Profile files are standard files used by AWS CLI tools
      • By default it will use the profile in your home directory (e.g. ~/.aws/credentials on unix based systems) file and the "default" profile, to change set these environment variables:
        • AWS_SHARED_CREDENTIALS_FILE to control which file.
        • AWS_PROFILE to control which profile to use.
    • Or, run rclone in an ECS task with an IAM role (AWS only).
    • Or, run rclone on an EC2 instance with an IAM role (AWS only).
    • Or, run rclone in an EKS pod with an IAM role that is associated with a service account (AWS only).

If none of these option actually end up providing rclone with AWS
credentials then S3 interaction will be non-authenticated (see below).

S3 Permissions

When using the sync subcommand of rclone the following minimum
permissions are required to be available on the bucket being written to:

  • ListBucket
  • DeleteObject
  • GetObject
  • PutObject
  • PutObjectACL

When using the lsd subcommand, the ListAllMyBuckets permission is required.

Example policy:

{
    "Version": "2012-10-17",
    "Statement": [
        {
            "Effect": "Allow",
            "Principal": {
                "AWS": "arn:aws:iam::USER_SID:user/USER_NAME"
            },
            "Action": [
                "s3:ListBucket",
                "s3:DeleteObject",
                "s3:GetObject",
                "s3:PutObject",
                "s3:PutObjectAcl"
            ],
            "Resource": [
              "arn:aws:s3:::BUCKET_NAME/*",
              "arn:aws:s3:::BUCKET_NAME"
            ]
        },
        {
            "Effect": "Allow",
            "Action": "s3:ListAllMyBuckets",
            "Resource": "arn:aws:s3:::*"
        }	
    ]
}

Notes on above:

  1. This is a policy that can be used when creating bucket. It assumes
    that USER_NAME has been created.
  2. The Resource entry must include both resource ARNs, as one implies
    the bucket and the other implies the bucket's objects.

For reference, here's an Ansible script
that will generate one or more buckets that will work with rclone sync.

Key Management System (KMS)

If you are using server-side encryption with KMS then you must make
sure rclone is configured with server_side_encryption = aws:kms
otherwise you will find you can't transfer small objects - these will
create checksum errors.

Glacier and Glacier Deep Archive

You can upload objects using the glacier storage class or transition them to glacier using a lifecycle policy.
The bucket can still be synced or copied into normally, but if rclone
tries to access data from the glacier storage class you will see an error like below.

2017/09/11 19:07:43 Failed to sync: failed to open source object: Object in GLACIER, restore first: path/to/file

In this case you need to restore
the object(s) in question before using rclone.

Note that rclone only speaks the S3 API it does not speak the Glacier
Vault API, so rclone cannot directly access Glacier Vaults.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to s3 (Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, Digital Ocean, Dreamhost, IBM COS, Minio, and Tencent COS).

--s3-provider

Choose your S3 provider.

  • Config: provider
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_PROVIDER
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "AWS"
      • Amazon Web Services (AWS) S3
    • "Alibaba"
      • Alibaba Cloud Object Storage System (OSS) formerly Aliyun
    • "Ceph"
      • Ceph Object Storage
    • "DigitalOcean"
      • Digital Ocean Spaces
    • "Dreamhost"
      • Dreamhost DreamObjects
    • "IBMCOS"
      • IBM COS S3
    • "Minio"
      • Minio Object Storage
    • "Netease"
      • Netease Object Storage (NOS)
    • "Scaleway"
      • Scaleway Object Storage
    • "StackPath"
      • StackPath Object Storage
    • "TencentCOS"
      • Tencent Cloud Object Storage (COS)
    • "Wasabi"
      • Wasabi Object Storage
    • "Other"
      • Any other S3 compatible provider

--s3-env-auth

Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.

  • Config: env_auth
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENV_AUTH
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false
  • Examples:
    • "false"
      • Enter AWS credentials in the next step
    • "true"
      • Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)

--s3-access-key-id

AWS Access Key ID.
Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.

  • Config: access_key_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ACCESS_KEY_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--s3-secret-access-key

AWS Secret Access Key (password)
Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.

  • Config: secret_access_key
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SECRET_ACCESS_KEY
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--s3-region

Region to connect to.

  • Config: region
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REGION
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "us-east-1"
      • The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.
      • US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest.
      • Leave location constraint empty.
    • "us-east-2"
      • US East (Ohio) Region
      • Needs location constraint us-east-2.
    • "us-west-1"
      • US West (Northern California) Region
      • Needs location constraint us-west-1.
    • "us-west-2"
      • US West (Oregon) Region
      • Needs location constraint us-west-2.
    • "ca-central-1"
      • Canada (Central) Region
      • Needs location constraint ca-central-1.
    • "eu-west-1"
      • EU (Ireland) Region
      • Needs location constraint EU or eu-west-1.
    • "eu-west-2"
      • EU (London) Region
      • Needs location constraint eu-west-2.
    • "eu-west-3"
      • EU (Paris) Region
      • Needs location constraint eu-west-3.
    • "eu-north-1"
      • EU (Stockholm) Region
      • Needs location constraint eu-north-1.
    • "eu-south-1"
      • EU (Milan) Region
      • Needs location constraint eu-south-1.
    • "eu-central-1"
      • EU (Frankfurt) Region
      • Needs location constraint eu-central-1.
    • "ap-southeast-1"
      • Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region
      • Needs location constraint ap-southeast-1.
    • "ap-southeast-2"
      • Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region
      • Needs location constraint ap-southeast-2.
    • "ap-northeast-1"
      • Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region
      • Needs location constraint ap-northeast-1.
    • "ap-northeast-2"
      • Asia Pacific (Seoul)
      • Needs location constraint ap-northeast-2.
    • "ap-northeast-3"
      • Asia Pacific (Osaka-Local)
      • Needs location constraint ap-northeast-3.
    • "ap-south-1"
      • Asia Pacific (Mumbai)
      • Needs location constraint ap-south-1.
    • "ap-east-1"
      • Asia Pacific (Hong Kong) Region
      • Needs location constraint ap-east-1.
    • "sa-east-1"
      • South America (Sao Paulo) Region
      • Needs location constraint sa-east-1.
    • "me-south-1"
      • Middle East (Bahrain) Region
      • Needs location constraint me-south-1.
    • "af-south-1"
      • Africa (Cape Town) Region
      • Needs location constraint af-south-1.
    • "cn-north-1"
      • China (Beijing) Region
      • Needs location constraint cn-north-1.
    • "cn-northwest-1"
      • China (Ningxia) Region
      • Needs location constraint cn-northwest-1.
    • "us-gov-east-1"
      • AWS GovCloud (US-East) Region
      • Needs location constraint us-gov-east-1.
    • "us-gov-west-1"
      • AWS GovCloud (US) Region
      • Needs location constraint us-gov-west-1.

--s3-region

Region to connect to.

  • Config: region
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REGION
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "nl-ams"
      • Amsterdam, The Netherlands
    • "fr-par"
      • Paris, France

--s3-region

Region to connect to.
Leave blank if you are using an S3 clone and you don't have a region.

  • Config: region
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REGION
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • ""
      • Use this if unsure. Will use v4 signatures and an empty region.
    • "other-v2-signature"
      • Use this only if v4 signatures don't work, e.g. pre Jewel/v10 CEPH.

--s3-endpoint

Endpoint for S3 API.
Leave blank if using AWS to use the default endpoint for the region.

  • Config: endpoint
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--s3-endpoint

Endpoint for IBM COS S3 API.
Specify if using an IBM COS On Premise.

  • Config: endpoint
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "s3.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • US Cross Region Endpoint
    • "s3.dal.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • US Cross Region Dallas Endpoint
    • "s3.wdc.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • US Cross Region Washington DC Endpoint
    • "s3.sjc.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • US Cross Region San Jose Endpoint
    • "s3.private.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • US Cross Region Private Endpoint
    • "s3.private.dal.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • US Cross Region Dallas Private Endpoint
    • "s3.private.wdc.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • US Cross Region Washington DC Private Endpoint
    • "s3.private.sjc.us.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • US Cross Region San Jose Private Endpoint
    • "s3.us-east.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • US Region East Endpoint
    • "s3.private.us-east.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • US Region East Private Endpoint
    • "s3.us-south.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • US Region South Endpoint
    • "s3.private.us-south.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • US Region South Private Endpoint
    • "s3.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • EU Cross Region Endpoint
    • "s3.fra.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • EU Cross Region Frankfurt Endpoint
    • "s3.mil.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • EU Cross Region Milan Endpoint
    • "s3.ams.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • EU Cross Region Amsterdam Endpoint
    • "s3.private.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • EU Cross Region Private Endpoint
    • "s3.private.fra.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • EU Cross Region Frankfurt Private Endpoint
    • "s3.private.mil.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • EU Cross Region Milan Private Endpoint
    • "s3.private.ams.eu.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • EU Cross Region Amsterdam Private Endpoint
    • "s3.eu-gb.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Great Britain Endpoint
    • "s3.private.eu-gb.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Great Britain Private Endpoint
    • "s3.eu-de.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • EU Region DE Endpoint
    • "s3.private.eu-de.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • EU Region DE Private Endpoint
    • "s3.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • APAC Cross Regional Endpoint
    • "s3.tok.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • APAC Cross Regional Tokyo Endpoint
    • "s3.hkg.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • APAC Cross Regional HongKong Endpoint
    • "s3.seo.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • APAC Cross Regional Seoul Endpoint
    • "s3.private.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • APAC Cross Regional Private Endpoint
    • "s3.private.tok.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • APAC Cross Regional Tokyo Private Endpoint
    • "s3.private.hkg.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • APAC Cross Regional HongKong Private Endpoint
    • "s3.private.seo.ap.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • APAC Cross Regional Seoul Private Endpoint
    • "s3.jp-tok.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • APAC Region Japan Endpoint
    • "s3.private.jp-tok.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • APAC Region Japan Private Endpoint
    • "s3.au-syd.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • APAC Region Australia Endpoint
    • "s3.private.au-syd.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • APAC Region Australia Private Endpoint
    • "s3.ams03.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Amsterdam Single Site Endpoint
    • "s3.private.ams03.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Amsterdam Single Site Private Endpoint
    • "s3.che01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Chennai Single Site Endpoint
    • "s3.private.che01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Chennai Single Site Private Endpoint
    • "s3.mel01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Melbourne Single Site Endpoint
    • "s3.private.mel01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Melbourne Single Site Private Endpoint
    • "s3.osl01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Oslo Single Site Endpoint
    • "s3.private.osl01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Oslo Single Site Private Endpoint
    • "s3.tor01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Toronto Single Site Endpoint
    • "s3.private.tor01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Toronto Single Site Private Endpoint
    • "s3.seo01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Seoul Single Site Endpoint
    • "s3.private.seo01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Seoul Single Site Private Endpoint
    • "s3.mon01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Montreal Single Site Endpoint
    • "s3.private.mon01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Montreal Single Site Private Endpoint
    • "s3.mex01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Mexico Single Site Endpoint
    • "s3.private.mex01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Mexico Single Site Private Endpoint
    • "s3.sjc04.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • San Jose Single Site Endpoint
    • "s3.private.sjc04.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • San Jose Single Site Private Endpoint
    • "s3.mil01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Milan Single Site Endpoint
    • "s3.private.mil01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Milan Single Site Private Endpoint
    • "s3.hkg02.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Hong Kong Single Site Endpoint
    • "s3.private.hkg02.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Hong Kong Single Site Private Endpoint
    • "s3.par01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Paris Single Site Endpoint
    • "s3.private.par01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Paris Single Site Private Endpoint
    • "s3.sng01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Singapore Single Site Endpoint
    • "s3.private.sng01.cloud-object-storage.appdomain.cloud"
      • Singapore Single Site Private Endpoint

--s3-endpoint

Endpoint for OSS API.

  • Config: endpoint
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "oss-cn-hangzhou.aliyuncs.com"
      • East China 1 (Hangzhou)
    • "oss-cn-shanghai.aliyuncs.com"
      • East China 2 (Shanghai)
    • "oss-cn-qingdao.aliyuncs.com"
      • North China 1 (Qingdao)
    • "oss-cn-beijing.aliyuncs.com"
      • North China 2 (Beijing)
    • "oss-cn-zhangjiakou.aliyuncs.com"
      • North China 3 (Zhangjiakou)
    • "oss-cn-huhehaote.aliyuncs.com"
      • North China 5 (Huhehaote)
    • "oss-cn-shenzhen.aliyuncs.com"
      • South China 1 (Shenzhen)
    • "oss-cn-hongkong.aliyuncs.com"
      • Hong Kong (Hong Kong)
    • "oss-us-west-1.aliyuncs.com"
      • US West 1 (Silicon Valley)
    • "oss-us-east-1.aliyuncs.com"
      • US East 1 (Virginia)
    • "oss-ap-southeast-1.aliyuncs.com"
      • Southeast Asia Southeast 1 (Singapore)
    • "oss-ap-southeast-2.aliyuncs.com"
      • Asia Pacific Southeast 2 (Sydney)
    • "oss-ap-southeast-3.aliyuncs.com"
      • Southeast Asia Southeast 3 (Kuala Lumpur)
    • "oss-ap-southeast-5.aliyuncs.com"
      • Asia Pacific Southeast 5 (Jakarta)
    • "oss-ap-northeast-1.aliyuncs.com"
      • Asia Pacific Northeast 1 (Japan)
    • "oss-ap-south-1.aliyuncs.com"
      • Asia Pacific South 1 (Mumbai)
    • "oss-eu-central-1.aliyuncs.com"
      • Central Europe 1 (Frankfurt)
    • "oss-eu-west-1.aliyuncs.com"
      • West Europe (London)
    • "oss-me-east-1.aliyuncs.com"
      • Middle East 1 (Dubai)

--s3-endpoint

Endpoint for Scaleway Object Storage.

  • Config: endpoint
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "s3.nl-ams.scw.cloud"
      • Amsterdam Endpoint
    • "s3.fr-par.scw.cloud"
      • Paris Endpoint

--s3-endpoint

Endpoint for StackPath Object Storage.

  • Config: endpoint
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "s3.us-east-2.stackpathstorage.com"
      • US East Endpoint
    • "s3.us-west-1.stackpathstorage.com"
      • US West Endpoint
    • "s3.eu-central-1.stackpathstorage.com"
      • EU Endpoint

--s3-endpoint

Endpoint for Tencent COS API.

  • Config: endpoint
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "cos.ap-beijing.myqcloud.com"
      • Beijing Region.
    • "cos.ap-nanjing.myqcloud.com"
      • Nanjing Region.
    • "cos.ap-shanghai.myqcloud.com"
      • Shanghai Region.
    • "cos.ap-guangzhou.myqcloud.com"
      • Guangzhou Region.
    • "cos.ap-nanjing.myqcloud.com"
      • Nanjing Region.
    • "cos.ap-chengdu.myqcloud.com"
      • Chengdu Region.
    • "cos.ap-chongqing.myqcloud.com"
      • Chongqing Region.
    • "cos.ap-hongkong.myqcloud.com"
      • Hong Kong (China) Region.
    • "cos.ap-singapore.myqcloud.com"
      • Singapore Region.
    • "cos.ap-mumbai.myqcloud.com"
      • Mumbai Region.
    • "cos.ap-seoul.myqcloud.com"
      • Seoul Region.
    • "cos.ap-bangkok.myqcloud.com"
      • Bangkok Region.
    • "cos.ap-tokyo.myqcloud.com"
      • Tokyo Region.
    • "cos.na-siliconvalley.myqcloud.com"
      • Silicon Valley Region.
    • "cos.na-ashburn.myqcloud.com"
      • Virginia Region.
    • "cos.na-toronto.myqcloud.com"
      • Toronto Region.
    • "cos.eu-frankfurt.myqcloud.com"
      • Frankfurt Region.
    • "cos.eu-moscow.myqcloud.com"
      • Moscow Region.
    • "cos.accelerate.myqcloud.com"
      • Use Tencent COS Accelerate Endpoint.

--s3-endpoint

Endpoint for S3 API.
Required when using an S3 clone.

  • Config: endpoint
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENDPOINT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "objects-us-east-1.dream.io"
      • Dream Objects endpoint
    • "nyc3.digitaloceanspaces.com"
      • Digital Ocean Spaces New York 3
    • "ams3.digitaloceanspaces.com"
      • Digital Ocean Spaces Amsterdam 3
    • "sgp1.digitaloceanspaces.com"
      • Digital Ocean Spaces Singapore 1
    • "s3.wasabisys.com"
      • Wasabi US East endpoint
    • "s3.us-west-1.wasabisys.com"
      • Wasabi US West endpoint
    • "s3.eu-central-1.wasabisys.com"
      • Wasabi EU Central endpoint

--s3-location-constraint

Location constraint - must be set to match the Region.
Used when creating buckets only.

  • Config: location_constraint
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LOCATION_CONSTRAINT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • ""
      • Empty for US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest.
    • "us-east-2"
      • US East (Ohio) Region.
    • "us-west-1"
      • US West (Northern California) Region.
    • "us-west-2"
      • US West (Oregon) Region.
    • "ca-central-1"
      • Canada (Central) Region.
    • "eu-west-1"
      • EU (Ireland) Region.
    • "eu-west-2"
      • EU (London) Region.
    • "eu-west-3"
      • EU (Paris) Region.
    • "eu-north-1"
      • EU (Stockholm) Region.
    • "eu-south-1"
      • EU (Milan) Region.
    • "EU"
      • EU Region.
    • "ap-southeast-1"
      • Asia Pacific (Singapore) Region.
    • "ap-southeast-2"
      • Asia Pacific (Sydney) Region.
    • "ap-northeast-1"
      • Asia Pacific (Tokyo) Region.
    • "ap-northeast-2"
      • Asia Pacific (Seoul) Region.
    • "ap-northeast-3"
      • Asia Pacific (Osaka-Local) Region.
    • "ap-south-1"
      • Asia Pacific (Mumbai) Region.
    • "ap-east-1"
      • Asia Pacific (Hong Kong) Region.
    • "sa-east-1"
      • South America (Sao Paulo) Region.
    • "me-south-1"
      • Middle East (Bahrain) Region.
    • "af-south-1"
      • Africa (Cape Town) Region.
    • "cn-north-1"
      • China (Beijing) Region
    • "cn-northwest-1"
      • China (Ningxia) Region.
    • "us-gov-east-1"
      • AWS GovCloud (US-East) Region.
    • "us-gov-west-1"
      • AWS GovCloud (US) Region.

--s3-location-constraint

Location constraint - must match endpoint when using IBM Cloud Public.
For on-prem COS, do not make a selection from this list, hit enter

  • Config: location_constraint
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LOCATION_CONSTRAINT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "us-standard"
      • US Cross Region Standard
    • "us-vault"
      • US Cross Region Vault
    • "us-cold"
      • US Cross Region Cold
    • "us-flex"
      • US Cross Region Flex
    • "us-east-standard"
      • US East Region Standard
    • "us-east-vault"
      • US East Region Vault
    • "us-east-cold"
      • US East Region Cold
    • "us-east-flex"
      • US East Region Flex
    • "us-south-standard"
      • US South Region Standard
    • "us-south-vault"
      • US South Region Vault
    • "us-south-cold"
      • US South Region Cold
    • "us-south-flex"
      • US South Region Flex
    • "eu-standard"
      • EU Cross Region Standard
    • "eu-vault"
      • EU Cross Region Vault
    • "eu-cold"
      • EU Cross Region Cold
    • "eu-flex"
      • EU Cross Region Flex
    • "eu-gb-standard"
      • Great Britain Standard
    • "eu-gb-vault"
      • Great Britain Vault
    • "eu-gb-cold"
      • Great Britain Cold
    • "eu-gb-flex"
      • Great Britain Flex
    • "ap-standard"
      • APAC Standard
    • "ap-vault"
      • APAC Vault
    • "ap-cold"
      • APAC Cold
    • "ap-flex"
      • APAC Flex
    • "mel01-standard"
      • Melbourne Standard
    • "mel01-vault"
      • Melbourne Vault
    • "mel01-cold"
      • Melbourne Cold
    • "mel01-flex"
      • Melbourne Flex
    • "tor01-standard"
      • Toronto Standard
    • "tor01-vault"
      • Toronto Vault
    • "tor01-cold"
      • Toronto Cold
    • "tor01-flex"
      • Toronto Flex

--s3-location-constraint

Location constraint - must be set to match the Region.
Leave blank if not sure. Used when creating buckets only.

  • Config: location_constraint
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LOCATION_CONSTRAINT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--s3-acl

Canned ACL used when creating buckets and storing or copying objects.

This ACL is used for creating objects and if bucket_acl isn't set, for creating buckets too.

For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl

Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3
doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.

  • Config: acl
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ACL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "default"
      • Owner gets Full_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default).
    • "private"
      • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default).
    • "public-read"
      • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ access.
    • "public-read-write"
      • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access.
      • Granting this on a bucket is generally not recommended.
    • "authenticated-read"
      • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AuthenticatedUsers group gets READ access.
    • "bucket-owner-read"
      • Object owner gets FULL_CONTROL. Bucket owner gets READ access.
      • If you specify this canned ACL when creating a bucket, Amazon S3 ignores it.
    • "bucket-owner-full-control"
      • Both the object owner and the bucket owner get FULL_CONTROL over the object.
      • If you specify this canned ACL when creating a bucket, Amazon S3 ignores it.
    • "private"
      • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default). This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra), IBM Cloud (Storage), On-Premise COS
    • "public-read"
      • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ access. This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra), IBM Cloud (Storage), On-Premise IBM COS
    • "public-read-write"
      • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access. This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra), On-Premise IBM COS
    • "authenticated-read"
      • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AuthenticatedUsers group gets READ access. Not supported on Buckets. This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra) and On-Premise IBM COS

--s3-server-side-encryption

The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3.

  • Config: server_side_encryption
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SERVER_SIDE_ENCRYPTION
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • ""
      • None
    • "AES256"
      • AES256
    • "aws:kms"
      • aws:kms

--s3-sse-kms-key-id

If using KMS ID you must provide the ARN of Key.

  • Config: sse_kms_key_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SSE_KMS_KEY_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • ""
      • None
    • "arn:aws:kms:us-east-1:*"
      • arn:aws:kms:*

--s3-storage-class

The storage class to use when storing new objects in S3.

  • Config: storage_class
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STORAGE_CLASS
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • ""
      • Default
    • "STANDARD"
      • Standard storage class
    • "REDUCED_REDUNDANCY"
      • Reduced redundancy storage class
    • "STANDARD_IA"
      • Standard Infrequent Access storage class
    • "ONEZONE_IA"
      • One Zone Infrequent Access storage class
    • "GLACIER"
      • Glacier storage class
    • "DEEP_ARCHIVE"
      • Glacier Deep Archive storage class
    • "INTELLIGENT_TIERING"
      • Intelligent-Tiering storage class

--s3-storage-class

The storage class to use when storing new objects in OSS.

  • Config: storage_class
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STORAGE_CLASS
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • ""
      • Default
    • "STANDARD"
      • Standard storage class
    • "GLACIER"
      • Archive storage mode.
    • "STANDARD_IA"
      • Infrequent access storage mode.

--s3-storage-class

The storage class to use when storing new objects in Tencent COS.

  • Config: storage_class
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STORAGE_CLASS
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • ""
      • Default
    • "STANDARD"
      • Standard storage class
    • "ARCHIVE"
      • Archive storage mode.
    • "STANDARD_IA"
      • Infrequent access storage mode.

--s3-storage-class

The storage class to use when storing new objects in S3.

  • Config: storage_class
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_STORAGE_CLASS
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • ""
      • Default
    • "STANDARD"
      • The Standard class for any upload; suitable for on-demand content like streaming or CDN.
    • "GLACIER"
      • Archived storage; prices are lower, but it needs to be restored first to be accessed.

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to s3 (Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, Digital Ocean, Dreamhost, IBM COS, Minio, and Tencent COS).

--s3-bucket-acl

Canned ACL used when creating buckets.

For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl

Note that this ACL is applied when only when creating buckets. If it
isn't set then "acl" is used instead.

  • Config: bucket_acl
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_BUCKET_ACL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "private"
      • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default).
    • "public-read"
      • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ access.
    • "public-read-write"
      • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access.
      • Granting this on a bucket is generally not recommended.
    • "authenticated-read"
      • Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AuthenticatedUsers group gets READ access.

--s3-requester-pays

Enables requester pays option when interacting with S3 bucket.

  • Config: requester_pays
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_REQUESTER_PAYS
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--s3-sse-customer-algorithm

If using SSE-C, the server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3.

  • Config: sse_customer_algorithm
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SSE_CUSTOMER_ALGORITHM
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • ""
      • None
    • "AES256"
      • AES256

--s3-sse-customer-key

If using SSE-C you must provide the secret encryption key used to encrypt/decrypt your data.

  • Config: sse_customer_key
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SSE_CUSTOMER_KEY
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • ""
      • None

--s3-sse-customer-key-md5

If using SSE-C you may provide the secret encryption key MD5 checksum (optional).

If you leave it blank, this is calculated automatically from the sse_customer_key provided.

  • Config: sse_customer_key_md5
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SSE_CUSTOMER_KEY_MD5
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • ""
      • None

--s3-upload-cutoff

Cutoff for switching to chunked upload

Any files larger than this will be uploaded in chunks of chunk_size.
The minimum is 0 and the maximum is 5GB.

  • Config: upload_cutoff
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_UPLOAD_CUTOFF
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 200M

--s3-chunk-size

Chunk size to use for uploading.

When uploading files larger than upload_cutoff or files with unknown
size (e.g. from "rclone rcat" or uploaded with "rclone mount" or google
photos or google docs) they will be uploaded as multipart uploads
using this chunk size.

Note that "--s3-upload-concurrency" chunks of this size are buffered
in memory per transfer.

If you are transferring large files over high-speed links and you have
enough memory, then increasing this will speed up the transfers.

Rclone will automatically increase the chunk size when uploading a
large file of known size to stay below the 10,000 chunks limit.

Files of unknown size are uploaded with the configured
chunk_size. Since the default chunk size is 5MB and there can be at
most 10,000 chunks, this means that by default the maximum size of
a file you can stream upload is 48GB. If you wish to stream upload
larger files then you will need to increase chunk_size.

  • Config: chunk_size
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_CHUNK_SIZE
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 5M

--s3-max-upload-parts

Maximum number of parts in a multipart upload.

This option defines the maximum number of multipart chunks to use
when doing a multipart upload.

This can be useful if a service does not support the AWS S3
specification of 10,000 chunks.

Rclone will automatically increase the chunk size when uploading a
large file of a known size to stay below this number of chunks limit.

  • Config: max_upload_parts
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_MAX_UPLOAD_PARTS
  • Type: int
  • Default: 10000

--s3-copy-cutoff

Cutoff for switching to multipart copy

Any files larger than this that need to be server-side copied will be
copied in chunks of this size.

The minimum is 0 and the maximum is 5GB.

  • Config: copy_cutoff
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_COPY_CUTOFF
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 4.656G

--s3-disable-checksum

Don't store MD5 checksum with object metadata

Normally rclone will calculate the MD5 checksum of the input before
uploading it so it can add it to metadata on the object. This is great
for data integrity checking but can cause long delays for large files
to start uploading.

  • Config: disable_checksum
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_DISABLE_CHECKSUM
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--s3-shared-credentials-file

Path to the shared credentials file

If env_auth = true then rclone can use a shared credentials file.

If this variable is empty rclone will look for the
"AWS_SHARED_CREDENTIALS_FILE" env variable. If the env value is empty
it will default to the current user's home directory.

Linux/OSX: "$HOME/.aws/credentials"
Windows:   "%USERPROFILE%\.aws\credentials"
  • Config: shared_credentials_file
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SHARED_CREDENTIALS_FILE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--s3-profile

Profile to use in the shared credentials file

If env_auth = true then rclone can use a shared credentials file. This
variable controls which profile is used in that file.

If empty it will default to the environment variable "AWS_PROFILE" or
"default" if that environment variable is also not set.

  • Config: profile
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_PROFILE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--s3-session-token

An AWS session token

  • Config: session_token
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_SESSION_TOKEN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--s3-upload-concurrency

Concurrency for multipart uploads.

This is the number of chunks of the same file that are uploaded
concurrently.

If you are uploading small numbers of large files over high-speed links
and these uploads do not fully utilize your bandwidth, then increasing
this may help to speed up the transfers.

  • Config: upload_concurrency
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_UPLOAD_CONCURRENCY
  • Type: int
  • Default: 4

--s3-force-path-style

If true use path style access if false use virtual hosted style.

If this is true (the default) then rclone will use path style access,
if false then rclone will use virtual path style. See the AWS S3
docs

for more info.

Some providers (e.g. AWS, Aliyun OSS, Netease COS, or Tencent COS) require this set to
false - rclone will do this automatically based on the provider
setting.

  • Config: force_path_style
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_FORCE_PATH_STYLE
  • Type: bool
  • Default: true

--s3-v2-auth

If true use v2 authentication.

If this is false (the default) then rclone will use v4 authentication.
If it is set then rclone will use v2 authentication.

Use this only if v4 signatures don't work, e.g. pre Jewel/v10 CEPH.

  • Config: v2_auth
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_V2_AUTH
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--s3-use-accelerate-endpoint

If true use the AWS S3 accelerated endpoint.

See: AWS S3 Transfer acceleration

  • Config: use_accelerate_endpoint
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_USE_ACCELERATE_ENDPOINT
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--s3-leave-parts-on-error

If true avoid calling abort upload on a failure, leaving all successfully uploaded parts on S3 for manual recovery.

It should be set to true for resuming uploads across different sessions.

WARNING: Storing parts of an incomplete multipart upload counts towards space usage on S3 and will add additional costs if not cleaned up.

  • Config: leave_parts_on_error
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LEAVE_PARTS_ON_ERROR
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--s3-list-chunk

Size of listing chunk (response list for each ListObject S3 request).

This option is also known as "MaxKeys", "max-items", or "page-size" from the AWS S3 specification.
Most services truncate the response list to 1000 objects even if requested more than that.
In AWS S3 this is a global maximum and cannot be changed, see AWS S3.
In Ceph, this can be increased with the "rgw list buckets max chunk" option.

  • Config: list_chunk
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_LIST_CHUNK
  • Type: int
  • Default: 1000

--s3-no-check-bucket

If set, don't attempt to check the bucket exists or create it

This can be useful when trying to minimise the number of transactions
rclone does if you know the bucket exists already.

It can also be needed if the user you are using does not have bucket
creation permissions. Before v1.52.0 this would have passed silently
due to a bug.

  • Config: no_check_bucket
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_NO_CHECK_BUCKET
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--s3-no-head

If set, don't HEAD uploaded objects to check integrity

This can be useful when trying to minimise the number of transactions
rclone does.

Setting it means that if rclone receives a 200 OK message after
uploading an object with PUT then it will assume that it got uploaded
properly.

In particular it will assume:

  • the metadata, including modtime, storage class and content type was as uploaded
  • the size was as uploaded

It reads the following items from the response for a single part PUT:

  • the MD5SUM
  • The uploaded date

For multipart uploads these items aren't read.

If an source object of unknown length is uploaded then rclone will do a
HEAD request.

Setting this flag increases the chance for undetected upload failures,
in particular an incorrect size, so it isn't recommended for normal
operation. In practice the chance of an undetected upload failure is
very small even with this flag.

  • Config: no_head
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_NO_HEAD
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--s3-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot

--s3-memory-pool-flush-time

How often internal memory buffer pools will be flushed.
Uploads which requires additional buffers (f.e multipart) will use memory pool for allocations.
This option controls how often unused buffers will be removed from the pool.

  • Config: memory_pool_flush_time
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_MEMORY_POOL_FLUSH_TIME
  • Type: Duration
  • Default: 1m0s

--s3-memory-pool-use-mmap

Whether to use mmap buffers in internal memory pool.

  • Config: memory_pool_use_mmap
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_MEMORY_POOL_USE_MMAP
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--s3-disable-http2

Disable usage of http2 for S3 backends

There is currently an unsolved issue with the s3 (specifically minio) backend
and HTTP/2. HTTP/2 is enabled by default for the s3 backend but can be
disabled here. When the issue is solved this flag will be removed.

See: https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/4673, https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/3631

  • Config: disable_http2
  • Env Var: RCLONE_S3_DISABLE_HTTP2
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

Backend commands

Here are the commands specific to the s3 backend.

Run them with

rclone backend COMMAND remote:

The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

See the "rclone backend" command for more
info on how to pass options and arguments.

These can be run on a running backend using the rc command
backend/command.

restore

Restore objects from GLACIER to normal storage

rclone backend restore remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

This command can be used to restore one or more objects from GLACIER
to normal storage.

Usage Examples:

rclone backend restore s3:bucket/path/to/object [-o priority=PRIORITY] [-o lifetime=DAYS]
rclone backend restore s3:bucket/path/to/directory [-o priority=PRIORITY] [-o lifetime=DAYS]
rclone backend restore s3:bucket [-o priority=PRIORITY] [-o lifetime=DAYS]

This flag also obeys the filters. Test first with -i/--interactive or --dry-run flags

rclone -i backend restore --include "*.txt" s3:bucket/path -o priority=Standard

All the objects shown will be marked for restore, then

rclone backend restore --include "*.txt" s3:bucket/path -o priority=Standard

It returns a list of status dictionaries with Remote and Status
keys. The Status will be OK if it was successful or an error message
if not.

[
    {
        "Status": "OK",
        "Path": "test.txt"
    },
    {
        "Status": "OK",
        "Path": "test/file4.txt"
    }
]

Options:

  • "description": The optional description for the job.
  • "lifetime": Lifetime of the active copy in days
  • "priority": Priority of restore: Standard|Expedited|Bulk

list-multipart-uploads

List the unfinished multipart uploads

rclone backend list-multipart-uploads remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

This command lists the unfinished multipart uploads in JSON format.

rclone backend list-multipart s3:bucket/path/to/object

It returns a dictionary of buckets with values as lists of unfinished
multipart uploads.

You can call it with no bucket in which case it lists all bucket, with
a bucket or with a bucket and path.

{
  "rclone": [
    {
      "Initiated": "2020-06-26T14:20:36Z",
      "Initiator": {
        "DisplayName": "XXX",
        "ID": "arn:aws:iam::XXX:user/XXX"
      },
      "Key": "KEY",
      "Owner": {
        "DisplayName": null,
        "ID": "XXX"
      },
      "StorageClass": "STANDARD",
      "UploadId": "XXX"
    }
  ],
  "rclone-1000files": [],
  "rclone-dst": []
}

cleanup

Remove unfinished multipart uploads.

rclone backend cleanup remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

This command removes unfinished multipart uploads of age greater than
max-age which defaults to 24 hours.

Note that you can use -i/--dry-run with this command to see what it
would do.

rclone backend cleanup s3:bucket/path/to/object
rclone backend cleanup -o max-age=7w s3:bucket/path/to/object

Durations are parsed as per the rest of rclone, 2h, 7d, 7w etc.

Options:

  • "max-age": Max age of upload to delete

Anonymous access to public buckets

If you want to use rclone to access a public bucket, configure with a
blank access_key_id and secret_access_key. Your config should end
up looking like this:

[anons3]
type = s3
provider = AWS
env_auth = false
access_key_id = 
secret_access_key = 
region = us-east-1
endpoint = 
location_constraint = 
acl = private
server_side_encryption = 
storage_class = 

Then use it as normal with the name of the public bucket, e.g.

rclone lsd anons3:1000genomes

You will be able to list and copy data but not upload it.

Ceph

Ceph is an open source unified, distributed
storage system designed for excellent performance, reliability and
scalability. It has an S3 compatible object storage interface.

To use rclone with Ceph, configure as above but leave the region blank
and set the endpoint. You should end up with something like this in
your config:

[ceph]
type = s3
provider = Ceph
env_auth = false
access_key_id = XXX
secret_access_key = YYY
region =
endpoint = https://ceph.endpoint.example.com
location_constraint =
acl =
server_side_encryption =
storage_class =

If you are using an older version of CEPH, e.g. 10.2.x Jewel, then you
may need to supply the parameter --s3-upload-cutoff 0 or put this in
the config file as upload_cutoff 0 to work around a bug which causes
uploading of small files to fail.

Note also that Ceph sometimes puts / in the passwords it gives
users. If you read the secret access key using the command line tools
you will get a JSON blob with the / escaped as \/. Make sure you
only write / in the secret access key.

Eg the dump from Ceph looks something like this (irrelevant keys
removed).

{
    "user_id": "xxx",
    "display_name": "xxxx",
    "keys": [
        {
            "user": "xxx",
            "access_key": "xxxxxx",
            "secret_key": "xxxxxx\/xxxx"
        }
    ],
}

Because this is a json dump, it is encoding the / as \/, so if you
use the secret key as xxxxxx/xxxx it will work fine.

Dreamhost

Dreamhost DreamObjects is
an object storage system based on CEPH.

To use rclone with Dreamhost, configure as above but leave the region blank
and set the endpoint. You should end up with something like this in
your config:

[dreamobjects]
type = s3
provider = DreamHost
env_auth = false
access_key_id = your_access_key
secret_access_key = your_secret_key
region =
endpoint = objects-us-west-1.dream.io
location_constraint =
acl = private
server_side_encryption =
storage_class =

DigitalOcean Spaces

Spaces is an S3-interoperable object storage service from cloud provider DigitalOcean.

To connect to DigitalOcean Spaces you will need an access key and secret key. These can be retrieved on the "Applications & API" page of the DigitalOcean control panel. They will be needed when prompted by rclone config for your access_key_id and secret_access_key.

When prompted for a region or location_constraint, press enter to use the default value. The region must be included in the endpoint setting (e.g. nyc3.digitaloceanspaces.com). The default values can be used for other settings.

Going through the whole process of creating a new remote by running rclone config, each prompt should be answered as shown below:

Storage> s3
env_auth> 1
access_key_id> YOUR_ACCESS_KEY
secret_access_key> YOUR_SECRET_KEY
region>
endpoint> nyc3.digitaloceanspaces.com
location_constraint>
acl>
storage_class>

The resulting configuration file should look like:

[spaces]
type = s3
provider = DigitalOcean
env_auth = false
access_key_id = YOUR_ACCESS_KEY
secret_access_key = YOUR_SECRET_KEY
region =
endpoint = nyc3.digitaloceanspaces.com
location_constraint =
acl =
server_side_encryption =
storage_class =

Once configured, you can create a new Space and begin copying files. For example:

rclone mkdir spaces:my-new-space
rclone copy /path/to/files spaces:my-new-space

IBM COS (S3)

Information stored with IBM Cloud Object Storage is encrypted and dispersed across multiple geographic locations, and accessed through an implementation of the S3 API. This service makes use of the distributed storage technologies provided by IBMs Cloud Object Storage System (formerly Cleversafe). For more information visit: (http://www.ibm.com/cloud/object-storage)

To configure access to IBM COS S3, follow the steps below:

  1. Run rclone config and select n for a new remote.
	2018/02/14 14:13:11 NOTICE: Config file "C:\\Users\\a\\.config\\rclone\\rclone.conf" not found - using defaults
	No remotes found - make a new one
	n) New remote
	s) Set configuration password
	q) Quit config
	n/s/q> n
  1. Enter the name for the configuration
	name> <YOUR NAME>
  1. Select "s3" storage.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 	1 / Alias for an existing remote
   	\ "alias"
 	2 / Amazon Drive
   	\ "amazon cloud drive"
 	3 / Amazon S3 Complaint Storage Providers (Dreamhost, Ceph, Minio, IBM COS)
   	\ "s3"
 	4 / Backblaze B2
   	\ "b2"
[snip]
	23 / http Connection
    \ "http"
Storage> 3
  1. Select IBM COS as the S3 Storage Provider.
Choose the S3 provider.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
	 1 / Choose this option to configure Storage to AWS S3
	   \ "AWS"
 	 2 / Choose this option to configure Storage to Ceph Systems
  	 \ "Ceph"
	 3 /  Choose this option to configure Storage to Dreamhost
     \ "Dreamhost"
   4 / Choose this option to the configure Storage to IBM COS S3
   	 \ "IBMCOS"
 	 5 / Choose this option to the configure Storage to Minio
     \ "Minio"
	 Provider>4
  1. Enter the Access Key and Secret.
	AWS Access Key ID - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
	access_key_id> <>
	AWS Secret Access Key (password) - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
	secret_access_key> <>
  1. Specify the endpoint for IBM COS. For Public IBM COS, choose from the option below. For On Premise IBM COS, enter an endpoint address.
	Endpoint for IBM COS S3 API.
	Specify if using an IBM COS On Premise.
	Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
	 1 / US Cross Region Endpoint
   	   \ "s3-api.us-geo.objectstorage.softlayer.net"
	 2 / US Cross Region Dallas Endpoint
   	   \ "s3-api.dal.us-geo.objectstorage.softlayer.net"
 	 3 / US Cross Region Washington DC Endpoint
   	   \ "s3-api.wdc-us-geo.objectstorage.softlayer.net"
	 4 / US Cross Region San Jose Endpoint
	   \ "s3-api.sjc-us-geo.objectstorage.softlayer.net"
	 5 / US Cross Region Private Endpoint
	   \ "s3-api.us-geo.objectstorage.service.networklayer.com"
	 6 / US Cross Region Dallas Private Endpoint
	   \ "s3-api.dal-us-geo.objectstorage.service.networklayer.com"
	 7 / US Cross Region Washington DC Private Endpoint
	   \ "s3-api.wdc-us-geo.objectstorage.service.networklayer.com"
	 8 / US Cross Region San Jose Private Endpoint
	   \ "s3-api.sjc-us-geo.objectstorage.service.networklayer.com"
	 9 / US Region East Endpoint
	   \ "s3.us-east.objectstorage.softlayer.net"
	10 / US Region East Private Endpoint
	   \ "s3.us-east.objectstorage.service.networklayer.com"
	11 / US Region South Endpoint
[snip]
	34 / Toronto Single Site Private Endpoint
	   \ "s3.tor01.objectstorage.service.networklayer.com"
	endpoint>1
  1. Specify a IBM COS Location Constraint. The location constraint must match endpoint when using IBM Cloud Public. For on-prem COS, do not make a selection from this list, hit enter
	 1 / US Cross Region Standard
	   \ "us-standard"
	 2 / US Cross Region Vault
	   \ "us-vault"
	 3 / US Cross Region Cold
	   \ "us-cold"
	 4 / US Cross Region Flex
	   \ "us-flex"
	 5 / US East Region Standard
	   \ "us-east-standard"
	 6 / US East Region Vault
	   \ "us-east-vault"
	 7 / US East Region Cold
	   \ "us-east-cold"
	 8 / US East Region Flex
	   \ "us-east-flex"
	 9 / US South Region Standard
	   \ "us-south-standard"
	10 / US South Region Vault
	   \ "us-south-vault"
[snip]
	32 / Toronto Flex
	   \ "tor01-flex"
location_constraint>1
  1. Specify a canned ACL. IBM Cloud (Storage) supports "public-read" and "private". IBM Cloud(Infra) supports all the canned ACLs. On-Premise COS supports all the canned ACLs.
Canned ACL used when creating buckets and/or storing objects in S3.
For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
      1 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default). This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra), IBM Cloud (Storage), On-Premise COS
      \ "private"
      2  / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ access. This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra), IBM Cloud (Storage), On-Premise IBM COS
      \ "public-read"
      3 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access. This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra), On-Premise IBM COS
      \ "public-read-write"
      4  / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AuthenticatedUsers group gets READ access. Not supported on Buckets. This acl is available on IBM Cloud (Infra) and On-Premise IBM COS
      \ "authenticated-read"
acl> 1
  1. Review the displayed configuration and accept to save the "remote" then quit. The config file should look like this
	[xxx]
	type = s3
	Provider = IBMCOS
	access_key_id = xxx
	secret_access_key = yyy
	endpoint = s3-api.us-geo.objectstorage.softlayer.net
	location_constraint = us-standard
	acl = private
  1. Execute rclone commands
	1)	Create a bucket.
		rclone mkdir IBM-COS-XREGION:newbucket
	2)	List available buckets.
		rclone lsd IBM-COS-XREGION:
		-1 2017-11-08 21:16:22        -1 test
		-1 2018-02-14 20:16:39        -1 newbucket
	3)	List contents of a bucket.
		rclone ls IBM-COS-XREGION:newbucket
		18685952 test.exe
	4)	Copy a file from local to remote.
		rclone copy /Users/file.txt IBM-COS-XREGION:newbucket
	5)	Copy a file from remote to local.
		rclone copy IBM-COS-XREGION:newbucket/file.txt .
	6)	Delete a file on remote.
		rclone delete IBM-COS-XREGION:newbucket/file.txt

Minio

Minio is an object storage server built for cloud application developers and devops.

It is very easy to install and provides an S3 compatible server which can be used by rclone.

To use it, install Minio following the instructions here.

When it configures itself Minio will print something like this

Endpoint:  http://192.168.1.106:9000  http://172.23.0.1:9000
AccessKey: USWUXHGYZQYFYFFIT3RE
SecretKey: MOJRH0mkL1IPauahWITSVvyDrQbEEIwljvmxdq03
Region:    us-east-1
SQS ARNs:  arn:minio:sqs:us-east-1:1:redis arn:minio:sqs:us-east-1:2:redis

Browser Access:
   http://192.168.1.106:9000  http://172.23.0.1:9000

Command-line Access: https://docs.minio.io/docs/minio-client-quickstart-guide
   $ mc config host add myminio http://192.168.1.106:9000 USWUXHGYZQYFYFFIT3RE MOJRH0mkL1IPauahWITSVvyDrQbEEIwljvmxdq03

Object API (Amazon S3 compatible):
   Go:         https://docs.minio.io/docs/golang-client-quickstart-guide
   Java:       https://docs.minio.io/docs/java-client-quickstart-guide
   Python:     https://docs.minio.io/docs/python-client-quickstart-guide
   JavaScript: https://docs.minio.io/docs/javascript-client-quickstart-guide
   .NET:       https://docs.minio.io/docs/dotnet-client-quickstart-guide

Drive Capacity: 26 GiB Free, 165 GiB Total

These details need to go into rclone config like this. Note that it
is important to put the region in as stated above.

env_auth> 1
access_key_id> USWUXHGYZQYFYFFIT3RE
secret_access_key> MOJRH0mkL1IPauahWITSVvyDrQbEEIwljvmxdq03
region> us-east-1
endpoint> http://192.168.1.106:9000
location_constraint>
server_side_encryption>

Which makes the config file look like this

[minio]
type = s3
provider = Minio
env_auth = false
access_key_id = USWUXHGYZQYFYFFIT3RE
secret_access_key = MOJRH0mkL1IPauahWITSVvyDrQbEEIwljvmxdq03
region = us-east-1
endpoint = http://192.168.1.106:9000
location_constraint =
server_side_encryption =

So once set up, for example to copy files into a bucket

rclone copy /path/to/files minio:bucket

Scaleway

Scaleway The Object Storage platform allows you to store anything from backups, logs and web assets to documents and photos.
Files can be dropped from the Scaleway console or transferred through our API and CLI or using any S3-compatible tool.

Scaleway provides an S3 interface which can be configured for use with rclone like this:

[scaleway]
type = s3
provider = Scaleway
env_auth = false
endpoint = s3.nl-ams.scw.cloud
access_key_id = SCWXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
secret_access_key = 1111111-2222-3333-44444-55555555555555
region = nl-ams
location_constraint =
acl = private
server_side_encryption =
storage_class =

Wasabi

Wasabi is a cloud-based object storage service for a
broad range of applications and use cases. Wasabi is designed for
individuals and organizations that require a high-performance,
reliable, and secure data storage infrastructure at minimal cost.

Wasabi provides an S3 interface which can be configured for use with
rclone like this.

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
n/s> n
name> wasabi
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Amazon S3 (also Dreamhost, Ceph, Minio)
   \ "s3"
[snip]
Storage> s3
Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars). Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step
   \ "false"
 2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
   \ "true"
env_auth> 1
AWS Access Key ID - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
access_key_id> YOURACCESSKEY
AWS Secret Access Key (password) - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
secret_access_key> YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
Region to connect to.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
   / The default endpoint - a good choice if you are unsure.
 1 | US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest.
   | Leave location constraint empty.
   \ "us-east-1"
[snip]
region> us-east-1
Endpoint for S3 API.
Leave blank if using AWS to use the default endpoint for the region.
Specify if using an S3 clone such as Ceph.
endpoint> s3.wasabisys.com
Location constraint - must be set to match the Region. Used when creating buckets only.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Empty for US Region, Northern Virginia, or Pacific Northwest.
   \ ""
[snip]
location_constraint>
Canned ACL used when creating buckets and/or storing objects in S3.
For more info visit https://docs.aws.amazon.com/AmazonS3/latest/dev/acl-overview.html#canned-acl
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default).
   \ "private"
[snip]
acl>
The server-side encryption algorithm used when storing this object in S3.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / None
   \ ""
 2 / AES256
   \ "AES256"
server_side_encryption>
The storage class to use when storing objects in S3.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Default
   \ ""
 2 / Standard storage class
   \ "STANDARD"
 3 / Reduced redundancy storage class
   \ "REDUCED_REDUNDANCY"
 4 / Standard Infrequent Access storage class
   \ "STANDARD_IA"
storage_class>
Remote config
--------------------
[wasabi]
env_auth = false
access_key_id = YOURACCESSKEY
secret_access_key = YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
region = us-east-1
endpoint = s3.wasabisys.com
location_constraint =
acl =
server_side_encryption =
storage_class =
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

This will leave the config file looking like this.

[wasabi]
type = s3
provider = Wasabi
env_auth = false
access_key_id = YOURACCESSKEY
secret_access_key = YOURSECRETACCESSKEY
region =
endpoint = s3.wasabisys.com
location_constraint =
acl =
server_side_encryption =
storage_class =

Alibaba OSS

Here is an example of making an Alibaba Cloud (Aliyun) OSS
configuration. First run:

rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> oss
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
 4 / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, Digital Ocean, Dreamhost, IBM COS, Minio, and Tencent COS
   \ "s3"
[snip]
Storage> s3
Choose your S3 provider.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Amazon Web Services (AWS) S3
   \ "AWS"
 2 / Alibaba Cloud Object Storage System (OSS) formerly Aliyun
   \ "Alibaba"
 3 / Ceph Object Storage
   \ "Ceph"
[snip]
provider> Alibaba
Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step
   \ "false"
 2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
   \ "true"
env_auth> 1
AWS Access Key ID.
Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
access_key_id> accesskeyid
AWS Secret Access Key (password)
Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
secret_access_key> secretaccesskey
Endpoint for OSS API.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / East China 1 (Hangzhou)
   \ "oss-cn-hangzhou.aliyuncs.com"
 2 / East China 2 (Shanghai)
   \ "oss-cn-shanghai.aliyuncs.com"
 3 / North China 1 (Qingdao)
   \ "oss-cn-qingdao.aliyuncs.com"
[snip]
endpoint> 1
Canned ACL used when creating buckets and storing or copying objects.

Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3
doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default).
   \ "private"
 2 / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ access.
   \ "public-read"
   / Owner gets FULL_CONTROL. The AllUsers group gets READ and WRITE access.
[snip]
acl> 1
The storage class to use when storing new objects in OSS.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Default
   \ ""
 2 / Standard storage class
   \ "STANDARD"
 3 / Archive storage mode.
   \ "GLACIER"
 4 / Infrequent access storage mode.
   \ "STANDARD_IA"
storage_class> 1
Edit advanced config? (y/n)
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> n
Remote config
--------------------
[oss]
type = s3
provider = Alibaba
env_auth = false
access_key_id = accesskeyid
secret_access_key = secretaccesskey
endpoint = oss-cn-hangzhou.aliyuncs.com
acl = private
storage_class = Standard
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

Tencent COS

Tencent Cloud Object Storage (COS) is a distributed storage service offered by Tencent Cloud for unstructured data. It is secure, stable, massive, convenient, low-delay and low-cost.

To configure access to Tencent COS, follow the steps below:

  1. Run rclone config and select n for a new remote.
rclone config
No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
  1. Give the name of the configuration. For example, name it 'cos'.
name> cos
  1. Select s3 storage.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
1 / 1Fichier
   \ "fichier"
 2 / Alias for an existing remote
   \ "alias"
 3 / Amazon Drive
   \ "amazon cloud drive"
 4 / Amazon S3 Compliant Storage Providers including AWS, Alibaba, Ceph, Digital Ocean, Dreamhost, IBM COS, Minio, and Tencent COS
   \ "s3"
[snip]
Storage> s3
  1. Select TencentCOS provider.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
1 / Amazon Web Services (AWS) S3
   \ "AWS"
[snip]
11 / Tencent Cloud Object Storage (COS)
   \ "TencentCOS"
[snip]
provider> TencentCOS
  1. Enter your SecretId and SecretKey of Tencent Cloud.
Get AWS credentials from runtime (environment variables or EC2/ECS meta data if no env vars).
Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Enter AWS credentials in the next step
   \ "false"
 2 / Get AWS credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
   \ "true"
env_auth> 1
AWS Access Key ID.
Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
access_key_id> AKIDxxxxxxxxxx
AWS Secret Access Key (password)
Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
secret_access_key> xxxxxxxxxxx
  1. Select endpoint for Tencent COS. This is the standard endpoint for different region.
 1 / Beijing Region.
   \ "cos.ap-beijing.myqcloud.com"
 2 / Nanjing Region.
   \ "cos.ap-nanjing.myqcloud.com"
 3 / Shanghai Region.
   \ "cos.ap-shanghai.myqcloud.com"
 4 / Guangzhou Region.
   \ "cos.ap-guangzhou.myqcloud.com"
[snip]
endpoint> 4
  1. Choose acl and storage class.
Note that this ACL is applied when server-side copying objects as S3
doesn't copy the ACL from the source but rather writes a fresh one.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Owner gets Full_CONTROL. No one else has access rights (default).
   \ "default"
[snip]
acl> 1
The storage class to use when storing new objects in Tencent COS.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Default
   \ ""
[snip]
storage_class> 1
Edit advanced config? (y/n)
y) Yes
n) No (default)
y/n> n
Remote config
--------------------
[cos]
type = s3
provider = TencentCOS
env_auth = false
access_key_id = xxx
secret_access_key = xxx
endpoint = cos.ap-guangzhou.myqcloud.com
acl = default
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK (default)
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y
Current remotes:

Name                 Type
====                 ====
cos                  s3

Netease NOS

For Netease NOS configure as per the configurator rclone config
setting the provider Netease. This will automatically set
force_path_style = false which is necessary for it to run properly.

Limitations

rclone about is not supported by the S3 backend. Backends without
this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or
use policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union
remote.

See List of backends that do not support rclone about
See rclone about

Backblaze B2

B2 is Backblaze's cloud storage system.

Paths are specified as remote:bucket (or remote: for the lsd
command.) You may put subdirectories in too, e.g. remote:bucket/path/to/dir.

Here is an example of making a b2 configuration. First run

rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process. To authenticate
you will either need your Account ID (a short hex number) and Master
Application Key (a long hex number) OR an Application Key, which is the
recommended method. See below for further details on generating and using
an Application Key.

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
q) Quit config
n/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Backblaze B2
   \ "b2"
[snip]
Storage> b2
Account ID or Application Key ID
account> 123456789abc
Application Key
key> 0123456789abcdef0123456789abcdef0123456789
Endpoint for the service - leave blank normally.
endpoint>
Remote config
--------------------
[remote]
account = 123456789abc
key = 0123456789abcdef0123456789abcdef0123456789
endpoint =
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

See all buckets

rclone lsd remote:

Create a new bucket

rclone mkdir remote:bucket

List the contents of a bucket

rclone ls remote:bucket

Sync /home/local/directory to the remote bucket, deleting any
excess files in the bucket.

rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:bucket

Application Keys

B2 supports multiple Application Keys for different access permission
to B2 Buckets
.

You can use these with rclone too; you will need to use rclone version 1.43
or later.

Follow Backblaze's docs to create an Application Key with the required
permission and add the applicationKeyId as the account and the
Application Key itself as the key.

Note that you must put the applicationKeyId as the account you
can't use the master Account ID. If you try then B2 will return 401
errors.

--fast-list

This remote supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer
transactions in exchange for more memory. See the rclone
docs
for more details.

Modified time

The modified time is stored as metadata on the object as
X-Bz-Info-src_last_modified_millis as milliseconds since 1970-01-01
in the Backblaze standard. Other tools should be able to use this as
a modified time.

Modified times are used in syncing and are fully supported. Note that
if a modification time needs to be updated on an object then it will
create a new version of the object.

Restricted filename characters

In addition to the default restricted characters set
the following characters are also replaced:

Character Value Replacement
\ 0x5C

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Note that in 2020-05 Backblaze started allowing \ characters in file
names. Rclone hasn't changed its encoding as this could cause syncs to
re-transfer files. If you want rclone not to replace \ then see the
--b2-encoding flag below and remove the BackSlash from the
string. This can be set in the config.

SHA1 checksums

The SHA1 checksums of the files are checked on upload and download and
will be used in the syncing process.

Large files (bigger than the limit in --b2-upload-cutoff) which are
uploaded in chunks will store their SHA1 on the object as
X-Bz-Info-large_file_sha1 as recommended by Backblaze.

For a large file to be uploaded with an SHA1 checksum, the source
needs to support SHA1 checksums. The local disk supports SHA1
checksums so large file transfers from local disk will have an SHA1.
See the overview for exactly which remotes
support SHA1.

Sources which don't support SHA1, in particular crypt will upload
large files without SHA1 checksums. This may be fixed in the future
(see #1767).

Files sizes below --b2-upload-cutoff will always have an SHA1
regardless of the source.

Transfers

Backblaze recommends that you do lots of transfers simultaneously for
maximum speed. In tests from my SSD equipped laptop the optimum
setting is about --transfers 32 though higher numbers may be used
for a slight speed improvement. The optimum number for you may vary
depending on your hardware, how big the files are, how much you want
to load your computer, etc. The default of --transfers 4 is
definitely too low for Backblaze B2 though.

Note that uploading big files (bigger than 200 MB by default) will use
a 96 MB RAM buffer by default. There can be at most --transfers of
these in use at any moment, so this sets the upper limit on the memory
used.

Versions

When rclone uploads a new version of a file it creates a new version
of it
.
Likewise when you delete a file, the old version will be marked hidden
and still be available. Conversely, you may opt in to a "hard delete"
of files with the --b2-hard-delete flag which would permanently remove
the file instead of hiding it.

Old versions of files, where available, are visible using the
--b2-versions flag.

NB Note that --b2-versions does not work with crypt at the
moment #1627. Using
--backup-dir with rclone is the recommended
way of working around this.

If you wish to remove all the old versions then you can use the
rclone cleanup remote:bucket command which will delete all the old
versions of files, leaving the current ones intact. You can also
supply a path and only old versions under that path will be deleted,
e.g. rclone cleanup remote:bucket/path/to/stuff.

Note that cleanup will remove partially uploaded files from the bucket
if they are more than a day old.

When you purge a bucket, the current and the old versions will be
deleted then the bucket will be deleted.

However delete will cause the current versions of the files to
become hidden old versions.

Here is a session showing the listing and retrieval of an old
version followed by a cleanup of the old versions.

Show current version and all the versions with --b2-versions flag.

$ rclone -q ls b2:cleanup-test
        9 one.txt

$ rclone -q --b2-versions ls b2:cleanup-test
        9 one.txt
        8 one-v2016-07-04-141032-000.txt
       16 one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt
       15 one-v2016-07-02-155621-000.txt

Retrieve an old version

$ rclone -q --b2-versions copy b2:cleanup-test/one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt /tmp

$ ls -l /tmp/one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt
-rw-rw-r-- 1 ncw ncw 16 Jul  2 17:46 /tmp/one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt

Clean up all the old versions and show that they've gone.

$ rclone -q cleanup b2:cleanup-test

$ rclone -q ls b2:cleanup-test
        9 one.txt

$ rclone -q --b2-versions ls b2:cleanup-test
        9 one.txt

Data usage

It is useful to know how many requests are sent to the server in different scenarios.

All copy commands send the following 4 requests:

/b2api/v1/b2_authorize_account
/b2api/v1/b2_create_bucket
/b2api/v1/b2_list_buckets
/b2api/v1/b2_list_file_names

The b2_list_file_names request will be sent once for every 1k files
in the remote path, providing the checksum and modification time of
the listed files. As of version 1.33 issue
#818 causes extra requests
to be sent when using B2 with Crypt. When a copy operation does not
require any files to be uploaded, no more requests will be sent.

Uploading files that do not require chunking, will send 2 requests per
file upload:

/b2api/v1/b2_get_upload_url
/b2api/v1/b2_upload_file/

Uploading files requiring chunking, will send 2 requests (one each to
start and finish the upload) and another 2 requests for each chunk:

/b2api/v1/b2_start_large_file
/b2api/v1/b2_get_upload_part_url
/b2api/v1/b2_upload_part/
/b2api/v1/b2_finish_large_file

Versions

Versions can be viewed with the --b2-versions flag. When it is set
rclone will show and act on older versions of files. For example

Listing without --b2-versions

$ rclone -q ls b2:cleanup-test
        9 one.txt

And with

$ rclone -q --b2-versions ls b2:cleanup-test
        9 one.txt
        8 one-v2016-07-04-141032-000.txt
       16 one-v2016-07-04-141003-000.txt
       15 one-v2016-07-02-155621-000.txt

Showing that the current version is unchanged but older versions can
be seen. These have the UTC date that they were uploaded to the
server to the nearest millisecond appended to them.

Note that when using --b2-versions no file write operations are
permitted, so you can't upload files or delete them.

Rclone supports generating file share links for private B2 buckets.
They can either be for a file for example:

./rclone link B2:bucket/path/to/file.txt
https://f002.backblazeb2.com/file/bucket/path/to/file.txt?Authorization=xxxxxxxx

or if run on a directory you will get:

./rclone link B2:bucket/path
https://f002.backblazeb2.com/file/bucket/path?Authorization=xxxxxxxx

you can then use the authorization token (the part of the url from the
?Authorization= on) on any file path under that directory. For example:

https://f002.backblazeb2.com/file/bucket/path/to/file1?Authorization=xxxxxxxx
https://f002.backblazeb2.com/file/bucket/path/file2?Authorization=xxxxxxxx
https://f002.backblazeb2.com/file/bucket/path/folder/file3?Authorization=xxxxxxxx

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to b2 (Backblaze B2).

--b2-account

Account ID or Application Key ID

  • Config: account
  • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_ACCOUNT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--b2-key

Application Key

  • Config: key
  • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_KEY
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--b2-hard-delete

Permanently delete files on remote removal, otherwise hide files.

  • Config: hard_delete
  • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_HARD_DELETE
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to b2 (Backblaze B2).

--b2-endpoint

Endpoint for the service.
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: endpoint
  • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_ENDPOINT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--b2-test-mode

A flag string for X-Bz-Test-Mode header for debugging.

This is for debugging purposes only. Setting it to one of the strings
below will cause b2 to return specific errors:

  • "fail_some_uploads"
  • "expire_some_account_authorization_tokens"
  • "force_cap_exceeded"

These will be set in the "X-Bz-Test-Mode" header which is documented
in the b2 integrations checklist.

  • Config: test_mode
  • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_TEST_MODE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--b2-versions

Include old versions in directory listings.
Note that when using this no file write operations are permitted,
so you can't upload files or delete them.

  • Config: versions
  • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_VERSIONS
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--b2-upload-cutoff

Cutoff for switching to chunked upload.

Files above this size will be uploaded in chunks of "--b2-chunk-size".

This value should be set no larger than 4.657GiB (== 5GB).

  • Config: upload_cutoff
  • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_UPLOAD_CUTOFF
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 200M

--b2-copy-cutoff

Cutoff for switching to multipart copy

Any files larger than this that need to be server-side copied will be
copied in chunks of this size.

The minimum is 0 and the maximum is 4.6GB.

  • Config: copy_cutoff
  • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_COPY_CUTOFF
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 4G

--b2-chunk-size

Upload chunk size. Must fit in memory.

When uploading large files, chunk the file into this size. Note that
these chunks are buffered in memory and there might a maximum of
"--transfers" chunks in progress at once. 5,000,000 Bytes is the
minimum size.

  • Config: chunk_size
  • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_CHUNK_SIZE
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 96M

--b2-disable-checksum

Disable checksums for large (> upload cutoff) files

Normally rclone will calculate the SHA1 checksum of the input before
uploading it so it can add it to metadata on the object. This is great
for data integrity checking but can cause long delays for large files
to start uploading.

  • Config: disable_checksum
  • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_DISABLE_CHECKSUM
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--b2-download-url

Custom endpoint for downloads.

This is usually set to a Cloudflare CDN URL as Backblaze offers
free egress for data downloaded through the Cloudflare network.
Rclone works with private buckets by sending an "Authorization" header.
If the custom endpoint rewrites the requests for authentication,
e.g., in Cloudflare Workers, this header needs to be handled properly.
Leave blank if you want to use the endpoint provided by Backblaze.

  • Config: download_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_DOWNLOAD_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--b2-download-auth-duration

Time before the authorization token will expire in s or suffix ms|s|m|h|d.

The duration before the download authorization token will expire.
The minimum value is 1 second. The maximum value is one week.

  • Config: download_auth_duration
  • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_DOWNLOAD_AUTH_DURATION
  • Type: Duration
  • Default: 1w

--b2-memory-pool-flush-time

How often internal memory buffer pools will be flushed.
Uploads which requires additional buffers (f.e multipart) will use memory pool for allocations.
This option controls how often unused buffers will be removed from the pool.

  • Config: memory_pool_flush_time
  • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_MEMORY_POOL_FLUSH_TIME
  • Type: Duration
  • Default: 1m0s

--b2-memory-pool-use-mmap

Whether to use mmap buffers in internal memory pool.

  • Config: memory_pool_use_mmap
  • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_MEMORY_POOL_USE_MMAP
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--b2-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_B2_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

rclone about is not supported by the B2 backend. Backends without
this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or
use policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union
remote.

See List of backends that do not support rclone about
See rclone about

Box

Paths are specified as remote:path

Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

The initial setup for Box involves getting a token from Box which you
can do either in your browser, or with a config.json downloaded from Box
to use JWT authentication. rclone config walks you through it.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Box
   \ "box"
[snip]
Storage> box
Box App Client Id - leave blank normally.
client_id> 
Box App Client Secret - leave blank normally.
client_secret>
Box App config.json location
Leave blank normally.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
box_config_file>
Box App Primary Access Token
Leave blank normally.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
access_token>

Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("user").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Rclone should act on behalf of a user
   \ "user"
 2 / Rclone should act on behalf of a service account
   \ "enterprise"
box_sub_type>
Remote config
Use auto config?
 * Say Y if not sure
 * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> y
If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
Log in and authorize rclone for access
Waiting for code...
Got code
--------------------
[remote]
client_id = 
client_secret = 
token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"bearer","refresh_token":"XXX","expiry":"XXX"}
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

See the remote setup docs for how to set it up on a
machine with no Internet browser available.

Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the
token as returned from Box. This only runs from the moment it opens
your browser to the moment you get back the verification code. This
is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require you to unblock
it temporarily if you are running a host firewall.

Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

List directories in top level of your Box

rclone lsd remote:

List all the files in your Box

rclone ls remote:

To copy a local directory to an Box directory called backup

rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Using rclone with an Enterprise account with SSO

If you have an "Enterprise" account type with Box with single sign on
(SSO), you need to create a password to use Box with rclone. This can
be done at your Enterprise Box account by going to Settings, "Account"
Tab, and then set the password in the "Authentication" field.

Once you have done this, you can setup your Enterprise Box account
using the same procedure detailed above in the, using the password you
have just set.

Invalid refresh token

According to the box docs:

Each refresh_token is valid for one use in 60 days.

This means that if you

  • Don't use the box remote for 60 days
  • Copy the config file with a box refresh token in and use it in two places
  • Get an error on a token refresh

then rclone will return an error which includes the text Invalid refresh token.

To fix this you will need to use oauth2 again to update the refresh
token. You can use the methods in the remote setup
docs
, bearing in mind that if you use the copy the
config file method, you should not use that remote on the computer you
did the authentication on.

Here is how to do it.

$ rclone config
Current remotes:

Name                 Type
====                 ====
remote               box

e) Edit existing remote
n) New remote
d) Delete remote
r) Rename remote
c) Copy remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
e/n/d/r/c/s/q> e
Choose a number from below, or type in an existing value
 1 > remote
remote> remote
--------------------
[remote]
type = box
token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"bearer","refresh_token":"XXX","expiry":"2017-07-08T23:40:08.059167677+01:00"}
--------------------
Edit remote
Value "client_id" = ""
Edit? (y/n)>
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> n
Value "client_secret" = ""
Edit? (y/n)>
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> n
Remote config
Already have a token - refresh?
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> y
Use auto config?
 * Say Y if not sure
 * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> y
If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
Log in and authorize rclone for access
Waiting for code...
Got code
--------------------
[remote]
type = box
token = {"access_token":"YYY","token_type":"bearer","refresh_token":"YYY","expiry":"2017-07-23T12:22:29.259137901+01:00"}
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

Modified time and hashes

Box allows modification times to be set on objects accurate to 1
second. These will be used to detect whether objects need syncing or
not.

Box supports SHA1 type hashes, so you can use the --checksum
flag.

Restricted filename characters

In addition to the default restricted characters set
the following characters are also replaced:

Character Value Replacement
\ 0x5C

File names can also not end with the following characters.
These only get replaced if they are the last character in the name:

Character Value Replacement
SP 0x20

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Transfers

For files above 50MB rclone will use a chunked transfer. Rclone will
upload up to --transfers chunks at the same time (shared among all
the multipart uploads). Chunks are buffered in memory and are
normally 8MB so increasing --transfers will increase memory use.

Deleting files

Depending on the enterprise settings for your user, the item will
either be actually deleted from Box or moved to the trash.

Emptying the trash is supported via the rclone however cleanup command
however this deletes every trashed file and folder individually so it
may take a very long time.
Emptying the trash via the WebUI does not have this limitation
so it is advised to empty the trash via the WebUI.

Root folder ID

You can set the root_folder_id for rclone. This is the directory
(identified by its Folder ID) that rclone considers to be the root
of your Box drive.

Normally you will leave this blank and rclone will determine the
correct root to use itself.

However you can set this to restrict rclone to a specific folder
hierarchy.

In order to do this you will have to find the Folder ID of the
directory you wish rclone to display. This will be the last segment
of the URL when you open the relevant folder in the Box web
interface.

So if the folder you want rclone to use has a URL which looks like
https://app.box.com/folder/11xxxxxxxxx8
in the browser, then you use 11xxxxxxxxx8 as
the root_folder_id in the config.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to box (Box).

--box-client-id

OAuth Client Id
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: client_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_CLIENT_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--box-client-secret

OAuth Client Secret
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: client_secret
  • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_CLIENT_SECRET
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--box-box-config-file

Box App config.json location
Leave blank normally.

Leading ~ will be expanded in the file name as will environment variables such as ${RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR}.

  • Config: box_config_file
  • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_BOX_CONFIG_FILE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--box-access-token

Box App Primary Access Token
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: access_token
  • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_ACCESS_TOKEN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--box-box-sub-type

  • Config: box_sub_type
  • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_BOX_SUB_TYPE
  • Type: string
  • Default: "user"
  • Examples:
    • "user"
      • Rclone should act on behalf of a user
    • "enterprise"
      • Rclone should act on behalf of a service account

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to box (Box).

--box-token

OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

  • Config: token
  • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_TOKEN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--box-auth-url

Auth server URL.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: auth_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_AUTH_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--box-token-url

Token server url.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: token_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_TOKEN_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--box-root-folder-id

Fill in for rclone to use a non root folder as its starting point.

  • Config: root_folder_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_ROOT_FOLDER_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: "0"

--box-upload-cutoff

Cutoff for switching to multipart upload (>= 50MB).

  • Config: upload_cutoff
  • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_UPLOAD_CUTOFF
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 50M

--box-commit-retries

Max number of times to try committing a multipart file.

  • Config: commit_retries
  • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_COMMIT_RETRIES
  • Type: int
  • Default: 100

--box-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_BOX_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,RightSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

Note that Box is case insensitive so you can't have a file called
"Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

Box file names can't have the \ character in. rclone maps this to
and from an identical looking unicode equivalent (U+FF3C Fullwidth
Reverse Solidus).

Box only supports filenames up to 255 characters in length.

rclone about is not supported by the Box backend. Backends without
this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or
use policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union
remote.

See List of backends that do not support rclone about
See rclone about

Cache (BETA)

The cache remote wraps another existing remote and stores file structure
and its data for long running tasks like rclone mount.

Status

The cache backend code is working but it currently doesn't
have a maintainer so there are outstanding bugs which aren't getting fixed.

The cache backend is due to be phased out in favour of the VFS caching
layer eventually which is more tightly integrated into rclone.

Until this happens we recommend only using the cache backend if you
find you can't work without it. There are many docs online describing
the use of the cache backend to minimize API hits and by-and-large
these are out of date and the cache backend isn't needed in those
scenarios any more.

Setup

To get started you just need to have an existing remote which can be configured
with cache.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called test-cache. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
r) Rename remote
c) Copy remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/r/c/s/q> n
name> test-cache
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Cache a remote
   \ "cache"
[snip]
Storage> cache
Remote to cache.
Normally should contain a ':' and a path, e.g. "myremote:path/to/dir",
"myremote:bucket" or maybe "myremote:" (not recommended).
remote> local:/test
Optional: The URL of the Plex server
plex_url> http://127.0.0.1:32400
Optional: The username of the Plex user
plex_username> dummyusername
Optional: The password of the Plex user
y) Yes type in my own password
g) Generate random password
n) No leave this optional password blank
y/g/n> y
Enter the password:
password:
Confirm the password:
password:
The size of a chunk. Lower value good for slow connections but can affect seamless reading.
Default: 5M
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / 1MB
   \ "1m"
 2 / 5 MB
   \ "5M"
 3 / 10 MB
   \ "10M"
chunk_size> 2
How much time should object info (file size, file hashes, etc.) be stored in cache. Use a very high value if you don't plan on changing the source FS from outside the cache.
Accepted units are: "s", "m", "h".
Default: 5m
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / 1 hour
   \ "1h"
 2 / 24 hours
   \ "24h"
 3 / 24 hours
   \ "48h"
info_age> 2
The maximum size of stored chunks. When the storage grows beyond this size, the oldest chunks will be deleted.
Default: 10G
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / 500 MB
   \ "500M"
 2 / 1 GB
   \ "1G"
 3 / 10 GB
   \ "10G"
chunk_total_size> 3
Remote config
--------------------
[test-cache]
remote = local:/test
plex_url = http://127.0.0.1:32400
plex_username = dummyusername
plex_password = *** ENCRYPTED ***
chunk_size = 5M
info_age = 48h
chunk_total_size = 10G

You can then use it like this,

List directories in top level of your drive

rclone lsd test-cache:

List all the files in your drive

rclone ls test-cache:

To start a cached mount

rclone mount --allow-other test-cache: /var/tmp/test-cache

Write Features

Offline uploading

In an effort to make writing through cache more reliable, the backend
now supports this feature which can be activated by specifying a
cache-tmp-upload-path.

A files goes through these states when using this feature:

  1. An upload is started (usually by copying a file on the cache remote)
  2. When the copy to the temporary location is complete the file is part
    of the cached remote and looks and behaves like any other file (reading included)
  3. After cache-tmp-wait-time passes and the file is next in line, rclone move
    is used to move the file to the cloud provider
  4. Reading the file still works during the upload but most modifications on it will be prohibited
  5. Once the move is complete the file is unlocked for modifications as it
    becomes as any other regular file
  6. If the file is being read through cache when it's actually
    deleted from the temporary path then cache will simply swap the source
    to the cloud provider without interrupting the reading (small blip can happen though)

Files are uploaded in sequence and only one file is uploaded at a time.
Uploads will be stored in a queue and be processed based on the order they were added.
The queue and the temporary storage is persistent across restarts but
can be cleared on startup with the --cache-db-purge flag.

Write Support

Writes are supported through cache.
One caveat is that a mounted cache remote does not add any retry or fallback
mechanism to the upload operation. This will depend on the implementation
of the wrapped remote. Consider using Offline uploading for reliable writes.

One special case is covered with cache-writes which will cache the file
data at the same time as the upload when it is enabled making it available
from the cache store immediately once the upload is finished.

Read Features

Multiple connections

To counter the high latency between a local PC where rclone is running
and cloud providers, the cache remote can split multiple requests to the
cloud provider for smaller file chunks and combines them together locally
where they can be available almost immediately before the reader usually
needs them.

This is similar to buffering when media files are played online. Rclone
will stay around the current marker but always try its best to stay ahead
and prepare the data before.

Plex Integration

There is a direct integration with Plex which allows cache to detect during reading
if the file is in playback or not. This helps cache to adapt how it queries
the cloud provider depending on what is needed for.

Scans will have a minimum amount of workers (1) while in a confirmed playback cache
will deploy the configured number of workers.

This integration opens the doorway to additional performance improvements
which will be explored in the near future.

Note: If Plex options are not configured, cache will function with its
configured options without adapting any of its settings.

How to enable? Run rclone config and add all the Plex options (endpoint, username
and password) in your remote and it will be automatically enabled.

Affected settings:

  • cache-workers: Configured value during confirmed playback or 1 all the other times
Certificate Validation

When the Plex server is configured to only accept secure connections, it is
possible to use .plex.direct URLs to ensure certificate validation succeeds.
These URLs are used by Plex internally to connect to the Plex server securely.

The format for these URLs is the following:

https://ip-with-dots-replaced.server-hash.plex.direct:32400/

The ip-with-dots-replaced part can be any IPv4 address, where the dots
have been replaced with dashes, e.g. 127.0.0.1 becomes 127-0-0-1.

To get the server-hash part, the easiest way is to visit

https://plex.tv/api/resources?includeHttps=1&X-Plex-Token=your-plex-token

This page will list all the available Plex servers for your account
with at least one .plex.direct link for each. Copy one URL and replace
the IP address with the desired address. This can be used as the
plex_url value.

Known issues

Mount and --dir-cache-time

--dir-cache-time controls the first layer of directory caching which works at the mount layer.
Being an independent caching mechanism from the cache backend, it will manage its own entries
based on the configured time.

To avoid getting in a scenario where dir cache has obsolete data and cache would have the correct
one, try to set --dir-cache-time to a lower time than --cache-info-age. Default values are
already configured in this way.

Windows support - Experimental

There are a couple of issues with Windows mount functionality that still require some investigations.
It should be considered as experimental thus far as fixes come in for this OS.

Most of the issues seem to be related to the difference between filesystems
on Linux flavors and Windows as cache is heavily dependent on them.

Any reports or feedback on how cache behaves on this OS is greatly appreciated.

Risk of throttling

Future iterations of the cache backend will make use of the pooling functionality
of the cloud provider to synchronize and at the same time make writing through it
more tolerant to failures.

There are a couple of enhancements in track to add these but in the meantime
there is a valid concern that the expiring cache listings can lead to cloud provider
throttles or bans due to repeated queries on it for very large mounts.

Some recommendations:

  • don't use a very small interval for entry information (--cache-info-age)
  • while writes aren't yet optimised, you can still write through cache which gives you the advantage
    of adding the file in the cache at the same time if configured to do so.

Future enhancements:

cache and crypt

One common scenario is to keep your data encrypted in the cloud provider
using the crypt remote. crypt uses a similar technique to wrap around
an existing remote and handles this translation in a seamless way.

There is an issue with wrapping the remotes in this order:
cloud remote -> crypt -> cache

During testing, I experienced a lot of bans with the remotes in this order.
I suspect it might be related to how crypt opens files on the cloud provider
which makes it think we're downloading the full file instead of small chunks.
Organizing the remotes in this order yields better results:
cloud remote -> cache -> crypt

absolute remote paths

cache can not differentiate between relative and absolute paths for the wrapped remote.
Any path given in the remote config setting and on the command line will be passed to
the wrapped remote as is, but for storing the chunks on disk the path will be made
relative by removing any leading / character.

This behavior is irrelevant for most backend types, but there are backends where a leading /
changes the effective directory, e.g. in the sftp backend paths starting with a / are
relative to the root of the SSH server and paths without are relative to the user home directory.
As a result sftp:bin and sftp:/bin will share the same cache folder, even if they represent
a different directory on the SSH server.

Cache and Remote Control (--rc)

Cache supports the new --rc mode in rclone and can be remote controlled through the following end points:
By default, the listener is disabled if you do not add the flag.

rc cache/expire

Purge a remote from the cache backend. Supports either a directory or a file.
It supports both encrypted and unencrypted file names if cache is wrapped by crypt.

Params:

  • remote = path to remote (required)
  • withData = true/false to delete cached data (chunks) as well (optional, false by default)

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to cache (Cache a remote).

--cache-remote

Remote to cache.
Normally should contain a ':' and a path, e.g. "myremote:path/to/dir",
"myremote:bucket" or maybe "myremote:" (not recommended).

  • Config: remote
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_REMOTE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--cache-plex-url

The URL of the Plex server

  • Config: plex_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_PLEX_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--cache-plex-username

The username of the Plex user

  • Config: plex_username
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_PLEX_USERNAME
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--cache-plex-password

The password of the Plex user

NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure.

  • Config: plex_password
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_PLEX_PASSWORD
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--cache-chunk-size

The size of a chunk (partial file data).

Use lower numbers for slower connections. If the chunk size is
changed, any downloaded chunks will be invalid and cache-chunk-path
will need to be cleared or unexpected EOF errors will occur.

  • Config: chunk_size
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_CHUNK_SIZE
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 5M
  • Examples:
    • "1m"
      • 1MB
    • "5M"
      • 5 MB
    • "10M"
      • 10 MB

--cache-info-age

How long to cache file structure information (directory listings, file size, times, etc.).
If all write operations are done through the cache then you can safely make
this value very large as the cache store will also be updated in real time.

  • Config: info_age
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_INFO_AGE
  • Type: Duration
  • Default: 6h0m0s
  • Examples:
    • "1h"
      • 1 hour
    • "24h"
      • 24 hours
    • "48h"
      • 48 hours

--cache-chunk-total-size

The total size that the chunks can take up on the local disk.

If the cache exceeds this value then it will start to delete the
oldest chunks until it goes under this value.

  • Config: chunk_total_size
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_CHUNK_TOTAL_SIZE
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 10G
  • Examples:
    • "500M"
      • 500 MB
    • "1G"
      • 1 GB
    • "10G"
      • 10 GB

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to cache (Cache a remote).

--cache-plex-token

The plex token for authentication - auto set normally

  • Config: plex_token
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_PLEX_TOKEN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--cache-plex-insecure

Skip all certificate verification when connecting to the Plex server

  • Config: plex_insecure
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_PLEX_INSECURE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--cache-db-path

Directory to store file structure metadata DB.
The remote name is used as the DB file name.

  • Config: db_path
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_DB_PATH
  • Type: string
  • Default: "$HOME/.cache/rclone/cache-backend"

--cache-chunk-path

Directory to cache chunk files.

Path to where partial file data (chunks) are stored locally. The remote
name is appended to the final path.

This config follows the "--cache-db-path". If you specify a custom
location for "--cache-db-path" and don't specify one for "--cache-chunk-path"
then "--cache-chunk-path" will use the same path as "--cache-db-path".

  • Config: chunk_path
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_CHUNK_PATH
  • Type: string
  • Default: "$HOME/.cache/rclone/cache-backend"

--cache-db-purge

Clear all the cached data for this remote on start.

  • Config: db_purge
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_DB_PURGE
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--cache-chunk-clean-interval

How often should the cache perform cleanups of the chunk storage.
The default value should be ok for most people. If you find that the
cache goes over "cache-chunk-total-size" too often then try to lower
this value to force it to perform cleanups more often.

  • Config: chunk_clean_interval
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_CHUNK_CLEAN_INTERVAL
  • Type: Duration
  • Default: 1m0s

--cache-read-retries

How many times to retry a read from a cache storage.

Since reading from a cache stream is independent from downloading file
data, readers can get to a point where there's no more data in the
cache. Most of the times this can indicate a connectivity issue if
cache isn't able to provide file data anymore.

For really slow connections, increase this to a point where the stream is
able to provide data but your experience will be very stuttering.

  • Config: read_retries
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_READ_RETRIES
  • Type: int
  • Default: 10

--cache-workers

How many workers should run in parallel to download chunks.

Higher values will mean more parallel processing (better CPU needed)
and more concurrent requests on the cloud provider. This impacts
several aspects like the cloud provider API limits, more stress on the
hardware that rclone runs on but it also means that streams will be
more fluid and data will be available much more faster to readers.

Note: If the optional Plex integration is enabled then this
setting will adapt to the type of reading performed and the value
specified here will be used as a maximum number of workers to use.

  • Config: workers
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_WORKERS
  • Type: int
  • Default: 4

--cache-chunk-no-memory

Disable the in-memory cache for storing chunks during streaming.

By default, cache will keep file data during streaming in RAM as well
to provide it to readers as fast as possible.

This transient data is evicted as soon as it is read and the number of
chunks stored doesn't exceed the number of workers. However, depending
on other settings like "cache-chunk-size" and "cache-workers" this footprint
can increase if there are parallel streams too (multiple files being read
at the same time).

If the hardware permits it, use this feature to provide an overall better
performance during streaming but it can also be disabled if RAM is not
available on the local machine.

  • Config: chunk_no_memory
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_CHUNK_NO_MEMORY
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--cache-rps

Limits the number of requests per second to the source FS (-1 to disable)

This setting places a hard limit on the number of requests per second
that cache will be doing to the cloud provider remote and try to
respect that value by setting waits between reads.

If you find that you're getting banned or limited on the cloud
provider through cache and know that a smaller number of requests per
second will allow you to work with it then you can use this setting
for that.

A good balance of all the other settings should make this setting
useless but it is available to set for more special cases.

NOTE: This will limit the number of requests during streams but
other API calls to the cloud provider like directory listings will
still pass.

  • Config: rps
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_RPS
  • Type: int
  • Default: -1

--cache-writes

Cache file data on writes through the FS

If you need to read files immediately after you upload them through
cache you can enable this flag to have their data stored in the
cache store at the same time during upload.

  • Config: writes
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_WRITES
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--cache-tmp-upload-path

Directory to keep temporary files until they are uploaded.

This is the path where cache will use as a temporary storage for new
files that need to be uploaded to the cloud provider.

Specifying a value will enable this feature. Without it, it is
completely disabled and files will be uploaded directly to the cloud
provider

  • Config: tmp_upload_path
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_TMP_UPLOAD_PATH
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--cache-tmp-wait-time

How long should files be stored in local cache before being uploaded

This is the duration that a file must wait in the temporary location
cache-tmp-upload-path before it is selected for upload.

Note that only one file is uploaded at a time and it can take longer
to start the upload if a queue formed for this purpose.

  • Config: tmp_wait_time
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_TMP_WAIT_TIME
  • Type: Duration
  • Default: 15s

--cache-db-wait-time

How long to wait for the DB to be available - 0 is unlimited

Only one process can have the DB open at any one time, so rclone waits
for this duration for the DB to become available before it gives an
error.

If you set it to 0 then it will wait forever.

  • Config: db_wait_time
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CACHE_DB_WAIT_TIME
  • Type: Duration
  • Default: 1s

Backend commands

Here are the commands specific to the cache backend.

Run them with

rclone backend COMMAND remote:

The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

See the "rclone backend" command for more
info on how to pass options and arguments.

These can be run on a running backend using the rc command
backend/command.

stats

Print stats on the cache backend in JSON format.

rclone backend stats remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

Chunker (BETA)

The chunker overlay transparently splits large files into smaller chunks
during upload to wrapped remote and transparently assembles them back
when the file is downloaded. This allows to effectively overcome size limits
imposed by storage providers.

To use it, first set up the underlying remote following the configuration
instructions for that remote. You can also use a local pathname instead of
a remote.

First check your chosen remote is working - we'll call it remote:path here.
Note that anything inside remote:path will be chunked and anything outside
won't. This means that if you are using a bucket based remote (e.g. S3, B2, swift)
then you should probably put the bucket in the remote s3:bucket.

Now configure chunker using rclone config. We will call this one overlay
to separate it from the remote itself.

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> overlay
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Transparently chunk/split large files
   \ "chunker"
[snip]
Storage> chunker
Remote to chunk/unchunk.
Normally should contain a ':' and a path, e.g. "myremote:path/to/dir",
"myremote:bucket" or maybe "myremote:" (not recommended).
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
remote> remote:path
Files larger than chunk size will be split in chunks.
Enter a size with suffix k,M,G,T. Press Enter for the default ("2G").
chunk_size> 100M
Choose how chunker handles hash sums. All modes but "none" require metadata.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("md5").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Pass any hash supported by wrapped remote for non-chunked files, return nothing otherwise
   \ "none"
 2 / MD5 for composite files
   \ "md5"
 3 / SHA1 for composite files
   \ "sha1"
 4 / MD5 for all files
   \ "md5all"
 5 / SHA1 for all files
   \ "sha1all"
 6 / Copying a file to chunker will request MD5 from the source falling back to SHA1 if unsupported
   \ "md5quick"
 7 / Similar to "md5quick" but prefers SHA1 over MD5
   \ "sha1quick"
hash_type> md5
Edit advanced config? (y/n)
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> n
Remote config
--------------------
[overlay]
type = chunker
remote = remote:bucket
chunk_size = 100M
hash_type = md5
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

Specifying the remote

In normal use, make sure the remote has a : in. If you specify the remote
without a : then rclone will use a local directory of that name.
So if you use a remote of /path/to/secret/files then rclone will
chunk stuff in that directory. If you use a remote of name then rclone
will put files in a directory called name in the current directory.

Chunking

When rclone starts a file upload, chunker checks the file size. If it
doesn't exceed the configured chunk size, chunker will just pass the file
to the wrapped remote. If a file is large, chunker will transparently cut
data in pieces with temporary names and stream them one by one, on the fly.
Each data chunk will contain the specified number of bytes, except for the
last one which may have less data. If file size is unknown in advance
(this is called a streaming upload), chunker will internally create
a temporary copy, record its size and repeat the above process.

When upload completes, temporary chunk files are finally renamed.
This scheme guarantees that operations can be run in parallel and look
from outside as atomic.
A similar method with hidden temporary chunks is used for other operations
(copy/move/rename, etc.). If an operation fails, hidden chunks are normally
destroyed, and the target composite file stays intact.

When a composite file download is requested, chunker transparently
assembles it by concatenating data chunks in order. As the split is trivial
one could even manually concatenate data chunks together to obtain the
original content.

When the list rclone command scans a directory on wrapped remote,
the potential chunk files are accounted for, grouped and assembled into
composite directory entries. Any temporary chunks are hidden.

List and other commands can sometimes come across composite files with
missing or invalid chunks, e.g. shadowed by like-named directory or
another file. This usually means that wrapped file system has been directly
tampered with or damaged. If chunker detects a missing chunk it will
by default print warning, skip the whole incomplete group of chunks but
proceed with current command.
You can set the --chunker-fail-hard flag to have commands abort with
error message in such cases.

Chunk names

The default chunk name format is *.rclone_chunk.###, hence by default
chunk names are BIG_FILE_NAME.rclone_chunk.001,
BIG_FILE_NAME.rclone_chunk.002 etc. You can configure another name format
using the name_format configuration file option. The format uses asterisk
* as a placeholder for the base file name and one or more consecutive
hash characters # as a placeholder for sequential chunk number.
There must be one and only one asterisk. The number of consecutive hash
characters defines the minimum length of a string representing a chunk number.
If decimal chunk number has less digits than the number of hashes, it is
left-padded by zeros. If the decimal string is longer, it is left intact.
By default numbering starts from 1 but there is another option that allows
user to start from 0, e.g. for compatibility with legacy software.

For example, if name format is big_*-##.part and original file name is
data.txt and numbering starts from 0, then the first chunk will be named
big_data.txt-00.part, the 99th chunk will be big_data.txt-98.part
and the 302nd chunk will become big_data.txt-301.part.

Note that list assembles composite directory entries only when chunk names
match the configured format and treats non-conforming file names as normal
non-chunked files.

Metadata

Besides data chunks chunker will by default create metadata object for
a composite file. The object is named after the original file.
Chunker allows user to disable metadata completely (the none format).
Note that metadata is normally not created for files smaller than the
configured chunk size. This may change in future rclone releases.

Simple JSON metadata format

This is the default format. It supports hash sums and chunk validation
for composite files. Meta objects carry the following fields:

  • ver - version of format, currently 1
  • size - total size of composite file
  • nchunks - number of data chunks in file
  • md5 - MD5 hashsum of composite file (if present)
  • sha1 - SHA1 hashsum (if present)

There is no field for composite file name as it's simply equal to the name
of meta object on the wrapped remote. Please refer to respective sections
for details on hashsums and modified time handling.

No metadata

You can disable meta objects by setting the meta format option to none.
In this mode chunker will scan directory for all files that follow
configured chunk name format, group them by detecting chunks with the same
base name and show group names as virtual composite files.
This method is more prone to missing chunk errors (especially missing
last chunk) than format with metadata enabled.

Hashsums

Chunker supports hashsums only when a compatible metadata is present.
Hence, if you choose metadata format of none, chunker will report hashsum
as UNSUPPORTED.

Please note that by default metadata is stored only for composite files.
If a file is smaller than configured chunk size, chunker will transparently
redirect hash requests to wrapped remote, so support depends on that.
You will see the empty string as a hashsum of requested type for small
files if the wrapped remote doesn't support it.

Many storage backends support MD5 and SHA1 hash types, so does chunker.
With chunker you can choose one or another but not both.
MD5 is set by default as the most supported type.
Since chunker keeps hashes for composite files and falls back to the
wrapped remote hash for non-chunked ones, we advise you to choose the same
hash type as supported by wrapped remote so that your file listings
look coherent.

If your storage backend does not support MD5 or SHA1 but you need consistent
file hashing, configure chunker with md5all or sha1all. These two modes
guarantee given hash for all files. If wrapped remote doesn't support it,
chunker will then add metadata to all files, even small. However, this can
double the amount of small files in storage and incur additional service charges.
You can even use chunker to force md5/sha1 support in any other remote
at expense of sidecar meta objects by setting e.g. chunk_type=sha1all
to force hashsums and chunk_size=1P to effectively disable chunking.

Normally, when a file is copied to chunker controlled remote, chunker
will ask the file source for compatible file hash and revert to on-the-fly
calculation if none is found. This involves some CPU overhead but provides
a guarantee that given hashsum is available. Also, chunker will reject
a server-side copy or move operation if source and destination hashsum
types are different resulting in the extra network bandwidth, too.
In some rare cases this may be undesired, so chunker provides two optional
choices: sha1quick and md5quick. If the source does not support primary
hash type and the quick mode is enabled, chunker will try to fall back to
the secondary type. This will save CPU and bandwidth but can result in empty
hashsums at destination. Beware of consequences: the sync command will
revert (sometimes silently) to time/size comparison if compatible hashsums
between source and target are not found.

Modified time

Chunker stores modification times using the wrapped remote so support
depends on that. For a small non-chunked file the chunker overlay simply
manipulates modification time of the wrapped remote file.
For a composite file with metadata chunker will get and set
modification time of the metadata object on the wrapped remote.
If file is chunked but metadata format is none then chunker will
use modification time of the first data chunk.

Migrations

The idiomatic way to migrate to a different chunk size, hash type or
chunk naming scheme is to:

  • Collect all your chunked files under a directory and have your
    chunker remote point to it.
  • Create another directory (most probably on the same cloud storage)
    and configure a new remote with desired metadata format,
    hash type, chunk naming etc.
  • Now run rclone sync -i oldchunks: newchunks: and all your data
    will be transparently converted in transfer.
    This may take some time, yet chunker will try server-side
    copy if possible.
  • After checking data integrity you may remove configuration section
    of the old remote.

If rclone gets killed during a long operation on a big composite file,
hidden temporary chunks may stay in the directory. They will not be
shown by the list command but will eat up your account quota.
Please note that the deletefile command deletes only active
chunks of a file. As a workaround, you can use remote of the wrapped
file system to see them.
An easy way to get rid of hidden garbage is to copy littered directory
somewhere using the chunker remote and purge the original directory.
The copy command will copy only active chunks while the purge will
remove everything including garbage.

Caveats and Limitations

Chunker requires wrapped remote to support server-side move (or copy +
delete) operations, otherwise it will explicitly refuse to start.
This is because it internally renames temporary chunk files to their final
names when an operation completes successfully.

Chunker encodes chunk number in file name, so with default name_format
setting it adds 17 characters. Also chunker adds 7 characters of temporary
suffix during operations. Many file systems limit base file name without path
by 255 characters. Using rclone's crypt remote as a base file system limits
file name by 143 characters. Thus, maximum name length is 231 for most files
and 119 for chunker-over-crypt. A user in need can change name format to
e.g. *.rcc## and save 10 characters (provided at most 99 chunks per file).

Note that a move implemented using the copy-and-delete method may incur
double charging with some cloud storage providers.

Chunker will not automatically rename existing chunks when you run
rclone config on a live remote and change the chunk name format.
Beware that in result of this some files which have been treated as chunks
before the change can pop up in directory listings as normal files
and vice versa. The same warning holds for the chunk size.
If you desperately need to change critical chunking settings, you should
run data migration as described above.

If wrapped remote is case insensitive, the chunker overlay will inherit
that property (so you can't have a file called "Hello.doc" and "hello.doc"
in the same directory).

Chunker included in rclone releases up to v1.54 can sometimes fail to
detect metadata produced by recent versions of rclone. We recommend users
to keep rclone up-to-date to avoid data corruption.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to chunker (Transparently chunk/split large files).

--chunker-remote

Remote to chunk/unchunk.
Normally should contain a ':' and a path, e.g. "myremote:path/to/dir",
"myremote:bucket" or maybe "myremote:" (not recommended).

  • Config: remote
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_REMOTE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--chunker-chunk-size

Files larger than chunk size will be split in chunks.

  • Config: chunk_size
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_CHUNK_SIZE
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 2G

--chunker-hash-type

Choose how chunker handles hash sums. All modes but "none" require metadata.

  • Config: hash_type
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_HASH_TYPE
  • Type: string
  • Default: "md5"
  • Examples:
    • "none"
      • Pass any hash supported by wrapped remote for non-chunked files, return nothing otherwise
    • "md5"
      • MD5 for composite files
    • "sha1"
      • SHA1 for composite files
    • "md5all"
      • MD5 for all files
    • "sha1all"
      • SHA1 for all files
    • "md5quick"
      • Copying a file to chunker will request MD5 from the source falling back to SHA1 if unsupported
    • "sha1quick"
      • Similar to "md5quick" but prefers SHA1 over MD5

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to chunker (Transparently chunk/split large files).

--chunker-name-format

String format of chunk file names.
The two placeholders are: base file name (*) and chunk number (#...).
There must be one and only one asterisk and one or more consecutive hash characters.
If chunk number has less digits than the number of hashes, it is left-padded by zeros.
If there are more digits in the number, they are left as is.
Possible chunk files are ignored if their name does not match given format.

  • Config: name_format
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_NAME_FORMAT
  • Type: string
  • Default: "*.rclone_chunk.###"

--chunker-start-from

Minimum valid chunk number. Usually 0 or 1.
By default chunk numbers start from 1.

  • Config: start_from
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_START_FROM
  • Type: int
  • Default: 1

--chunker-meta-format

Format of the metadata object or "none". By default "simplejson".
Metadata is a small JSON file named after the composite file.

  • Config: meta_format
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_META_FORMAT
  • Type: string
  • Default: "simplejson"
  • Examples:
    • "none"
      • Do not use metadata files at all. Requires hash type "none".
    • "simplejson"
      • Simple JSON supports hash sums and chunk validation.
      • It has the following fields: ver, size, nchunks, md5, sha1.

--chunker-fail-hard

Choose how chunker should handle files with missing or invalid chunks.

  • Config: fail_hard
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CHUNKER_FAIL_HARD
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false
  • Examples:
    • "true"
      • Report errors and abort current command.
    • "false"
      • Warn user, skip incomplete file and proceed.

Citrix ShareFile

Citrix ShareFile is a secure file sharing and transfer service aimed as business.

The initial setup for Citrix ShareFile involves getting a token from
Citrix ShareFile which you can in your browser. rclone config walks you
through it.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
XX / Citrix Sharefile
   \ "sharefile"
Storage> sharefile
** See help for sharefile backend at: https://rclone.org/sharefile/ **

ID of the root folder

Leave blank to access "Personal Folders".  You can use one of the
standard values here or any folder ID (long hex number ID).
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Access the Personal Folders. (Default)
   \ ""
 2 / Access the Favorites folder.
   \ "favorites"
 3 / Access all the shared folders.
   \ "allshared"
 4 / Access all the individual connectors.
   \ "connectors"
 5 / Access the home, favorites, and shared folders as well as the connectors.
   \ "top"
root_folder_id> 
Edit advanced config? (y/n)
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> n
Remote config
Use auto config?
 * Say Y if not sure
 * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> y
If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth?state=XXX
Log in and authorize rclone for access
Waiting for code...
Got code
--------------------
[remote]
type = sharefile
endpoint = https://XXX.sharefile.com
token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"bearer","refresh_token":"XXX","expiry":"2019-09-30T19:41:45.878561877+01:00"}
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

See the remote setup docs for how to set it up on a
machine with no Internet browser available.

Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the
token as returned from Citrix ShareFile. This only runs from the moment it opens
your browser to the moment you get back the verification code. This
is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require you to unblock
it temporarily if you are running a host firewall.

Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

List directories in top level of your ShareFile

rclone lsd remote:

List all the files in your ShareFile

rclone ls remote:

To copy a local directory to an ShareFile directory called backup

rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

Modified time and hashes

ShareFile allows modification times to be set on objects accurate to 1
second. These will be used to detect whether objects need syncing or
not.

ShareFile supports MD5 type hashes, so you can use the --checksum
flag.

Transfers

For files above 128MB rclone will use a chunked transfer. Rclone will
upload up to --transfers chunks at the same time (shared among all
the multipart uploads). Chunks are buffered in memory and are
normally 64MB so increasing --transfers will increase memory use.

Limitations

Note that ShareFile is case insensitive so you can't have a file called
"Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

ShareFile only supports filenames up to 256 characters in length.

Restricted filename characters

In addition to the default restricted characters set
the following characters are also replaced:

Character Value Replacement
\ 0x5C
* 0x2A
< 0x3C
> 0x3E
? 0x3F
: 0x3A
| 0x7C
" 0x22

File names can also not start or end with the following characters.
These only get replaced if they are the first or last character in the
name:

Character Value Replacement
SP 0x20
. 0x2E

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to sharefile (Citrix Sharefile).

--sharefile-root-folder-id

ID of the root folder

Leave blank to access "Personal Folders". You can use one of the
standard values here or any folder ID (long hex number ID).

  • Config: root_folder_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SHAREFILE_ROOT_FOLDER_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • ""
      • Access the Personal Folders. (Default)
    • "favorites"
      • Access the Favorites folder.
    • "allshared"
      • Access all the shared folders.
    • "connectors"
      • Access all the individual connectors.
    • "top"
      • Access the home, favorites, and shared folders as well as the connectors.

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to sharefile (Citrix Sharefile).

--sharefile-upload-cutoff

Cutoff for switching to multipart upload.

  • Config: upload_cutoff
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SHAREFILE_UPLOAD_CUTOFF
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 128M

--sharefile-chunk-size

Upload chunk size. Must a power of 2 >= 256k.

Making this larger will improve performance, but note that each chunk
is buffered in memory one per transfer.

Reducing this will reduce memory usage but decrease performance.

  • Config: chunk_size
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SHAREFILE_CHUNK_SIZE
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 64M

--sharefile-endpoint

Endpoint for API calls.

This is usually auto discovered as part of the oauth process, but can
be set manually to something like: https://XXX.sharefile.com

  • Config: endpoint
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SHAREFILE_ENDPOINT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sharefile-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SHAREFILE_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Ctl,LeftSpace,LeftPeriod,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

rclone about is not supported by the Citrix ShareFile backend. Backends without
this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or
use policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union
remote.

See List of backends that do not support rclone about
See rclone about

Crypt

Rclone crypt remotes encrypt and decrypt other remotes.

A remote of type crypt does not access a storage system
directly, but instead wraps another remote, which in turn accesses
the storage system. This is similar to how alias,
union, chunker
and a few others work. It makes the usage very flexible, as you can
add a layer, in this case an encryption layer, on top of any other
backend, even in multiple layers. Rclone's functionality
can be used as with any other remote, for example you can
mount a crypt remote.

Accessing a storage system through a crypt remote realizes client-side
encryption, which makes it safe to keep your data in a location you do
not trust will not get compromised.
When working against the crypt remote, rclone will automatically
encrypt (before uploading) and decrypt (after downloading) on your local
system as needed on the fly, leaving the data encrypted at rest in the
wrapped remote. If you access the storage system using an application
other than rclone, or access the wrapped remote directly using rclone,
there will not be any encryption/decryption: Downloading existing content
will just give you the encrypted (scrambled) format, and anything you
upload will not become encrypted.

The encryption is a secret-key encryption (also called symmetric key encryption)
algorithm, where a password (or pass phrase) is used to generate real encryption key.
The password can be supplied by user, or you may chose to let rclone
generate one. It will be stored in the configuration file, in a lightly obscured form.
If you are in an environment where you are not able to keep your configuration
secured, you should add
configuration encryption
as protection. As long as you have this configuration file, you will be able to
decrypt your data. Without the configuration file, as long as you remember
the password (or keep it in a safe place), you can re-create the configuration
and gain access to the existing data. You may also configure a corresponding
remote in a different installation to access the same data.
See below for guidance to changing password.

Encryption uses cryptographic salt,
to permute the encryption key so that the same string may be encrypted in
different ways. When configuring the crypt remote it is optional to enter a salt,
or to let rclone generate a unique salt. If omitted, rclone uses a built-in unique string.
Normally in cryptography, the salt is stored together with the encrypted content,
and do not have to be memorized by the user. This is not the case in rclone,
because rclone does not store any additional information on the remotes. Use of
custom salt is effectively a second password that must be memorized.

File content encryption is performed using
NaCl SecretBox,
based on XSalsa20 cipher and Poly1305 for integrity.
Names (file- and directory names) are also encrypted
by default, but this has some implications and is therefore
possible to turned off.

Configuration

Here is an example of how to make a remote called secret.

To use crypt, first set up the underlying remote. Follow the
rclone config instructions for the specific backend.

Before configuring the crypt remote, check the underlying remote is
working. In this example the underlying remote is called remote.
We will configure a path path within this remote to contain the
encrypted content. Anything inside remote:path will be encrypted
and anything outside will not.

Configure crypt using rclone config. In this example the crypt
remote is called secret, to differentiate it from the underlying
remote.

When you are done you can use the crypt remote named secret just
as you would with any other remote, e.g. rclone copy D:\docs secret:\docs,
and rclone will encrypt and decrypt as needed on the fly.
If you access the wrapped remote remote:path directly you will bypass
the encryption, and anything you read will be in encrypted form, and
anything you write will be undencrypted. To avoid issues it is best to
configure a dedicated path for encrypted content, and access it
exclusively through a crypt remote.

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> secret
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Encrypt/Decrypt a remote
   \ "crypt"
[snip]
Storage> crypt
** See help for crypt backend at: https://rclone.org/crypt/ **

Remote to encrypt/decrypt.
Normally should contain a ':' and a path, eg "myremote:path/to/dir",
"myremote:bucket" or maybe "myremote:" (not recommended).
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
remote> remote:path
How to encrypt the filenames.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("standard").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Encrypt the filenames see the docs for the details.
   \ "standard"
 2 / Very simple filename obfuscation.
   \ "obfuscate"
 3 / Don't encrypt the file names.  Adds a ".bin" extension only.
   \ "off"
filename_encryption>
Option to either encrypt directory names or leave them intact.

NB If filename_encryption is "off" then this option will do nothing.
Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("true").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Encrypt directory names.
   \ "true"
 2 / Don't encrypt directory names, leave them intact.
   \ "false"
directory_name_encryption>
Password or pass phrase for encryption.
y) Yes type in my own password
g) Generate random password
y/g> y
Enter the password:
password:
Confirm the password:
password:
Password or pass phrase for salt. Optional but recommended.
Should be different to the previous password.
y) Yes type in my own password
g) Generate random password
n) No leave this optional password blank (default)
y/g/n> g
Password strength in bits.
64 is just about memorable
128 is secure
1024 is the maximum
Bits> 128
Your password is: JAsJvRcgR-_veXNfy_sGmQ
Use this password? Please note that an obscured version of this
password (and not the password itself) will be stored under your
configuration file, so keep this generated password in a safe place.
y) Yes (default)
n) No
y/n>
Edit advanced config? (y/n)
y) Yes
n) No (default)
y/n>
Remote config
--------------------
[secret]
type = crypt
remote = remote:path
password = *** ENCRYPTED ***
password2 = *** ENCRYPTED ***
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK (default)
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d>

Important The crypt password stored in rclone.conf is lightly
obscured. That only protects it from cursory inspection. It is not
secure unless configuration encryption of rclone.conf is specified.

A long passphrase is recommended, or rclone config can generate a
random one.

The obscured password is created using AES-CTR with a static key. The
salt is stored verbatim at the beginning of the obscured password. This
static key is shared between all versions of rclone.

If you reconfigure rclone with the same passwords/passphrases
elsewhere it will be compatible, but the obscured version will be different
due to the different salt.

Rclone does not encrypt

  • file length - this can be calculated within 16 bytes
  • modification time - used for syncing

Specifying the remote

When configuring the remote to encrypt/decrypt, you may specify any
string that rclone accepts as a source/destination of other commands.

The primary use case is to specify the path into an already configured
remote (e.g. remote:path/to/dir or remote:bucket), such that
data in a remote untrusted location can be stored encrypted.

You may also specify a local filesystem path, such as
/path/to/dir on Linux, C:\path\to\dir on Windows. By creating
a crypt remote pointing to such a local filesystem path, you can
use rclone as a utility for pure local file encryption, for example
to keep encrypted files on a removable USB drive.

Note: A string which do not contain a : will by rclone be treated
as a relative path in the local filesystem. For example, if you enter
the name remote without the trailing :, it will be treated as
a subdirectory of the current directory with name "remote".

If a path remote:path/to/dir is specified, rclone stores encrypted
files in path/to/dir on the remote. With file name encryption, files
saved to secret:subdir/subfile are stored in the unencrypted path
path/to/dir but the subdir/subpath element is encrypted.

The path you specify does not have to exist, rclone will create
it when needed.

If you intend to use the wrapped remote both directly for keeping
unencrypted content, as well as through a crypt remote for encrypted
content, it is recommended to point the crypt remote to a separate
directory within the wrapped remote. If you use a bucket based storage
system (e.g. Swift, S3, Google Compute Storage, B2, Hubic) it is generally
advisable to wrap the crypt remote around a specific bucket (s3:bucket).
If wrapping around the entire root of the storage (s3:), and use the
optional file name encryption, rclone will encrypt the bucket name.

Changing password

Should the password, or the configuration file containing a lightly obscured
form of the password, be compromised, you need to re-encrypt your data with
a new password. Since rclone uses secret-key encryption, where the encryption
key is generated directly from the password kept on the client, it is not
possible to change the password/key of already encrypted content. Just changing
the password configured for an existing crypt remote means you will no longer
able to decrypt any of the previously encrypted content. The only possibility
is to re-upload everything via a crypt remote configured with your new password.

Depending on the size of your data, your bandwith, storage quota etc, there are
different approaches you can take:

  • If you have everything in a different location, for example on your local system,
    you could remove all of the prior encrypted files, change the password for your
    configured crypt remote (or delete and re-create the crypt configuration),
    and then re-upload everything from the alternative location.
  • If you have enough space on the storage system you can create a new crypt
    remote pointing to a separate directory on the same backend, and then use
    rclone to copy everything from the original crypt remote to the new,
    effectively decrypting everything on the fly using the old password and
    re-encrypting using the new password. When done, delete the original crypt
    remote directory and finally the rclone crypt configuration with the old password.
    All data will be streamed from the storage system and back, so you will
    get half the bandwith and be charged twice if you have upload and download quota
    on the storage system.

Note: A security problem related to the random password generator
was fixed in rclone version 1.53.3 (released 2020-11-19). Passwords generated
by rclone config in version 1.49.0 (released 2019-08-26) to 1.53.2
(released 2020-10-26) are not considered secure and should be changed.
If you made up your own password, or used rclone version older than 1.49.0 or
newer than 1.53.2 to generate it, you are not affected by this issue.
See issue #4783 for more
details, and a tool you can use to check if you are affected.

Example

Create the following file structure using "standard" file name
encryption.

plaintext/
├── file0.txt
├── file1.txt
└── subdir
    ├── file2.txt
    ├── file3.txt
    └── subsubdir
        └── file4.txt

Copy these to the remote, and list them

$ rclone -q copy plaintext secret:
$ rclone -q ls secret:
        7 file1.txt
        6 file0.txt
        8 subdir/file2.txt
       10 subdir/subsubdir/file4.txt
        9 subdir/file3.txt

The crypt remote looks like

$ rclone -q ls remote:path
       55 hagjclgavj2mbiqm6u6cnjjqcg
       54 v05749mltvv1tf4onltun46gls
       57 86vhrsv86mpbtd3a0akjuqslj8/dlj7fkq4kdq72emafg7a7s41uo
       58 86vhrsv86mpbtd3a0akjuqslj8/7uu829995du6o42n32otfhjqp4/b9pausrfansjth5ob3jkdqd4lc
       56 86vhrsv86mpbtd3a0akjuqslj8/8njh1sk437gttmep3p70g81aps

The directory structure is preserved

$ rclone -q ls secret:subdir
        8 file2.txt
        9 file3.txt
       10 subsubdir/file4.txt

Without file name encryption .bin extensions are added to underlying
names. This prevents the cloud provider attempting to interpret file
content.

$ rclone -q ls remote:path
       54 file0.txt.bin
       57 subdir/file3.txt.bin
       56 subdir/file2.txt.bin
       58 subdir/subsubdir/file4.txt.bin
       55 file1.txt.bin

File name encryption modes

Off

  • doesn't hide file names or directory structure
  • allows for longer file names (~246 characters)
  • can use sub paths and copy single files

Standard

  • file names encrypted
  • file names can't be as long (~143 characters)
  • can use sub paths and copy single files
  • directory structure visible
  • identical files names will have identical uploaded names
  • can use shortcuts to shorten the directory recursion

Obfuscation

This is a simple "rotate" of the filename, with each file having a rot
distance based on the filename. Rclone stores the distance at the
beginning of the filename. A file called "hello" may become "53.jgnnq".

Obfuscation is not a strong encryption of filenames, but hinders
automated scanning tools picking up on filename patterns. It is an
intermediate between "off" and "standard" which allows for longer path
segment names.

There is a possibility with some unicode based filenames that the
obfuscation is weak and may map lower case characters to upper case
equivalents.

Obfuscation cannot be relied upon for strong protection.

  • file names very lightly obfuscated
  • file names can be longer than standard encryption
  • can use sub paths and copy single files
  • directory structure visible
  • identical files names will have identical uploaded names

Cloud storage systems have limits on file name length and
total path length which rclone is more likely to breach using
"Standard" file name encryption. Where file names are less thn 156
characters in length issues should not be encountered, irrespective of
cloud storage provider.

An alternative, future rclone file name encryption mode may tolerate
backend provider path length limits.

Directory name encryption

Crypt offers the option of encrypting dir names or leaving them intact.
There are two options:

True

Encrypts the whole file path including directory names
Example:
1/12/123.txt is encrypted to
p0e52nreeaj0a5ea7s64m4j72s/l42g6771hnv3an9cgc8cr2n1ng/qgm4avr35m5loi1th53ato71v0

False

Only encrypts file names, skips directory names
Example:
1/12/123.txt is encrypted to
1/12/qgm4avr35m5loi1th53ato71v0

Modified time and hashes

Crypt stores modification times using the underlying remote so support
depends on that.

Hashes are not stored for crypt. However the data integrity is
protected by an extremely strong crypto authenticator.

Use the rclone cryptcheck command to check the
integrity of a crypted remote instead of rclone check which can't
check the checksums properly.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to crypt (Encrypt/Decrypt a remote).

--crypt-remote

Remote to encrypt/decrypt.
Normally should contain a ':' and a path, e.g. "myremote:path/to/dir",
"myremote:bucket" or maybe "myremote:" (not recommended).

  • Config: remote
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_REMOTE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--crypt-filename-encryption

How to encrypt the filenames.

  • Config: filename_encryption
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_FILENAME_ENCRYPTION
  • Type: string
  • Default: "standard"
  • Examples:
    • "standard"
      • Encrypt the filenames see the docs for the details.
    • "obfuscate"
      • Very simple filename obfuscation.
    • "off"
      • Don't encrypt the file names. Adds a ".bin" extension only.

--crypt-directory-name-encryption

Option to either encrypt directory names or leave them intact.

NB If filename_encryption is "off" then this option will do nothing.

  • Config: directory_name_encryption
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_DIRECTORY_NAME_ENCRYPTION
  • Type: bool
  • Default: true
  • Examples:
    • "true"
      • Encrypt directory names.
    • "false"
      • Don't encrypt directory names, leave them intact.

--crypt-password

Password or pass phrase for encryption.

NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure.

  • Config: password
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_PASSWORD
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--crypt-password2

Password or pass phrase for salt. Optional but recommended.
Should be different to the previous password.

NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure.

  • Config: password2
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_PASSWORD2
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to crypt (Encrypt/Decrypt a remote).

--crypt-server-side-across-configs

Allow server-side operations (e.g. copy) to work across different crypt configs.

Normally this option is not what you want, but if you have two crypts
pointing to the same backend you can use it.

This can be used, for example, to change file name encryption type
without re-uploading all the data. Just make two crypt backends
pointing to two different directories with the single changed
parameter and use rclone move to move the files between the crypt
remotes.

  • Config: server_side_across_configs
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_SERVER_SIDE_ACROSS_CONFIGS
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--crypt-show-mapping

For all files listed show how the names encrypt.

If this flag is set then for each file that the remote is asked to
list, it will log (at level INFO) a line stating the decrypted file
name and the encrypted file name.

This is so you can work out which encrypted names are which decrypted
names just in case you need to do something with the encrypted file
names, or for debugging purposes.

  • Config: show_mapping
  • Env Var: RCLONE_CRYPT_SHOW_MAPPING
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

Backend commands

Here are the commands specific to the crypt backend.

Run them with

rclone backend COMMAND remote:

The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

See the "rclone backend" command for more
info on how to pass options and arguments.

These can be run on a running backend using the rc command
backend/command.

encode

Encode the given filename(s)

rclone backend encode remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

This encodes the filenames given as arguments returning a list of
strings of the encoded results.

Usage Example:

rclone backend encode crypt: file1 [file2...]
rclone rc backend/command command=encode fs=crypt: file1 [file2...]

decode

Decode the given filename(s)

rclone backend decode remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

This decodes the filenames given as arguments returning a list of
strings of the decoded results. It will return an error if any of the
inputs are invalid.

Usage Example:

rclone backend decode crypt: encryptedfile1 [encryptedfile2...]
rclone rc backend/command command=decode fs=crypt: encryptedfile1 [encryptedfile2...]

Backing up a crypted remote

If you wish to backup a crypted remote, it is recommended that you use
rclone sync on the encrypted files, and make sure the passwords are
the same in the new encrypted remote.

This will have the following advantages

  • rclone sync will check the checksums while copying
  • you can use rclone check between the encrypted remotes
  • you don't decrypt and encrypt unnecessarily

For example, let's say you have your original remote at remote: with
the encrypted version at eremote: with path remote:crypt. You
would then set up the new remote remote2: and then the encrypted
version eremote2: with path remote2:crypt using the same passwords
as eremote:.

To sync the two remotes you would do

rclone sync -i remote:crypt remote2:crypt

And to check the integrity you would do

rclone check remote:crypt remote2:crypt

File formats

File encryption

Files are encrypted 1:1 source file to destination object. The file
has a header and is divided into chunks.

Header

  • 8 bytes magic string RCLONE\x00\x00
  • 24 bytes Nonce (IV)

The initial nonce is generated from the operating systems crypto
strong random number generator. The nonce is incremented for each
chunk read making sure each nonce is unique for each block written.
The chance of a nonce being re-used is minuscule. If you wrote an
exabyte of data (10¹⁸ bytes) you would have a probability of
approximately 2×10⁻³² of re-using a nonce.

Chunk

Each chunk will contain 64kB of data, except for the last one which
may have less data. The data chunk is in standard NaCl SecretBox
format. SecretBox uses XSalsa20 and Poly1305 to encrypt and
authenticate messages.

Each chunk contains:

  • 16 Bytes of Poly1305 authenticator
  • 1 - 65536 bytes XSalsa20 encrypted data

64k chunk size was chosen as the best performing chunk size (the
authenticator takes too much time below this and the performance drops
off due to cache effects above this). Note that these chunks are
buffered in memory so they can't be too big.

This uses a 32 byte (256 bit key) key derived from the user password.

Examples

1 byte file will encrypt to

  • 32 bytes header
  • 17 bytes data chunk

49 bytes total

1MB (1048576 bytes) file will encrypt to

  • 32 bytes header
  • 16 chunks of 65568 bytes

1049120 bytes total (a 0.05% overhead). This is the overhead for big
files.

Name encryption

File names are encrypted segment by segment - the path is broken up
into / separated strings and these are encrypted individually.

File segments are padded using PKCS#7 to a multiple of 16 bytes
before encryption.

They are then encrypted with EME using AES with 256 bit key. EME
(ECB-Mix-ECB) is a wide-block encryption mode presented in the 2003
paper "A Parallelizable Enciphering Mode" by Halevi and Rogaway.

This makes for deterministic encryption which is what we want - the
same filename must encrypt to the same thing otherwise we can't find
it on the cloud storage system.

This means that

  • filenames with the same name will encrypt the same
  • filenames which start the same won't have a common prefix

This uses a 32 byte key (256 bits) and a 16 byte (128 bits) IV both of
which are derived from the user password.

After encryption they are written out using a modified version of
standard base32 encoding as described in RFC4648. The standard
encoding is modified in two ways:

  • it becomes lower case (no-one likes upper case filenames!)
  • we strip the padding character =

base32 is used rather than the more efficient base64 so rclone can be
used on case insensitive remotes (e.g. Windows, Amazon Drive).

Key derivation

Rclone uses scrypt with parameters N=16384, r=8, p=1 with an
optional user supplied salt (password2) to derive the 32+32+16 = 80
bytes of key material required. If the user doesn't supply a salt
then rclone uses an internal one.

scrypt makes it impractical to mount a dictionary attack on rclone
encrypted data. For full protection against this you should always use
a salt.

SEE ALSO

Compress (Experimental)

Warning

This remote is currently experimental. Things may break and data may be lost. Anything you do with this remote is
at your own risk. Please understand the risks associated with using experimental code and don't use this remote in
critical applications.

The Compress remote adds compression to another remote. It is best used with remotes containing
many large compressible files.

To use this remote, all you need to do is specify another remote and a compression mode to use:

Current remotes:

Name                 Type
====                 ====
remote_to_press      sometype

e) Edit existing remote
$ rclone config
n) New remote
d) Delete remote
r) Rename remote
c) Copy remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
e/n/d/r/c/s/q> n
name> compress
...
 8 / Compress a remote
   \ "compress"
...
Storage> compress
** See help for compress backend at: https://rclone.org/compress/ **

Remote to compress.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
remote> remote_to_press:subdir 
Compression mode.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("gzip").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Gzip compression balanced for speed and compression strength.
   \ "gzip"
compression_mode> gzip
Edit advanced config? (y/n)
y) Yes
n) No (default)
y/n> n
Remote config
--------------------
[compress]
type = compress
remote = remote_to_press:subdir
compression_mode = gzip
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK (default)
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

Compression Modes

Currently only gzip compression is supported, it provides a decent balance between speed and strength and is well
supported by other application. Compression strength can further be configured via an advanced setting where 0 is no
compression and 9 is strongest compression.

Filetype

If you open a remote wrapped by press, you will see that there are many files with an extension corresponding to
the compression algorithm you chose. These files are standard files that can be opened by various archive programs,
but they have some hidden metadata that allows them to be used by rclone.
While you may download and decompress these files at will, do not manually delete or rename files. Files without
correct metadata files will not be recognized by rclone.

File names

The compressed files will be named *.###########.gz where * is the base file and the # part is base64 encoded
size of the uncompressed file. The file names should not be changed by anything other than the rclone compression backend.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to compress (Compress a remote).

--compress-remote

Remote to compress.

  • Config: remote
  • Env Var: RCLONE_COMPRESS_REMOTE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--compress-mode

Compression mode.

  • Config: mode
  • Env Var: RCLONE_COMPRESS_MODE
  • Type: string
  • Default: "gzip"
  • Examples:
    • "gzip"
      • Standard gzip compression with fastest parameters.

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to compress (Compress a remote).

--compress-level

GZIP compression level (-2 to 9).

		Generally -1 (default, equivalent to 5) is recommended.
		Levels 1 to 9 increase compressiong at the cost of speed.. Going past 6 
		generally offers very little return.
		
		Level -2 uses Huffmann encoding only. Only use if you now what you
		are doing
		Level 0 turns off compression.
  • Config: level
  • Env Var: RCLONE_COMPRESS_LEVEL
  • Type: int
  • Default: -1

--compress-ram-cache-limit

Some remotes don't allow the upload of files with unknown size.
In this case the compressed file will need to be cached to determine
it's size.

			   Files smaller than this limit will be cached in RAM, file larger than 
			   this limit will be cached on disk
  • Config: ram_cache_limit
  • Env Var: RCLONE_COMPRESS_RAM_CACHE_LIMIT
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 20M

Dropbox

Paths are specified as remote:path

Dropbox paths may be as deep as required, e.g.
remote:directory/subdirectory.

The initial setup for dropbox involves getting a token from Dropbox
which you need to do in your browser. rclone config walks you
through it.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

n) New remote
d) Delete remote
q) Quit config
e/n/d/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Dropbox
   \ "dropbox"
[snip]
Storage> dropbox
Dropbox App Key - leave blank normally.
app_key>
Dropbox App Secret - leave blank normally.
app_secret>
Remote config
Please visit:
https://www.dropbox.com/1/oauth2/authorize?client_id=XXXXXXXXXXXXXXX&response_type=code
Enter the code: XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX_XXXXXXXXXX
--------------------
[remote]
app_key =
app_secret =
token = XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX_XXXX_XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

You can then use it like this,

List directories in top level of your dropbox

rclone lsd remote:

List all the files in your dropbox

rclone ls remote:

To copy a local directory to a dropbox directory called backup

rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Dropbox for business

Rclone supports Dropbox for business and Team Folders.

When using Dropbox for business remote: and remote:path/to/file
will refer to your personal folder.

If you wish to see Team Folders you must use a leading / in the
path, so rclone lsd remote:/ will refer to the root and show you all
Team Folders and your User Folder.

You can then use team folders like this remote:/TeamFolder and
remote:/TeamFolder/path/to/file.

A leading / for a Dropbox personal account will do nothing, but it
will take an extra HTTP transaction so it should be avoided.

Modified time and Hashes

Dropbox supports modified times, but the only way to set a
modification time is to re-upload the file.

This means that if you uploaded your data with an older version of
rclone which didn't support the v2 API and modified times, rclone will
decide to upload all your old data to fix the modification times. If
you don't want this to happen use --size-only or --checksum flag
to stop it.

Dropbox supports its own hash
type
which
is checked for all transfers.

Restricted filename characters

Character Value Replacement
NUL 0x00
/ 0x2F
DEL 0x7F
\ 0x5C

File names can also not end with the following characters.
These only get replaced if they are the last character in the name:

Character Value Replacement
SP 0x20

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to dropbox (Dropbox).

--dropbox-client-id

OAuth Client Id
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: client_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_CLIENT_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--dropbox-client-secret

OAuth Client Secret
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: client_secret
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_CLIENT_SECRET
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to dropbox (Dropbox).

--dropbox-token

OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

  • Config: token
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_TOKEN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--dropbox-auth-url

Auth server URL.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: auth_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_AUTH_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--dropbox-token-url

Token server url.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: token_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_TOKEN_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--dropbox-chunk-size

Upload chunk size. (< 150M).

Any files larger than this will be uploaded in chunks of this size.

Note that chunks are buffered in memory (one at a time) so rclone can
deal with retries. Setting this larger will increase the speed
slightly (at most 10% for 128MB in tests) at the cost of using more
memory. It can be set smaller if you are tight on memory.

  • Config: chunk_size
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_CHUNK_SIZE
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 48M

--dropbox-impersonate

Impersonate this user when using a business account.

  • Config: impersonate
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_IMPERSONATE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--dropbox-shared-files

Instructs rclone to work on individual shared files.

In this mode rclone's features are extremely limited - only list (ls, lsl, etc.)
operations and read operations (e.g. downloading) are supported in this mode.
All other operations will be disabled.

  • Config: shared_files
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_SHARED_FILES
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--dropbox-shared-folders

Instructs rclone to work on shared folders.

When this flag is used with no path only the List operation is supported and
all available shared folders will be listed. If you specify a path the first part
will be interpreted as the name of shared folder. Rclone will then try to mount this
shared to the root namespace. On success shared folder rclone proceeds normally.
The shared folder is now pretty much a normal folder and all normal operations
are supported.

Note that we don't unmount the shared folder afterwards so the
--dropbox-shared-folders can be omitted after the first use of a particular
shared folder.

  • Config: shared_folders
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_SHARED_FOLDERS
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--dropbox-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DROPBOX_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,RightSpace,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

Note that Dropbox is case insensitive so you can't have a file called
"Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

There are some file names such as thumbs.db which Dropbox can't
store. There is a full list of them in the "Ignored Files" section
of this document
. Rclone will
issue an error message File name disallowed - not uploading if it
attempts to upload one of those file names, but the sync won't fail.

Some errors may occur if you try to sync copyright-protected files
because Dropbox has its own copyright detector that
prevents this sort of file being downloaded. This will return the error ERROR : /path/to/your/file: Failed to copy: failed to open source object: path/restricted_content/.

If you have more than 10,000 files in a directory then rclone purge dropbox:dir will return the error Failed to purge: There are too many files involved in this operation. As a work-around do an
rclone delete dropbox:dir followed by an rclone rmdir dropbox:dir.

Get your own Dropbox App ID

When you use rclone with Dropbox in its default configuration you are using rclone's App ID. This is shared between all the rclone users.

Here is how to create your own Dropbox App ID for rclone:

  1. Log into the Dropbox App console with your Dropbox Account (It need not
    to be the same account as the Dropbox you want to access)

  2. Choose an API => Usually this should be Dropbox API

  3. Choose the type of access you want to use => Full Dropbox or App Folder

  4. Name your App. The app name is global, so you can't use rclone for example

  5. Click the button Create App

  6. Fill Redirect URIs as http://localhost:53682/

  7. Find the App key and App secret Use these values in rclone config to add a new remote or edit an existing remote.

Enterprise File Fabric

This backend supports Storage Made Easy's Enterprise File
Fabric™
which provides a software
solution to integrate and unify File and Object Storage accessible
through a global file system.

The initial setup for the Enterprise File Fabric backend involves
getting a token from the the Enterprise File Fabric which you need to
do in your browser. rclone config walks you through it.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Enterprise File Fabric
   \ "filefabric"
[snip]
Storage> filefabric
** See help for filefabric backend at: https://rclone.org/filefabric/ **

URL of the Enterprise File Fabric to connect to
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Storage Made Easy US
   \ "https://storagemadeeasy.com"
 2 / Storage Made Easy EU
   \ "https://eu.storagemadeeasy.com"
 3 / Connect to your Enterprise File Fabric
   \ "https://yourfabric.smestorage.com"
url> https://yourfabric.smestorage.com/
ID of the root folder
Leave blank normally.

Fill in to make rclone start with directory of a given ID.

Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
root_folder_id> 
Permanent Authentication Token

A Permanent Authentication Token can be created in the Enterprise File
Fabric, on the users Dashboard under Security, there is an entry
you'll see called "My Authentication Tokens". Click the Manage button
to create one.

These tokens are normally valid for several years.

For more info see: https://docs.storagemadeeasy.com/organisationcloud/api-tokens

Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
permanent_token> xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx-xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
Edit advanced config? (y/n)
y) Yes
n) No (default)
y/n> n
Remote config
--------------------
[remote]
type = filefabric
url = https://yourfabric.smestorage.com/
permanent_token = xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx-xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK (default)
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

List directories in top level of your Enterprise File Fabric

rclone lsd remote:

List all the files in your Enterprise File Fabric

rclone ls remote:

To copy a local directory to an Enterprise File Fabric directory called backup

rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Modified time and hashes

The Enterprise File Fabric allows modification times to be set on
files accurate to 1 second. These will be used to detect whether
objects need syncing or not.

The Enterprise File Fabric does not support any data hashes at this time.

Restricted filename characters

The default restricted characters set
will be replaced.

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Empty files

Empty files aren't supported by the Enterprise File Fabric. Rclone will therefore
upload an empty file as a single space with a mime type of
application/vnd.rclone.empty.file and files with that mime type are
treated as empty.

Root folder ID

You can set the root_folder_id for rclone. This is the directory
(identified by its Folder ID) that rclone considers to be the root
of your Enterprise File Fabric.

Normally you will leave this blank and rclone will determine the
correct root to use itself.

However you can set this to restrict rclone to a specific folder
hierarchy.

In order to do this you will have to find the Folder ID of the
directory you wish rclone to display. These aren't displayed in the
web interface, but you can use rclone lsf to find them, for example

$ rclone lsf --dirs-only -Fip --csv filefabric:
120673758,Burnt PDFs/
120673759,My Quick Uploads/
120673755,My Syncs/
120673756,My backups/
120673757,My contacts/
120673761,S3 Storage/

The ID for "S3 Storage" would be 120673761.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to filefabric (Enterprise File Fabric).

--filefabric-url

URL of the Enterprise File Fabric to connect to

--filefabric-root-folder-id

ID of the root folder
Leave blank normally.

Fill in to make rclone start with directory of a given ID.

  • Config: root_folder_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_ROOT_FOLDER_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--filefabric-permanent-token

Permanent Authentication Token

A Permanent Authentication Token can be created in the Enterprise File
Fabric, on the users Dashboard under Security, there is an entry
you'll see called "My Authentication Tokens". Click the Manage button
to create one.

These tokens are normally valid for several years.

For more info see: https://docs.storagemadeeasy.com/organisationcloud/api-tokens

  • Config: permanent_token
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_PERMANENT_TOKEN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to filefabric (Enterprise File Fabric).

--filefabric-token

Session Token

This is a session token which rclone caches in the config file. It is
usually valid for 1 hour.

Don't set this value - rclone will set it automatically.

  • Config: token
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_TOKEN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--filefabric-token-expiry

Token expiry time

Don't set this value - rclone will set it automatically.

  • Config: token_expiry
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_TOKEN_EXPIRY
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--filefabric-version

Version read from the file fabric

Don't set this value - rclone will set it automatically.

  • Config: version
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_VERSION
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--filefabric-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FILEFABRIC_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

FTP

FTP is the File Transfer Protocol. Rclone FTP support is provided using the
github.com/jlaffaye/ftp
package.

Limitations of Rclone's FTP backend

Paths are specified as remote:path. If the path does not begin with
a / it is relative to the home directory of the user. An empty path
remote: refers to the user's home directory.

To create an FTP configuration named remote, run

rclone config

Rclone config guides you through an interactive setup process. A minimal
rclone FTP remote definition only requires host, username and password.
For an anonymous FTP server, use anonymous as username and your email
address as password.

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
r) Rename remote
c) Copy remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/r/c/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / FTP Connection
   \ "ftp"
[snip]
Storage> ftp
** See help for ftp backend at: https://rclone.org/ftp/ **

FTP host to connect to
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Connect to ftp.example.com
   \ "ftp.example.com"
host> ftp.example.com
FTP username, leave blank for current username, $USER
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
user> 
FTP port, leave blank to use default (21)
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
port> 
FTP password
y) Yes type in my own password
g) Generate random password
y/g> y
Enter the password:
password:
Confirm the password:
password:
Use FTP over TLS (Implicit)
Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
tls> 
Use FTP over TLS (Explicit)
Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
explicit_tls> 
Remote config
--------------------
[remote]
type = ftp
host = ftp.example.com
pass = *** ENCRYPTED ***
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

To see all directories in the home directory of remote

rclone lsd remote:

Make a new directory

rclone mkdir remote:path/to/directory

List the contents of a directory

rclone ls remote:path/to/directory

Sync /home/local/directory to the remote directory, deleting any
excess files in the directory.

rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:directory

Example without a config file

rclone lsf :ftp: --ftp-host=speedtest.tele2.net --ftp-user=anonymous --ftp-pass=`rclone obscure dummy`

Implicit TLS

Rlone FTP supports implicit FTP over TLS servers (FTPS). This has to
be enabled in the FTP backend config for the remote, or with
[--ftp-tls]{#ftp-tls}. The default FTPS port is 990, not 21 and
can be set with [--ftp-port]{#ftp-port}.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to ftp (FTP Connection).

--ftp-host

FTP host to connect to

  • Config: host
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_HOST
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "ftp.example.com"
      • Connect to ftp.example.com

--ftp-user

FTP username, leave blank for current username, $USER

  • Config: user
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_USER
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--ftp-port

FTP port, leave blank to use default (21)

  • Config: port
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_PORT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--ftp-pass

FTP password

NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure.

  • Config: pass
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_PASS
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--ftp-tls

Use Implicit FTPS (FTP over TLS)
When using implicit FTP over TLS the client connects using TLS
right from the start which breaks compatibility with
non-TLS-aware servers. This is usually served over port 990 rather
than port 21. Cannot be used in combination with explicit FTP.

  • Config: tls
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_TLS
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--ftp-explicit-tls

Use Explicit FTPS (FTP over TLS)
When using explicit FTP over TLS the client explicitly requests
security from the server in order to upgrade a plain text connection
to an encrypted one. Cannot be used in combination with implicit FTP.

  • Config: explicit_tls
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_EXPLICIT_TLS
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to ftp (FTP Connection).

--ftp-concurrency

Maximum number of FTP simultaneous connections, 0 for unlimited

  • Config: concurrency
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_CONCURRENCY
  • Type: int
  • Default: 0

--ftp-no-check-certificate

Do not verify the TLS certificate of the server

  • Config: no_check_certificate
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_NO_CHECK_CERTIFICATE
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--ftp-disable-epsv

Disable using EPSV even if server advertises support

  • Config: disable_epsv
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_DISABLE_EPSV
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--ftp-disable-mlsd

Disable using MLSD even if server advertises support

  • Config: disable_mlsd
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_DISABLE_MLSD
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--ftp-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_FTP_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,Del,Ctl,RightSpace,Dot

Limitations

Modified times are not supported. Times you see on the FTP server
through rclone are those of upload.

Rclone's FTP backend does not support any checksums but can compare
file sizes.

rclone about is not supported by the FTP backend. Backends without
this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or
use policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union
remote.

See List of backends that do not support rclone about
See rclone about

The implementation of : --dump headers,
--dump bodies, --dump auth for debugging isn't the same as
for rclone HTTP based backends - it has less fine grained control.

--timeout isn't supported (but --contimeout is).

--bind isn't supported.

Rclone's FTP backend could support server-side move but does not
at present.

The ftp_proxy environment variable is not currently supported.

FTP servers acting as rclone remotes must support 'passive'
mode. Rclone's FTP implementation is not compatible with 'active'
mode.

Restricted filename characters

In addition to the default restricted characters set
the following characters are also replaced:

File names cannot end with the following characters. Repacement is
limited to the last character in a file name:

Character Value Replacement
SP 0x20

Not all FTP servers can have all characters in file names, for example:

FTP Server Forbidden characters
proftpd *
pureftpd \ [ ]

Google Cloud Storage

Paths are specified as remote:bucket (or remote: for the lsd
command.) You may put subdirectories in too, e.g. remote:bucket/path/to/dir.

The initial setup for google cloud storage involves getting a token from Google Cloud Storage
which you need to do in your browser. rclone config walks you
through it.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

n) New remote
d) Delete remote
q) Quit config
e/n/d/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Google Cloud Storage (this is not Google Drive)
   \ "google cloud storage"
[snip]
Storage> google cloud storage
Google Application Client Id - leave blank normally.
client_id>
Google Application Client Secret - leave blank normally.
client_secret>
Project number optional - needed only for list/create/delete buckets - see your developer console.
project_number> 12345678
Service Account Credentials JSON file path - needed only if you want use SA instead of interactive login.
service_account_file>
Access Control List for new objects.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Object owner gets OWNER access, and all Authenticated Users get READER access.
   \ "authenticatedRead"
 2 / Object owner gets OWNER access, and project team owners get OWNER access.
   \ "bucketOwnerFullControl"
 3 / Object owner gets OWNER access, and project team owners get READER access.
   \ "bucketOwnerRead"
 4 / Object owner gets OWNER access [default if left blank].
   \ "private"
 5 / Object owner gets OWNER access, and project team members get access according to their roles.
   \ "projectPrivate"
 6 / Object owner gets OWNER access, and all Users get READER access.
   \ "publicRead"
object_acl> 4
Access Control List for new buckets.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Project team owners get OWNER access, and all Authenticated Users get READER access.
   \ "authenticatedRead"
 2 / Project team owners get OWNER access [default if left blank].
   \ "private"
 3 / Project team members get access according to their roles.
   \ "projectPrivate"
 4 / Project team owners get OWNER access, and all Users get READER access.
   \ "publicRead"
 5 / Project team owners get OWNER access, and all Users get WRITER access.
   \ "publicReadWrite"
bucket_acl> 2
Location for the newly created buckets.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Empty for default location (US).
   \ ""
 2 / Multi-regional location for Asia.
   \ "asia"
 3 / Multi-regional location for Europe.
   \ "eu"
 4 / Multi-regional location for United States.
   \ "us"
 5 / Taiwan.
   \ "asia-east1"
 6 / Tokyo.
   \ "asia-northeast1"
 7 / Singapore.
   \ "asia-southeast1"
 8 / Sydney.
   \ "australia-southeast1"
 9 / Belgium.
   \ "europe-west1"
10 / London.
   \ "europe-west2"
11 / Iowa.
   \ "us-central1"
12 / South Carolina.
   \ "us-east1"
13 / Northern Virginia.
   \ "us-east4"
14 / Oregon.
   \ "us-west1"
location> 12
The storage class to use when storing objects in Google Cloud Storage.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Default
   \ ""
 2 / Multi-regional storage class
   \ "MULTI_REGIONAL"
 3 / Regional storage class
   \ "REGIONAL"
 4 / Nearline storage class
   \ "NEARLINE"
 5 / Coldline storage class
   \ "COLDLINE"
 6 / Durable reduced availability storage class
   \ "DURABLE_REDUCED_AVAILABILITY"
storage_class> 5
Remote config
Use auto config?
 * Say Y if not sure
 * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine or Y didn't work
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> y
If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
Log in and authorize rclone for access
Waiting for code...
Got code
--------------------
[remote]
type = google cloud storage
client_id =
client_secret =
token = {"AccessToken":"xxxx.xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx-xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","RefreshToken":"x/xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx_xxxxxxxxx","Expiry":"2014-07-17T20:49:14.929208288+01:00","Extra":null}
project_number = 12345678
object_acl = private
bucket_acl = private
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the
token as returned from Google if you use auto config mode. This only
runs from the moment it opens your browser to the moment you get back
the verification code. This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this
it may require you to unblock it temporarily if you are running a host
firewall, or use manual mode.

This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

See all the buckets in your project

rclone lsd remote:

Make a new bucket

rclone mkdir remote:bucket

List the contents of a bucket

rclone ls remote:bucket

Sync /home/local/directory to the remote bucket, deleting any excess
files in the bucket.

rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:bucket

Service Account support

You can set up rclone with Google Cloud Storage in an unattended mode,
i.e. not tied to a specific end-user Google account. This is useful
when you want to synchronise files onto machines that don't have
actively logged-in users, for example build machines.

To get credentials for Google Cloud Platform
IAM Service Accounts,
please head to the
Service Account
section of the Google Developer Console. Service Accounts behave just
like normal User permissions in
Google Cloud Storage ACLs,
so you can limit their access (e.g. make them read only). After
creating an account, a JSON file containing the Service Account's
credentials will be downloaded onto your machines. These credentials
are what rclone will use for authentication.

To use a Service Account instead of OAuth2 token flow, enter the path
to your Service Account credentials at the service_account_file
prompt and rclone won't use the browser based authentication
flow. If you'd rather stuff the contents of the credentials file into
the rclone config file, you can set service_account_credentials with
the actual contents of the file instead, or set the equivalent
environment variable.

Anonymous Access

For downloads of objects that permit public access you can configure rclone
to use anonymous access by setting anonymous to true.
With unauthorized access you can't write or create files but only read or list
those buckets and objects that have public read access.

Application Default Credentials

If no other source of credentials is provided, rclone will fall back
to
Application Default Credentials
this is useful both when you already have configured authentication
for your developer account, or in production when running on a google
compute host. Note that if running in docker, you may need to run
additional commands on your google compute machine -
see this page.

Note that in the case application default credentials are used, there
is no need to explicitly configure a project number.

--fast-list

This remote supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer
transactions in exchange for more memory. See the rclone
docs
for more details.

Custom upload headers

You can set custom upload headers with the --header-upload
flag. Google Cloud Storage supports the headers as described in the
working with metadata documentation

  • Cache-Control
  • Content-Disposition
  • Content-Encoding
  • Content-Language
  • Content-Type
  • X-Goog-Storage-Class
  • X-Goog-Meta-

Eg --header-upload "Content-Type text/potato"

Note that the last of these is for setting custom metadata in the form
--header-upload "x-goog-meta-key: value"

Modified time

Google google cloud storage stores md5sums natively and rclone stores
modification times as metadata on the object, under the "mtime" key in
RFC3339 format accurate to 1ns.

Restricted filename characters

Character Value Replacement
NUL 0x00
LF 0x0A
CR 0x0D
/ 0x2F

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to google cloud storage (Google Cloud Storage (this is not Google Drive)).

--gcs-client-id

OAuth Client Id
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: client_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_CLIENT_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--gcs-client-secret

OAuth Client Secret
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: client_secret
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_CLIENT_SECRET
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--gcs-project-number

Project number.
Optional - needed only for list/create/delete buckets - see your developer console.

  • Config: project_number
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_PROJECT_NUMBER
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--gcs-service-account-file

Service Account Credentials JSON file path
Leave blank normally.
Needed only if you want use SA instead of interactive login.

Leading ~ will be expanded in the file name as will environment variables such as ${RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR}.

  • Config: service_account_file
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_SERVICE_ACCOUNT_FILE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--gcs-service-account-credentials

Service Account Credentials JSON blob
Leave blank normally.
Needed only if you want use SA instead of interactive login.

  • Config: service_account_credentials
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_SERVICE_ACCOUNT_CREDENTIALS
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--gcs-anonymous

Access public buckets and objects without credentials
Set to 'true' if you just want to download files and don't configure credentials.

  • Config: anonymous
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_ANONYMOUS
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--gcs-object-acl

Access Control List for new objects.

  • Config: object_acl
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_OBJECT_ACL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "authenticatedRead"
      • Object owner gets OWNER access, and all Authenticated Users get READER access.
    • "bucketOwnerFullControl"
      • Object owner gets OWNER access, and project team owners get OWNER access.
    • "bucketOwnerRead"
      • Object owner gets OWNER access, and project team owners get READER access.
    • "private"
      • Object owner gets OWNER access [default if left blank].
    • "projectPrivate"
      • Object owner gets OWNER access, and project team members get access according to their roles.
    • "publicRead"
      • Object owner gets OWNER access, and all Users get READER access.

--gcs-bucket-acl

Access Control List for new buckets.

  • Config: bucket_acl
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_BUCKET_ACL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "authenticatedRead"
      • Project team owners get OWNER access, and all Authenticated Users get READER access.
    • "private"
      • Project team owners get OWNER access [default if left blank].
    • "projectPrivate"
      • Project team members get access according to their roles.
    • "publicRead"
      • Project team owners get OWNER access, and all Users get READER access.
    • "publicReadWrite"
      • Project team owners get OWNER access, and all Users get WRITER access.

--gcs-bucket-policy-only

Access checks should use bucket-level IAM policies.

If you want to upload objects to a bucket with Bucket Policy Only set
then you will need to set this.

When it is set, rclone:

  • ignores ACLs set on buckets
  • ignores ACLs set on objects
  • creates buckets with Bucket Policy Only set

Docs: https://cloud.google.com/storage/docs/bucket-policy-only

  • Config: bucket_policy_only
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_BUCKET_POLICY_ONLY
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--gcs-location

Location for the newly created buckets.

  • Config: location
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_LOCATION
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • ""
      • Empty for default location (US).
    • "asia"
      • Multi-regional location for Asia.
    • "eu"
      • Multi-regional location for Europe.
    • "us"
      • Multi-regional location for United States.
    • "asia-east1"
      • Taiwan.
    • "asia-east2"
      • Hong Kong.
    • "asia-northeast1"
      • Tokyo.
    • "asia-south1"
      • Mumbai.
    • "asia-southeast1"
      • Singapore.
    • "australia-southeast1"
      • Sydney.
    • "europe-north1"
      • Finland.
    • "europe-west1"
      • Belgium.
    • "europe-west2"
      • London.
    • "europe-west3"
      • Frankfurt.
    • "europe-west4"
      • Netherlands.
    • "us-central1"
      • Iowa.
    • "us-east1"
      • South Carolina.
    • "us-east4"
      • Northern Virginia.
    • "us-west1"
      • Oregon.
    • "us-west2"
      • California.

--gcs-storage-class

The storage class to use when storing objects in Google Cloud Storage.

  • Config: storage_class
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_STORAGE_CLASS
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • ""
      • Default
    • "MULTI_REGIONAL"
      • Multi-regional storage class
    • "REGIONAL"
      • Regional storage class
    • "NEARLINE"
      • Nearline storage class
    • "COLDLINE"
      • Coldline storage class
    • "ARCHIVE"
      • Archive storage class
    • "DURABLE_REDUCED_AVAILABILITY"
      • Durable reduced availability storage class

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to google cloud storage (Google Cloud Storage (this is not Google Drive)).

--gcs-token

OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

  • Config: token
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_TOKEN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--gcs-auth-url

Auth server URL.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: auth_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_AUTH_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--gcs-token-url

Token server url.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: token_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_TOKEN_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--gcs-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GCS_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,CrLf,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

rclone about is not supported by the Google Cloud Storage backend. Backends without
this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or
use policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union
remote.

See List of backends that do not support rclone about
See rclone about

Google Drive

Paths are specified as drive:path

Drive paths may be as deep as required, e.g. drive:directory/subdirectory.

The initial setup for drive involves getting a token from Google drive
which you need to do in your browser. rclone config walks you
through it.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
r) Rename remote
c) Copy remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/r/c/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Google Drive
   \ "drive"
[snip]
Storage> drive
Google Application Client Id - leave blank normally.
client_id>
Google Application Client Secret - leave blank normally.
client_secret>
Scope that rclone should use when requesting access from drive.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Full access all files, excluding Application Data Folder.
   \ "drive"
 2 / Read-only access to file metadata and file contents.
   \ "drive.readonly"
   / Access to files created by rclone only.
 3 | These are visible in the drive website.
   | File authorization is revoked when the user deauthorizes the app.
   \ "drive.file"
   / Allows read and write access to the Application Data folder.
 4 | This is not visible in the drive website.
   \ "drive.appfolder"
   / Allows read-only access to file metadata but
 5 | does not allow any access to read or download file content.
   \ "drive.metadata.readonly"
scope> 1
ID of the root folder - leave blank normally.  Fill in to access "Computers" folders. (see docs).
root_folder_id> 
Service Account Credentials JSON file path - needed only if you want use SA instead of interactive login.
service_account_file>
Remote config
Use auto config?
 * Say Y if not sure
 * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine or Y didn't work
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> y
If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
Log in and authorize rclone for access
Waiting for code...
Got code
Configure this as a team drive?
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> n
--------------------
[remote]
client_id = 
client_secret = 
scope = drive
root_folder_id = 
service_account_file =
token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"Bearer","refresh_token":"XXX","expiry":"2014-03-16T13:57:58.955387075Z"}
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the
token as returned from Google if you use auto config mode. This only
runs from the moment it opens your browser to the moment you get back
the verification code. This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this
it may require you to unblock it temporarily if you are running a host
firewall, or use manual mode.

You can then use it like this,

List directories in top level of your drive

rclone lsd remote:

List all the files in your drive

rclone ls remote:

To copy a local directory to a drive directory called backup

rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Scopes

Rclone allows you to select which scope you would like for rclone to
use. This changes what type of token is granted to rclone. The
scopes are defined
here
.

The scope are

drive

This is the default scope and allows full access to all files, except
for the Application Data Folder (see below).

Choose this one if you aren't sure.

drive.readonly

This allows read only access to all files. Files may be listed and
downloaded but not uploaded, renamed or deleted.

drive.file

With this scope rclone can read/view/modify only those files and
folders it creates.

So if you uploaded files to drive via the web interface (or any other
means) they will not be visible to rclone.

This can be useful if you are using rclone to backup data and you want
to be sure confidential data on your drive is not visible to rclone.

Files created with this scope are visible in the web interface.

drive.appfolder

This gives rclone its own private area to store files. Rclone will
not be able to see any other files on your drive and you won't be able
to see rclone's files from the web interface either.

drive.metadata.readonly

This allows read only access to file names only. It does not allow
rclone to download or upload data, or rename or delete files or
directories.

Root folder ID

You can set the root_folder_id for rclone. This is the directory
(identified by its Folder ID) that rclone considers to be the root
of your drive.

Normally you will leave this blank and rclone will determine the
correct root to use itself.

However you can set this to restrict rclone to a specific folder
hierarchy or to access data within the "Computers" tab on the drive
web interface (where files from Google's Backup and Sync desktop
program go).

In order to do this you will have to find the Folder ID of the
directory you wish rclone to display. This will be the last segment
of the URL when you open the relevant folder in the drive web
interface.

So if the folder you want rclone to use has a URL which looks like
https://drive.google.com/drive/folders/1XyfxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxKHCh
in the browser, then you use 1XyfxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxKHCh as
the root_folder_id in the config.

NB folders under the "Computers" tab seem to be read only (drive
gives a 500 error) when using rclone.

There doesn't appear to be an API to discover the folder IDs of the
"Computers" tab - please contact us if you know otherwise!

Note also that rclone can't access any data under the "Backups" tab on
the google drive web interface yet.

Service Account support

You can set up rclone with Google Drive in an unattended mode,
i.e. not tied to a specific end-user Google account. This is useful
when you want to synchronise files onto machines that don't have
actively logged-in users, for example build machines.

To use a Service Account instead of OAuth2 token flow, enter the path
to your Service Account credentials at the service_account_file
prompt during rclone config and rclone won't use the browser based
authentication flow. If you'd rather stuff the contents of the
credentials file into the rclone config file, you can set
service_account_credentials with the actual contents of the file
instead, or set the equivalent environment variable.

Use case - Google Apps/G-suite account and individual Drive

Let's say that you are the administrator of a Google Apps (old) or
G-suite account.
The goal is to store data on an individual's Drive account, who IS
a member of the domain.
We'll call the domain example.com, and the user
foo@example.com.

There's a few steps we need to go through to accomplish this:

1. Create a service account for example.com
  • To create a service account and obtain its credentials, go to the
    Google Developer Console.
  • You must have a project - create one if you don't.
  • Then go to "IAM & admin" -> "Service Accounts".
  • Use the "Create Credentials" button. Fill in "Service account name"
    with something that identifies your client. "Role" can be empty.
  • Tick "Furnish a new private key" - select "Key type JSON".
  • Tick "Enable G Suite Domain-wide Delegation". This option makes
    "impersonation" possible, as documented here:
    Delegating domain-wide authority to the service account
  • These credentials are what rclone will use for authentication.
    If you ever need to remove access, press the "Delete service
    account key" button.
2. Allowing API access to example.com Google Drive
  • Go to example.com's admin console
  • Go into "Security" (or use the search bar)
  • Select "Show more" and then "Advanced settings"
  • Select "Manage API client access" in the "Authentication" section
  • In the "Client Name" field enter the service account's
    "Client ID" - this can be found in the Developer Console under
    "IAM & Admin" -> "Service Accounts", then "View Client ID" for
    the newly created service account.
    It is a ~21 character numerical string.
  • In the next field, "One or More API Scopes", enter
    https://www.googleapis.com/auth/drive
    to grant access to Google Drive specifically.
3. Configure rclone, assuming a new install
rclone config

n/s/q> n         # New
name>gdrive      # Gdrive is an example name
Storage>         # Select the number shown for Google Drive
client_id>       # Can be left blank
client_secret>   # Can be left blank
scope>           # Select your scope, 1 for example
root_folder_id>  # Can be left blank
service_account_file> /home/foo/myJSONfile.json # This is where the JSON file goes!
y/n>             # Auto config, y

4. Verify that it's working
  • rclone -v --drive-impersonate foo@example.com lsf gdrive:backup
  • The arguments do:
    • -v - verbose logging
    • --drive-impersonate foo@example.com - this is what does
      the magic, pretending to be user foo.
    • lsf - list files in a parsing friendly way
    • gdrive:backup - use the remote called gdrive, work in
      the folder named backup.

Note: in case you configured a specific root folder on gdrive and rclone is unable to access the contents of that folder when using --drive-impersonate, do this instead:

  • in the gdrive web interface, share your root folder with the user/email of the new Service Account you created/selected at step #1
  • use rclone without specifying the --drive-impersonate option, like this:
    rclone -v foo@example.com lsf gdrive:backup

Team drives

If you want to configure the remote to point to a Google Team Drive
then answer y to the question Configure this as a team drive?.

This will fetch the list of Team Drives from google and allow you to
configure which one you want to use. You can also type in a team
drive ID if you prefer.

For example:

Configure this as a team drive?
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> y
Fetching team drive list...
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Rclone Test
   \ "xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx"
 2 / Rclone Test 2
   \ "yyyyyyyyyyyyyyyyyyyy"
 3 / Rclone Test 3
   \ "zzzzzzzzzzzzzzzzzzzz"
Enter a Team Drive ID> 1
--------------------
[remote]
client_id =
client_secret =
token = {"AccessToken":"xxxx.x.xxxxx_xxxxxxxxxxx_xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","RefreshToken":"1/xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx_xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","Expiry":"2014-03-16T13:57:58.955387075Z","Extra":null}
team_drive = xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

--fast-list

This remote supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer
transactions in exchange for more memory. See the rclone
docs
for more details.

It does this by combining multiple list calls into a single API request.

This works by combining many '%s' in parents filters into one expression.
To list the contents of directories a, b and c, the following requests will be send by the regular List function:

trashed=false and 'a' in parents
trashed=false and 'b' in parents
trashed=false and 'c' in parents

These can now be combined into a single request:

trashed=false and ('a' in parents or 'b' in parents or 'c' in parents)

The implementation of ListR will put up to 50 parents filters into one request.
It will use the --checkers value to specify the number of requests to run in parallel.

In tests, these batch requests were up to 20x faster than the regular method.
Running the following command against different sized folders gives:

rclone lsjson -vv -R --checkers=6 gdrive:folder

small folder (220 directories, 700 files):

  • without --fast-list: 38s
  • with --fast-list: 10s

large folder (10600 directories, 39000 files):

  • without --fast-list: 22:05 min
  • with --fast-list: 58s

Modified time

Google drive stores modification times accurate to 1 ms.

Restricted filename characters

Only Invalid UTF-8 bytes will be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

In contrast to other backends, / can also be used in names and .
or .. are valid names.

Revisions

Google drive stores revisions of files. When you upload a change to
an existing file to google drive using rclone it will create a new
revision of that file.

Revisions follow the standard google policy which at time of writing
was

  • They are deleted after 30 days or 100 revisions (whatever comes first).
  • They do not count towards a user storage quota.

Deleting files

By default rclone will send all files to the trash when deleting
files. If deleting them permanently is required then use the
--drive-use-trash=false flag, or set the equivalent environment
variable.

Shortcuts

In March 2020 Google introduced a new feature in Google Drive called
drive shortcuts
(API). These
will (by September 2020) replace the ability for files or folders to
be in multiple folders at once
.

Shortcuts are files that link to other files on Google Drive somewhat
like a symlink in unix, except they point to the underlying file data
(e.g. the inode in unix terms) so they don't break if the source is
renamed or moved about.

Be default rclone treats these as follows.

For shortcuts pointing to files:

  • When listing a file shortcut appears as the destination file.
  • When downloading the contents of the destination file is downloaded.
  • When updating shortcut file with a non shortcut file, the shortcut is removed then a new file is uploaded in place of the shortcut.
  • When server-side moving (renaming) the shortcut is renamed, not the destination file.
  • When server-side copying the shortcut is copied, not the contents of the shortcut.
  • When deleting the shortcut is deleted not the linked file.
  • When setting the modification time, the modification time of the linked file will be set.

For shortcuts pointing to folders:

  • When listing the shortcut appears as a folder and that folder will contain the contents of the linked folder appear (including any sub folders)
  • When downloading the contents of the linked folder and sub contents are downloaded
  • When uploading to a shortcut folder the file will be placed in the linked folder
  • When server-side moving (renaming) the shortcut is renamed, not the destination folder
  • When server-side copying the contents of the linked folder is copied, not the shortcut.
  • When deleting with rclone rmdir or rclone purge the shortcut is deleted not the linked folder.
  • NB When deleting with rclone remove or rclone mount the contents of the linked folder will be deleted.

The rclone backend command can be used to create shortcuts.

Shortcuts can be completely ignored with the --drive-skip-shortcuts flag
or the corresponding skip_shortcuts configuration setting.

Emptying trash

If you wish to empty your trash you can use the rclone cleanup remote:
command which will permanently delete all your trashed files. This command
does not take any path arguments.

Note that Google Drive takes some time (minutes to days) to empty the
trash even though the command returns within a few seconds. No output
is echoed, so there will be no confirmation even using -v or -vv.

Quota information

To view your current quota you can use the rclone about remote:
command which will display your usage limit (quota), the usage in Google
Drive, the size of all files in the Trash and the space used by other
Google services such as Gmail. This command does not take any path
arguments.

Import/Export of google documents

Google documents can be exported from and uploaded to Google Drive.

When rclone downloads a Google doc it chooses a format to download
depending upon the --drive-export-formats setting.
By default the export formats are docx,xlsx,pptx,svg which are a
sensible default for an editable document.

When choosing a format, rclone runs down the list provided in order
and chooses the first file format the doc can be exported as from the
list. If the file can't be exported to a format on the formats list,
then rclone will choose a format from the default list.

If you prefer an archive copy then you might use --drive-export-formats pdf, or if you prefer openoffice/libreoffice formats you might use
--drive-export-formats ods,odt,odp.

Note that rclone adds the extension to the google doc, so if it is
called My Spreadsheet on google docs, it will be exported as My Spreadsheet.xlsx or My Spreadsheet.pdf etc.

When importing files into Google Drive, rclone will convert all
files with an extension in --drive-import-formats to their
associated document type.
rclone will not convert any files by default, since the conversion
is lossy process.

The conversion must result in a file with the same extension when
the --drive-export-formats rules are applied to the uploaded document.

Here are some examples for allowed and prohibited conversions.

export-formats import-formats Upload Ext Document Ext Allowed
odt odt odt odt Yes
odt docx,odt odt odt Yes
docx docx docx Yes
odt odt docx No
odt,docx docx,odt docx odt No
docx,odt docx,odt docx docx Yes
docx,odt docx,odt odt docx No

This limitation can be disabled by specifying --drive-allow-import-name-change.
When using this flag, rclone can convert multiple files types resulting
in the same document type at once, e.g. with --drive-import-formats docx,odt,txt,
all files having these extension would result in a document represented as a docx file.
This brings the additional risk of overwriting a document, if multiple files
have the same stem. Many rclone operations will not handle this name change
in any way. They assume an equal name when copying files and might copy the
file again or delete them when the name changes.

Here are the possible export extensions with their corresponding mime types.
Most of these can also be used for importing, but there more that are not
listed here. Some of these additional ones might only be available when
the operating system provides the correct MIME type entries.

This list can be changed by Google Drive at any time and might not
represent the currently available conversions.

Extension Mime Type Description
csv text/csv Standard CSV format for Spreadsheets
docx application/vnd.openxmlformats-officedocument.wordprocessingml.document Microsoft Office Document
epub application/epub+zip E-book format
html text/html An HTML Document
jpg image/jpeg A JPEG Image File
json application/vnd.google-apps.script+json JSON Text Format
odp application/vnd.oasis.opendocument.presentation Openoffice Presentation
ods application/vnd.oasis.opendocument.spreadsheet Openoffice Spreadsheet
ods application/x-vnd.oasis.opendocument.spreadsheet Openoffice Spreadsheet
odt application/vnd.oasis.opendocument.text Openoffice Document
pdf application/pdf Adobe PDF Format
png image/png PNG Image Format
pptx application/vnd.openxmlformats-officedocument.presentationml.presentation Microsoft Office Powerpoint
rtf application/rtf Rich Text Format
svg image/svg+xml Scalable Vector Graphics Format
tsv text/tab-separated-values Standard TSV format for spreadsheets
txt text/plain Plain Text
xlsx application/vnd.openxmlformats-officedocument.spreadsheetml.sheet Microsoft Office Spreadsheet
zip application/zip A ZIP file of HTML, Images CSS

Google documents can also be exported as link files. These files will
open a browser window for the Google Docs website of that document
when opened. The link file extension has to be specified as a
--drive-export-formats parameter. They will match all available
Google Documents.

Extension Description OS Support
desktop freedesktop.org specified desktop entry Linux
link.html An HTML Document with a redirect All
url INI style link file macOS, Windows
webloc macOS specific XML format macOS

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to drive (Google Drive).

--drive-client-id

Google Application Client Id
Setting your own is recommended.
See https://rclone.org/drive/#making-your-own-client-id for how to create your own.
If you leave this blank, it will use an internal key which is low performance.

  • Config: client_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_CLIENT_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--drive-client-secret

OAuth Client Secret
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: client_secret
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_CLIENT_SECRET
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--drive-scope

Scope that rclone should use when requesting access from drive.

  • Config: scope
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SCOPE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "drive"
      • Full access all files, excluding Application Data Folder.
    • "drive.readonly"
      • Read-only access to file metadata and file contents.
    • "drive.file"
      • Access to files created by rclone only.
      • These are visible in the drive website.
      • File authorization is revoked when the user deauthorizes the app.
    • "drive.appfolder"
      • Allows read and write access to the Application Data folder.
      • This is not visible in the drive website.
    • "drive.metadata.readonly"
      • Allows read-only access to file metadata but
      • does not allow any access to read or download file content.

--drive-root-folder-id

ID of the root folder
Leave blank normally.

Fill in to access "Computers" folders (see docs), or for rclone to use
a non root folder as its starting point.

  • Config: root_folder_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_ROOT_FOLDER_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--drive-service-account-file

Service Account Credentials JSON file path
Leave blank normally.
Needed only if you want use SA instead of interactive login.

Leading ~ will be expanded in the file name as will environment variables such as ${RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR}.

  • Config: service_account_file
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SERVICE_ACCOUNT_FILE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--drive-alternate-export

Deprecated: no longer needed

  • Config: alternate_export
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_ALTERNATE_EXPORT
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to drive (Google Drive).

--drive-token

OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

  • Config: token
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_TOKEN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--drive-auth-url

Auth server URL.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: auth_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_AUTH_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--drive-token-url

Token server url.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: token_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_TOKEN_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--drive-service-account-credentials

Service Account Credentials JSON blob
Leave blank normally.
Needed only if you want use SA instead of interactive login.

  • Config: service_account_credentials
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SERVICE_ACCOUNT_CREDENTIALS
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--drive-team-drive

ID of the Team Drive

  • Config: team_drive
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_TEAM_DRIVE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--drive-auth-owner-only

Only consider files owned by the authenticated user.

  • Config: auth_owner_only
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_AUTH_OWNER_ONLY
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--drive-use-trash

Send files to the trash instead of deleting permanently.
Defaults to true, namely sending files to the trash.
Use --drive-use-trash=false to delete files permanently instead.

  • Config: use_trash
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_USE_TRASH
  • Type: bool
  • Default: true

--drive-skip-gdocs

Skip google documents in all listings.
If given, gdocs practically become invisible to rclone.

  • Config: skip_gdocs
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SKIP_GDOCS
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--drive-skip-checksum-gphotos

Skip MD5 checksum on Google photos and videos only.

Use this if you get checksum errors when transferring Google photos or
videos.

Setting this flag will cause Google photos and videos to return a
blank MD5 checksum.

Google photos are identified by being in the "photos" space.

Corrupted checksums are caused by Google modifying the image/video but
not updating the checksum.

  • Config: skip_checksum_gphotos
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SKIP_CHECKSUM_GPHOTOS
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--drive-shared-with-me

Only show files that are shared with me.

Instructs rclone to operate on your "Shared with me" folder (where
Google Drive lets you access the files and folders others have shared
with you).

This works both with the "list" (lsd, lsl, etc.) and the "copy"
commands (copy, sync, etc.), and with all other commands too.

  • Config: shared_with_me
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SHARED_WITH_ME
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--drive-trashed-only

Only show files that are in the trash.
This will show trashed files in their original directory structure.

  • Config: trashed_only
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_TRASHED_ONLY
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--drive-starred-only

Only show files that are starred.

  • Config: starred_only
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_STARRED_ONLY
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--drive-formats

Deprecated: see export_formats

  • Config: formats
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_FORMATS
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--drive-export-formats

Comma separated list of preferred formats for downloading Google docs.

  • Config: export_formats
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_EXPORT_FORMATS
  • Type: string
  • Default: "docx,xlsx,pptx,svg"

--drive-import-formats

Comma separated list of preferred formats for uploading Google docs.

  • Config: import_formats
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_IMPORT_FORMATS
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--drive-allow-import-name-change

Allow the filetype to change when uploading Google docs (e.g. file.doc to file.docx). This will confuse sync and reupload every time.

  • Config: allow_import_name_change
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_ALLOW_IMPORT_NAME_CHANGE
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--drive-use-created-date

Use file created date instead of modified date.,

Useful when downloading data and you want the creation date used in
place of the last modified date.

WARNING: This flag may have some unexpected consequences.

When uploading to your drive all files will be overwritten unless they
haven't been modified since their creation. And the inverse will occur
while downloading. This side effect can be avoided by using the
"--checksum" flag.

This feature was implemented to retain photos capture date as recorded
by google photos. You will first need to check the "Create a Google
Photos folder" option in your google drive settings. You can then copy
or move the photos locally and use the date the image was taken
(created) set as the modification date.

  • Config: use_created_date
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_USE_CREATED_DATE
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--drive-use-shared-date

Use date file was shared instead of modified date.

Note that, as with "--drive-use-created-date", this flag may have
unexpected consequences when uploading/downloading files.

If both this flag and "--drive-use-created-date" are set, the created
date is used.

  • Config: use_shared_date
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_USE_SHARED_DATE
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--drive-list-chunk

Size of listing chunk 100-1000. 0 to disable.

  • Config: list_chunk
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_LIST_CHUNK
  • Type: int
  • Default: 1000

--drive-impersonate

Impersonate this user when using a service account.

  • Config: impersonate
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_IMPERSONATE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--drive-upload-cutoff

Cutoff for switching to chunked upload

  • Config: upload_cutoff
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_UPLOAD_CUTOFF
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 8M

--drive-chunk-size

Upload chunk size. Must a power of 2 >= 256k.

Making this larger will improve performance, but note that each chunk
is buffered in memory one per transfer.

Reducing this will reduce memory usage but decrease performance.

  • Config: chunk_size
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_CHUNK_SIZE
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 8M

--drive-acknowledge-abuse

Set to allow files which return cannotDownloadAbusiveFile to be downloaded.

If downloading a file returns the error "This file has been identified
as malware or spam and cannot be downloaded" with the error code
"cannotDownloadAbusiveFile" then supply this flag to rclone to
indicate you acknowledge the risks of downloading the file and rclone
will download it anyway.

  • Config: acknowledge_abuse
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_ACKNOWLEDGE_ABUSE
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--drive-keep-revision-forever

Keep new head revision of each file forever.

  • Config: keep_revision_forever
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_KEEP_REVISION_FOREVER
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--drive-size-as-quota

Show sizes as storage quota usage, not actual size.

Show the size of a file as the storage quota used. This is the
current version plus any older versions that have been set to keep
forever.

WARNING: This flag may have some unexpected consequences.

It is not recommended to set this flag in your config - the
recommended usage is using the flag form --drive-size-as-quota when
doing rclone ls/lsl/lsf/lsjson/etc only.

If you do use this flag for syncing (not recommended) then you will
need to use --ignore size also.

  • Config: size_as_quota
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SIZE_AS_QUOTA
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--drive-v2-download-min-size

If Object's are greater, use drive v2 API to download.

  • Config: v2_download_min_size
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_V2_DOWNLOAD_MIN_SIZE
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: off

--drive-pacer-min-sleep

Minimum time to sleep between API calls.

  • Config: pacer_min_sleep
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_PACER_MIN_SLEEP
  • Type: Duration
  • Default: 100ms

--drive-pacer-burst

Number of API calls to allow without sleeping.

  • Config: pacer_burst
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_PACER_BURST
  • Type: int
  • Default: 100

--drive-server-side-across-configs

Allow server-side operations (e.g. copy) to work across different drive configs.

This can be useful if you wish to do a server-side copy between two
different Google drives. Note that this isn't enabled by default
because it isn't easy to tell if it will work between any two
configurations.

  • Config: server_side_across_configs
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SERVER_SIDE_ACROSS_CONFIGS
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--drive-disable-http2

Disable drive using http2

There is currently an unsolved issue with the google drive backend and
HTTP/2. HTTP/2 is therefore disabled by default for the drive backend
but can be re-enabled here. When the issue is solved this flag will
be removed.

See: https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/3631

  • Config: disable_http2
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_DISABLE_HTTP2
  • Type: bool
  • Default: true

--drive-stop-on-upload-limit

Make upload limit errors be fatal

At the time of writing it is only possible to upload 750GB of data to
Google Drive a day (this is an undocumented limit). When this limit is
reached Google Drive produces a slightly different error message. When
this flag is set it causes these errors to be fatal. These will stop
the in-progress sync.

Note that this detection is relying on error message strings which
Google don't document so it may break in the future.

See: https://github.com/rclone/rclone/issues/3857

  • Config: stop_on_upload_limit
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_STOP_ON_UPLOAD_LIMIT
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--drive-stop-on-download-limit

Make download limit errors be fatal

At the time of writing it is only possible to download 10TB of data from
Google Drive a day (this is an undocumented limit). When this limit is
reached Google Drive produces a slightly different error message. When
this flag is set it causes these errors to be fatal. These will stop
the in-progress sync.

Note that this detection is relying on error message strings which
Google don't document so it may break in the future.

  • Config: stop_on_download_limit
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_STOP_ON_DOWNLOAD_LIMIT
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--drive-skip-shortcuts

If set skip shortcut files

Normally rclone dereferences shortcut files making them appear as if
they are the original file (see the shortcuts section).
If this flag is set then rclone will ignore shortcut files completely.

  • Config: skip_shortcuts
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_SKIP_SHORTCUTS
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--drive-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_DRIVE_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: InvalidUtf8

Backend commands

Here are the commands specific to the drive backend.

Run them with

rclone backend COMMAND remote:

The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

See the "rclone backend" command for more
info on how to pass options and arguments.

These can be run on a running backend using the rc command
backend/command.

get

Get command for fetching the drive config parameters

rclone backend get remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

This is a get command which will be used to fetch the various drive config parameters

Usage Examples:

rclone backend get drive: [-o service_account_file] [-o chunk_size]
rclone rc backend/command command=get fs=drive: [-o service_account_file] [-o chunk_size]

Options:

  • "chunk_size": show the current upload chunk size
  • "service_account_file": show the current service account file

set

Set command for updating the drive config parameters

rclone backend set remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

This is a set command which will be used to update the various drive config parameters

Usage Examples:

rclone backend set drive: [-o service_account_file=sa.json] [-o chunk_size=67108864]
rclone rc backend/command command=set fs=drive: [-o service_account_file=sa.json] [-o chunk_size=67108864]

Options:

  • "chunk_size": update the current upload chunk size
  • "service_account_file": update the current service account file

shortcut

Create shortcuts from files or directories

rclone backend shortcut remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

This command creates shortcuts from files or directories.

Usage:

rclone backend shortcut drive: source_item destination_shortcut
rclone backend shortcut drive: source_item -o target=drive2: destination_shortcut

In the first example this creates a shortcut from the "source_item"
which can be a file or a directory to the "destination_shortcut". The
"source_item" and the "destination_shortcut" should be relative paths
from "drive:"

In the second example this creates a shortcut from the "source_item"
relative to "drive:" to the "destination_shortcut" relative to
"drive2:". This may fail with a permission error if the user
authenticated with "drive2:" can't read files from "drive:".

Options:

  • "target": optional target remote for the shortcut destination

drives

List the shared drives available to this account

rclone backend drives remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

This command lists the shared drives (teamdrives) available to this
account.

Usage:

rclone backend drives drive:

This will return a JSON list of objects like this

[
    {
        "id": "0ABCDEF-01234567890",
        "kind": "drive#teamDrive",
        "name": "My Drive"
    },
    {
        "id": "0ABCDEFabcdefghijkl",
        "kind": "drive#teamDrive",
        "name": "Test Drive"
    }
]

untrash

Untrash files and directories

rclone backend untrash remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

This command untrashes all the files and directories in the directory
passed in recursively.

Usage:

This takes an optional directory to trash which make this easier to
use via the API.

rclone backend untrash drive:directory
rclone backend -i untrash drive:directory subdir

Use the -i flag to see what would be restored before restoring it.

Result:

{
    "Untrashed": 17,
    "Errors": 0
}

copyid

Copy files by ID

rclone backend copyid remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

This command copies files by ID

Usage:

rclone backend copyid drive: ID path
rclone backend copyid drive: ID1 path1 ID2 path2

It copies the drive file with ID given to the path (an rclone path which
will be passed internally to rclone copyto). The ID and path pairs can be
repeated.

The path should end with a / to indicate copy the file as named to
this directory. If it doesn't end with a / then the last path
component will be used as the file name.

If the destination is a drive backend then server-side copying will be
attempted if possible.

Use the -i flag to see what would be copied before copying.

Limitations

Drive has quite a lot of rate limiting. This causes rclone to be
limited to transferring about 2 files per second only. Individual
files may be transferred much faster at 100s of MBytes/s but lots of
small files can take a long time.

Server side copies are also subject to a separate rate limit. If you
see User rate limit exceeded errors, wait at least 24 hours and retry.
You can disable server-side copies with --disable copy to download
and upload the files if you prefer.

Limitations of Google Docs

Google docs will appear as size -1 in rclone ls and as size 0 in
anything which uses the VFS layer, e.g. rclone mount, rclone serve.

This is because rclone can't find out the size of the Google docs
without downloading them.

Google docs will transfer correctly with rclone sync, rclone copy
etc as rclone knows to ignore the size when doing the transfer.

However an unfortunate consequence of this is that you may not be able
to download Google docs using rclone mount. If it doesn't work you
will get a 0 sized file. If you try again the doc may gain its
correct size and be downloadable. Whether it will work on not depends
on the application accessing the mount and the OS you are running -
experiment to find out if it does work for you!

Duplicated files

Sometimes, for no reason I've been able to track down, drive will
duplicate a file that rclone uploads. Drive unlike all the other
remotes can have duplicated files.

Duplicated files cause problems with the syncing and you will see
messages in the log about duplicates.

Use rclone dedupe to fix duplicated files.

Note that this isn't just a problem with rclone, even Google Photos on
Android duplicates files on drive sometimes.

Rclone appears to be re-copying files it shouldn't

The most likely cause of this is the duplicated file issue above - run
rclone dedupe and check your logs for duplicate object or directory
messages.

This can also be caused by a delay/caching on google drive's end when
comparing directory listings. Specifically with team drives used in
combination with --fast-list. Files that were uploaded recently may
not appear on the directory list sent to rclone when using --fast-list.

Waiting a moderate period of time between attempts (estimated to be
approximately 1 hour) and/or not using --fast-list both seem to be
effective in preventing the problem.

Making your own client_id

When you use rclone with Google drive in its default configuration you
are using rclone's client_id. This is shared between all the rclone
users. There is a global rate limit on the number of queries per
second that each client_id can do set by Google. rclone already has a
high quota and I will continue to make sure it is high enough by
contacting Google.

It is strongly recommended to use your own client ID as the default rclone ID is heavily used. If you have multiple services running, it is recommended to use an API key for each service. The default Google quota is 10 transactions per second so it is recommended to stay under that number as if you use more than that, it will cause rclone to rate limit and make things slower.

Here is how to create your own Google Drive client ID for rclone:

  1. Log into the Google API
    Console
    with your Google
    account. It doesn't matter what Google account you use. (It need not
    be the same account as the Google Drive you want to access)

  2. Select a project or create a new project.

  3. Under "ENABLE APIS AND SERVICES" search for "Drive", and enable the
    "Google Drive API".

  4. Click "Credentials" in the left-side panel (not "Create
    credentials", which opens the wizard), then "Create credentials"

  5. If you already configured an "Oauth Consent Screen", then skip
    to the next step; if not, click on "CONFIGURE CONSENT SCREEN" button
    (near the top right corner of the right panel), then select "External"
    and click on "CREATE"; on the next screen, enter an "Application name"
    ("rclone" is OK) then click on "Save" (all other data is optional).
    Click again on "Credentials" on the left panel to go back to the
    "Credentials" screen.

(PS: if you are a GSuite user, you could also select "Internal" instead
of "External" above, but this has not been tested/documented so far).

  1. Click on the "+ CREATE CREDENTIALS" button at the top of the screen,
    then select "OAuth client ID".

  2. Choose an application type of "Desktop app" if you using a Google account or "Other" if
    you using a GSuite account and click "Create". (the default name is fine)

  3. It will show you a client ID and client secret. Use these values
    in rclone config to add a new remote or edit an existing remote.

Be aware that, due to the "enhanced security" recently introduced by
Google, you are theoretically expected to "submit your app for verification"
and then wait a few weeks(!) for their response; in practice, you can go right
ahead and use the client ID and client secret with rclone, the only issue will
be a very scary confirmation screen shown when you connect via your browser
for rclone to be able to get its token-id (but as this only happens during
the remote configuration, it's not such a big deal).

(Thanks to @balazer on github for these instructions.)

Sometimes, creation of an OAuth consent in Google API Console fails due to an error message
“The request failed because changes to one of the field of the resource is not supported”.
As a convenient workaround, the necessary Google Drive API key can be created on the
Python Quickstart page.
Just push the Enable the Drive API button to receive the Client ID and Secret.
Note that it will automatically create a new project in the API Console.

Google Photos

The rclone backend for Google Photos is
a specialized backend for transferring photos and videos to and from
Google Photos.

NB The Google Photos API which rclone uses has quite a few
limitations, so please read the limitations section
carefully to make sure it is suitable for your use.

Configuring Google Photos

The initial setup for google cloud storage involves getting a token from Google Photos
which you need to do in your browser. rclone config walks you
through it.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Google Photos
   \ "google photos"
[snip]
Storage> google photos
** See help for google photos backend at: https://rclone.org/googlephotos/ **

Google Application Client Id
Leave blank normally.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
client_id> 
Google Application Client Secret
Leave blank normally.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
client_secret> 
Set to make the Google Photos backend read only.

If you choose read only then rclone will only request read only access
to your photos, otherwise rclone will request full access.
Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
read_only> 
Edit advanced config? (y/n)
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> n
Remote config
Use auto config?
 * Say Y if not sure
 * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> y
If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
Log in and authorize rclone for access
Waiting for code...
Got code

*** IMPORTANT: All media items uploaded to Google Photos with rclone
*** are stored in full resolution at original quality.  These uploads
*** will count towards storage in your Google Account.

--------------------
[remote]
type = google photos
token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"Bearer","refresh_token":"XXX","expiry":"2019-06-28T17:38:04.644930156+01:00"}
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the
token as returned from Google if you use auto config mode. This only
runs from the moment it opens your browser to the moment you get back
the verification code. This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this
may require you to unblock it temporarily if you are running a host
firewall, or use manual mode.

This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

See all the albums in your photos

rclone lsd remote:album

Make a new album

rclone mkdir remote:album/newAlbum

List the contents of an album

rclone ls remote:album/newAlbum

Sync /home/local/images to the Google Photos, removing any excess
files in the album.

rclone sync -i /home/local/image remote:album/newAlbum

Layout

As Google Photos is not a general purpose cloud storage system the
backend is laid out to help you navigate it.

The directories under media show different ways of categorizing the
media. Each file will appear multiple times. So if you want to make
a backup of your google photos you might choose to backup
remote:media/by-month. (NB remote:media/by-day is rather slow
at the moment so avoid for syncing.)

Note that all your photos and videos will appear somewhere under
media, but they may not appear under album unless you've put them
into albums.

/
- upload
    - file1.jpg
    - file2.jpg
    - ...
- media
    - all
        - file1.jpg
        - file2.jpg
        - ...
    - by-year
        - 2000
            - file1.jpg
            - ...
        - 2001
            - file2.jpg
            - ...
        - ...
    - by-month
        - 2000
            - 2000-01
                - file1.jpg
                - ...
            - 2000-02
                - file2.jpg
                - ...
        - ...
    - by-day
        - 2000
            - 2000-01-01
                - file1.jpg
                - ...
            - 2000-01-02
                - file2.jpg
                - ...
        - ...
- album
    - album name
    - album name/sub
- shared-album
    - album name
    - album name/sub
- feature
    - favorites
        - file1.jpg
        - file2.jpg

There are two writable parts of the tree, the upload directory and
sub directories of the album directory.

The upload directory is for uploading files you don't want to put
into albums. This will be empty to start with and will contain the
files you've uploaded for one rclone session only, becoming empty
again when you restart rclone. The use case for this would be if you
have a load of files you just want to once off dump into Google
Photos. For repeated syncing, uploading to album will work better.

Directories within the album directory are also writeable and you
may create new directories (albums) under album. If you copy files
with a directory hierarchy in there then rclone will create albums
with the / character in them. For example if you do

rclone copy /path/to/images remote:album/images

and the images directory contains

images
    - file1.jpg
    dir
        file2.jpg
    dir2
        dir3
            file3.jpg

Then rclone will create the following albums with the following files in

  • images
    • file1.jpg
  • images/dir
    • file2.jpg
  • images/dir2/dir3
    • file3.jpg

This means that you can use the album path pretty much like a normal
filesystem and it is a good target for repeated syncing.

The shared-album directory shows albums shared with you or by you.
This is similar to the Sharing tab in the Google Photos web interface.

Limitations

Only images and videos can be uploaded. If you attempt to upload non
videos or images or formats that Google Photos doesn't understand,
rclone will upload the file, then Google Photos will give an error
when it is put turned into a media item.

Note that all media items uploaded to Google Photos through the API
are stored in full resolution at "original quality" and will count
towards your storage quota in your Google Account. The API does
not offer a way to upload in "high quality" mode..

rclone about is not supported by the Google Photos backend. Backends without
this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or
use policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union
remote.

See List of backends that do not support rclone about
See rclone about

Downloading Images

When Images are downloaded this strips EXIF location (according to the
docs and my tests). This is a limitation of the Google Photos API and
is covered by bug #112096115.

The current google API does not allow photos to be downloaded at original resolution. This is very important if you are, for example, relying on "Google Photos" as a backup of your photos. You will not be able to use rclone to redownload original images. You could use 'google takeout' to recover the original photos as a last resort

Downloading Videos

When videos are downloaded they are downloaded in a really compressed
version of the video compared to downloading it via the Google Photos
web interface. This is covered by bug #113672044.

Duplicates

If a file name is duplicated in a directory then rclone will add the
file ID into its name. So two files called file.jpg would then
appear as file {123456}.jpg and file {ABCDEF}.jpg (the actual IDs
are a lot longer alas!).

If you upload the same image (with the same binary data) twice then
Google Photos will deduplicate it. However it will retain the
filename from the first upload which may confuse rclone. For example
if you uploaded an image to upload then uploaded the same image to
album/my_album the filename of the image in album/my_album will be
what it was uploaded with initially, not what you uploaded it with to
album. In practise this shouldn't cause too many problems.

Modified time

The date shown of media in Google Photos is the creation date as
determined by the EXIF information, or the upload date if that is not
known.

This is not changeable by rclone and is not the modification date of
the media on local disk. This means that rclone cannot use the dates
from Google Photos for syncing purposes.

Size

The Google Photos API does not return the size of media. This means
that when syncing to Google Photos, rclone can only do a file
existence check.

It is possible to read the size of the media, but this needs an extra
HTTP HEAD request per media item so is very slow and uses up a lot of
transactions. This can be enabled with the --gphotos-read-size
option or the read_size = true config parameter.

If you want to use the backend with rclone mount you may need to
enable this flag (depending on your OS and application using the
photos) otherwise you may not be able to read media off the mount.
You'll need to experiment to see if it works for you without the flag.

Albums

Rclone can only upload files to albums it created. This is a
limitation of the Google Photos API.

Rclone can remove files it uploaded from albums it created only.

Deleting files

Rclone can remove files from albums it created, but note that the
Google Photos API does not allow media to be deleted permanently so
this media will still remain. See bug #109759781.

Rclone cannot delete files anywhere except under album.

Deleting albums

The Google Photos API does not support deleting albums - see bug #135714733.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to google photos (Google Photos).

--gphotos-client-id

OAuth Client Id
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: client_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_CLIENT_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--gphotos-client-secret

OAuth Client Secret
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: client_secret
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_CLIENT_SECRET
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--gphotos-read-only

Set to make the Google Photos backend read only.

If you choose read only then rclone will only request read only access
to your photos, otherwise rclone will request full access.

  • Config: read_only
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_READ_ONLY
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to google photos (Google Photos).

--gphotos-token

OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

  • Config: token
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_TOKEN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--gphotos-auth-url

Auth server URL.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: auth_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_AUTH_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--gphotos-token-url

Token server url.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: token_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_TOKEN_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--gphotos-read-size

Set to read the size of media items.

Normally rclone does not read the size of media items since this takes
another transaction. This isn't necessary for syncing. However
rclone mount needs to know the size of files in advance of reading
them, so setting this flag when using rclone mount is recommended if
you want to read the media.

  • Config: read_size
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_READ_SIZE
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--gphotos-start-year

Year limits the photos to be downloaded to those which are uploaded after the given year

  • Config: start_year
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_START_YEAR
  • Type: int
  • Default: 2000

--gphotos-include-archived

Also view and download archived media.

By default rclone does not request archived media. Thus, when syncing,
archived media is not visible in directory listings or transferred.

Note that media in albums is always visible and synced, no matter
their archive status.

With this flag, archived media are always visible in directory
listings and transferred.

Without this flag, archived media will not be visible in directory
listings and won't be transferred.

  • Config: include_archived
  • Env Var: RCLONE_GPHOTOS_INCLUDE_ARCHIVED
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

HDFS

HDFS is a
distributed file-system, part of the Apache Hadoop framework.

Paths are specified as remote: or remote:path/to/dir.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[skip]
XX / Hadoop distributed file system
   \ "hdfs"
[skip]
Storage> hdfs
** See help for hdfs backend at: https://rclone.org/hdfs/ **

hadoop name node and port
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Connect to host namenode at port 8020
   \ "namenode:8020"
namenode> namenode.hadoop:8020
hadoop user name
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Connect to hdfs as root
   \ "root"
username> root
Edit advanced config? (y/n)
y) Yes
n) No (default)
y/n> n
Remote config
--------------------
[remote]
type = hdfs
namenode = namenode.hadoop:8020
username = root
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK (default)
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y
Current remotes:

Name                 Type
====                 ====
hadoop               hdfs

e) Edit existing remote
n) New remote
d) Delete remote
r) Rename remote
c) Copy remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
e/n/d/r/c/s/q> q

This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

See all the top level directories

rclone lsd remote:

List the contents of a directory

rclone ls remote:directory

Sync the remote directory to /home/local/directory, deleting any excess files.

rclone sync -i remote:directory /home/local/directory

Setting up your own HDFS instance for testing

You may start with a manual setup
or use the docker image from the tests:

If you want to build the docker image

git clone https://github.com/rclone/rclone.git
cd rclone/fstest/testserver/images/test-hdfs
docker build --rm -t rclone/test-hdfs .

Or you can just use the latest one pushed

docker run --rm --name "rclone-hdfs" -p 127.0.0.1:9866:9866 -p 127.0.0.1:8020:8020 --hostname "rclone-hdfs" rclone/test-hdfs

NB it need few seconds to startup.

For this docker image the remote needs to be configured like this:

[remote]
type = hdfs
namenode = 127.0.0.1:8020
username = root

You can stop this image with docker kill rclone-hdfs (NB it does not use volumes, so all data
uploaded will be lost.)

Modified time

Time accurate to 1 second is stored.

Checksum

No checksums are implemented.

Usage information

You can use the rclone about remote: command which will display filesystem size and current usage.

Restricted filename characters

In addition to the default restricted characters set
the following characters are also replaced:

Character Value Replacement
: 0x3A

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced.

Limitations

  • No server-side Move or DirMove.
  • Checksums not implemented.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to hdfs (Hadoop distributed file system).

--hdfs-namenode

hadoop name node and port

  • Config: namenode
  • Env Var: RCLONE_HDFS_NAMENODE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "namenode:8020"
      • Connect to host namenode at port 8020

--hdfs-username

hadoop user name

  • Config: username
  • Env Var: RCLONE_HDFS_USERNAME
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "root"
      • Connect to hdfs as root

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to hdfs (Hadoop distributed file system).

--hdfs-service-principal-name

Kerberos service principal name for the namenode

Enables KERBEROS authentication. Specifies the Service Principal Name
(/) for the namenode.

  • Config: service_principal_name
  • Env Var: RCLONE_HDFS_SERVICE_PRINCIPAL_NAME
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "hdfs/namenode.hadoop.docker"
      • Namenode running as service 'hdfs' with FQDN 'namenode.hadoop.docker'.

--hdfs-data-transfer-protection

Kerberos data transfer protection: authentication|integrity|privacy

Specifies whether or not authentication, data signature integrity
checks, and wire encryption is required when communicating the the
datanodes. Possible values are 'authentication', 'integrity' and
'privacy'. Used only with KERBEROS enabled.

  • Config: data_transfer_protection
  • Env Var: RCLONE_HDFS_DATA_TRANSFER_PROTECTION
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "privacy"
      • Ensure authentication, integrity and encryption enabled.

--hdfs-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_HDFS_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,Colon,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

HTTP

The HTTP remote is a read only remote for reading files of a
webserver. The webserver should provide file listings which rclone
will read and turn into a remote. This has been tested with common
webservers such as Apache/Nginx/Caddy and will likely work with file
listings from most web servers. (If it doesn't then please file an
issue, or send a pull request!)

Paths are specified as remote: or remote:path/to/dir.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First
run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / http Connection
   \ "http"
[snip]
Storage> http
URL of http host to connect to
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Connect to example.com
   \ "https://example.com"
url> https://beta.rclone.org
Remote config
--------------------
[remote]
url = https://beta.rclone.org
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y
Current remotes:

Name                 Type
====                 ====
remote               http

e) Edit existing remote
n) New remote
d) Delete remote
r) Rename remote
c) Copy remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
e/n/d/r/c/s/q> q

This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

See all the top level directories

rclone lsd remote:

List the contents of a directory

rclone ls remote:directory

Sync the remote directory to /home/local/directory, deleting any excess files.

rclone sync -i remote:directory /home/local/directory

Read only

This remote is read only - you can't upload files to an HTTP server.

Modified time

Most HTTP servers store time accurate to 1 second.

Checksum

No checksums are stored.

Usage without a config file

Since the http remote only has one config parameter it is easy to use
without a config file:

rclone lsd --http-url https://beta.rclone.org :http:

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to http (http Connection).

--http-url

URL of http host to connect to

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to http (http Connection).

--http-headers

Set HTTP headers for all transactions

Use this to set additional HTTP headers for all transactions

The input format is comma separated list of key,value pairs. Standard
CSV encoding may be used.

For example to set a Cookie use 'Cookie,name=value', or '"Cookie","name=value"'.

You can set multiple headers, e.g. '"Cookie","name=value","Authorization","xxx"'.

  • Config: headers
  • Env Var: RCLONE_HTTP_HEADERS
  • Type: CommaSepList
  • Default:

--http-no-slash

Set this if the site doesn't end directories with /

Use this if your target website does not use / on the end of
directories.

A / on the end of a path is how rclone normally tells the difference
between files and directories. If this flag is set, then rclone will
treat all files with Content-Type: text/html as directories and read
URLs from them rather than downloading them.

Note that this may cause rclone to confuse genuine HTML files with
directories.

  • Config: no_slash
  • Env Var: RCLONE_HTTP_NO_SLASH
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--http-no-head

Don't use HEAD requests to find file sizes in dir listing

If your site is being very slow to load then you can try this option.
Normally rclone does a HEAD request for each potential file in a
directory listing to:

  • find its size
  • check it really exists
  • check to see if it is a directory

If you set this option, rclone will not do the HEAD request. This will mean

  • directory listings are much quicker

  • rclone won't have the times or sizes of any files

  • some files that don't exist may be in the listing

  • Config: no_head

  • Env Var: RCLONE_HTTP_NO_HEAD

  • Type: bool

  • Default: false

Limitations

rclone about is not supported by the HTTP backend. Backends without
this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or
use policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union
remote.

See List of backends that do not support rclone about
See rclone about

Hubic

Paths are specified as remote:path

Paths are specified as remote:container (or remote: for the lsd
command.) You may put subdirectories in too, e.g. remote:container/path/to/dir.

The initial setup for Hubic involves getting a token from Hubic which
you need to do in your browser. rclone config walks you through it.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
n/s> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Hubic
   \ "hubic"
[snip]
Storage> hubic
Hubic Client Id - leave blank normally.
client_id>
Hubic Client Secret - leave blank normally.
client_secret>
Remote config
Use auto config?
 * Say Y if not sure
 * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> y
If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
Log in and authorize rclone for access
Waiting for code...
Got code
--------------------
[remote]
client_id =
client_secret =
token = {"access_token":"XXXXXX"}
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

See the remote setup docs for how to set it up on a
machine with no Internet browser available.

Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the
token as returned from Hubic. This only runs from the moment it opens
your browser to the moment you get back the verification code. This
is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require you to unblock
it temporarily if you are running a host firewall.

Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

List containers in the top level of your Hubic

rclone lsd remote:

List all the files in your Hubic

rclone ls remote:

To copy a local directory to an Hubic directory called backup

rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

If you want the directory to be visible in the official Hubic
browser
, you need to copy your files to the default directory

rclone copy /home/source remote:default/backup

--fast-list

This remote supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer
transactions in exchange for more memory. See the rclone
docs
for more details.

Modified time

The modified time is stored as metadata on the object as
X-Object-Meta-Mtime as floating point since the epoch accurate to 1
ns.

This is a de facto standard (used in the official python-swiftclient
amongst others) for storing the modification time for an object.

Note that Hubic wraps the Swift backend, so most of the properties of
are the same.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to hubic (Hubic).

--hubic-client-id

OAuth Client Id
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: client_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_HUBIC_CLIENT_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--hubic-client-secret

OAuth Client Secret
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: client_secret
  • Env Var: RCLONE_HUBIC_CLIENT_SECRET
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to hubic (Hubic).

--hubic-token

OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

  • Config: token
  • Env Var: RCLONE_HUBIC_TOKEN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--hubic-auth-url

Auth server URL.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: auth_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_HUBIC_AUTH_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--hubic-token-url

Token server url.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: token_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_HUBIC_TOKEN_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--hubic-chunk-size

Above this size files will be chunked into a _segments container.

Above this size files will be chunked into a _segments container. The
default for this is 5GB which is its maximum value.

  • Config: chunk_size
  • Env Var: RCLONE_HUBIC_CHUNK_SIZE
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 5G

--hubic-no-chunk

Don't chunk files during streaming upload.

When doing streaming uploads (e.g. using rcat or mount) setting this
flag will cause the swift backend to not upload chunked files.

This will limit the maximum upload size to 5GB. However non chunked
files are easier to deal with and have an MD5SUM.

Rclone will still chunk files bigger than chunk_size when doing normal
copy operations.

  • Config: no_chunk
  • Env Var: RCLONE_HUBIC_NO_CHUNK
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--hubic-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_HUBIC_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,InvalidUtf8

Limitations

This uses the normal OpenStack Swift mechanism to refresh the Swift
API credentials and ignores the expires field returned by the Hubic
API.

The Swift API doesn't return a correct MD5SUM for segmented files
(Dynamic or Static Large Objects) so rclone won't check or use the
MD5SUM for these.

Jottacloud

Jottacloud is a cloud storage service provider from a Norwegian company, using its own datacenters in Norway.

In addition to the official service at jottacloud.com, there are
also several whitelabel versions which should work with this backend.

Paths are specified as remote:path

Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

Setup

Default Setup

To configure Jottacloud you will need to generate a personal security token in the Jottacloud web interface.
You will the option to do in your account security settings
(for whitelabel version you need to find this page in its web interface).
Note that the web interface may refer to this token as a JottaCli token.

Legacy Setup

If you are using one of the whitelabel versions (Elgiganten, Com Hem Cloud) you may not have the option
to generate a CLI token. In this case you'll have to use the legacy authentication. To to this select
yes when the setup asks for legacy authentication and enter your username and password.
The rest of the setup is identical to the default setup.

Telia Cloud Setup

Similar to other whitelabel versions Telia Cloud doesn't offer the option of creating a CLI token, and
additionally uses a separate authentication flow where the username is generated internally. To setup
rclone to use Telia Cloud, choose Telia Cloud authentication in the setup. The rest of the setup is
identical to the default setup.

Example

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote with the default setup. First run:

rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Jottacloud
   \ "jottacloud"
[snip]
Storage> jottacloud
** See help for jottacloud backend at: https://rclone.org/jottacloud/ **

Edit advanced config? (y/n)
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> n
Remote config
Use legacy authentication?.
This is only required for certain whitelabel versions of Jottacloud and not recommended for normal users.
y) Yes
n) No (default)
y/n> n

Generate a personal login token here: https://www.jottacloud.com/web/secure
Login Token> <your token here>

Do you want to use a non standard device/mountpoint e.g. for accessing files uploaded using the official Jottacloud client?

y) Yes
n) No
y/n> y
Please select the device to use. Normally this will be Jotta
Choose a number from below, or type in an existing value
 1 > DESKTOP-3H31129
 2 > Jotta
Devices> 2
Please select the mountpoint to user. Normally this will be Archive
Choose a number from below, or type in an existing value
 1 > Archive
 2 > Links
 3 > Sync
 
Mountpoints> 1
--------------------
[jotta]
type = jottacloud
token = {........}
device = Jotta
mountpoint = Archive
configVersion = 1
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

List directories in top level of your Jottacloud

rclone lsd remote:

List all the files in your Jottacloud

rclone ls remote:

To copy a local directory to an Jottacloud directory called backup

rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Devices and Mountpoints

The official Jottacloud client registers a device for each computer you install it on,
and then creates a mountpoint for each folder you select for Backup.
The web interface uses a special device called Jotta for the Archive and Sync mountpoints.
In most cases you'll want to use the Jotta/Archive device/mountpoint, however if you want to access
files uploaded by any of the official clients rclone provides the option to select other devices
and mountpoints during config.

The built-in Jotta device may also contain several other mountpoints, such as: Latest, Links, Shared and Trash.
These are special mountpoints with a different internal representation than the "regular" mountpoints.
Rclone will only to a very limited degree support them. Generally you should avoid these, unless you know what you
are doing.

--fast-list

This remote supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer
transactions in exchange for more memory. See the rclone
docs
for more details.

Note that the implementation in Jottacloud always uses only a single
API request to get the entire list, so for large folders this could
lead to long wait time before the first results are shown.

Modified time and hashes

Jottacloud allows modification times to be set on objects accurate to 1
second. These will be used to detect whether objects need syncing or
not.

Jottacloud supports MD5 type hashes, so you can use the --checksum
flag.

Note that Jottacloud requires the MD5 hash before upload so if the
source does not have an MD5 checksum then the file will be cached
temporarily on disk (wherever the TMPDIR environment variable points
to) before it is uploaded. Small files will be cached in memory - see
the --jottacloud-md5-memory-limit flag.
When uploading from local disk the source checksum is always available,
so this does not apply. Starting with rclone version 1.52 the same is
true for crypted remotes (in older versions the crypt backend would not
calculate hashes for uploads from local disk, so the Jottacloud
backend had to do it as described above).

Restricted filename characters

In addition to the default restricted characters set
the following characters are also replaced:

Character Value Replacement
" 0x22
* 0x2A
: 0x3A
< 0x3C
> 0x3E
? 0x3F
| 0x7C

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in XML strings.

Deleting files

By default rclone will send all files to the trash when deleting files. They will be permanently
deleted automatically after 30 days. You may bypass the trash and permanently delete files immediately
by using the --jottacloud-hard-delete flag, or set the equivalent environment variable.
Emptying the trash is supported by the cleanup command.

Versions

Jottacloud supports file versioning. When rclone uploads a new version of a file it creates a new version of it.
Currently rclone only supports retrieving the current version but older versions can be accessed via the Jottacloud Website.

Quota information

To view your current quota you can use the rclone about remote:
command which will display your usage limit (unless it is unlimited)
and the current usage.

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to jottacloud (Jottacloud).

--jottacloud-md5-memory-limit

Files bigger than this will be cached on disk to calculate the MD5 if required.

  • Config: md5_memory_limit
  • Env Var: RCLONE_JOTTACLOUD_MD5_MEMORY_LIMIT
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 10M

--jottacloud-trashed-only

Only show files that are in the trash.
This will show trashed files in their original directory structure.

  • Config: trashed_only
  • Env Var: RCLONE_JOTTACLOUD_TRASHED_ONLY
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--jottacloud-hard-delete

Delete files permanently rather than putting them into the trash.

  • Config: hard_delete
  • Env Var: RCLONE_JOTTACLOUD_HARD_DELETE
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--jottacloud-upload-resume-limit

Files bigger than this can be resumed if the upload fail's.

  • Config: upload_resume_limit
  • Env Var: RCLONE_JOTTACLOUD_UPLOAD_RESUME_LIMIT
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 10M

--jottacloud-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_JOTTACLOUD_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

Note that Jottacloud is case insensitive so you can't have a file called
"Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

There are quite a few characters that can't be in Jottacloud file names. Rclone will map these names to and from an identical
looking unicode equivalent. For example if a file has a ? in it will be mapped to instead.

Jottacloud only supports filenames up to 255 characters in length.

Troubleshooting

Jottacloud exhibits some inconsistent behaviours regarding deleted files and folders which may cause Copy, Move and DirMove
operations to previously deleted paths to fail. Emptying the trash should help in such cases.

Koofr

Paths are specified as remote:path

Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

The initial setup for Koofr involves creating an application password for
rclone. You can do that by opening the Koofr
web application,
giving the password a nice name like rclone and clicking on generate.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called koofr. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> koofr 
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Koofr
   \ "koofr"
[snip]
Storage> koofr
** See help for koofr backend at: https://rclone.org/koofr/ **

Your Koofr user name
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
user> USER@NAME
Your Koofr password for rclone (generate one at https://app.koofr.net/app/admin/preferences/password)
y) Yes type in my own password
g) Generate random password
y/g> y
Enter the password:
password:
Confirm the password:
password:
Edit advanced config? (y/n)
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> n
Remote config
--------------------
[koofr]
type = koofr
baseurl = https://app.koofr.net
user = USER@NAME
password = *** ENCRYPTED ***
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

You can choose to edit advanced config in order to enter your own service URL
if you use an on-premise or white label Koofr instance, or choose an alternative
mount instead of your primary storage.

Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

List directories in top level of your Koofr

rclone lsd koofr:

List all the files in your Koofr

rclone ls koofr:

To copy a local directory to an Koofr directory called backup

rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Restricted filename characters

In addition to the default restricted characters set
the following characters are also replaced:

Character Value Replacement
\ 0x5C

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in XML strings.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to koofr (Koofr).

--koofr-user

Your Koofr user name

  • Config: user
  • Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_USER
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--koofr-password

Your Koofr password for rclone (generate one at https://app.koofr.net/app/admin/preferences/password)

NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure.

  • Config: password
  • Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_PASSWORD
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to koofr (Koofr).

--koofr-endpoint

The Koofr API endpoint to use

--koofr-mountid

Mount ID of the mount to use. If omitted, the primary mount is used.

  • Config: mountid
  • Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_MOUNTID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--koofr-setmtime

Does the backend support setting modification time. Set this to false if you use a mount ID that points to a Dropbox or Amazon Drive backend.

  • Config: setmtime
  • Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_SETMTIME
  • Type: bool
  • Default: true

--koofr-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_KOOFR_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

Note that Koofr is case insensitive so you can't have a file called
"Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

Mail.ru Cloud

Mail.ru Cloud is a cloud storage provided by a Russian internet company Mail.Ru Group. The official desktop client is Disk-O:, available only on Windows. (Please note that official sites are in Russian)

Currently it is recommended to disable 2FA on Mail.ru accounts intended for rclone until it gets eventually implemented.

Features highlights

  • Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory
  • Files have a last modified time property, directories don't
  • Deleted files are by default moved to the trash
  • Files and directories can be shared via public links
  • Partial uploads or streaming are not supported, file size must be known before upload
  • Maximum file size is limited to 2G for a free account, unlimited for paid accounts
  • Storage keeps hash for all files and performs transparent deduplication,
    the hash algorithm is a modified SHA1
  • If a particular file is already present in storage, one can quickly submit file hash
    instead of long file upload (this optimization is supported by rclone)

Configuration

Here is an example of making a mailru configuration. First create a Mail.ru Cloud
account and choose a tariff, then run

rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Mail.ru Cloud
   \ "mailru"
[snip]
Storage> mailru
User name (usually email)
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
user> username@mail.ru
Password
y) Yes type in my own password
g) Generate random password
y/g> y
Enter the password:
password:
Confirm the password:
password:
Skip full upload if there is another file with same data hash.
This feature is called "speedup" or "put by hash". It is especially efficient
in case of generally available files like popular books, video or audio clips
[snip]
Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("true").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Enable
   \ "true"
 2 / Disable
   \ "false"
speedup_enable> 1
Edit advanced config? (y/n)
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> n
Remote config
--------------------
[remote]
type = mailru
user = username@mail.ru
pass = *** ENCRYPTED ***
speedup_enable = true
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

Configuration of this backend does not require a local web browser.
You can use the configured backend as shown below:

See top level directories

rclone lsd remote:

Make a new directory

rclone mkdir remote:directory

List the contents of a directory

rclone ls remote:directory

Sync /home/local/directory to the remote path, deleting any
excess files in the path.

rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:directory

Modified time

Files support a modification time attribute with up to 1 second precision.
Directories do not have a modification time, which is shown as "Jan 1 1970".

Hash checksums

Hash sums use a custom Mail.ru algorithm based on SHA1.
If file size is less than or equal to the SHA1 block size (20 bytes),
its hash is simply its data right-padded with zero bytes.
Hash sum of a larger file is computed as a SHA1 sum of the file data
bytes concatenated with a decimal representation of the data length.

Emptying Trash

Removing a file or directory actually moves it to the trash, which is not
visible to rclone but can be seen in a web browser. The trashed file
still occupies part of total quota. If you wish to empty your trash
and free some quota, you can use the rclone cleanup remote: command,
which will permanently delete all your trashed files.
This command does not take any path arguments.

Quota information

To view your current quota you can use the rclone about remote:
command which will display your usage limit (quota) and the current usage.

Restricted filename characters

In addition to the default restricted characters set
the following characters are also replaced:

Character Value Replacement
" 0x22
* 0x2A
: 0x3A
< 0x3C
> 0x3E
? 0x3F
\ 0x5C
| 0x7C

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Limitations

File size limits depend on your account. A single file size is limited by 2G
for a free account and unlimited for paid tariffs. Please refer to the Mail.ru
site for the total uploaded size limits.

Note that Mailru is case insensitive so you can't have a file called
"Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to mailru (Mail.ru Cloud).

--mailru-user

User name (usually email)

  • Config: user
  • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_USER
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--mailru-pass

Password

NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure.

  • Config: pass
  • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_PASS
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--mailru-speedup-enable

Skip full upload if there is another file with same data hash.
This feature is called "speedup" or "put by hash". It is especially efficient
in case of generally available files like popular books, video or audio clips,
because files are searched by hash in all accounts of all mailru users.
It is meaningless and ineffective if source file is unique or encrypted.
Please note that rclone may need local memory and disk space to calculate
content hash in advance and decide whether full upload is required.
Also, if rclone does not know file size in advance (e.g. in case of
streaming or partial uploads), it will not even try this optimization.

  • Config: speedup_enable
  • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_SPEEDUP_ENABLE
  • Type: bool
  • Default: true
  • Examples:
    • "true"
      • Enable
    • "false"
      • Disable

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to mailru (Mail.ru Cloud).

--mailru-speedup-file-patterns

Comma separated list of file name patterns eligible for speedup (put by hash).
Patterns are case insensitive and can contain '*' or '?' meta characters.

  • Config: speedup_file_patterns
  • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_SPEEDUP_FILE_PATTERNS
  • Type: string
  • Default: ".mkv,.avi,.mp4,.mp3,.zip,.gz,.rar,.pdf"
  • Examples:
    • ""
      • Empty list completely disables speedup (put by hash).
    • "*"
      • All files will be attempted for speedup.
    • ".mkv,.avi,.mp4,.mp3"
      • Only common audio/video files will be tried for put by hash.
    • ".zip,.gz,.rar,.pdf"
      • Only common archives or PDF books will be tried for speedup.

--mailru-speedup-max-disk

This option allows you to disable speedup (put by hash) for large files
(because preliminary hashing can exhaust you RAM or disk space)

  • Config: speedup_max_disk
  • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_SPEEDUP_MAX_DISK
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 3G
  • Examples:
    • "0"
      • Completely disable speedup (put by hash).
    • "1G"
      • Files larger than 1Gb will be uploaded directly.
    • "3G"
      • Choose this option if you have less than 3Gb free on local disk.

--mailru-speedup-max-memory

Files larger than the size given below will always be hashed on disk.

  • Config: speedup_max_memory
  • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_SPEEDUP_MAX_MEMORY
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 32M
  • Examples:
    • "0"
      • Preliminary hashing will always be done in a temporary disk location.
    • "32M"
      • Do not dedicate more than 32Mb RAM for preliminary hashing.
    • "256M"
      • You have at most 256Mb RAM free for hash calculations.

--mailru-check-hash

What should copy do if file checksum is mismatched or invalid

  • Config: check_hash
  • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_CHECK_HASH
  • Type: bool
  • Default: true
  • Examples:
    • "true"
      • Fail with error.
    • "false"
      • Ignore and continue.

--mailru-user-agent

HTTP user agent used internally by client.
Defaults to "rclone/VERSION" or "--user-agent" provided on command line.

  • Config: user_agent
  • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_USER_AGENT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--mailru-quirks

Comma separated list of internal maintenance flags.
This option must not be used by an ordinary user. It is intended only to
facilitate remote troubleshooting of backend issues. Strict meaning of
flags is not documented and not guaranteed to persist between releases.
Quirks will be removed when the backend grows stable.
Supported quirks: atomicmkdir binlist unknowndirs

  • Config: quirks
  • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_QUIRKS
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--mailru-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_MAILRU_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Mega

Mega is a cloud storage and file hosting service
known for its security feature where all files are encrypted locally
before they are uploaded. This prevents anyone (including employees of
Mega) from accessing the files without knowledge of the key used for
encryption.

This is an rclone backend for Mega which supports the file transfer
features of Mega using the same client side encryption.

Paths are specified as remote:path

Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Mega
   \ "mega"
[snip]
Storage> mega
User name
user> you@example.com
Password.
y) Yes type in my own password
g) Generate random password
n) No leave this optional password blank
y/g/n> y
Enter the password:
password:
Confirm the password:
password:
Remote config
--------------------
[remote]
type = mega
user = you@example.com
pass = *** ENCRYPTED ***
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

NOTE: The encryption keys need to have been already generated after a regular login
via the browser, otherwise attempting to use the credentials in rclone will fail.

Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

List directories in top level of your Mega

rclone lsd remote:

List all the files in your Mega

rclone ls remote:

To copy a local directory to an Mega directory called backup

rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Modified time and hashes

Mega does not support modification times or hashes yet.

Restricted filename characters

Character Value Replacement
NUL 0x00
/ 0x2F

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Duplicated files

Mega can have two files with exactly the same name and path (unlike a
normal file system).

Duplicated files cause problems with the syncing and you will see
messages in the log about duplicates.

Use rclone dedupe to fix duplicated files.

Failure to log-in

Mega remotes seem to get blocked (reject logins) under "heavy use".
We haven't worked out the exact blocking rules but it seems to be
related to fast paced, successive rclone commands.

For example, executing this command 90 times in a row rclone link remote:file will cause the remote to become "blocked". This is not an
abnormal situation, for example if you wish to get the public links of
a directory with hundred of files... After more or less a week, the
remote will remote accept rclone logins normally again.

You can mitigate this issue by mounting the remote it with rclone mount. This will log-in when mounting and a log-out when unmounting
only. You can also run rclone rcd and then use rclone rc to run
the commands over the API to avoid logging in each time.

Rclone does not currently close mega sessions (you can see them in the
web interface), however closing the sessions does not solve the issue.

If you space rclone commands by 3 seconds it will avoid blocking the
remote. We haven't identified the exact blocking rules, so perhaps one
could execute the command 80 times without waiting and avoid blocking
by waiting 3 seconds, then continuing...

Note that this has been observed by trial and error and might not be
set in stone.

Other tools seem not to produce this blocking effect, as they use a
different working approach (state-based, using sessionIDs instead of
log-in) which isn't compatible with the current stateless rclone
approach.

Note that once blocked, the use of other tools (such as megacmd) is
not a sure workaround: following megacmd login times have been
observed in succession for blocked remote: 7 minutes, 20 min, 30min, 30
min, 30min. Web access looks unaffected though.

Investigation is continuing in relation to workarounds based on
timeouts, pacers, retrials and tpslimits - if you discover something
relevant, please post on the forum.

So, if rclone was working nicely and suddenly you are unable to log-in
and you are sure the user and the password are correct, likely you
have got the remote blocked for a while.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to mega (Mega).

--mega-user

User name

  • Config: user
  • Env Var: RCLONE_MEGA_USER
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--mega-pass

Password.

NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure.

  • Config: pass
  • Env Var: RCLONE_MEGA_PASS
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to mega (Mega).

--mega-debug

Output more debug from Mega.

If this flag is set (along with -vv) it will print further debugging
information from the mega backend.

  • Config: debug
  • Env Var: RCLONE_MEGA_DEBUG
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--mega-hard-delete

Delete files permanently rather than putting them into the trash.

Normally the mega backend will put all deletions into the trash rather
than permanently deleting them. If you specify this then rclone will
permanently delete objects instead.

  • Config: hard_delete
  • Env Var: RCLONE_MEGA_HARD_DELETE
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--mega-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_MEGA_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

This backend uses the go-mega go library which is an opensource
go library implementing the Mega API. There doesn't appear to be any
documentation for the mega protocol beyond the mega C++ SDK source code
so there are likely quite a few errors still remaining in this library.

Mega allows duplicate files which may confuse rclone.

Memory

The memory backend is an in RAM backend. It does not persist its
data - use the local backend for that.

The memory backend behaves like a bucket based remote (e.g. like
s3). Because it has no parameters you can just use it with the
:memory: remote name.

You can configure it as a remote like this with rclone config too if
you want to:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Memory
   \ "memory"
[snip]
Storage> memory
** See help for memory backend at: https://rclone.org/memory/ **

Remote config

--------------------
[remote]
type = memory
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK (default)
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

Because the memory backend isn't persistent it is most useful for
testing or with an rclone server or rclone mount, e.g.

rclone mount :memory: /mnt/tmp
rclone serve webdav :memory:
rclone serve sftp :memory:

Modified time and hashes

The memory backend supports MD5 hashes and modification times accurate to 1 nS.

Restricted filename characters

The memory backend replaces the default restricted characters
set
.

Microsoft Azure Blob Storage

Paths are specified as remote:container (or remote: for the lsd
command.) You may put subdirectories in too, e.g.
remote:container/path/to/dir.

Here is an example of making a Microsoft Azure Blob Storage
configuration. For a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Microsoft Azure Blob Storage
   \ "azureblob"
[snip]
Storage> azureblob
Storage Account Name
account> account_name
Storage Account Key
key> base64encodedkey==
Endpoint for the service - leave blank normally.
endpoint> 
Remote config
--------------------
[remote]
account = account_name
key = base64encodedkey==
endpoint = 
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

See all containers

rclone lsd remote:

Make a new container

rclone mkdir remote:container

List the contents of a container

rclone ls remote:container

Sync /home/local/directory to the remote container, deleting any excess
files in the container.

rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:container

--fast-list

This remote supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer
transactions in exchange for more memory. See the rclone
docs
for more details.

Modified time

The modified time is stored as metadata on the object with the mtime
key. It is stored using RFC3339 Format time with nanosecond
precision. The metadata is supplied during directory listings so
there is no overhead to using it.

Restricted filename characters

In addition to the default restricted characters set
the following characters are also replaced:

Character Value Replacement
/ 0x2F
\ 0x5C

File names can also not end with the following characters.
These only get replaced if they are the last character in the name:

Character Value Replacement
. 0x2E

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Hashes

MD5 hashes are stored with blobs. However blobs that were uploaded in
chunks only have an MD5 if the source remote was capable of MD5
hashes, e.g. the local disk.

Authenticating with Azure Blob Storage

Rclone has 3 ways of authenticating with Azure Blob Storage:

Account and Key

This is the most straight forward and least flexible way. Just fill
in the account and key lines and leave the rest blank.

SAS URL

This can be an account level SAS URL or container level SAS URL.

To use it leave account, key blank and fill in sas_url.

An account level SAS URL or container level SAS URL can be obtained
from the Azure portal or the Azure Storage Explorer. To get a
container level SAS URL right click on a container in the Azure Blob
explorer in the Azure portal.

If you use a container level SAS URL, rclone operations are permitted
only on a particular container, e.g.

rclone ls azureblob:container

You can also list the single container from the root. This will only
show the container specified by the SAS URL.

$ rclone lsd azureblob:
container/

Note that you can't see or access any other containers - this will
fail

rclone ls azureblob:othercontainer

Container level SAS URLs are useful for temporarily allowing third
parties access to a single container or putting credentials into an
untrusted environment such as a CI build server.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to azureblob (Microsoft Azure Blob Storage).

--azureblob-account

Storage Account Name (leave blank to use SAS URL or Emulator)

  • Config: account
  • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_ACCOUNT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--azureblob-service-principal-file

Path to file containing credentials for use with a service principal.

Leave blank normally. Needed only if you want to use a service principal instead of interactive login.

$ az sp create-for-rbac --name "<name>" \
  --role "Storage Blob Data Owner" \
  --scopes "/subscriptions/<subscription>/resourceGroups/<resource-group>/providers/Microsoft.Storage/storageAccounts/<storage-account>/blobServices/default/containers/<container>" \
  > azure-principal.json

See Use Azure CLI to assign an Azure role for access to blob and queue data
for more details.

  • Config: service_principal_file
  • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_SERVICE_PRINCIPAL_FILE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--azureblob-key

Storage Account Key (leave blank to use SAS URL or Emulator)

  • Config: key
  • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_KEY
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--azureblob-sas-url

SAS URL for container level access only
(leave blank if using account/key or Emulator)

  • Config: sas_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_SAS_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--azureblob-use-msi

Use a managed service identity to authenticate (only works in Azure)

When true, use a managed service identity
to authenticate to Azure Storage instead of a SAS token or account key.

If the VM(SS) on which this program is running has a system-assigned identity, it will
be used by default. If the resource has no system-assigned but exactly one user-assigned identity,
the user-assigned identity will be used by default. If the resource has multiple user-assigned
identities, the identity to use must be explicitly specified using exactly one of the msi_object_id,
msi_client_id, or msi_mi_res_id parameters.

  • Config: use_msi
  • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_USE_MSI
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--azureblob-use-emulator

Uses local storage emulator if provided as 'true' (leave blank if using real azure storage endpoint)

  • Config: use_emulator
  • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_USE_EMULATOR
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to azureblob (Microsoft Azure Blob Storage).

--azureblob-msi-object-id

Object ID of the user-assigned MSI to use, if any. Leave blank if msi_client_id or msi_mi_res_id specified.

  • Config: msi_object_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_MSI_OBJECT_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--azureblob-msi-client-id

Object ID of the user-assigned MSI to use, if any. Leave blank if msi_object_id or msi_mi_res_id specified.

  • Config: msi_client_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_MSI_CLIENT_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--azureblob-msi-mi-res-id

Azure resource ID of the user-assigned MSI to use, if any. Leave blank if msi_client_id or msi_object_id specified.

  • Config: msi_mi_res_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_MSI_MI_RES_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--azureblob-endpoint

Endpoint for the service
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: endpoint
  • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_ENDPOINT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--azureblob-upload-cutoff

Cutoff for switching to chunked upload (<= 256MB). (Deprecated)

  • Config: upload_cutoff
  • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_UPLOAD_CUTOFF
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--azureblob-chunk-size

Upload chunk size (<= 100MB).

Note that this is stored in memory and there may be up to
"--transfers" chunks stored at once in memory.

  • Config: chunk_size
  • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_CHUNK_SIZE
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 4M

--azureblob-list-chunk

Size of blob list.

This sets the number of blobs requested in each listing chunk. Default
is the maximum, 5000. "List blobs" requests are permitted 2 minutes
per megabyte to complete. If an operation is taking longer than 2
minutes per megabyte on average, it will time out (
source
). This can be used to limit the number of blobs items to return, to
avoid the time out.

  • Config: list_chunk
  • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_LIST_CHUNK
  • Type: int
  • Default: 5000

--azureblob-access-tier

Access tier of blob: hot, cool or archive.

Archived blobs can be restored by setting access tier to hot or
cool. Leave blank if you intend to use default access tier, which is
set at account level

If there is no "access tier" specified, rclone doesn't apply any tier.
rclone performs "Set Tier" operation on blobs while uploading, if objects
are not modified, specifying "access tier" to new one will have no effect.
If blobs are in "archive tier" at remote, trying to perform data transfer
operations from remote will not be allowed. User should first restore by
tiering blob to "Hot" or "Cool".

  • Config: access_tier
  • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_ACCESS_TIER
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--azureblob-archive-tier-delete

Delete archive tier blobs before overwriting.

Archive tier blobs cannot be updated. So without this flag, if you
attempt to update an archive tier blob, then rclone will produce the
error:

can't update archive tier blob without --azureblob-archive-tier-delete

With this flag set then before rclone attempts to overwrite an archive
tier blob, it will delete the existing blob before uploading its
replacement. This has the potential for data loss if the upload fails
(unlike updating a normal blob) and also may cost more since deleting
archive tier blobs early may be chargable.

  • Config: archive_tier_delete
  • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_ARCHIVE_TIER_DELETE
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--azureblob-disable-checksum

Don't store MD5 checksum with object metadata.

Normally rclone will calculate the MD5 checksum of the input before
uploading it so it can add it to metadata on the object. This is great
for data integrity checking but can cause long delays for large files
to start uploading.

  • Config: disable_checksum
  • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_DISABLE_CHECKSUM
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--azureblob-memory-pool-flush-time

How often internal memory buffer pools will be flushed.
Uploads which requires additional buffers (f.e multipart) will use memory pool for allocations.
This option controls how often unused buffers will be removed from the pool.

  • Config: memory_pool_flush_time
  • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_MEMORY_POOL_FLUSH_TIME
  • Type: Duration
  • Default: 1m0s

--azureblob-memory-pool-use-mmap

Whether to use mmap buffers in internal memory pool.

  • Config: memory_pool_use_mmap
  • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_MEMORY_POOL_USE_MMAP
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--azureblob-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_AZUREBLOB_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8

Limitations

MD5 sums are only uploaded with chunked files if the source has an MD5
sum. This will always be the case for a local to azure copy.

rclone about is not supported by the Microsoft Azure Blob storage backend. Backends without
this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or
use policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union
remote.

See List of backends that do not support rclone about
See rclone about

Azure Storage Emulator Support

You can test rclone with storage emulator locally, to do this make sure azure storage emulator
installed locally and set up a new remote with rclone config follow instructions described in
introduction, set use_emulator config as true, you do not need to provide default account name
or key if using emulator.

Microsoft OneDrive

Paths are specified as remote:path

Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

The initial setup for OneDrive involves getting a token from
Microsoft which you need to do in your browser. rclone config walks
you through it.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

e) Edit existing remote
n) New remote
d) Delete remote
r) Rename remote
c) Copy remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
e/n/d/r/c/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Microsoft OneDrive
   \ "onedrive"
[snip]
Storage> onedrive
Microsoft App Client Id
Leave blank normally.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
client_id>
Microsoft App Client Secret
Leave blank normally.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
client_secret>
Edit advanced config? (y/n)
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> n
Remote config
Use auto config?
 * Say Y if not sure
 * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> y
If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
Log in and authorize rclone for access
Waiting for code...
Got code
Choose a number from below, or type in an existing value
 1 / OneDrive Personal or Business
   \ "onedrive"
 2 / Sharepoint site
   \ "sharepoint"
 3 / Type in driveID
   \ "driveid"
 4 / Type in SiteID
   \ "siteid"
 5 / Search a Sharepoint site
   \ "search"
Your choice> 1
Found 1 drives, please select the one you want to use:
0: OneDrive (business) id=b!Eqwertyuiopasdfghjklzxcvbnm-7mnbvcxzlkjhgfdsapoiuytrewqk
Chose drive to use:> 0
Found drive 'root' of type 'business', URL: https://org-my.sharepoint.com/personal/you/Documents
Is that okay?
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> y
--------------------
[remote]
type = onedrive
token = {"access_token":"youraccesstoken","token_type":"Bearer","refresh_token":"yourrefreshtoken","expiry":"2018-08-26T22:39:52.486512262+08:00"}
drive_id = b!Eqwertyuiopasdfghjklzxcvbnm-7mnbvcxzlkjhgfdsapoiuytrewqk
drive_type = business
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

See the remote setup docs for how to set it up on a
machine with no Internet browser available.

Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the
token as returned from Microsoft. This only runs from the moment it
opens your browser to the moment you get back the verification
code. This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require
you to unblock it temporarily if you are running a host firewall.

Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

List directories in top level of your OneDrive

rclone lsd remote:

List all the files in your OneDrive

rclone ls remote:

To copy a local directory to an OneDrive directory called backup

rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Getting your own Client ID and Key

You can use your own Client ID if the default (client_id left blank)
one doesn't work for you or you see lots of throttling. The default
Client ID and Key is shared by all rclone users when performing
requests.

If you are having problems with them (E.g., seeing a lot of throttling), you can get your own
Client ID and Key by following the steps below:

  1. Open https://portal.azure.com/#blade/Microsoft_AAD_RegisteredApps/ApplicationsListBlade and then click New registration.
  2. Enter a name for your app, choose account type Accounts in any organizational directory (Any Azure AD directory - Multitenant) and personal Microsoft accounts (e.g. Skype, Xbox), select Web in Redirect URI, then type (do not copy and paste) http://localhost:53682/ and click Register. Copy and keep the Application (client) ID under the app name for later use.
  3. Under manage select Certificates & secrets, click New client secret. Copy and keep that secret for later use.
  4. Under manage select API permissions, click Add a permission and select Microsoft Graph then select delegated permissions.
  5. Search and select the following permissions: Files.Read, Files.ReadWrite, Files.Read.All, Files.ReadWrite.All, offline_access, User.Read. Once selected click Add permissions at the bottom.

Now the application is complete. Run rclone config to create or edit a OneDrive remote.
Supply the app ID and password as Client ID and Secret, respectively. rclone will walk you through the remaining steps.

Modification time and hashes

OneDrive allows modification times to be set on objects accurate to 1
second. These will be used to detect whether objects need syncing or
not.

OneDrive personal supports SHA1 type hashes. OneDrive for business and
Sharepoint Server support
QuickXorHash.

For all types of OneDrive you can use the --checksum flag.

Restricted filename characters

In addition to the default restricted characters set
the following characters are also replaced:

Character Value Replacement
" 0x22
* 0x2A
: 0x3A
< 0x3C
> 0x3E
? 0x3F
\ 0x5C
| 0x7C

File names can also not end with the following characters.
These only get replaced if they are the last character in the name:

Character Value Replacement
SP 0x20
. 0x2E

File names can also not begin with the following characters.
These only get replaced if they are the first character in the name:

Character Value Replacement
SP 0x20
~ 0x7E

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Deleting files

Any files you delete with rclone will end up in the trash. Microsoft
doesn't provide an API to permanently delete files, nor to empty the
trash, so you will have to do that with one of Microsoft's apps or via
the OneDrive website.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to onedrive (Microsoft OneDrive).

--onedrive-client-id

OAuth Client Id
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: client_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_CLIENT_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--onedrive-client-secret

OAuth Client Secret
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: client_secret
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_CLIENT_SECRET
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--onedrive-region

Choose national cloud region for OneDrive.

  • Config: region
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_REGION
  • Type: string
  • Default: "global"
  • Examples:
    • "global"
      • Microsoft Cloud Global
    • "us"
      • Microsoft Cloud for US Government
    • "de"
      • Microsoft Cloud Germany
    • "cn"
      • Azure and Office 365 operated by 21Vianet in China

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to onedrive (Microsoft OneDrive).

--onedrive-token

OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

  • Config: token
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_TOKEN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--onedrive-auth-url

Auth server URL.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: auth_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_AUTH_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--onedrive-token-url

Token server url.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: token_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_TOKEN_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--onedrive-chunk-size

Chunk size to upload files with - must be multiple of 320k (327,680 bytes).

Above this size files will be chunked - must be multiple of 320k (327,680 bytes) and
should not exceed 250M (262,144,000 bytes) else you may encounter "Microsoft.SharePoint.Client.InvalidClientQueryException: The request message is too big."
Note that the chunks will be buffered into memory.

  • Config: chunk_size
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_CHUNK_SIZE
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 10M

--onedrive-drive-id

The ID of the drive to use

  • Config: drive_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_DRIVE_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--onedrive-drive-type

The type of the drive ( personal | business | documentLibrary )

  • Config: drive_type
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_DRIVE_TYPE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--onedrive-expose-onenote-files

Set to make OneNote files show up in directory listings.

By default rclone will hide OneNote files in directory listings because
operations like "Open" and "Update" won't work on them. But this
behaviour may also prevent you from deleting them. If you want to
delete OneNote files or otherwise want them to show up in directory
listing, set this option.

  • Config: expose_onenote_files
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_EXPOSE_ONENOTE_FILES
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--onedrive-server-side-across-configs

Allow server-side operations (e.g. copy) to work across different onedrive configs.

This will only work if you are copying between two OneDrive Personal drives AND
the files to copy are already shared between them. In other cases, rclone will
fall back to normal copy (which will be slightly slower).

  • Config: server_side_across_configs
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_SERVER_SIDE_ACROSS_CONFIGS
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--onedrive-no-versions

Remove all versions on modifying operations

Onedrive for business creates versions when rclone uploads new files
overwriting an existing one and when it sets the modification time.

These versions take up space out of the quota.

This flag checks for versions after file upload and setting
modification time and removes all but the last version.

NB Onedrive personal can't currently delete versions so don't use
this flag there.

  • Config: no_versions
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_NO_VERSIONS
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

Set the scope of the links created by the link command.

  • Config: link_scope
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_LINK_SCOPE
  • Type: string
  • Default: "anonymous"
  • Examples:
    • "anonymous"
      • Anyone with the link has access, without needing to sign in. This may include people outside of your organization. Anonymous link support may be disabled by an administrator.
    • "organization"
      • Anyone signed into your organization (tenant) can use the link to get access. Only available in OneDrive for Business and SharePoint.

Set the type of the links created by the link command.

  • Config: link_type
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_LINK_TYPE
  • Type: string
  • Default: "view"
  • Examples:
    • "view"
      • Creates a read-only link to the item.
    • "edit"
      • Creates a read-write link to the item.
    • "embed"
      • Creates an embeddable link to the item.

Set the password for links created by the link command.

At the time of writing this only works with OneDrive personal paid accounts.

  • Config: link_password
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_LINK_PASSWORD
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--onedrive-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ONEDRIVE_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,LeftSpace,LeftTilde,RightSpace,RightPeriod,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

If you don't use rclone for 90 days the refresh token will
expire. This will result in authorization problems. This is easy to
fix by running the rclone config reconnect remote: command to get a
new token and refresh token.

Naming

Note that OneDrive is case insensitive so you can't have a
file called "Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

There are quite a few characters that can't be in OneDrive file
names. These can't occur on Windows platforms, but on non-Windows
platforms they are common. Rclone will map these names to and from an
identical looking unicode equivalent. For example if a file has a ?
in it will be mapped to instead.

File sizes

The largest allowed file size is 250GB for both OneDrive Personal and OneDrive for Business (Updated 13 Jan 2021).

Path length

The entire path, including the file name, must contain fewer than 400 characters for OneDrive, OneDrive for Business and SharePoint Online. If you are encrypting file and folder names with rclone, you may want to pay attention to this limitation because the encrypted names are typically longer than the original ones.

Number of files

OneDrive seems to be OK with at least 50,000 files in a folder, but at
100,000 rclone will get errors listing the directory like couldnt list files: UnknownError:. See
#2707 for more info.

An official document about the limitations for different types of OneDrive can be found here.

Versions

Every change in a file OneDrive causes the service to create a new
version of the the file. This counts against a users quota. For
example changing the modification time of a file creates a second
version, so the file apparently uses twice the space.

For example the copy command is affected by this as rclone copies
the file and then afterwards sets the modification time to match the
source file which uses another version.

You can use the rclone cleanup command (see below) to remove all old
versions.

Or you can set the no_versions parameter to true and rclone will
remove versions after operations which create new versions. This takes
extra transactions so only enable it if you need it.

Note At the time of writing Onedrive Personal creates versions
(but not for setting the modification time) but the API for removing
them returns "API not found" so cleanup and no_versions should not
be used on Onedrive Personal.

Disabling versioning

Starting October 2018, users will no longer be able to
disable versioning by default. This is because Microsoft has brought
an
update
to the mechanism. To change this new default setting, a PowerShell
command is required to be run by a SharePoint admin. If you are an
admin, you can run these commands in PowerShell to change that
setting:

  1. Install-Module -Name Microsoft.Online.SharePoint.PowerShell (in case you haven't installed this already)
  2. Import-Module Microsoft.Online.SharePoint.PowerShell -DisableNameChecking
  3. Connect-SPOService -Url https://YOURSITE-admin.sharepoint.com -Credential YOU@YOURSITE.COM (replacing YOURSITE, YOU, YOURSITE.COM with the actual values; this will prompt for your credentials)
  4. Set-SPOTenant -EnableMinimumVersionRequirement $False
  5. Disconnect-SPOService (to disconnect from the server)

Below are the steps for normal users to disable versioning. If you don't see the "No Versioning" option, make sure the above requirements are met.

User Weropol has found a method to disable
versioning on OneDrive

  1. Open the settings menu by clicking on the gear symbol at the top of the OneDrive Business page.
  2. Click Site settings.
  3. Once on the Site settings page, navigate to Site Administration > Site libraries and lists.
  4. Click Customize "Documents".
  5. Click General Settings > Versioning Settings.
  6. Under Document Version History select the option No versioning.
    Note: This will disable the creation of new file versions, but will not remove any previous versions. Your documents are safe.
  7. Apply the changes by clicking OK.
  8. Use rclone to upload or modify files. (I also use the --no-update-modtime flag)
  9. Restore the versioning settings after using rclone. (Optional)

Cleanup

OneDrive supports rclone cleanup which causes rclone to look through
every file under the path supplied and delete all version but the
current version. Because this involves traversing all the files, then
querying each file for versions it can be quite slow. Rclone does
--checkers tests in parallel. The command also supports -i which
is a great way to see what it would do.

rclone cleanup -i remote:path/subdir # interactively remove all old version for path/subdir
rclone cleanup remote:path/subdir    # unconditionally remove all old version for path/subdir

NB Onedrive personal can't currently delete versions

Troubleshooting

Unexpected file size/hash differences on Sharepoint

It is a
known
issue that Sharepoint (not OneDrive or OneDrive for Business) silently modifies
uploaded files, mainly Office files (.docx, .xlsx, etc.), causing file size and
hash checks to fail. There are also other situations that will cause OneDrive to
report inconsistent file sizes. To use rclone with such
affected files on Sharepoint, you
may disable these checks with the following command line arguments:

--ignore-checksum --ignore-size

Alternatively, if you have write access to the OneDrive files, it may be possible
to fix this problem for certain files, by attempting the steps below.
Open the web interface for OneDrive and find the
affected files (which will be in the error messages/log for rclone). Simply click on
each of these files, causing OneDrive to open them on the web. This will cause each
file to be converted in place to a format that is functionally equivalent
but which will no longer trigger the size discrepancy. Once all problematic files
are converted you will no longer need the ignore options above.

Replacing/deleting existing files on Sharepoint gets "item not found"

It is a known issue
that Sharepoint (not OneDrive or OneDrive for Business) may return "item not
found" errors when users try to replace or delete uploaded files; this seems to
mainly affect Office files (.docx, .xlsx, etc.). As a workaround, you may use
the --backup-dir <BACKUP_DIR> command line argument so rclone moves the
files to be replaced/deleted into a given backup directory (instead of directly
replacing/deleting them). For example, to instruct rclone to move the files into
the directory rclone-backup-dir on backend mysharepoint, you may use:

--backup-dir mysharepoint:rclone-backup-dir

access_denied (AADSTS65005)

Error: access_denied
Code: AADSTS65005
Description: Using application 'rclone' is currently not supported for your organization [YOUR_ORGANIZATION] because it is in an unmanaged state. An administrator needs to claim ownership of the company by DNS validation of [YOUR_ORGANIZATION] before the application rclone can be provisioned.

This means that rclone can't use the OneDrive for Business API with your account. You can't do much about it, maybe write an email to your admins.

However, there are other ways to interact with your OneDrive account. Have a look at the webdav backend: https://rclone.org/webdav/#sharepoint

invalid_grant (AADSTS50076)

Error: invalid_grant
Code: AADSTS50076
Description: Due to a configuration change made by your administrator, or because you moved to a new location, you must use multi-factor authentication to access '...'.

If you see the error above after enabling multi-factor authentication for your account, you can fix it by refreshing your OAuth refresh token. To do that, run rclone config, and choose to edit your OneDrive backend. Then, you don't need to actually make any changes until you reach this question: Already have a token - refresh?. For this question, answer y and go through the process to refresh your token, just like the first time the backend is configured. After this, rclone should work again for this backend.

OpenDrive

Paths are specified as remote:path

Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

n) New remote
d) Delete remote
q) Quit config
e/n/d/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / OpenDrive
   \ "opendrive"
[snip]
Storage> opendrive
Username
username>
Password
y) Yes type in my own password
g) Generate random password
y/g> y
Enter the password:
password:
Confirm the password:
password:
--------------------
[remote]
username =
password = *** ENCRYPTED ***
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

List directories in top level of your OpenDrive

rclone lsd remote:

List all the files in your OpenDrive

rclone ls remote:

To copy a local directory to an OpenDrive directory called backup

rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Modified time and MD5SUMs

OpenDrive allows modification times to be set on objects accurate to 1
second. These will be used to detect whether objects need syncing or
not.

Restricted filename characters

Character Value Replacement
NUL 0x00
/ 0x2F
" 0x22
* 0x2A
: 0x3A
< 0x3C
> 0x3E
? 0x3F
\ 0x5C
| 0x7C

File names can also not begin or end with the following characters.
These only get replaced if they are the first or last character in the name:

Character Value Replacement
SP 0x20
HT 0x09
LF 0x0A
VT 0x0B
CR 0x0D

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to opendrive (OpenDrive).

--opendrive-username

Username

  • Config: username
  • Env Var: RCLONE_OPENDRIVE_USERNAME
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--opendrive-password

Password.

NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure.

  • Config: password
  • Env Var: RCLONE_OPENDRIVE_PASSWORD
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to opendrive (OpenDrive).

--opendrive-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_OPENDRIVE_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,LtGt,DoubleQuote,Colon,Question,Asterisk,Pipe,BackSlash,LeftSpace,LeftCrLfHtVt,RightSpace,RightCrLfHtVt,InvalidUtf8,Dot

--opendrive-chunk-size

Files will be uploaded in chunks this size.

Note that these chunks are buffered in memory so increasing them will
increase memory use.

  • Config: chunk_size
  • Env Var: RCLONE_OPENDRIVE_CHUNK_SIZE
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 10M

Limitations

Note that OpenDrive is case insensitive so you can't have a
file called "Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

There are quite a few characters that can't be in OpenDrive file
names. These can't occur on Windows platforms, but on non-Windows
platforms they are common. Rclone will map these names to and from an
identical looking unicode equivalent. For example if a file has a ?
in it will be mapped to instead.

rclone about is not supported by the OpenDrive backend. Backends without
this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or
use policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union
remote.

See List of backends that do not support rclone about
See rclone about

QingStor

Paths are specified as remote:bucket (or remote: for the lsd
command.) You may put subdirectories in too, e.g. remote:bucket/path/to/dir.

Here is an example of making an QingStor configuration. First run

rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
r) Rename remote
c) Copy remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/r/c/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / QingStor Object Storage
   \ "qingstor"
[snip]
Storage> qingstor
Get QingStor credentials from runtime. Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Enter QingStor credentials in the next step
   \ "false"
 2 / Get QingStor credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)
   \ "true"
env_auth> 1
QingStor Access Key ID - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
access_key_id> access_key
QingStor Secret Access Key (password) - leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.
secret_access_key> secret_key
Enter an endpoint URL to connection QingStor API.
Leave blank will use the default value "https://qingstor.com:443"
endpoint>
Zone connect to. Default is "pek3a".
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
   / The Beijing (China) Three Zone
 1 | Needs location constraint pek3a.
   \ "pek3a"
   / The Shanghai (China) First Zone
 2 | Needs location constraint sh1a.
   \ "sh1a"
zone> 1
Number of connection retry.
Leave blank will use the default value "3".
connection_retries>
Remote config
--------------------
[remote]
env_auth = false
access_key_id = access_key
secret_access_key = secret_key
endpoint =
zone = pek3a
connection_retries =
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

See all buckets

rclone lsd remote:

Make a new bucket

rclone mkdir remote:bucket

List the contents of a bucket

rclone ls remote:bucket

Sync /home/local/directory to the remote bucket, deleting any excess
files in the bucket.

rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:bucket

--fast-list

This remote supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer
transactions in exchange for more memory. See the rclone
docs
for more details.

Multipart uploads

rclone supports multipart uploads with QingStor which means that it can
upload files bigger than 5GB. Note that files uploaded with multipart
upload don't have an MD5SUM.

Note that incomplete multipart uploads older than 24 hours can be
removed with rclone cleanup remote:bucket just for one bucket
rclone cleanup remote: for all buckets. QingStor does not ever
remove incomplete multipart uploads so it may be necessary to run this
from time to time.

Buckets and Zone

With QingStor you can list buckets (rclone lsd) using any zone,
but you can only access the content of a bucket from the zone it was
created in. If you attempt to access a bucket from the wrong zone,
you will get an error, incorrect zone, the bucket is not in 'XXX' zone.

Authentication

There are two ways to supply rclone with a set of QingStor
credentials. In order of precedence:

  • Directly in the rclone configuration file (as configured by rclone config)
    • set access_key_id and secret_access_key
  • Runtime configuration:
    • set env_auth to true in the config file
    • Exporting the following environment variables before running rclone
      • Access Key ID: QS_ACCESS_KEY_ID or QS_ACCESS_KEY
      • Secret Access Key: QS_SECRET_ACCESS_KEY or QS_SECRET_KEY

Restricted filename characters

The control characters 0x00-0x1F and / are replaced as in the default
restricted characters set
. Note
that 0x7F is not replaced.

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to qingstor (QingCloud Object Storage).

--qingstor-env-auth

Get QingStor credentials from runtime. Only applies if access_key_id and secret_access_key is blank.

  • Config: env_auth
  • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_ENV_AUTH
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false
  • Examples:
    • "false"
      • Enter QingStor credentials in the next step
    • "true"
      • Get QingStor credentials from the environment (env vars or IAM)

--qingstor-access-key-id

QingStor Access Key ID
Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.

  • Config: access_key_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_ACCESS_KEY_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--qingstor-secret-access-key

QingStor Secret Access Key (password)
Leave blank for anonymous access or runtime credentials.

  • Config: secret_access_key
  • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_SECRET_ACCESS_KEY
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--qingstor-endpoint

Enter an endpoint URL to connection QingStor API.
Leave blank will use the default value "https://qingstor.com:443"

  • Config: endpoint
  • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_ENDPOINT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--qingstor-zone

Zone to connect to.
Default is "pek3a".

  • Config: zone
  • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_ZONE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "pek3a"
      • The Beijing (China) Three Zone
      • Needs location constraint pek3a.
    • "sh1a"
      • The Shanghai (China) First Zone
      • Needs location constraint sh1a.
    • "gd2a"
      • The Guangdong (China) Second Zone
      • Needs location constraint gd2a.

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to qingstor (QingCloud Object Storage).

--qingstor-connection-retries

Number of connection retries.

  • Config: connection_retries
  • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_CONNECTION_RETRIES
  • Type: int
  • Default: 3

--qingstor-upload-cutoff

Cutoff for switching to chunked upload

Any files larger than this will be uploaded in chunks of chunk_size.
The minimum is 0 and the maximum is 5GB.

  • Config: upload_cutoff
  • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_UPLOAD_CUTOFF
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 200M

--qingstor-chunk-size

Chunk size to use for uploading.

When uploading files larger than upload_cutoff they will be uploaded
as multipart uploads using this chunk size.

Note that "--qingstor-upload-concurrency" chunks of this size are buffered
in memory per transfer.

If you are transferring large files over high-speed links and you have
enough memory, then increasing this will speed up the transfers.

  • Config: chunk_size
  • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_CHUNK_SIZE
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 4M

--qingstor-upload-concurrency

Concurrency for multipart uploads.

This is the number of chunks of the same file that are uploaded
concurrently.

NB if you set this to > 1 then the checksums of multipart uploads
become corrupted (the uploads themselves are not corrupted though).

If you are uploading small numbers of large files over high-speed links
and these uploads do not fully utilize your bandwidth, then increasing
this may help to speed up the transfers.

  • Config: upload_concurrency
  • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_UPLOAD_CONCURRENCY
  • Type: int
  • Default: 1

--qingstor-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_QINGSTOR_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,Ctl,InvalidUtf8

Limitations

rclone about is not supported by the qingstor backend. Backends without
this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or
use policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union
remote.

See List of backends that do not support rclone about
See rclone about

Swift

Swift refers to OpenStack Object Storage.
Commercial implementations of that being:

Paths are specified as remote:container (or remote: for the lsd
command.) You may put subdirectories in too, e.g. remote:container/path/to/dir.

Here is an example of making a swift configuration. First run

rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / OpenStack Swift (Rackspace Cloud Files, Memset Memstore, OVH)
   \ "swift"
[snip]
Storage> swift
Get swift credentials from environment variables in standard OpenStack form.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Enter swift credentials in the next step
   \ "false"
 2 / Get swift credentials from environment vars. Leave other fields blank if using this.
   \ "true"
env_auth> true
User name to log in (OS_USERNAME).
user> 
API key or password (OS_PASSWORD).
key> 
Authentication URL for server (OS_AUTH_URL).
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Rackspace US
   \ "https://auth.api.rackspacecloud.com/v1.0"
 2 / Rackspace UK
   \ "https://lon.auth.api.rackspacecloud.com/v1.0"
 3 / Rackspace v2
   \ "https://identity.api.rackspacecloud.com/v2.0"
 4 / Memset Memstore UK
   \ "https://auth.storage.memset.com/v1.0"
 5 / Memset Memstore UK v2
   \ "https://auth.storage.memset.com/v2.0"
 6 / OVH
   \ "https://auth.cloud.ovh.net/v3"
auth> 
User ID to log in - optional - most swift systems use user and leave this blank (v3 auth) (OS_USER_ID).
user_id> 
User domain - optional (v3 auth) (OS_USER_DOMAIN_NAME)
domain> 
Tenant name - optional for v1 auth, this or tenant_id required otherwise (OS_TENANT_NAME or OS_PROJECT_NAME)
tenant> 
Tenant ID - optional for v1 auth, this or tenant required otherwise (OS_TENANT_ID)
tenant_id> 
Tenant domain - optional (v3 auth) (OS_PROJECT_DOMAIN_NAME)
tenant_domain> 
Region name - optional (OS_REGION_NAME)
region> 
Storage URL - optional (OS_STORAGE_URL)
storage_url> 
Auth Token from alternate authentication - optional (OS_AUTH_TOKEN)
auth_token> 
AuthVersion - optional - set to (1,2,3) if your auth URL has no version (ST_AUTH_VERSION)
auth_version> 
Endpoint type to choose from the service catalogue (OS_ENDPOINT_TYPE)
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Public (default, choose this if not sure)
   \ "public"
 2 / Internal (use internal service net)
   \ "internal"
 3 / Admin
   \ "admin"
endpoint_type> 
Remote config
--------------------
[test]
env_auth = true
user = 
key = 
auth = 
user_id = 
domain = 
tenant = 
tenant_id = 
tenant_domain = 
region = 
storage_url = 
auth_token = 
auth_version = 
endpoint_type = 
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

This remote is called remote and can now be used like this

See all containers

rclone lsd remote:

Make a new container

rclone mkdir remote:container

List the contents of a container

rclone ls remote:container

Sync /home/local/directory to the remote container, deleting any
excess files in the container.

rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:container

Configuration from an OpenStack credentials file

An OpenStack credentials file typically looks something something
like this (without the comments)

export OS_AUTH_URL=https://a.provider.net/v2.0
export OS_TENANT_ID=ffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff
export OS_TENANT_NAME="1234567890123456"
export OS_USERNAME="123abc567xy"
echo "Please enter your OpenStack Password: "
read -sr OS_PASSWORD_INPUT
export OS_PASSWORD=$OS_PASSWORD_INPUT
export OS_REGION_NAME="SBG1"
if [ -z "$OS_REGION_NAME" ]; then unset OS_REGION_NAME; fi

The config file needs to look something like this where $OS_USERNAME
represents the value of the OS_USERNAME variable - 123abc567xy in
the example above.

[remote]
type = swift
user = $OS_USERNAME
key = $OS_PASSWORD
auth = $OS_AUTH_URL
tenant = $OS_TENANT_NAME

Note that you may (or may not) need to set region too - try without first.

Configuration from the environment

If you prefer you can configure rclone to use swift using a standard
set of OpenStack environment variables.

When you run through the config, make sure you choose true for
env_auth and leave everything else blank.

rclone will then set any empty config parameters from the environment
using standard OpenStack environment variables. There is a list of
the
variables

in the docs for the swift library.

Using an alternate authentication method

If your OpenStack installation uses a non-standard authentication method
that might not be yet supported by rclone or the underlying swift library,
you can authenticate externally (e.g. calling manually the openstack
commands to get a token). Then, you just need to pass the two
configuration variables auth_token and storage_url.
If they are both provided, the other variables are ignored. rclone will
not try to authenticate but instead assume it is already authenticated
and use these two variables to access the OpenStack installation.

Using rclone without a config file

You can use rclone with swift without a config file, if desired, like
this:

source openstack-credentials-file
export RCLONE_CONFIG_MYREMOTE_TYPE=swift
export RCLONE_CONFIG_MYREMOTE_ENV_AUTH=true
rclone lsd myremote:

--fast-list

This remote supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer
transactions in exchange for more memory. See the rclone
docs
for more details.

--update and --use-server-modtime

As noted below, the modified time is stored on metadata on the object. It is
used by default for all operations that require checking the time a file was
last updated. It allows rclone to treat the remote more like a true filesystem,
but it is inefficient because it requires an extra API call to retrieve the
metadata.

For many operations, the time the object was last uploaded to the remote is
sufficient to determine if it is "dirty". By using --update along with
--use-server-modtime, you can avoid the extra API call and simply upload
files whose local modtime is newer than the time it was last uploaded.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to swift (OpenStack Swift (Rackspace Cloud Files, Memset Memstore, OVH)).

--swift-env-auth

Get swift credentials from environment variables in standard OpenStack form.

  • Config: env_auth
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_ENV_AUTH
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false
  • Examples:
    • "false"
      • Enter swift credentials in the next step
    • "true"
      • Get swift credentials from environment vars. Leave other fields blank if using this.

--swift-user

User name to log in (OS_USERNAME).

  • Config: user
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_USER
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--swift-key

API key or password (OS_PASSWORD).

  • Config: key
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_KEY
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--swift-auth

Authentication URL for server (OS_AUTH_URL).

--swift-user-id

User ID to log in - optional - most swift systems use user and leave this blank (v3 auth) (OS_USER_ID).

  • Config: user_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_USER_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--swift-domain

User domain - optional (v3 auth) (OS_USER_DOMAIN_NAME)

  • Config: domain
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_DOMAIN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--swift-tenant

Tenant name - optional for v1 auth, this or tenant_id required otherwise (OS_TENANT_NAME or OS_PROJECT_NAME)

  • Config: tenant
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_TENANT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--swift-tenant-id

Tenant ID - optional for v1 auth, this or tenant required otherwise (OS_TENANT_ID)

  • Config: tenant_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_TENANT_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--swift-tenant-domain

Tenant domain - optional (v3 auth) (OS_PROJECT_DOMAIN_NAME)

  • Config: tenant_domain
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_TENANT_DOMAIN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--swift-region

Region name - optional (OS_REGION_NAME)

  • Config: region
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_REGION
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--swift-storage-url

Storage URL - optional (OS_STORAGE_URL)

  • Config: storage_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_STORAGE_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--swift-auth-token

Auth Token from alternate authentication - optional (OS_AUTH_TOKEN)

  • Config: auth_token
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_AUTH_TOKEN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--swift-application-credential-id

Application Credential ID (OS_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_ID)

  • Config: application_credential_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--swift-application-credential-name

Application Credential Name (OS_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_NAME)

  • Config: application_credential_name
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_NAME
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--swift-application-credential-secret

Application Credential Secret (OS_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_SECRET)

  • Config: application_credential_secret
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_APPLICATION_CREDENTIAL_SECRET
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--swift-auth-version

AuthVersion - optional - set to (1,2,3) if your auth URL has no version (ST_AUTH_VERSION)

  • Config: auth_version
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_AUTH_VERSION
  • Type: int
  • Default: 0

--swift-endpoint-type

Endpoint type to choose from the service catalogue (OS_ENDPOINT_TYPE)

  • Config: endpoint_type
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_ENDPOINT_TYPE
  • Type: string
  • Default: "public"
  • Examples:
    • "public"
      • Public (default, choose this if not sure)
    • "internal"
      • Internal (use internal service net)
    • "admin"
      • Admin

--swift-storage-policy

The storage policy to use when creating a new container

This applies the specified storage policy when creating a new
container. The policy cannot be changed afterwards. The allowed
configuration values and their meaning depend on your Swift storage
provider.

  • Config: storage_policy
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_STORAGE_POLICY
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • ""
      • Default
    • "pcs"
      • OVH Public Cloud Storage
    • "pca"
      • OVH Public Cloud Archive

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to swift (OpenStack Swift (Rackspace Cloud Files, Memset Memstore, OVH)).

--swift-leave-parts-on-error

If true avoid calling abort upload on a failure. It should be set to true for resuming uploads across different sessions.

  • Config: leave_parts_on_error
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_LEAVE_PARTS_ON_ERROR
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--swift-chunk-size

Above this size files will be chunked into a _segments container.

Above this size files will be chunked into a _segments container. The
default for this is 5GB which is its maximum value.

  • Config: chunk_size
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_CHUNK_SIZE
  • Type: SizeSuffix
  • Default: 5G

--swift-no-chunk

Don't chunk files during streaming upload.

When doing streaming uploads (e.g. using rcat or mount) setting this
flag will cause the swift backend to not upload chunked files.

This will limit the maximum upload size to 5GB. However non chunked
files are easier to deal with and have an MD5SUM.

Rclone will still chunk files bigger than chunk_size when doing normal
copy operations.

  • Config: no_chunk
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_NO_CHUNK
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--swift-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SWIFT_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,InvalidUtf8

Modified time

The modified time is stored as metadata on the object as
X-Object-Meta-Mtime as floating point since the epoch accurate to 1
ns.

This is a de facto standard (used in the official python-swiftclient
amongst others) for storing the modification time for an object.

Restricted filename characters

Character Value Replacement
NUL 0x00
/ 0x2F

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Limitations

The Swift API doesn't return a correct MD5SUM for segmented files
(Dynamic or Static Large Objects) so rclone won't check or use the
MD5SUM for these.

Troubleshooting

Rclone gives Failed to create file system for "remote:": Bad Request

Due to an oddity of the underlying swift library, it gives a "Bad
Request" error rather than a more sensible error when the
authentication fails for Swift.

So this most likely means your username / password is wrong. You can
investigate further with the --dump-bodies flag.

This may also be caused by specifying the region when you shouldn't
have (e.g. OVH).

Rclone gives Failed to create file system: Response didn't have storage url and auth token

This is most likely caused by forgetting to specify your tenant when
setting up a swift remote.

pCloud

Paths are specified as remote:path

Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

The initial setup for pCloud involves getting a token from pCloud which you
need to do in your browser. rclone config walks you through it.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Pcloud
   \ "pcloud"
[snip]
Storage> pcloud
Pcloud App Client Id - leave blank normally.
client_id> 
Pcloud App Client Secret - leave blank normally.
client_secret> 
Remote config
Use auto config?
 * Say Y if not sure
 * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> y
If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
Log in and authorize rclone for access
Waiting for code...
Got code
--------------------
[remote]
client_id = 
client_secret = 
token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"bearer","expiry":"0001-01-01T00:00:00Z"}
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

See the remote setup docs for how to set it up on a
machine with no Internet browser available.

Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the
token as returned from pCloud. This only runs from the moment it opens
your browser to the moment you get back the verification code. This
is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require you to unblock
it temporarily if you are running a host firewall.

Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

List directories in top level of your pCloud

rclone lsd remote:

List all the files in your pCloud

rclone ls remote:

To copy a local directory to an pCloud directory called backup

rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Modified time and hashes

pCloud allows modification times to be set on objects accurate to 1
second. These will be used to detect whether objects need syncing or
not. In order to set a Modification time pCloud requires the object
be re-uploaded.

pCloud supports MD5 and SHA1 type hashes in the US region but and SHA1
only in the EU region, so you can use the --checksum flag.

(Note that pCloud also support SHA256 in the EU region, but rclone
does not have support for that yet.)

Restricted filename characters

In addition to the default restricted characters set
the following characters are also replaced:

Character Value Replacement
\ 0x5C

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Deleting files

Deleted files will be moved to the trash. Your subscription level
will determine how long items stay in the trash. rclone cleanup can
be used to empty the trash.

Root folder ID

You can set the root_folder_id for rclone. This is the directory
(identified by its Folder ID) that rclone considers to be the root
of your pCloud drive.

Normally you will leave this blank and rclone will determine the
correct root to use itself.

However you can set this to restrict rclone to a specific folder
hierarchy.

In order to do this you will have to find the Folder ID of the
directory you wish rclone to display. This will be the folder field
of the URL when you open the relevant folder in the pCloud web
interface.

So if the folder you want rclone to use has a URL which looks like
https://my.pcloud.com/#page=filemanager&folder=5xxxxxxxx8&tpl=foldergrid
in the browser, then you use 5xxxxxxxx8 as
the root_folder_id in the config.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to pcloud (Pcloud).

--pcloud-client-id

OAuth Client Id
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: client_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_CLIENT_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--pcloud-client-secret

OAuth Client Secret
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: client_secret
  • Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_CLIENT_SECRET
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to pcloud (Pcloud).

--pcloud-token

OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

  • Config: token
  • Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_TOKEN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--pcloud-auth-url

Auth server URL.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: auth_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_AUTH_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--pcloud-token-url

Token server url.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: token_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_TOKEN_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--pcloud-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

--pcloud-root-folder-id

Fill in for rclone to use a non root folder as its starting point.

  • Config: root_folder_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_ROOT_FOLDER_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: "d0"

--pcloud-hostname

Hostname to connect to.

This is normally set when rclone initially does the oauth connection,
however you will need to set it by hand if you are using remote config
with rclone authorize.

  • Config: hostname
  • Env Var: RCLONE_PCLOUD_HOSTNAME
  • Type: string
  • Default: "api.pcloud.com"
  • Examples:
    • "api.pcloud.com"
      • Original/US region
    • "eapi.pcloud.com"
      • EU region

premiumize.me

Paths are specified as remote:path

Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

The initial setup for premiumize.me involves getting a token from premiumize.me which you
need to do in your browser. rclone config walks you through it.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / premiumize.me
   \ "premiumizeme"
[snip]
Storage> premiumizeme
** See help for premiumizeme backend at: https://rclone.org/premiumizeme/ **

Remote config
Use auto config?
 * Say Y if not sure
 * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> y
If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
Log in and authorize rclone for access
Waiting for code...
Got code
--------------------
[remote]
type = premiumizeme
token = {"access_token":"XXX","token_type":"Bearer","refresh_token":"XXX","expiry":"2029-08-07T18:44:15.548915378+01:00"}
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> 

See the remote setup docs for how to set it up on a
machine with no Internet browser available.

Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the
token as returned from premiumize.me. This only runs from the moment it opens
your browser to the moment you get back the verification code. This
is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require you to unblock
it temporarily if you are running a host firewall.

Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

List directories in top level of your premiumize.me

rclone lsd remote:

List all the files in your premiumize.me

rclone ls remote:

To copy a local directory to an premiumize.me directory called backup

rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Modified time and hashes

premiumize.me does not support modification times or hashes, therefore
syncing will default to --size-only checking. Note that using
--update will work.

Restricted filename characters

In addition to the default restricted characters set
the following characters are also replaced:

Character Value Replacement
\ 0x5C
" 0x22

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to premiumizeme (premiumize.me).

--premiumizeme-api-key

API Key.

This is not normally used - use oauth instead.

  • Config: api_key
  • Env Var: RCLONE_PREMIUMIZEME_API_KEY
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to premiumizeme (premiumize.me).

--premiumizeme-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_PREMIUMIZEME_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,DoubleQuote,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

Note that premiumize.me is case insensitive so you can't have a file called
"Hello.doc" and one called "hello.doc".

premiumize.me file names can't have the \ or " characters in.
rclone maps these to and from an identical looking unicode equivalents
and

premiumize.me only supports filenames up to 255 characters in length.

put.io

Paths are specified as remote:path

put.io paths may be as deep as required, e.g.
remote:directory/subdirectory.

The initial setup for put.io involves getting a token from put.io
which you need to do in your browser. rclone config walks you
through it.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> putio
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Put.io
   \ "putio"
[snip]
Storage> putio
** See help for putio backend at: https://rclone.org/putio/ **

Remote config
Use auto config?
 * Say Y if not sure
 * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> y
If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
Log in and authorize rclone for access
Waiting for code...
Got code
--------------------
[putio]
type = putio
token = {"access_token":"XXXXXXXX","expiry":"0001-01-01T00:00:00Z"}
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y
Current remotes:

Name                 Type
====                 ====
putio                putio

e) Edit existing remote
n) New remote
d) Delete remote
r) Rename remote
c) Copy remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
e/n/d/r/c/s/q> q

Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the
token as returned from Google if you use auto config mode. This only
runs from the moment it opens your browser to the moment you get back
the verification code. This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this
it may require you to unblock it temporarily if you are running a host
firewall, or use manual mode.

You can then use it like this,

List directories in top level of your put.io

rclone lsd remote:

List all the files in your put.io

rclone ls remote:

To copy a local directory to a put.io directory called backup

rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Restricted filename characters

In addition to the default restricted characters set
the following characters are also replaced:

Character Value Replacement
\ 0x5C

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to putio (Put.io).

--putio-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_PUTIO_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,BackSlash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Seafile

This is a backend for the Seafile storage service:

  • It works with both the free community edition or the professional edition.
  • Seafile versions 6.x and 7.x are all supported.
  • Encrypted libraries are also supported.
  • It supports 2FA enabled users

Root mode vs Library mode

There are two distinct modes you can setup your remote:

  • you point your remote to the root of the server, meaning you don't specify a library during the configuration:
    Paths are specified as remote:library. You may put subdirectories in too, e.g. remote:library/path/to/dir.
  • you point your remote to a specific library during the configuration:
    Paths are specified as remote:path/to/dir. This is the recommended mode when using encrypted libraries. (This mode is possibly slightly faster than the root mode)

Configuration in root mode

Here is an example of making a seafile configuration for a user with no two-factor authentication. First run

rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process. To authenticate
you will need the URL of your server, your email (or username) and your password.

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> seafile
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Seafile
   \ "seafile"
[snip]
Storage> seafile
** See help for seafile backend at: https://rclone.org/seafile/ **

URL of seafile host to connect to
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Connect to cloud.seafile.com
   \ "https://cloud.seafile.com/"
url> http://my.seafile.server/
User name (usually email address)
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
user> me@example.com
Password
y) Yes type in my own password
g) Generate random password
n) No leave this optional password blank (default)
y/g> y
Enter the password:
password:
Confirm the password:
password:
Two-factor authentication ('true' if the account has 2FA enabled)
Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
2fa> false
Name of the library. Leave blank to access all non-encrypted libraries.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
library>
Library password (for encrypted libraries only). Leave blank if you pass it through the command line.
y) Yes type in my own password
g) Generate random password
n) No leave this optional password blank (default)
y/g/n> n
Edit advanced config? (y/n)
y) Yes
n) No (default)
y/n> n
Remote config
Two-factor authentication is not enabled on this account.
--------------------
[seafile]
type = seafile
url = http://my.seafile.server/
user = me@example.com
pass = *** ENCRYPTED ***
2fa = false
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK (default)
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

This remote is called seafile. It's pointing to the root of your seafile server and can now be used like this:

See all libraries

rclone lsd seafile:

Create a new library

rclone mkdir seafile:library

List the contents of a library

rclone ls seafile:library

Sync /home/local/directory to the remote library, deleting any
excess files in the library.

rclone sync -i /home/local/directory seafile:library

Configuration in library mode

Here's an example of a configuration in library mode with a user that has the two-factor authentication enabled. Your 2FA code will be asked at the end of the configuration, and will attempt to authenticate you:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> seafile
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Seafile
   \ "seafile"
[snip]
Storage> seafile
** See help for seafile backend at: https://rclone.org/seafile/ **

URL of seafile host to connect to
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Connect to cloud.seafile.com
   \ "https://cloud.seafile.com/"
url> http://my.seafile.server/
User name (usually email address)
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
user> me@example.com
Password
y) Yes type in my own password
g) Generate random password
n) No leave this optional password blank (default)
y/g> y
Enter the password:
password:
Confirm the password:
password:
Two-factor authentication ('true' if the account has 2FA enabled)
Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
2fa> true
Name of the library. Leave blank to access all non-encrypted libraries.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
library> My Library
Library password (for encrypted libraries only). Leave blank if you pass it through the command line.
y) Yes type in my own password
g) Generate random password
n) No leave this optional password blank (default)
y/g/n> n
Edit advanced config? (y/n)
y) Yes
n) No (default)
y/n> n
Remote config
Two-factor authentication: please enter your 2FA code
2fa code> 123456
Authenticating...
Success!
--------------------
[seafile]
type = seafile
url = http://my.seafile.server/
user = me@example.com
pass = 
2fa = true
library = My Library
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK (default)
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

You'll notice your password is blank in the configuration. It's because we only need the password to authenticate you once.

You specified My Library during the configuration. The root of the remote is pointing at the
root of the library My Library:

See all files in the library:

rclone lsd seafile:

Create a new directory inside the library

rclone mkdir seafile:directory

List the contents of a directory

rclone ls seafile:directory

Sync /home/local/directory to the remote library, deleting any
excess files in the library.

rclone sync -i /home/local/directory seafile:

--fast-list

Seafile version 7+ supports --fast-list which allows you to use fewer
transactions in exchange for more memory. See the rclone
docs
for more details.
Please note this is not supported on seafile server version 6.x

Restricted filename characters

In addition to the default restricted characters set
the following characters are also replaced:

Character Value Replacement
/ 0x2F
" 0x22
\ 0x5C

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Rclone supports generating share links for non-encrypted libraries only.
They can either be for a file or a directory:

rclone link seafile:seafile-tutorial.doc
http://my.seafile.server/f/fdcd8a2f93f84b8b90f4/

or if run on a directory you will get:

rclone link seafile:dir
http://my.seafile.server/d/9ea2455f6f55478bbb0d/

Please note a share link is unique for each file or directory. If you run a link command on a file/dir
that has already been shared, you will get the exact same link.

Compatibility

It has been actively tested using the seafile docker image of these versions:

  • 6.3.4 community edition
  • 7.0.5 community edition
  • 7.1.3 community edition

Versions below 6.0 are not supported.
Versions between 6.0 and 6.3 haven't been tested and might not work properly.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to seafile (seafile).

--seafile-url

URL of seafile host to connect to

  • Config: url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:

--seafile-user

User name (usually email address)

  • Config: user
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_USER
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--seafile-pass

Password

NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure.

  • Config: pass
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_PASS
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--seafile-2fa

Two-factor authentication ('true' if the account has 2FA enabled)

  • Config: 2fa
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_2FA
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--seafile-library

Name of the library. Leave blank to access all non-encrypted libraries.

  • Config: library
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_LIBRARY
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--seafile-library-key

Library password (for encrypted libraries only). Leave blank if you pass it through the command line.

NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure.

  • Config: library_key
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_LIBRARY_KEY
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--seafile-auth-token

Authentication token

  • Config: auth_token
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_AUTH_TOKEN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to seafile (seafile).

--seafile-create-library

Should rclone create a library if it doesn't exist

  • Config: create_library
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_CREATE_LIBRARY
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--seafile-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SEAFILE_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,DoubleQuote,BackSlash,Ctl,InvalidUtf8

SFTP

SFTP is the Secure (or SSH) File Transfer
Protocol
.

The SFTP backend can be used with a number of different providers:

  • C14
  • rsync.net

SFTP runs over SSH v2 and is installed as standard with most modern
SSH installations.

Paths are specified as remote:path. If the path does not begin with
a / it is relative to the home directory of the user. An empty path
remote: refers to the user's home directory.

"Note that some SFTP servers will need the leading / - Synology is a
good example of this. rsync.net, on the other hand, requires users to
OMIT the leading /.

Here is an example of making an SFTP configuration. First run

rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process.

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / SSH/SFTP Connection
   \ "sftp"
[snip]
Storage> sftp
SSH host to connect to
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Connect to example.com
   \ "example.com"
host> example.com
SSH username, leave blank for current username, $USER
user> sftpuser
SSH port, leave blank to use default (22)
port>
SSH password, leave blank to use ssh-agent.
y) Yes type in my own password
g) Generate random password
n) No leave this optional password blank
y/g/n> n
Path to unencrypted PEM-encoded private key file, leave blank to use ssh-agent.
key_file>
Remote config
--------------------
[remote]
host = example.com
user = sftpuser
port =
pass =
key_file =
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

This remote is called remote and can now be used like this:

See all directories in the home directory

rclone lsd remote:

Make a new directory

rclone mkdir remote:path/to/directory

List the contents of a directory

rclone ls remote:path/to/directory

Sync /home/local/directory to the remote directory, deleting any
excess files in the directory.

rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:directory

SSH Authentication

The SFTP remote supports three authentication methods:

  • Password
  • Key file, including certificate signed keys
  • ssh-agent

Key files should be PEM-encoded private key files. For instance /home/$USER/.ssh/id_rsa.
Only unencrypted OpenSSH or PEM encrypted files are supported.

The key file can be specified in either an external file (key_file) or contained within the
rclone config file (key_pem). If using key_pem in the config file, the entry should be on a
single line with new line ('\n' or '\r\n') separating lines. i.e.

key_pem = -----BEGIN RSA PRIVATE KEY-----\nMaMbaIXtE\n0gAMbMbaSsd\nMbaass\n-----END RSA PRIVATE KEY-----

This will generate it correctly for key_pem for use in the config:

awk '{printf "%s\\n", $0}' < ~/.ssh/id_rsa

If you don't specify pass, key_file, or key_pem then rclone will attempt to contact an ssh-agent.

You can also specify key_use_agent to force the usage of an ssh-agent. In this case
key_file or key_pem can also be specified to force the usage of a specific key in the ssh-agent.

Using an ssh-agent is the only way to load encrypted OpenSSH keys at the moment.

If you set the --sftp-ask-password option, rclone will prompt for a
password when needed and no password has been configured.

If you have a certificate then you can provide the path to the public key that contains the certificate. For example:

[remote]
type = sftp
host = example.com
user = sftpuser
key_file = ~/id_rsa
pubkey_file = ~/id_rsa-cert.pub

If you concatenate a cert with a private key then you can specify the
merged file in both places.

Note: the cert must come first in the file. e.g.

cat id_rsa-cert.pub id_rsa > merged_key

Host key validation

By default rclone will not check the server's host key for validation. This
can allow an attacker to replace a server with their own and if you use
password authentication then this can lead to that password being exposed.

Host key matching, using standard known_hosts files can be turned on by
enabling the known_hosts_file option. This can point to the file maintained
by OpenSSH or can point to a unique file.

e.g.

[remote]
type = sftp
host = example.com
user = sftpuser
pass = 
known_hosts_file = ~/.ssh/known_hosts

There are some limitations:

  • rclone will not manage this file for you. If the key is missing or
    wrong then the connection will be refused.
  • If the server is set up for a certificate host key then the entry in
    the known_hosts file must be the @cert-authority entry for the CA
  • Unlike OpenSSH, the libraries used by rclone do not permit (at time
    of writing) multiple host keys to be listed for a server. Only the first
    entry is used.

If the host key provided by the server does not match the one in the
file (or is missing) then the connection will be aborted and an error
returned such as

NewFs: couldn't connect SSH: ssh: handshake failed: knownhosts: key mismatch

or

NewFs: couldn't connect SSH: ssh: handshake failed: knownhosts: key is unknown

If you see an error such as

NewFs: couldn't connect SSH: ssh: handshake failed: ssh: no authorities for hostname: example.com:22

then it is likely the server has presented a CA signed host certificate
and you will need to add the appropriate @cert-authority entry.

The known_hosts_file setting can be set during rclone config as an
advanced option.

ssh-agent on macOS

Note that there seem to be various problems with using an ssh-agent on
macOS due to recent changes in the OS. The most effective work-around
seems to be to start an ssh-agent in each session, e.g.

eval `ssh-agent -s` && ssh-add -A

And then at the end of the session

eval `ssh-agent -k`

These commands can be used in scripts of course.

Modified time

Modified times are stored on the server to 1 second precision.

Modified times are used in syncing and are fully supported.

Some SFTP servers disable setting/modifying the file modification time after
upload (for example, certain configurations of ProFTPd with mod_sftp). If you
are using one of these servers, you can set the option set_modtime = false in
your RClone backend configuration to disable this behaviour.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to sftp (SSH/SFTP Connection).

--sftp-host

SSH host to connect to

  • Config: host
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_HOST
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "example.com"
      • Connect to example.com

--sftp-user

SSH username, leave blank for current username, $USER

  • Config: user
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_USER
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sftp-port

SSH port, leave blank to use default (22)

  • Config: port
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_PORT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sftp-pass

SSH password, leave blank to use ssh-agent.

NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure.

  • Config: pass
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_PASS
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sftp-key-pem

Raw PEM-encoded private key, If specified, will override key_file parameter.

  • Config: key_pem
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_KEY_PEM
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sftp-key-file

Path to PEM-encoded private key file, leave blank or set key-use-agent to use ssh-agent.

Leading ~ will be expanded in the file name as will environment variables such as ${RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR}.

  • Config: key_file
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_KEY_FILE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sftp-key-file-pass

The passphrase to decrypt the PEM-encoded private key file.

Only PEM encrypted key files (old OpenSSH format) are supported. Encrypted keys
in the new OpenSSH format can't be used.

NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure.

  • Config: key_file_pass
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_KEY_FILE_PASS
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sftp-pubkey-file

Optional path to public key file.

Set this if you have a signed certificate you want to use for authentication.

Leading ~ will be expanded in the file name as will environment variables such as ${RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR}.

  • Config: pubkey_file
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_PUBKEY_FILE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sftp-key-use-agent

When set forces the usage of the ssh-agent.

When key-file is also set, the ".pub" file of the specified key-file is read and only the associated key is
requested from the ssh-agent. This allows to avoid Too many authentication failures for *username* errors
when the ssh-agent contains many keys.

  • Config: key_use_agent
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_KEY_USE_AGENT
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--sftp-use-insecure-cipher

Enable the use of insecure ciphers and key exchange methods.

This enables the use of the following insecure ciphers and key exchange methods:

  • aes128-cbc
  • aes192-cbc
  • aes256-cbc
  • 3des-cbc
  • diffie-hellman-group-exchange-sha256
  • diffie-hellman-group-exchange-sha1

Those algorithms are insecure and may allow plaintext data to be recovered by an attacker.

  • Config: use_insecure_cipher
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_USE_INSECURE_CIPHER
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false
  • Examples:
    • "false"
      • Use default Cipher list.
    • "true"
      • Enables the use of the aes128-cbc cipher and diffie-hellman-group-exchange-sha256, diffie-hellman-group-exchange-sha1 key exchange.

--sftp-disable-hashcheck

Disable the execution of SSH commands to determine if remote file hashing is available.
Leave blank or set to false to enable hashing (recommended), set to true to disable hashing.

  • Config: disable_hashcheck
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_DISABLE_HASHCHECK
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to sftp (SSH/SFTP Connection).

--sftp-known-hosts-file

Optional path to known_hosts file.

Set this value to enable server host key validation.

Leading ~ will be expanded in the file name as will environment variables such as ${RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR}.

  • Config: known_hosts_file
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_KNOWN_HOSTS_FILE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "~/.ssh/known_hosts"
      • Use OpenSSH's known_hosts file

--sftp-ask-password

Allow asking for SFTP password when needed.

If this is set and no password is supplied then rclone will:

  • ask for a password

  • not contact the ssh agent

  • Config: ask_password

  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_ASK_PASSWORD

  • Type: bool

  • Default: false

--sftp-path-override

Override path used by SSH connection.

This allows checksum calculation when SFTP and SSH paths are
different. This issue affects among others Synology NAS boxes.

Shared folders can be found in directories representing volumes

rclone sync /home/local/directory remote:/directory --ssh-path-override /volume2/directory

Home directory can be found in a shared folder called "home"

rclone sync /home/local/directory remote:/home/directory --ssh-path-override /volume1/homes/USER/directory
  • Config: path_override
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_PATH_OVERRIDE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sftp-set-modtime

Set the modified time on the remote if set.

  • Config: set_modtime
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_SET_MODTIME
  • Type: bool
  • Default: true

--sftp-md5sum-command

The command used to read md5 hashes. Leave blank for autodetect.

  • Config: md5sum_command
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_MD5SUM_COMMAND
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sftp-sha1sum-command

The command used to read sha1 hashes. Leave blank for autodetect.

  • Config: sha1sum_command
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_SHA1SUM_COMMAND
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

Set to skip any symlinks and any other non regular files.

  • Config: skip_links
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_SKIP_LINKS
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--sftp-subsystem

Specifies the SSH2 subsystem on the remote host.

  • Config: subsystem
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_SUBSYSTEM
  • Type: string
  • Default: "sftp"

--sftp-server-command

Specifies the path or command to run a sftp server on the remote host.

The subsystem option is ignored when server_command is defined.

  • Config: server_command
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_SERVER_COMMAND
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sftp-use-fstat

If set use fstat instead of stat

Some servers limit the amount of open files and calling Stat after opening
the file will throw an error from the server. Setting this flag will call
Fstat instead of Stat which is called on an already open file handle.

It has been found that this helps with IBM Sterling SFTP servers which have
"extractability" level set to 1 which means only 1 file can be opened at
any given time.

  • Config: use_fstat
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SFTP_USE_FSTAT
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

Limitations

SFTP supports checksums if the same login has shell access and md5sum
or sha1sum as well as echo are in the remote's PATH.
This remote checksumming (file hashing) is recommended and enabled by default.
Disabling the checksumming may be required if you are connecting to SFTP servers
which are not under your control, and to which the execution of remote commands
is prohibited. Set the configuration option disable_hashcheck to true to
disable checksumming.

SFTP also supports about if the same login has shell
access and df are in the remote's PATH. about will
return the total space, free space, and used space on the remote
for the disk of the specified path on the remote or, if not set,
the disk of the root on the remote.
about will fail if it does not have shell
access or if df is not in the remote's PATH.

Note that some SFTP servers (e.g. Synology) the paths are different for
SSH and SFTP so the hashes can't be calculated properly. For them
using disable_hashcheck is a good idea.

The only ssh agent supported under Windows is Putty's pageant.

The Go SSH library disables the use of the aes128-cbc cipher by
default, due to security concerns. This can be re-enabled on a
per-connection basis by setting the use_insecure_cipher setting in
the configuration file to true. Further details on the insecurity of
this cipher can be found [in this paper]
(http://www.isg.rhul.ac.uk/~kp/SandPfinal.pdf).

SFTP isn't supported under plan9 until this
issue
is fixed.

Note that since SFTP isn't HTTP based the following flags don't work
with it: --dump-headers, --dump-bodies, --dump-auth

Note that --timeout isn't supported (but --contimeout is).

C14

C14 is supported through the SFTP backend.

See C14's documentation

rsync.net

rsync.net is supported through the SFTP backend.

See rsync.net's documentation of rclone examples.

SugarSync

SugarSync is a cloud service that enables
active synchronization of files across computers and other devices for
file backup, access, syncing, and sharing.

The initial setup for SugarSync involves getting a token from SugarSync which you
can do with rclone. rclone config walks you through it.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Sugarsync
   \ "sugarsync"
[snip]
Storage> sugarsync
** See help for sugarsync backend at: https://rclone.org/sugarsync/ **

Sugarsync App ID.
Leave blank to use rclone's.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
app_id> 
Sugarsync Access Key ID.
Leave blank to use rclone's.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
access_key_id> 
Sugarsync Private Access Key
Leave blank to use rclone's.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
private_access_key> 
Permanently delete files if true
otherwise put them in the deleted files.
Enter a boolean value (true or false). Press Enter for the default ("false").
hard_delete> 
Edit advanced config? (y/n)
y) Yes
n) No (default)
y/n> n
Remote config
Username (email address)> nick@craig-wood.com
Your Sugarsync password is only required during setup and will not be stored.
password:
--------------------
[remote]
type = sugarsync
refresh_token = https://api.sugarsync.com/app-authorization/XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK (default)
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

Note that the config asks for your email and password but doesn't
store them, it only uses them to get the initial token.

Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

List directories (sync folders) in top level of your SugarSync

rclone lsd remote:

List all the files in your SugarSync folder "Test"

rclone ls remote:Test

To copy a local directory to an SugarSync folder called backup

rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Paths are specified as remote:path

Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

NB you can't create files in the top level folder you have to
create a folder, which rclone will create as a "Sync Folder" with
SugarSync.

Modified time and hashes

SugarSync does not support modification times or hashes, therefore
syncing will default to --size-only checking. Note that using
--update will work as rclone can read the time files were uploaded.

Restricted filename characters

SugarSync replaces the default restricted characters set
except for DEL.

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in XML strings.

Deleting files

Deleted files will be moved to the "Deleted items" folder by default.

However you can supply the flag --sugarsync-hard-delete or set the
config parameter hard_delete = true if you would like files to be
deleted straight away.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to sugarsync (Sugarsync).

--sugarsync-app-id

Sugarsync App ID.

Leave blank to use rclone's.

  • Config: app_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_APP_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sugarsync-access-key-id

Sugarsync Access Key ID.

Leave blank to use rclone's.

  • Config: access_key_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_ACCESS_KEY_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sugarsync-private-access-key

Sugarsync Private Access Key

Leave blank to use rclone's.

  • Config: private_access_key
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_PRIVATE_ACCESS_KEY
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sugarsync-hard-delete

Permanently delete files if true
otherwise put them in the deleted files.

  • Config: hard_delete
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_HARD_DELETE
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to sugarsync (Sugarsync).

--sugarsync-refresh-token

Sugarsync refresh token

Leave blank normally, will be auto configured by rclone.

  • Config: refresh_token
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_REFRESH_TOKEN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sugarsync-authorization

Sugarsync authorization

Leave blank normally, will be auto configured by rclone.

  • Config: authorization
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_AUTHORIZATION
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sugarsync-authorization-expiry

Sugarsync authorization expiry

Leave blank normally, will be auto configured by rclone.

  • Config: authorization_expiry
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_AUTHORIZATION_EXPIRY
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sugarsync-user

Sugarsync user

Leave blank normally, will be auto configured by rclone.

  • Config: user
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_USER
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sugarsync-root-id

Sugarsync root id

Leave blank normally, will be auto configured by rclone.

  • Config: root_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_ROOT_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sugarsync-deleted-id

Sugarsync deleted folder id

Leave blank normally, will be auto configured by rclone.

  • Config: deleted_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_DELETED_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--sugarsync-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_SUGARSYNC_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Limitations

rclone about is not supported by the SugarSync backend. Backends without
this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or
use policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union
remote.

See List of backends that do not support rclone about
See rclone about

Tardigrade

Tardigrade is an encrypted, secure, and
cost-effective object storage service that enables you to store, back up, and
archive large amounts of data in a decentralized manner.

Setup

To make a new Tardigrade configuration you need one of the following:

  • Access Grant that someone else shared with you.
  • API Key
    of a Tardigrade project you are a member of.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

Setup with access grant

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Tardigrade Decentralized Cloud Storage
   \ "tardigrade"
[snip]
Storage> tardigrade
** See help for tardigrade backend at: https://rclone.org/tardigrade/ **

Choose an authentication method.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("existing").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Use an existing access grant.
   \ "existing"
 2 / Create a new access grant from satellite address, API key, and passphrase.
   \ "new"
provider> existing
Access Grant.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
access_grant> your-access-grant-received-by-someone-else
Remote config
--------------------
[remote]
type = tardigrade
access_grant = your-access-grant-received-by-someone-else
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK (default)
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

Setup with API key and passphrase

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Tardigrade Decentralized Cloud Storage
   \ "tardigrade"
[snip]
Storage> tardigrade
** See help for tardigrade backend at: https://rclone.org/tardigrade/ **

Choose an authentication method.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("existing").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Use an existing access grant.
   \ "existing"
 2 / Create a new access grant from satellite address, API key, and passphrase.
   \ "new"
provider> new
Satellite Address. Custom satellite address should match the format: `<nodeid>@<address>:<port>`.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("us-central-1.tardigrade.io").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / US Central 1
   \ "us-central-1.tardigrade.io"
 2 / Europe West 1
   \ "europe-west-1.tardigrade.io"
 3 / Asia East 1
   \ "asia-east-1.tardigrade.io"
satellite_address> 1
API Key.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
api_key> your-api-key-for-your-tardigrade-project
Encryption Passphrase. To access existing objects enter passphrase used for uploading.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
passphrase> your-human-readable-encryption-passphrase
Remote config
--------------------
[remote]
type = tardigrade
satellite_address = 12EayRS2V1kEsWESU9QMRseFhdxYxKicsiFmxrsLZHeLUtdps3S@us-central-1.tardigrade.io:7777
api_key = your-api-key-for-your-tardigrade-project
passphrase = your-human-readable-encryption-passphrase
access_grant = the-access-grant-generated-from-the-api-key-and-passphrase
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK (default)
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

Usage

Paths are specified as remote:bucket (or remote: for the lsf
command.) You may put subdirectories in too, e.g. remote:bucket/path/to/dir.

Once configured you can then use rclone like this.

Create a new bucket

Use the mkdir command to create new bucket, e.g. bucket.

rclone mkdir remote:bucket

List all buckets

Use the lsf command to list all buckets.

rclone lsf remote:

Note the colon (:) character at the end of the command line.

Delete a bucket

Use the rmdir command to delete an empty bucket.

rclone rmdir remote:bucket

Use the purge command to delete a non-empty bucket with all its content.

rclone purge remote:bucket

Upload objects

Use the copy command to upload an object.

rclone copy --progress /home/local/directory/file.ext remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

The --progress flag is for displaying progress information.
Remove it if you don't need this information.

Use a folder in the local path to upload all its objects.

rclone copy --progress /home/local/directory/ remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

Only modified files will be copied.

List objects

Use the ls command to list recursively all objects in a bucket.

rclone ls remote:bucket

Add the folder to the remote path to list recursively all objects in this folder.

rclone ls remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

Use the lsf command to list non-recursively all objects in a bucket or a folder.

rclone lsf remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

Download objects

Use the copy command to download an object.

rclone copy --progress remote:bucket/path/to/dir/file.ext /home/local/directory/

The --progress flag is for displaying progress information.
Remove it if you don't need this information.

Use a folder in the remote path to download all its objects.

rclone copy --progress remote:bucket/path/to/dir/ /home/local/directory/

Delete objects

Use the deletefile command to delete a single object.

rclone deletefile remote:bucket/path/to/dir/file.ext

Use the delete command to delete all object in a folder.

rclone delete remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

Print the total size of objects

Use the size command to print the total size of objects in a bucket or a folder.

rclone size remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

Sync two Locations

Use the sync command to sync the source to the destination,
changing the destination only, deleting any excess files.

rclone sync -i --progress /home/local/directory/ remote:bucket/path/to/dir/

The --progress flag is for displaying progress information.
Remove it if you don't need this information.

Since this can cause data loss, test first with the --dry-run flag
to see exactly what would be copied and deleted.

The sync can be done also from Tardigrade to the local file system.

rclone sync -i --progress remote:bucket/path/to/dir/ /home/local/directory/

Or between two Tardigrade buckets.

rclone sync -i --progress remote-us:bucket/path/to/dir/ remote-europe:bucket/path/to/dir/

Or even between another cloud storage and Tardigrade.

rclone sync -i --progress s3:bucket/path/to/dir/ tardigrade:bucket/path/to/dir/

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to tardigrade (Tardigrade Decentralized Cloud Storage).

--tardigrade-provider

Choose an authentication method.

  • Config: provider
  • Env Var: RCLONE_TARDIGRADE_PROVIDER
  • Type: string
  • Default: "existing"
  • Examples:
    • "existing"
      • Use an existing access grant.
    • "new"
      • Create a new access grant from satellite address, API key, and passphrase.

--tardigrade-access-grant

Access Grant.

  • Config: access_grant
  • Env Var: RCLONE_TARDIGRADE_ACCESS_GRANT
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--tardigrade-satellite-address

Satellite Address. Custom satellite address should match the format: <nodeid>@<address>:<port>.

  • Config: satellite_address
  • Env Var: RCLONE_TARDIGRADE_SATELLITE_ADDRESS
  • Type: string
  • Default: "us-central-1.tardigrade.io"
  • Examples:
    • "us-central-1.tardigrade.io"
      • US Central 1
    • "europe-west-1.tardigrade.io"
      • Europe West 1
    • "asia-east-1.tardigrade.io"
      • Asia East 1

--tardigrade-api-key

API Key.

  • Config: api_key
  • Env Var: RCLONE_TARDIGRADE_API_KEY
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--tardigrade-passphrase

Encryption Passphrase. To access existing objects enter passphrase used for uploading.

  • Config: passphrase
  • Env Var: RCLONE_TARDIGRADE_PASSPHRASE
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

Limitations

rclone about is not supported by the rclone Tardigrade backend. Backends without
this capability cannot determine free space for an rclone mount or
use policy mfs (most free space) as a member of an rclone union
remote.

See List of backends that do not support rclone about
See rclone about

Union

The union remote provides a unification similar to UnionFS using other remotes.

Paths may be as deep as required or a local path,
e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory or /directory/subdirectory.

During the initial setup with rclone config you will specify the upstream
remotes as a space separated list. The upstream remotes can either be a local paths or other remotes.

Attribute :ro and :nc can be attach to the end of path to tag the remote as read only or no create,
e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory:ro or remote:directory/subdirectory:nc.

Subfolders can be used in upstream remotes. Assume a union remote named backup
with the remotes mydrive:private/backup. Invoking rclone mkdir backup:desktop
is exactly the same as invoking rclone mkdir mydrive:private/backup/desktop.

There will be no special handling of paths containing .. segments.
Invoking rclone mkdir backup:../desktop is exactly the same as invoking
rclone mkdir mydrive:private/backup/../desktop.

Behavior / Policies

The behavior of union backend is inspired by trapexit/mergerfs. All functions are grouped into 3 categories: action, create and search. These functions and categories can be assigned a policy which dictates what file or directory is chosen when performing that behavior. Any policy can be assigned to a function or category though some may not be very useful in practice. For instance: rand (random) may be useful for file creation (create) but could lead to very odd behavior if used for delete if there were more than one copy of the file.

Function / Category classifications

Category Description Functions
action Writing Existing file move, rmdir, rmdirs, delete, purge and copy, sync (as destination when file exist)
create Create non-existing file copy, sync (as destination when file not exist)
search Reading and listing file ls, lsd, lsl, cat, md5sum, sha1sum and copy, sync (as source)
N/A size, about

Path Preservation

Policies, as described below, are of two basic types. path preserving and non-path preserving.

All policies which start with ep (epff, eplfs, eplus, epmfs, eprand) are path preserving. ep stands for existing path.

A path preserving policy will only consider upstreams where the relative path being accessed already exists.

When using non-path preserving policies paths will be created in target upstreams as necessary.

Quota Relevant Policies

Some policies rely on quota information. These policies should be used only if your upstreams support the respective quota fields.

Policy Required Field
lfs, eplfs Free
mfs, epmfs Free
lus, eplus Used
lno, eplno Objects

To check if your upstream supports the field, run rclone about remote: [flags] and see if the required field exists.

Filters

Policies basically search upstream remotes and create a list of files / paths for functions to work on. The policy is responsible for filtering and sorting. The policy type defines the sorting but filtering is mostly uniform as described below.

  • No search policies filter.
  • All action policies will filter out remotes which are tagged as read-only.
  • All create policies will filter out remotes which are tagged read-only or no-create.

If all remotes are filtered an error will be returned.

Policy descriptions

The policies definition are inspired by trapexit/mergerfs but not exactly the same. Some policy definition could be different due to the much larger latency of remote file systems.

Policy Description
all Search category: same as epall. Action category: same as epall. Create category: act on all upstreams.
epall (existing path, all) Search category: Given this order configured, act on the first one found where the relative path exists. Action category: apply to all found. Create category: act on all upstreams where the relative path exists.
epff (existing path, first found) Act on the first one found, by the time upstreams reply, where the relative path exists.
eplfs (existing path, least free space) Of all the upstreams on which the relative path exists choose the one with the least free space.
eplus (existing path, least used space) Of all the upstreams on which the relative path exists choose the one with the least used space.
eplno (existing path, least number of objects) Of all the upstreams on which the relative path exists choose the one with the least number of objects.
epmfs (existing path, most free space) Of all the upstreams on which the relative path exists choose the one with the most free space.
eprand (existing path, random) Calls epall and then randomizes. Returns only one upstream.
ff (first found) Search category: same as epff. Action category: same as epff. Create category: Act on the first one found by the time upstreams reply.
lfs (least free space) Search category: same as eplfs. Action category: same as eplfs. Create category: Pick the upstream with the least available free space.
lus (least used space) Search category: same as eplus. Action category: same as eplus. Create category: Pick the upstream with the least used space.
lno (least number of objects) Search category: same as eplno. Action category: same as eplno. Create category: Pick the upstream with the least number of objects.
mfs (most free space) Search category: same as epmfs. Action category: same as epmfs. Create category: Pick the upstream with the most available free space.
newest Pick the file / directory with the largest mtime.
rand (random) Calls all and then randomizes. Returns only one upstream.

Setup

Here is an example of how to make a union called remote for local folders.
First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Union merges the contents of several remotes
   \ "union"
[snip]
Storage> union
List of space separated upstreams.
Can be 'upstreama:test/dir upstreamb:', '\"upstreama:test/space:ro dir\" upstreamb:', etc.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
upstreams> remote1:dir1 remote2:dir2 remote3:dir3
Policy to choose upstream on ACTION class.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("epall").
action_policy>
Policy to choose upstream on CREATE class.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("epmfs").
create_policy>
Policy to choose upstream on SEARCH class.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("ff").
search_policy>
Cache time of usage and free space (in seconds). This option is only useful when a path preserving policy is used.
Enter a signed integer. Press Enter for the default ("120").
cache_time>
Remote config
--------------------
[remote]
type = union
upstreams = remote1:dir1 remote2:dir2 remote3:dir3
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y
Current remotes:

Name                 Type
====                 ====
remote               union

e) Edit existing remote
n) New remote
d) Delete remote
r) Rename remote
c) Copy remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
e/n/d/r/c/s/q> q

Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

List directories in top level in remote1:dir1, remote2:dir2 and remote3:dir3

rclone lsd remote:

List all the files in remote1:dir1, remote2:dir2 and remote3:dir3

rclone ls remote:

Copy another local directory to the union directory called source, which will be placed into remote3:dir3

rclone copy C:\source remote:source

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to union (Union merges the contents of several upstream fs).

--union-upstreams

List of space separated upstreams.
Can be 'upstreama:test/dir upstreamb:', '"upstreama:test/space:ro dir" upstreamb:', etc.

  • Config: upstreams
  • Env Var: RCLONE_UNION_UPSTREAMS
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--union-action-policy

Policy to choose upstream on ACTION category.

  • Config: action_policy
  • Env Var: RCLONE_UNION_ACTION_POLICY
  • Type: string
  • Default: "epall"

--union-create-policy

Policy to choose upstream on CREATE category.

  • Config: create_policy
  • Env Var: RCLONE_UNION_CREATE_POLICY
  • Type: string
  • Default: "epmfs"

--union-search-policy

Policy to choose upstream on SEARCH category.

  • Config: search_policy
  • Env Var: RCLONE_UNION_SEARCH_POLICY
  • Type: string
  • Default: "ff"

--union-cache-time

Cache time of usage and free space (in seconds). This option is only useful when a path preserving policy is used.

  • Config: cache_time
  • Env Var: RCLONE_UNION_CACHE_TIME
  • Type: int
  • Default: 120

WebDAV

Paths are specified as remote:path

Paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

To configure the WebDAV remote you will need to have a URL for it, and
a username and password. If you know what kind of system you are
connecting to then rclone can enable extra features.

Here is an example of how to make a remote called remote. First run:

 rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
q) Quit config
n/s/q> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Webdav
   \ "webdav"
[snip]
Storage> webdav
URL of http host to connect to
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Connect to example.com
   \ "https://example.com"
url> https://example.com/remote.php/webdav/
Name of the Webdav site/service/software you are using
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / Nextcloud
   \ "nextcloud"
 2 / Owncloud
   \ "owncloud"
 3 / Sharepoint
   \ "sharepoint"
 4 / Other site/service or software
   \ "other"
vendor> 1
User name
user> user
Password.
y) Yes type in my own password
g) Generate random password
n) No leave this optional password blank
y/g/n> y
Enter the password:
password:
Confirm the password:
password:
Bearer token instead of user/pass (e.g. a Macaroon)
bearer_token>
Remote config
--------------------
[remote]
type = webdav
url = https://example.com/remote.php/webdav/
vendor = nextcloud
user = user
pass = *** ENCRYPTED ***
bearer_token =
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

List directories in top level of your WebDAV

rclone lsd remote:

List all the files in your WebDAV

rclone ls remote:

To copy a local directory to an WebDAV directory called backup

rclone copy /home/source remote:backup

Modified time and hashes

Plain WebDAV does not support modified times. However when used with
Owncloud or Nextcloud rclone will support modified times.

Likewise plain WebDAV does not support hashes, however when used with
Owncloud or Nextcloud rclone will support SHA1 and MD5 hashes.
Depending on the exact version of Owncloud or Nextcloud hashes may
appear on all objects, or only on objects which had a hash uploaded
with them.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to webdav (Webdav).

--webdav-url

URL of http host to connect to

  • Config: url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:

--webdav-vendor

Name of the Webdav site/service/software you are using

  • Config: vendor
  • Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_VENDOR
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "nextcloud"
      • Nextcloud
    • "owncloud"
      • Owncloud
    • "sharepoint"
      • Sharepoint
    • "other"
      • Other site/service or software

--webdav-user

User name

  • Config: user
  • Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_USER
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--webdav-pass

Password.

NB Input to this must be obscured - see rclone obscure.

  • Config: pass
  • Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_PASS
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--webdav-bearer-token

Bearer token instead of user/pass (e.g. a Macaroon)

  • Config: bearer_token
  • Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_BEARER_TOKEN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to webdav (Webdav).

--webdav-bearer-token-command

Command to run to get a bearer token

  • Config: bearer_token_command
  • Env Var: RCLONE_WEBDAV_BEARER_TOKEN_COMMAND
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

Provider notes

See below for notes on specific providers.

Owncloud

Click on the settings cog in the bottom right of the page and this
will show the WebDAV URL that rclone needs in the config step. It
will look something like https://example.com/remote.php/webdav/.

Owncloud supports modified times using the X-OC-Mtime header.

Nextcloud

This is configured in an identical way to Owncloud. Note that
Nextcloud initially did not support streaming of files (rcat) whereas
Owncloud did, but this seems to be fixed as of 2020-11-27 (tested with rclone v1.53.1 and Nextcloud Server v19).

Sharepoint

Rclone can be used with Sharepoint provided by OneDrive for Business
or Office365 Education Accounts.
This feature is only needed for a few of these Accounts,
mostly Office365 Education ones. These accounts are sometimes not
verified by the domain owner github#1975

This means that these accounts can't be added using the official
API (other Accounts should work with the "onedrive" option). However,
it is possible to access them using webdav.

To use a sharepoint remote with rclone, add it like this:
First, you need to get your remote's URL:

  • Go here
    to open your OneDrive or to sign in
  • Now take a look at your address bar, the URL should look like this:
    https://[YOUR-DOMAIN]-my.sharepoint.com/personal/[YOUR-EMAIL]/_layouts/15/onedrive.aspx

You'll only need this URL up to the email address. After that, you'll
most likely want to add "/Documents". That subdirectory contains
the actual data stored on your OneDrive.

Add the remote to rclone like this:
Configure the url as https://[YOUR-DOMAIN]-my.sharepoint.com/personal/[YOUR-EMAIL]/Documents
and use your normal account email and password for user and pass.
If you have 2FA enabled, you have to generate an app password.
Set the vendor to sharepoint.

Your config file should look like this:

[sharepoint]
type = webdav
url = https://[YOUR-DOMAIN]-my.sharepoint.com/personal/[YOUR-EMAIL]/Documents
vendor = other
user = YourEmailAddress
pass = encryptedpassword

Required Flags for SharePoint

As SharePoint does some special things with uploaded documents, you won't be able to use the documents size or the documents hash to compare if a file has been changed since the upload / which file is newer.

For Rclone calls copying files (especially Office files such as .docx, .xlsx, etc.) from/to SharePoint (like copy, sync, etc.), you should append these flags to ensure Rclone uses the "Last Modified" datetime property to compare your documents:

--ignore-size --ignore-checksum --update

dCache

dCache is a storage system that supports many protocols and
authentication/authorisation schemes. For WebDAV clients, it allows
users to authenticate with username and password (BASIC), X.509,
Kerberos, and various bearer tokens, including
Macaroons
and OpenID-Connect
access tokens.

Configure as normal using the other type. Don't enter a username or
password, instead enter your Macaroon as the bearer_token.

The config will end up looking something like this.

[dcache]
type = webdav
url = https://dcache...
vendor = other
user =
pass =
bearer_token = your-macaroon

There is a script that
obtains a Macaroon from a dCache WebDAV endpoint, and creates an rclone config file.

Macaroons may also be obtained from the dCacheView
web-browser/JavaScript client that comes with dCache.

OpenID-Connect

dCache also supports authenticating with OpenID-Connect access tokens.
OpenID-Connect is a protocol (based on OAuth 2.0) that allows services
to identify users who have authenticated with some central service.

Support for OpenID-Connect in rclone is currently achieved using
another software package called
oidc-agent. This is a
command-line tool that facilitates obtaining an access token. Once
installed and configured, an access token is obtained by running the
oidc-token command. The following example shows a (shortened)
access token obtained from the XDC OIDC Provider.

paul@celebrimbor:~$ oidc-token XDC
eyJraWQ[...]QFXDt0
paul@celebrimbor:~$

Note Before the oidc-token command will work, the refresh token
must be loaded into the oidc agent. This is done with the oidc-add
command (e.g., oidc-add XDC). This is typically done once per login
session. Full details on this and how to register oidc-agent with
your OIDC Provider are provided in the oidc-agent
documentation
.

The rclone bearer_token_command configuration option is used to
fetch the access token from oidc-agent.

Configure as a normal WebDAV endpoint, using the 'other' vendor,
leaving the username and password empty. When prompted, choose to
edit the advanced config and enter the command to get a bearer token
(e.g., oidc-agent XDC).

The following example config shows a WebDAV endpoint that uses
oidc-agent to supply an access token from the XDC OIDC Provider.

[dcache]
type = webdav
url = https://dcache.example.org/
vendor = other
bearer_token_command = oidc-token XDC

Yandex Disk

Yandex Disk is a cloud storage solution created by Yandex.

Here is an example of making a yandex configuration. First run

rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
n/s> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Yandex Disk
   \ "yandex"
[snip]
Storage> yandex
Yandex Client Id - leave blank normally.
client_id>
Yandex Client Secret - leave blank normally.
client_secret>
Remote config
Use auto config?
 * Say Y if not sure
 * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
y) Yes
n) No
y/n> y
If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth
Log in and authorize rclone for access
Waiting for code...
Got code
--------------------
[remote]
client_id =
client_secret =
token = {"access_token":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","token_type":"bearer","expiry":"2016-12-29T12:27:11.362788025Z"}
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> y

See the remote setup docs for how to set it up on a
machine with no Internet browser available.

Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the
token as returned from Yandex Disk. This only runs from the moment it
opens your browser to the moment you get back the verification code.
This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require you to
unblock it temporarily if you are running a host firewall.

Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

See top level directories

rclone lsd remote:

Make a new directory

rclone mkdir remote:directory

List the contents of a directory

rclone ls remote:directory

Sync /home/local/directory to the remote path, deleting any
excess files in the path.

rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:directory

Yandex paths may be as deep as required, e.g. remote:directory/subdirectory.

Modified time

Modified times are supported and are stored accurate to 1 ns in custom
metadata called rclone_modified in RFC3339 with nanoseconds format.

MD5 checksums

MD5 checksums are natively supported by Yandex Disk.

Emptying Trash

If you wish to empty your trash you can use the rclone cleanup remote:
command which will permanently delete all your trashed files. This command
does not take any path arguments.

Quota information

To view your current quota you can use the rclone about remote:
command which will display your usage limit (quota) and the current usage.

Restricted filename characters

The default restricted characters set
are replaced.

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be used in JSON strings.

Limitations

When uploading very large files (bigger than about 5GB) you will need
to increase the --timeout parameter. This is because Yandex pauses
(perhaps to calculate the MD5SUM for the entire file) before returning
confirmation that the file has been uploaded. The default handling of
timeouts in rclone is to assume a 5 minute pause is an error and close
the connection - you'll see net/http: timeout awaiting response headers errors in the logs if this is happening. Setting the timeout
to twice the max size of file in GB should be enough, so if you want
to upload a 30GB file set a timeout of 2 * 30 = 60m, that is
--timeout 60m.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to yandex (Yandex Disk).

--yandex-client-id

OAuth Client Id
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: client_id
  • Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_CLIENT_ID
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--yandex-client-secret

OAuth Client Secret
Leave blank normally.

  • Config: client_secret
  • Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_CLIENT_SECRET
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to yandex (Yandex Disk).

--yandex-token

OAuth Access Token as a JSON blob.

  • Config: token
  • Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_TOKEN
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--yandex-auth-url

Auth server URL.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: auth_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_AUTH_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--yandex-token-url

Token server url.
Leave blank to use the provider defaults.

  • Config: token_url
  • Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_TOKEN_URL
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""

--yandex-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_YANDEX_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8,Dot

Zoho Workdrive

Zoho WorkDrive is a cloud storage solution created by Zoho.

Here is an example of making a zoho configuration. First run

rclone config

This will guide you through an interactive setup process:

No remotes found - make a new one
n) New remote
s) Set configuration password
n/s> n
name> remote
Type of storage to configure.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
[snip]
XX / Zoho
   \ "zoho"
[snip]
Storage> zoho
** See help for zoho backend at: https://rclone.org/zoho/ **

OAuth Client Id
Leave blank normally.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
client_id> 
OAuth Client Secret
Leave blank normally.
Enter a string value. Press Enter for the default ("").
client_secret> 
Edit advanced config? (y/n)
y) Yes
n) No (default)
y/n> n
Remote config
Use auto config?
 * Say Y if not sure
 * Say N if you are working on a remote or headless machine
y) Yes (default)
n) No
y/n> 
If your browser doesn't open automatically go to the following link: http://127.0.0.1:53682/auth?state=LVn0IHzxej1ZkmQw31d0wQ
Log in and authorize rclone for access
Waiting for code...
Got code
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / MyTeam
   \ "4u28602177065ff22426787a6745dba8954eb"
Enter a Team ID> 1
Choose a number from below, or type in your own value
 1 / General
   \ "4u2869d2aa6fca04f4f2f896b6539243b85b1"
Enter a Workspace ID> 1
--------------------
[remote]
type = zoho
token = {"access_token":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","token_type":"Zoho-oauthtoken","refresh_token":"xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx","expiry":"2020-10-12T00:54:52.370275223+02:00"}
root_folder_id = xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
--------------------
y) Yes this is OK (default)
e) Edit this remote
d) Delete this remote
y/e/d> 

See the remote setup docs for how to set it up on a
machine with no Internet browser available.

Note that rclone runs a webserver on your local machine to collect the
token as returned from Zoho Workdrive. This only runs from the moment it
opens your browser to the moment you get back the verification code.
This is on http://127.0.0.1:53682/ and this it may require you to
unblock it temporarily if you are running a host firewall.

Once configured you can then use rclone like this,

See top level directories

rclone lsd remote:

Make a new directory

rclone mkdir remote:directory

List the contents of a directory

rclone ls remote:directory

Sync /home/local/directory to the remote path, deleting any
excess files in the path.

rclone sync -i /home/local/directory remote:directory

Zoho paths may be as deep as required, eg remote:directory/subdirectory.

Modified time

Modified times are currently not supported for Zoho Workdrive

Checksums

No checksums are supported.

Usage information

To view your current quota you can use the rclone about remote:
command which will display your current usage.

Restricted filename characters

Only control characters and invalid UTF-8 are replaced. In addition most
Unicode full-width characters are not supported at all and will be removed
from filenames during upload.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to zoho (Zoho).

--zoho-region

Zoho region to connect to. You'll have to use the region you organization is registered in.

  • Config: region
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ZOHO_REGION
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "com"
      • United states / Global
    • "eu"
      • Europe
    • "in"
      • India
    • "com.au"
      • Australia

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to zoho (Zoho).

--zoho-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_ZOHO_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Del,Ctl,InvalidUtf8

Local Filesystem

Local paths are specified as normal filesystem paths, e.g. /path/to/wherever, so

rclone sync -i /home/source /tmp/destination

Will sync /home/source to /tmp/destination

These can be configured into the config file for consistencies sake,
but it is probably easier not to.

Modified time

Rclone reads and writes the modified time using an accuracy determined by
the OS. Typically this is 1ns on Linux, 10 ns on Windows and 1 Second
on OS X.

Filenames

Filenames should be encoded in UTF-8 on disk. This is the normal case
for Windows and OS X.

There is a bit more uncertainty in the Linux world, but new
distributions will have UTF-8 encoded files names. If you are using an
old Linux filesystem with non UTF-8 file names (e.g. latin1) then you
can use the convmv tool to convert the filesystem to UTF-8. This
tool is available in most distributions' package managers.

If an invalid (non-UTF8) filename is read, the invalid characters will
be replaced with a quoted representation of the invalid bytes. The name
gro\xdf will be transferred as groDF. rclone will emit a debug
message in this case (use -v to see), e.g.

Local file system at .: Replacing invalid UTF-8 characters in "gro\xdf"

Restricted characters

On non Windows platforms the following characters are replaced when
handling file names.

Character Value Replacement
NUL 0x00
/ 0x2F

When running on Windows the following characters are replaced. This
list is based on the Windows file naming conventions.

Character Value Replacement
NUL 0x00
SOH 0x01
STX 0x02
ETX 0x03
EOT 0x04
ENQ 0x05
ACK 0x06
BEL 0x07
BS 0x08
HT 0x09
LF 0x0A
VT 0x0B
FF 0x0C
CR 0x0D
SO 0x0E
SI 0x0F
DLE 0x10
DC1 0x11
DC2 0x12
DC3 0x13
DC4 0x14
NAK 0x15
SYN 0x16
ETB 0x17
CAN 0x18
EM 0x19
SUB 0x1A
ESC 0x1B
FS 0x1C
GS 0x1D
RS 0x1E
US 0x1F
/ 0x2F
" 0x22
* 0x2A
: 0x3A
< 0x3C
> 0x3E
? 0x3F
\ 0x5C
| 0x7C

File names on Windows can also not end with the following characters.
These only get replaced if they are the last character in the name:

Character Value Replacement
SP 0x20
. 0x2E

Invalid UTF-8 bytes will also be replaced,
as they can't be converted to UTF-16.

Long paths on Windows

Rclone handles long paths automatically, by converting all paths to long
UNC paths
which allows paths up to 32,767 characters.

This is why you will see that your paths, for instance c:\files is
converted to the UNC path \\?\c:\files in the output,
and \\server\share is converted to \\?\UNC\server\share.

However, in rare cases this may cause problems with buggy file
system drivers like EncFS.
To disable UNC conversion globally, add this to your .rclone.conf file:

[local]
nounc = true

If you want to selectively disable UNC, you can add it to a separate entry like this:

[nounc]
type = local
nounc = true

And use rclone like this:

rclone copy c:\src nounc:z:\dst

This will use UNC paths on c:\src but not on z:\dst.
Of course this will cause problems if the absolute path length of a
file exceeds 258 characters on z, so only use this option if you have to.

Normally rclone will ignore symlinks or junction points (which behave
like symlinks under Windows).

If you supply --copy-links or -L then rclone will follow the
symlink and copy the pointed to file or directory. Note that this
flag is incompatible with -links / -l.

This flag applies to all commands.

For example, supposing you have a directory structure like this

$ tree /tmp/a
/tmp/a
├── b -> ../b
├── expected -> ../expected
├── one
└── two
    └── three

Then you can see the difference with and without the flag like this

$ rclone ls /tmp/a
        6 one
        6 two/three

and

$ rclone -L ls /tmp/a
     4174 expected
        6 one
        6 two/three
        6 b/two
        6 b/one

Normally rclone will ignore symlinks or junction points (which behave
like symlinks under Windows).

If you supply this flag then rclone will copy symbolic links from the local storage,
and store them as text files, with a '.rclonelink' suffix in the remote storage.

The text file will contain the target of the symbolic link (see example).

This flag applies to all commands.

For example, supposing you have a directory structure like this

$ tree /tmp/a
/tmp/a
├── file1 -> ./file4
└── file2 -> /home/user/file3

Copying the entire directory with '-l'

$ rclone copyto -l /tmp/a/file1 remote:/tmp/a/

The remote files are created with a '.rclonelink' suffix

$ rclone ls remote:/tmp/a
       5 file1.rclonelink
      14 file2.rclonelink

The remote files will contain the target of the symbolic links

$ rclone cat remote:/tmp/a/file1.rclonelink
./file4

$ rclone cat remote:/tmp/a/file2.rclonelink
/home/user/file3

Copying them back with '-l'

$ rclone copyto -l remote:/tmp/a/ /tmp/b/

$ tree /tmp/b
/tmp/b
├── file1 -> ./file4
└── file2 -> /home/user/file3

However, if copied back without '-l'

$ rclone copyto remote:/tmp/a/ /tmp/b/

$ tree /tmp/b
/tmp/b
├── file1.rclonelink
└── file2.rclonelink

Note that this flag is incompatible with -copy-links / -L.

Restricting filesystems with --one-file-system

Normally rclone will recurse through filesystems as mounted.

However if you set --one-file-system or -x this tells rclone to
stay in the filesystem specified by the root and not to recurse into
different file systems.

For example if you have a directory hierarchy like this

root
├── disk1     - disk1 mounted on the root
│   └── file3 - stored on disk1
├── disk2     - disk2 mounted on the root
│   └── file4 - stored on disk12
├── file1     - stored on the root disk
└── file2     - stored on the root disk

Using rclone --one-file-system copy root remote: will only copy file1 and file2. Eg

$ rclone -q --one-file-system ls root
        0 file1
        0 file2
$ rclone -q ls root
        0 disk1/file3
        0 disk2/file4
        0 file1
        0 file2

NB Rclone (like most unix tools such as du, rsync and tar)
treats a bind mount to the same device as being on the same
filesystem.

NB This flag is only available on Unix based systems. On systems
where it isn't supported (e.g. Windows) it will be ignored.

Standard Options

Here are the standard options specific to local (Local Disk).

--local-nounc

Disable UNC (long path names) conversion on Windows

  • Config: nounc
  • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_NOUNC
  • Type: string
  • Default: ""
  • Examples:
    • "true"
      • Disables long file names

Advanced Options

Here are the advanced options specific to local (Local Disk).

Follow symlinks and copy the pointed to item.

  • Config: copy_links
  • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_COPY_LINKS
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

Translate symlinks to/from regular files with a '.rclonelink' extension

  • Config: links
  • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_LINKS
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

Don't warn about skipped symlinks.
This flag disables warning messages on skipped symlinks or junction
points, as you explicitly acknowledge that they should be skipped.

  • Config: skip_links
  • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_SKIP_LINKS
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

Assume the Stat size of links is zero (and read them instead)

On some virtual filesystems (such ash LucidLink), reading a link size via a Stat call always returns 0.
However, on unix it reads as the length of the text in the link. This may cause errors like this when
syncing:

Failed to copy: corrupted on transfer: sizes differ 0 vs 13

Setting this flag causes rclone to read the link and use that as the size of the link
instead of 0 which in most cases fixes the problem.

  • Config: zero_size_links
  • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_ZERO_SIZE_LINKS
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--local-no-unicode-normalization

Don't apply unicode normalization to paths and filenames (Deprecated)

This flag is deprecated now. Rclone no longer normalizes unicode file
names, but it compares them with unicode normalization in the sync
routine instead.

  • Config: no_unicode_normalization
  • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_NO_UNICODE_NORMALIZATION
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--local-no-check-updated

Don't check to see if the files change during upload

Normally rclone checks the size and modification time of files as they
are being uploaded and aborts with a message which starts "can't copy

  • source file is being updated" if the file changes during upload.

However on some file systems this modification time check may fail (e.g.
Glusterfs #2206) so this
check can be disabled with this flag.

If this flag is set, rclone will use its best efforts to transfer a
file which is being updated. If the file is only having things
appended to it (e.g. a log) then rclone will transfer the log file with
the size it had the first time rclone saw it.

If the file is being modified throughout (not just appended to) then
the transfer may fail with a hash check failure.

In detail, once the file has had stat() called on it for the first
time we:

  • Only transfer the size that stat gave

  • Only checksum the size that stat gave

  • Don't update the stat info for the file

  • Config: no_check_updated

  • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_NO_CHECK_UPDATED

  • Type: bool

  • Default: false

--one-file-system / -x

Don't cross filesystem boundaries (unix/macOS only).

  • Config: one_file_system
  • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_ONE_FILE_SYSTEM
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--local-case-sensitive

Force the filesystem to report itself as case sensitive.

Normally the local backend declares itself as case insensitive on
Windows/macOS and case sensitive for everything else. Use this flag
to override the default choice.

  • Config: case_sensitive
  • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_CASE_SENSITIVE
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--local-case-insensitive

Force the filesystem to report itself as case insensitive

Normally the local backend declares itself as case insensitive on
Windows/macOS and case sensitive for everything else. Use this flag
to override the default choice.

  • Config: case_insensitive
  • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_CASE_INSENSITIVE
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--local-no-sparse

Disable sparse files for multi-thread downloads

On Windows platforms rclone will make sparse files when doing
multi-thread downloads. This avoids long pauses on large files where
the OS zeros the file. However sparse files may be undesirable as they
cause disk fragmentation and can be slow to work with.

  • Config: no_sparse
  • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_NO_SPARSE
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--local-no-set-modtime

Disable setting modtime

Normally rclone updates modification time of files after they are done
uploading. This can cause permissions issues on Linux platforms when
the user rclone is running as does not own the file uploaded, such as
when copying to a CIFS mount owned by another user. If this option is
enabled, rclone will no longer update the modtime after copying a file.

  • Config: no_set_modtime
  • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_NO_SET_MODTIME
  • Type: bool
  • Default: false

--local-encoding

This sets the encoding for the backend.

See: the encoding section in the overview for more info.

  • Config: encoding
  • Env Var: RCLONE_LOCAL_ENCODING
  • Type: MultiEncoder
  • Default: Slash,Dot

Backend commands

Here are the commands specific to the local backend.

Run them with

rclone backend COMMAND remote:

The help below will explain what arguments each command takes.

See the "rclone backend" command for more
info on how to pass options and arguments.

These can be run on a running backend using the rc command
backend/command.

noop

A null operation for testing backend commands

rclone backend noop remote: [options] [<arguments>+]

This is a test command which has some options
you can try to change the output.

Options:

  • "echo": echo the input arguments
  • "error": return an error based on option value

Changelog

v1.54.0 - 2021-02-02

See commits

  • New backends
    • Compression remote (experimental)(buengese)
    • Enterprise File Fabric (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • HDFS (Hadoop Distributed File System) (Yury Stankevich)
    • Zoho workdrive (buengese)
  • New Features
    • Deglobalise the config (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Global config now read from the context
      • Global config can be passed into the rc
      • This work was sponsored by Digitalis
    • Add --bwlimit for upload and download (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Obey bwlimit in http Transport for better limiting
    • Enhance systemd integration (Hekmon)
      • log level identification
      • manual activation with flag
      • automatic systemd launch detection
      • Don't compile systemd log integration for non unix systems (Benjamin Gustin)
    • Add a download flag to hashsum and related commands to force rclone to download and hash files locally (lostheli)
    • build
      • Raise minimum go version to go1.12 (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • check
      • Make the error count match up in the log message (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • cmd
      • Add --progress-terminal-title to print ETA to terminal title (LaSombra)
      • Make backend env vars show in help as the defaults for backend flags (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • dedupe
      • Add --by-hash to dedupe on hash not file name (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add --dedupe-mode list to just list dupes, changing nothing (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add warning if used on a remote which can't have duplicate names (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • flags: Improve error message when reading environment vars (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • fs
      • Add Shutdown optional method for backends (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • When using --files-from check files concurrently (zhucan)
      • Accumulate stats when using --dry-run (Ingo Weiss)
      • Always show stats when using --dry-run or --interactive (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add support for flag --no-console on windows to hide the console window (albertony)
    • genautocomplete: Add support to output to stdout (Ingo)
    • ncdu
      • Highlight read errors instead of aborting (Claudio Bantaloukas)
      • Add sort by average size in directory (Adam Plánský)
      • Add toggle option for average size in directory - key 'a' (Adam Plánský)
      • Add empty folder flag into ncdu browser (Adam Plánský)
      • Add ! (errror) and . (unreadable) file flags to go with e (empty) (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • obscure: Make rclone osbcure - ignore newline at end of line (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • operations
      • Add logs when need to upload files to set mod times (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Move and copy log name of the destination object in verbose (Adam Plánský)
      • Add size if known to skipped items and JSON log (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rc
      • Prefer actual listener address if using ":port" or "addr:0" only (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add listener for finished jobs (Aleksandar Jankovic)
    • serve ftp: Add options to enable TLS (Deepak Sah)
    • serve http/webdav: Redirect requests to the base url without the / (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • serve restic: Implement object cache (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • stats: Add counter for deleted directories (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • sync: Only print "There was nothing to transfer" if no errors (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • webui
      • Prompt user for updating webui if an update is available (Chaitanya Bankanhal)
      • Fix plugins initialization (negative0)
  • Bug Fixes
    • build
      • Explicitly set ARM version to fix build (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Don't explicitly set ARM version to fix ARMv5 build (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix nfpm install (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix docker build by upgrading ilteoood/docker_buildx (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Temporary fix for Windows build errors (Ivan Andreev)
    • fs
      • Fix nil pointer on copy & move operations directly to remote (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)
      • Fix parsing of .. when joining remotes (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • log: Fix enabling systemd logging when using --log-file (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • move: Fix data loss when moving the same object (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • operations
      • Fix --cutof-mode hard not cutting off immediately (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix --immutable error message (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • sync
      • Fix --cutoff-mode soft & cautious so it doesn't end the transfer early (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix --immutable errors retrying many times (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Docs
    • Many fixes and a rewrite of the filtering docs (edwardxml)
    • Many spelling and grammar problems (Josh Soref)
    • Doc fixes for commands delete, purge, rmdir, rmdirs and mount (albertony)
    • And thanks to these people for many doc fixes too numerous to list
      • Ameer Dawood, Antoine GIRARD, Bob Bagwill, Christopher Stewart
      • CokeMine, David, Dov Murik, Durval Menezes, Evan Harris, gtorelly
      • Ilyess Bachiri, Janne Johansson, Kerry Su, Marcin Zelent,
      • Martin Michlmayr, Milly, Sơn Trần-Nguyễn
  • Mount
    • Update systemd status with cache stats (Hekmon)
    • Disable bazil/fuse based mount on macOS (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Make mount be cmount under macOS (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Implement mknod to make NFS file creation work (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Make sure we don't call umount more than once (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Don't call host.Umount if a signal has been received (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • More user friendly mounting as network drive on windows (albertony)
    • Cleanup OS specific option handling and documentation (albertony)
    • Detect if uid or gid are set in same option string: -o uid=123,gid=456 (albertony)
    • Don't attempt to unmount if fs has been destroyed already (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • VFS
    • Fix virtual entries causing deleted files to still appear (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix "file already exists" error for stale cache files (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix file leaks with --vfs-cache-mode full and --buffer-size 0 (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix invalid cache path on windows when using :backend: as remote (albertony)
  • Local
    • Continue listing files/folders when a circular symlink is detected (Manish Gupta)
    • New flag --local-zero-size-links to fix sync on some virtual filesystems (Riccardo Iaconelli)
  • Azure Blob
    • Add support for service principals (James Lim)
    • Utilize streaming capabilities (Denis Neuling)
    • Update SDK to v0.13.0 and fix API breakage (Nick Craig-Wood, Mitsuo Heijo)
    • Fix setting of mime types (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix crash when listing outside a SAS URL's root (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Delete archive tier blobs before update if --azureblob-archive-tier-delete (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add support for managed identities (Brad Ackerman)
    • Fix crash on startup (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add examples for access tier (Bob Pusateri)
    • Fix memory usage by upgrading the SDK and implementing a TransferManager (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Require go1.14+ to compile due to SDK changes (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • B2
    • Make NewObject use less expensive API calls (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fixed possible crash when accessing Backblaze b2 remote (lluuaapp)
  • Box
    • Fix NewObject for files that differ in case (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix finding directories in a case insentive way (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Chunker
    • Skip long local hashing, hash in-transit (fixes) (Ivan Andreev)
    • Set Features.ReadMimeType=false as Object.MimeType not supported (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix case-insensitive NewObject, test metadata detection (Ivan Andreev)
  • Drive
    • Implement "rclone backend copyid" command for copying files by ID (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Added flag --drive-stop-on-download-limit to stop transfers when the download limit is exceeded (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)
    • Implement CleanUp workaround for team drives (buengese)
    • Allow shortcut resolution and creation to be retried (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Log that emptying the trash can take some time (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add xdg office icons to xdg desktop files (Pau Rodriguez-Estivill)
  • Dropbox
    • Add support for viewing shared files and folders (buengese)
    • Implement IDer (buengese)
    • Set Features.ReadMimeType=false as Object.MimeType not supported (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Tidy repeated error message (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Make malformed_path errors from too long files not retriable (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Test file name length before upload to fix upload loop (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Enable short lived access tokens (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Fichier
    • Set Features.ReadMimeType=true as Object.MimeType is supported (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • FTP
    • Add --ftp-disable-msld option to ignore MLSD for really old servers (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Make --tpslimit apply (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Google Cloud Storage
    • Storage class object header support (Laurens Janssen)
    • Fix anonymous client to use rclone's HTTP client (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix Entry doesn't belong in directory "" (same as directory) - ignoring (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Googlephotos
    • New flag --gphotos-include-archived (Nicolas Rueff)
  • Jottacloud
    • Don't erroniously report support for writing mime types (buengese)
    • Add support for Telia Cloud (#4930) (Patrik Nordlén)
  • Mailru
    • Fix uploads after recent changes on server (Ivan Andreev)
    • Fix range requests after June 2020 changes on server (Ivan Andreev)
    • Fix invalid timestamp on corrupted files (fixes) (Ivan Andreev)
    • Remove deprecated protocol quirks (Ivan Andreev)
    • Accept special folders eg camera-upload (Ivan Andreev)
    • Avoid prehashing of large local files (Ivan Andreev)
  • Memory
    • Fix setting of mime types (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Onedrive
    • Add support for china region operated by 21vianet and other regional suppliers (#4963) (NyaMisty)
    • Warn on gateway timeout errors (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fall back to normal copy if server-side copy unavailable (#4903) (Alex Chen)
    • Fix server-side copy completely disabled on OneDrive for Business (Cnly)
    • (business only) workaround to replace existing file on server-side copy (#4904) (Alex Chen)
    • Enhance link creation with expiry, scope, type and password (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Remove % and # from the set of encoded characters (#4909) (Alex Chen)
    • Support addressing site by server-relative URL (#4761) (kice)
  • Opendrive
    • Fix finding directories in a case insensitive way (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Pcloud
    • Fix setting of mime types (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Premiumizeme
    • Fix finding directories in a case insensitive way (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Qingstor
    • Fix error propagation in CleanUp (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix rclone cleanup (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • S3
    • Added --s3-disable-http2 to disable http/2 (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)
    • Complete SSE-C implementation (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix hashes on small files with AWS:KMS and SSE-C (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add MD5 metadata to objects uploaded with SSE-AWS/SSE-C (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Update docs with a Reducing Costs section (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Added error handling for error code 429 indicating too many requests (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)
    • Add requester pays option (kelv)
    • Fix copy multipart with v2 auth failing with 'SignatureDoesNotMatch' (Louis Koo)
    • Add --s3-no-head parameter to minimise transactions on upload (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • SFTP
    • Allow cert based auth via optional pubkey (Stephen Harris)
    • Allow user to optionally check server hosts key to add security (Stephen Harris)
    • Defer asking for user passwords until the SSH connection succeeds (Stephen Harris)
    • Remember entered password in AskPass mode (Stephen Harris)
    • Implement Shutdown method (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Implement keyboard interactive authentication (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Make --tpslimit apply (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Implement --sftp-use-fstat (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Sugarsync
    • Fix NewObject for files that differ in case (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix finding directories in a case insentive way (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Swift
    • Fix deletion of parts of Static Large Object (SLO) (Nguyễn Hữu Luân)
    • Ensure partially uploaded large files are uploaded unless --swift-leave-parts-on-error (Nguyễn Hữu Luân)
  • Tardigrade
    • Upgrade to uplink v1.4.1 (Caleb Case)
  • WebDAV
    • Updated docs to show streaming to nextcloud is working (Durval Menezes)
  • Yandex
    • Set Features.WriteMimeType=false as Yandex ignores mime types (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.53.4 - 2021-01-20

See commits

  • Bug Fixes
    • accounting: Fix data race in Transferred() (Maciej Zimnoch)
    • build
      • Stop tagged releases making a current beta (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Upgrade docker buildx action (Matteo Pietro Dazzi)
      • Add -buildmode to cross-compile.go (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix docker build by upgrading ilteoood/docker_buildx (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Revert GitHub actions brew fix since this is now fixed (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix brew install --cask syntax for macOS build (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Update nfpm syntax to fix build of .deb/.rpm packages (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix for Windows build errors (Ivan Andreev)
    • fs: Parseduration: fixed tests to use UTC time (Ankur Gupta)
    • fshttp: Prevent overlap of HTTP headers in logs (Nathan Collins)
    • rc
      • Fix core/command giving 500 internal error (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add Copy method to rc.Params (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix 500 error when marshalling errors from core/command (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • plugins: Create plugins files only if webui is enabled. (negative0)
    • serve http: Fix serving files of unknown length (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • serve sftp: Fix authentication on one connection blocking others (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Mount
    • Add optional brew tag to throw an error when using mount in the binaries installed via Homebrew (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)
    • Add "." and ".." to directories to match cmount and expectations (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • VFS
    • Make cache dir absolute before using it to fix path too long errors (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Chunker
    • Improve detection of incompatible metadata (Ivan Andreev)
  • Google Cloud Storage
    • Fix server side copy of large objects (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Jottacloud
    • Fix token renewer to fix long uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix token refresh failed: is not a regular file error (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Pcloud
    • Only use SHA1 hashes in EU region (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Sharefile
    • Undo Fix backend due to API swapping integers for strings (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • WebDAV
    • Fix Open Range requests to fix 4shared mount (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add "Depth: 0" to GET requests to fix bitrix (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.53.3 - 2020-11-19

See commits

  • Bug Fixes
    • random: Fix incorrect use of math/rand instead of crypto/rand CVE-2020-28924 (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Passwords you have generated with rclone config may be insecure
      • See issue #4783 for more details and a checking tool
    • random: Seed math/rand in one place with crypto strong seed (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • VFS
    • Fix vfs/refresh calls with fs= parameter (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Sharefile
    • Fix backend due to API swapping integers for strings (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.53.2 - 2020-10-26

See commits

  • Bug Fixes
    • acounting
      • Fix incorrect speed and transferTime in core/stats (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Stabilize display order of transfers on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • operations
      • Fix use of --suffix without --backup-dir (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix spurious "--checksum is in use but the source and destination have no hashes in common" (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • build
      • Work around GitHub actions brew problem (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Stop using set-env and set-path in the GitHub actions (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Mount
    • mount2: Fix the swapped UID / GID values (Russell Cattelan)
  • VFS
    • Detect and recover from a file being removed externally from the cache (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix a deadlock vulnerability in downloaders.Close (Leo Luan)
    • Fix a race condition in retryFailedResets (Leo Luan)
    • Fix missed concurrency control between some item operations and reset (Leo Luan)
    • Add exponential backoff during ENOSPC retries (Leo Luan)
    • Add a missed update of used cache space (Leo Luan)
    • Fix --no-modtime to not attempt to set modtimes (as documented) (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Local
    • Fix sizes and syncing with --links option on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Chunker
    • Disable ListR to fix missing files on GDrive (workaround) (Ivan Andreev)
    • Fix upload over crypt (Ivan Andreev)
  • Fichier
    • Increase maximum file size from 100GB to 300GB (gyutw)
  • Jottacloud
    • Remove clientSecret from config when upgrading to token based authentication (buengese)
    • Avoid double url escaping of device/mountpoint (albertony)
    • Remove DirMove workaround as it's not required anymore - also (buengese)
  • Mailru
    • Fix uploads after recent changes on server (Ivan Andreev)
    • Fix range requests after june changes on server (Ivan Andreev)
    • Fix invalid timestamp on corrupted files (fixes) (Ivan Andreev)
  • Onedrive
    • Fix disk usage for sharepoint (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • S3
    • Add missing regions for AWS (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)
  • Seafile
    • Fix accessing libraries > 2GB on 32 bit systems (Muffin King)
  • SFTP
    • Always convert the checksum to lower case (buengese)
  • Union
    • Create root directories if none exist (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.53.1 - 2020-09-13

See commits

  • Bug Fixes
    • accounting: Remove new line from end of --stats-one-line display (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • check
      • Add back missing --download flag (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix docs (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • docs
      • Note --log-file does append (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add full stops for consistency in rclone --help (edwardxml)
      • Add Tencent COS to s3 provider list (wjielai)
      • Updated mount command to reflect that it requires Go 1.13 or newer (Evan Harris)
      • jottacloud: Mention that uploads from local disk will not need to cache files to disk for md5 calculation (albertony)
      • Fix formatting of rc docs page (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • build
      • Include vendor tar ball in release and fix startdev (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix "Illegal instruction" error for ARMv6 builds (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix architecture name in ARMv7 build (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • VFS
    • Fix spurious error "vfs cache: failed to _ensure cache EOF" (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Log an ERROR if we fail to set the file to be sparse (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Local
    • Log an ERROR if we fail to set the file to be sparse (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Drive
    • Re-adds special oauth help text (Tim Gallant)
  • Opendrive
    • Do not retry 400 errors (Evan Harris)

v1.53.0 - 2020-09-02

See commits

  • New Features
    • The VFS layer was heavily reworked for this release - see below for more details
    • Interactive mode -i/--interactive for destructive operations (fishbullet)
    • Add --bwlimit-file flag to limit speeds of individual file transfers (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Transfers are sorted by start time in the stats and progress output (Max Sum)
    • Make sure backends expand ~ and environment vars in file names they use (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --refresh-times flag to set modtimes on hashless backends (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • build
      • Remove vendor directory in favour of Go modules (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Build with go1.15.x by default (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Drop macOS 386 build as it is no longer supported by go1.15 (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add ARMv7 to the supported builds (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Enable rclone cmount on macOS (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Make rclone build with gccgo (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Make rclone build with wasm (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Change beta numbering to be semver compatible (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add file properties and icon to Windows executable (albertony)
      • Add experimental interface for integrating rclone into browsers (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • lib: Add file name compression (Klaus Post)
    • rc
      • Allow installation and use of plugins and test plugins with rclone-webui (Chaitanya Bankanhal)
      • Add reverse proxy pluginsHandler for serving plugins (Chaitanya Bankanhal)
      • Add mount/listmounts option for listing current mounts (Chaitanya Bankanhal)
      • Add operations/uploadfile to upload a file through rc using encoding multipart/form-data (Chaitanya Bankanhal)
      • Add core/command to execute rclone terminal commands. (Chaitanya Bankanhal)
    • rclone check
      • Add reporting of filenames for same/missing/changed (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Make check command obey --dry-run/-i/--interactive (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Make check do --checkers files concurrently (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Retry downloads if they fail when using the --download flag (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Make it show stats by default (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rclone obscure: Allow obscure command to accept password on STDIN (David Ibarra)
    • rclone config
      • Set RCLONE_CONFIG_DIR for use in config files and subprocesses (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Reject remote names starting with a dash. (jtagcat)
    • rclone cryptcheck: Add reporting of filenames for same/missing/changed (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rclone dedupe: Make it obey the --size-only flag for duplicate detection (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rclone link: Add --expire and --unlink flags (Roman Kredentser)
    • rclone mkdir: Warn when using mkdir on remotes which can't have empty directories (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rclone rc: Allow JSON parameters to simplify command line usage (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rclone serve ftp
      • Don't compile on < go1.13 after dependency update (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add error message if auth proxy fails (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Use refactored goftp.io/server library for binary shrink (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rclone serve restic: Expose interfaces so that rclone can be used as a library from within restic (Jack)
    • rclone sync: Add --track-renames-strategy leaf (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rclone touch: Add ability to set nanosecond resolution times (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rclone tree: Remove -i shorthand for --noindent as it conflicts with -i/--interactive (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Bug Fixes
    • accounting
      • Fix documentation for speed/speedAvg (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix elapsed time not show actual time since beginning (Chaitanya Bankanhal)
      • Fix deadlock in stats printing (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • build
      • Fix file handle leak in GitHub release tool (Garrett Squire)
    • rclone check: Fix successful retries with --download counting errors (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rclone dedupe: Fix logging to be easier to understand (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Mount
    • Warn macOS users that mount implementation is changing (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • to test the new implementation use rclone cmount instead of rclone mount
      • this is because the library rclone uses has dropped macOS support
    • rc interface
      • Add call for unmount all (Chaitanya Bankanhal)
      • Make mount/mount remote control take vfsOpt option (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add mountOpt to mount/mount (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add VFS and Mount options to mount/listmounts (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Catch panics in cgofuse initialization and turn into error messages (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Always supply stat information in Readdir (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add support for reading unknown length files using direct IO (Windows) (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix On Windows don't add -o uid/gid=-1 if user supplies -o uid/gid. (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix macOS losing directory contents in cmount (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix volume name broken in recent refactor (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • VFS
    • Implement partial reads for --vfs-cache-mode full (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --vfs-writeback option to delay writes back to cloud storage (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --vfs-read-ahead parameter for use with --vfs-cache-mode full (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Restart pending uploads on restart of the cache (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Support synchronous cache space recovery upon ENOSPC (Leo Luan)
    • Allow ReadAt and WriteAt to run concurrently with themselves (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Change modtime of file before upload to current (Rob Calistri)
    • Recommend --vfs-cache-modes writes on backends which can't stream (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add an optional fs parameter to vfs rc methods (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix errors when using > 260 char files in the cache in Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix renaming of items while they are being uploaded (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix very high load caused by slow directory listings (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix renamed files not being uploaded with --vfs-cache-mode minimal (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix directory locking caused by slow directory listings (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix saving from chrome without --vfs-cache-mode writes (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Local
    • Add --local-no-updated to provide a consistent view of changing objects (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --local-no-set-modtime option to prevent modtime changes (tyhuber1)
    • Fix race conditions updating and reading Object metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Cache
    • Make any created backends be cached to fix rc problems (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix dedupe on caches wrapping drives (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Crypt
    • Add --crypt-server-side-across-configs flag (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Make any created backends be cached to fix rc problems (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Alias
    • Make any created backends be cached to fix rc problems (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Azure Blob
    • Don't compile on < go1.13 after dependency update (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • B2
    • Implement server-side copy for files > 5GB (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Cancel in progress multipart uploads and copies on rclone exit (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Note that b2's encoding now allows \ but rclone's hasn't changed (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix transfers when using download_url (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Box
    • Implement rclone cleanup (buengese)
    • Cancel in progress multipart uploads and copies on rclone exit (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Allow authentication with access token (David)
  • Chunker
    • Make any created backends be cached to fix rc problems (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Drive
    • Add rclone backend drives to list shared drives (teamdrives) (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Implement rclone backend untrash (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Work around drive bug which didn't set modtime of copied docs (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Added --drive-starred-only to only show starred files (Jay McEntire)
    • Deprecate --drive-alternate-export as it is no longer needed (themylogin)
    • Fix duplication of Google docs on server-side copy (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix "panic: send on closed channel" when recycling dir entries (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Dropbox
    • Add copyright detector info in limitations section in the docs (Alex Guerrero)
    • Fix rclone link by removing expires parameter (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Fichier
    • Detect Flood detected: IP Locked error and sleep for 30s (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • FTP
    • Add explicit TLS support (Heiko Bornholdt)
    • Add support for --dump bodies and --dump auth for debugging (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix interoperation with pure-ftpd (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Google Cloud Storage
    • Add support for anonymous access (Kai Lüke)
  • Jottacloud
    • Bring back legacy authentication for use with whitelabel versions (buengese)
    • Switch to new api root - also implement a very ugly workaround for the DirMove failures (buengese)
  • Onedrive
    • Rework cancel of multipart uploads on rclone exit (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Implement rclone cleanup (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --onedrive-no-versions flag to remove old versions (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Pcloud
    • Implement rclone link for public link creation (buengese)
  • Qingstor
    • Cancel in progress multipart uploads on rclone exit (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • S3
    • Preserve metadata when doing multipart copy (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Cancel in progress multipart uploads and copies on rclone exit (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add rclone link for public link sharing (Roman Kredentser)
    • Add rclone backend restore command to restore objects from GLACIER (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add rclone cleanup and rclone backend cleanup to clean unfinished multipart uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add rclone backend list-multipart-uploads to list unfinished multipart uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --s3-max-upload-parts support (Kamil Trzciński)
    • Add --s3-no-check-bucket for minimising rclone transactions and perms (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --s3-profile and --s3-shared-credentials-file options (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Use regional s3 us-east-1 endpoint (David)
    • Add Scaleway provider (Vincent Feltz)
    • Update IBM COS endpoints (Egor Margineanu)
    • Reduce the default --s3-copy-cutoff to < 5GB for Backblaze S3 compatibility (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix detection of bucket existing (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • SFTP
    • Use the absolute path instead of the relative path for listing for improved compatibility (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --sftp-subsystem and --sftp-server-command options (aus)
  • Swift
    • Fix dangling large objects breaking the listing (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix purge not deleting directory markers (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix update multipart object removing all of its own parts (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix missing hash from object returned from upload (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Tardigrade
    • Upgrade to uplink v1.2.0 (Kaloyan Raev)
  • Union
    • Fix writing with the all policy (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • WebDAV
    • Fix directory creation with 4shared (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.52.3 - 2020-08-07

See commits

  • Bug Fixes
    • docs
      • Disable smart typography (e.g. en-dash) in MANUAL.* and man page (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Update install.md to reflect minimum Go version (Evan Harris)
      • Update install from source instructions (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • make_manual: Support SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH (Morten Linderud)
    • log: Fix --use-json-log going to stderr not --log-file on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • serve dlna: Fix file list on Samsung Series 6+ TVs (Matteo Pietro Dazzi)
    • sync: Fix deadlock with --track-renames-strategy modtime (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Cache
    • Fix moveto/copyto remote:file remote:file2 (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Drive
    • Stop using root_folder_id as a cache (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Make dangling shortcuts appear in listings (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Drop "Disabling ListR" messages down to debug (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Workaround and policy for Google Drive API (Dmitry Ustalov)
  • FTP
    • Add note to docs about home vs root directory selection (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Onedrive
    • Fix reverting to Copy when Move would have worked (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Avoid comma rendered in URL in onedrive.md (Kevin)
  • Pcloud
    • Fix oauth on European region "eapi.pcloud.com" (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • S3
    • Fix bucket Region auto detection when Region unset in config (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.52.2 - 2020-06-24

See commits

  • Bug Fixes
    • build
      • Fix docker release build action (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix custom timezone in Docker image (NoLooseEnds)
    • check: Fix misleading message which printed errors instead of differences (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • errors: Add WSAECONNREFUSED and more to the list of retriable Windows errors (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rcd: Fix incorrect prometheus metrics (Gary Kim)
    • serve restic: Fix flags so they use environment variables (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • serve webdav: Fix flags so they use environment variables (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • sync: Fix --track-renames-strategy modtime (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Drive
    • Fix not being able to delete a directory with a trashed shortcut (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix creating a directory inside a shortcut (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix --drive-impersonate with cached root_folder_id (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • SFTP
    • Fix SSH key PEM loading (Zac Rubin)
  • Swift
    • Speed up deletes by not retrying segment container deletes (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Tardigrade
    • Upgrade to uplink v1.1.1 (Caleb Case)
  • WebDAV
    • Fix free/used display for rclone about/df for certain backends (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.52.1 - 2020-06-10

See commits

  • Bug Fixes
    • lib/file: Fix SetSparse on Windows 7 which fixes downloads of files > 250MB (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • build
      • Update go.mod to go1.14 to enable -mod=vendor build (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Remove quicktest from Dockerfile (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Build Docker images with GitHub actions (Matteo Pietro Dazzi)
      • Update Docker build workflows (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Set user_allow_other in /etc/fuse.conf in the Docker image (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix xgo build after go1.14 go.mod update (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • docs
      • Add link to source and modified time to footer of every page (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Remove manually set dates and use git dates instead (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Minor tense, punctuation, brevity and positivity changes for the home page (edwardxml)
      • Remove leading slash in page reference in footer when present (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Note commands which need obscured input in the docs (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • obscure: Write more help as we are referencing it elsewhere (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • VFS
    • Fix OS vs Unix path confusion - fixes ChangeNotify on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Drive
    • Fix missing items when listing using --fast-list / ListR (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Putio
    • Fix panic on Object.Open (Cenk Alti)
  • S3
    • Fix upload of single files into buckets without create permission (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix --header-upload (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Tardigrade
    • Fix listing bug by upgrading to v1.0.7
    • Set UserAgent to rclone (Caleb Case)

v1.52.0 - 2020-05-27

Special thanks to Martin Michlmayr for proof reading and correcting
all the docs and Edward Barker for helping re-write the front page.

See commits

  • New backends
    • Tardigrade backend for use with storj.io (Caleb Case)
    • Union re-write to have multiple writable remotes (Max Sum)
    • Seafile for Seafile server (Fred @creativeprojects)
  • New commands
    • backend: command for backend specific commands (see backends) (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • cachestats: Deprecate in favour of rclone backend stats cache: (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • dbhashsum: Deprecate in favour of rclone hashsum DropboxHash (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • New Features
    • Add --header-download and --header-upload flags for setting HTTP headers when uploading/downloading (Tim Gallant)
    • Add --header flag to add HTTP headers to every HTTP transaction (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --check-first to do all checking before starting transfers (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --track-renames-strategy for configurable matching criteria for --track-renames (Bernd Schoolmann)
    • Add --cutoff-mode hard,soft,cautious (Shing Kit Chan & Franklyn Tackitt)
    • Filter flags (e.g. --files-from -) can read from stdin (fishbullet)
    • Add --error-on-no-transfer option (Jon Fautley)
    • Implement --order-by xxx,mixed for copying some small and some big files (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Allow --max-backlog to be negative meaning as large as possible (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Added --no-unicode-normalization flag to allow Unicode filenames to remain unique (Ben Zenker)
    • Allow --min-age/--max-age to take a date as well as a duration (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add rename statistics for file and directory renames (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add statistics output to JSON log (reddi)
    • Make stats be printed on non-zero exit code (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • When running --password-command allow use of stdin (Sébastien Gross)
    • Stop empty strings being a valid remote path (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • accounting: support WriterTo for less memory copying (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • build
      • Update to use go1.14 for the build (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add -trimpath to release build for reproduceable builds (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Remove GOOS and GOARCH from Dockerfile (Brandon Philips)
    • config
      • Fsync the config file after writing to save more reliably (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add --obscure and --no-obscure flags to config create/update (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Make config show take remote: as well as remote (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • copyurl: Add --no-clobber flag (Denis)
    • delete: Added --rmdirs flag to delete directories as well (Kush)
    • filter: Added --files-from-raw flag (Ankur Gupta)
    • genautocomplete: Add support for fish shell (Matan Rosenberg)
    • log: Add support for syslog LOCAL facilities (Patryk Jakuszew)
    • lsjson: Add --hash-type parameter and use it in lsf to speed up hashing (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rc
      • Add -o/--opt and -a/--arg for more structured input (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Implement backend/command for running backend specific commands remotely (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add mount/mount command for starting rclone mount via the API (Chaitanya)
    • rcd: Add Prometheus metrics support (Gary Kim)
    • serve http
      • Added a --template flag for user defined markup (calistri)
      • Add Last-Modified headers to files and directories (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • serve sftp: Add support for multiple host keys by repeating --key flag (Maxime Suret)
    • touch: Add --localtime flag to make --timestamp localtime not UTC (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Bug Fixes
    • accounting
      • Restore "Max number of stats groups reached" log line (Michał Matczuk)
      • Correct exitcode on Transfer Limit Exceeded flag. (Anuar Serdaliyev)
      • Reset bytes read during copy retry (Ankur Gupta)
      • Fix race clearing stats (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • copy: Only create empty directories when they don't exist on the remote (Ishuah Kariuki)
    • dedupe: Stop dedupe deleting files with identical IDs (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • oauth
      • Use custom http client so that --no-check-certificate is honored by oauth token fetch (Mark Spieth)
      • Replace deprecated oauth2.NoContext (Lars Lehtonen)
    • operations
      • Fix setting the timestamp on Windows for multithread copy (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Make rcat obey --ignore-checksum (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Make --max-transfer more accurate (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rc
      • Fix dropped error (Lars Lehtonen)
      • Fix misplaced http server config (Xiaoxing Ye)
      • Disable duplicate log (ElonH)
    • serve dlna
      • Cds: don't specify childCount at all when unknown (Dan Walters)
      • Cds: use modification time as date in dlna metadata (Dan Walters)
    • serve restic: Fix tests after restic project removed vendoring (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • sync
      • Fix incorrect "nothing to transfer" message using --delete-before (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Only create empty directories when they don't exist on the remote (Ishuah Kariuki)
  • Mount
    • Add --async-read flag to disable asynchronous reads (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Ignore --allow-root flag with a warning as it has been removed upstream (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Warn if --allow-non-empty used on Windows and clarify docs (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Constrain to go1.13 or above otherwise bazil.org/fuse fails to compile (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix fail because of too long volume name (evileye)
    • Report 1PB free for unknown disk sizes (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Map more rclone errors into file systems errors (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix disappearing cwd problem (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Use ReaddirPlus on Windows to improve directory listing performance (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Send a hint as to whether the filesystem is case insensitive or not (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add rc command mount/types (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Change maximum leaf name length to 1024 bytes (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • VFS
    • Add --vfs-read-wait and --vfs-write-wait flags to control time waiting for a sequential read/write (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Change default --vfs-read-wait to 20ms (it was 5ms and not configurable) (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Make df output more consistent on a rclone mount. (Yves G)
    • Report 1PB free for unknown disk sizes (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix race condition caused by unlocked reading of Dir.path (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Make File lock and Dir lock not overlap to avoid deadlock (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Implement lock ordering between File and Dir to eliminate deadlocks (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Factor the vfs cache into its own package (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Pin the Fs in use in the Fs cache (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add SetSys() methods to Node to allow caching stuff on a node (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Ignore file not found errors from Hash in Read.Release (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix hang in read wait code (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Local
    • Speed up multi thread downloads by using sparse files on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Implement --local-no-sparse flag for disabling sparse files (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Implement rclone backend noop for testing purposes (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix "file not found" errors on post transfer Hash calculation (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Cache
    • Implement rclone backend stats command (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix Server Side Copy with Temp Upload (Brandon McNama)
    • Remove Unused Functions (Lars Lehtonen)
    • Disable race tests until bbolt is fixed (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Move methods used for testing into test file (greatroar)
    • Add Pin and Unpin and canonicalised lookup (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Use proper import path go.etcd.io/bbolt (Robert-André Mauchin)
  • Crypt
    • Calculate hashes for uploads from local disk (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • This allows crypted Jottacloud uploads without using local disk
      • This means crypted s3/b2 uploads will now have hashes
    • Added rclone backend decode/encode commands to replicate functionality of cryptdecode (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)
    • Get rid of the unused Cipher interface as it obfuscated the code (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Azure Blob
    • Implement streaming of unknown sized files so rcat is now supported (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Implement memory pooling to control memory use (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --azureblob-disable-checksum flag (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Retry InvalidBlobOrBlock error as it may indicate block concurrency problems (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Remove unused Object.parseTimeString() (Lars Lehtonen)
    • Fix permission error on SAS URL limited to container (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • B2
    • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)
    • Ignore directory markers at the root also (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Force the case of the SHA1 to lowercase (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Remove unused largeUpload.clearUploadURL() (Lars Lehtonen)
  • Box
    • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)
    • Implement About to read size used (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add token renew function for jwt auth (David Bramwell)
    • Added support for interchangeable root folder for Box backend (Sunil Patra)
    • Remove unnecessary iat from jws claims (David)
  • Drive
    • Follow shortcuts by default, skip with --drive-skip-shortcuts (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Implement rclone backend shortcut command for creating shortcuts (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Added rclone backend command to change service_account_file and chunk_size (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)
    • Fix missing files when using --fast-list and --drive-shared-with-me (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix duplicate items when using --drive-shared-with-me (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Extend --drive-stop-on-upload-limit to respond to teamDriveFileLimitExceeded. (harry)
    • Don't delete files with multiple parents to avoid data loss (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Server side copy docs use default description if empty (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Dropbox
    • Make error insufficient space to be fatal (harry)
    • Add info about required redirect url (Elan Ruusamäe)
  • Fichier
    • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)
    • Implement custom pacer to deal with the new rate limiting (buengese)
  • FTP
    • Fix lockup when using concurrency limit on failed connections (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix lockup on failed upload when using concurrency limit (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix lockup on Close failures when using concurrency limit (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Work around pureftp sending spurious 150 messages (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Google Cloud Storage
    • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add ARCHIVE storage class to help (Adam Stroud)
    • Ignore directory markers at the root (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Googlephotos
    • Make the start year configurable (Daven)
    • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)
    • Create feature/favorites directory (Brandon Philips)
    • Fix "concurrent map write" error (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Don't put an image in error message (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • HTTP
    • Improved directory listing with new template from Caddy project (calisro)
  • Jottacloud
    • Implement --jottacloud-trashed-only (buengese)
    • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)
    • Use RawURLEncoding when decoding base64 encoded login token (buengese)
    • Implement cleanup (buengese)
    • Update docs regarding cleanup, removed remains from old auth, and added warning about special mountpoints. (albertony)
  • Mailru
    • Describe 2FA requirements (valery1707)
  • Onedrive
    • Implement --onedrive-server-side-across-configs (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)
    • Fix occasional 416 errors on multipart uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Added maximum chunk size limit warning in the docs (Harry)
    • Fix missing drive on config (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Make error quotaLimitReached to be fatal (harry)
  • Opendrive
    • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)
  • Pcloud
    • Added support for interchangeable root folder for pCloud backend (Sunil Patra)
    • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)
    • Fix initial config "Auth state doesn't match" message (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Premiumizeme
    • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)
    • Prune unused functions (Lars Lehtonen)
  • Putio
    • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Make downloading files use the rclone http Client (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix parsing of remotes with leading and trailing / (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Qingstor
    • Make rclone cleanup remove pending multipart uploads older than 24h (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Try harder to cancel failed multipart uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Prune multiUploader.list() (Lars Lehtonen)
    • Lint fix (Lars Lehtonen)
  • S3
    • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)
    • Use memory pool for buffer allocations (Maciej Zimnoch)
    • Add SSE-C support for AWS, Ceph, and MinIO (Jack Anderson)
    • Fail fast multipart upload (Michał Matczuk)
    • Report errors on bucket creation (mkdir) correctly (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Specify that Minio supports URL encoding in listings (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Added 500 as retryErrorCode (Michał Matczuk)
    • Use --low-level-retries as the number of SDK retries (Aleksandar Janković)
    • Fix multipart abort context (Aleksandar Jankovic)
    • Replace deprecated session.New() with session.NewSession() (Lars Lehtonen)
    • Use the provided size parameter when allocating a new memory pool (Joachim Brandon LeBlanc)
    • Use rclone's low level retries instead of AWS SDK to fix listing retries (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Ignore directory markers at the root also (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Use single memory pool (Michał Matczuk)
    • Do not resize buf on put to memBuf (Michał Matczuk)
    • Improve docs for --s3-disable-checksum (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Don't leak memory or tokens in edge cases for multipart upload (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Seafile
    • Implement 2FA (Fred)
  • SFTP
    • Added --sftp-pem-key to support inline key files (calisro)
    • Fix post transfer copies failing with 0 size when using set_modtime=false (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Sharefile
    • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)
  • Sugarsync
    • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)
  • Swift
    • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix cosmetic issue in error message (Martin Michlmayr)
  • Union
    • Implement multiple writable remotes (Max Sum)
    • Fix server-side copy (Max Sum)
    • Implement ListR (Max Sum)
    • Enable ListR when upstreams contain local (Max Sum)
  • WebDAV
    • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)
    • Fix X-OC-Mtime header for Transip compatibility (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Report full and consistent usage with about (Yves G)
  • Yandex
    • Add support for --header-upload and --header-download (Tim Gallant)

v1.51.0 - 2020-02-01

  • New backends
  • New Features
    • Adjust all backends to have --backend-encoding parameter (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • this enables the encoding for special characters to be adjusted or disabled
    • Add --max-duration flag to control the maximum duration of a transfer session (boosh)
    • Add --expect-continue-timeout flag, default 1s (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --no-check-dest flag for copying without testing the destination (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Implement --order-by flag to order transfers (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • accounting
      • Don't show entries in both transferring and checking (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add option to delete stats (Aleksandar Jankovic)
    • build
      • Compress the test builds with gzip (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Implement a framework for starting test servers during tests (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • cmd: Always print elapsed time to tenth place seconds in progress (Gary Kim)
    • config
      • Add --password-command to allow dynamic config password (Damon Permezel)
      • Give config questions default values (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Check a remote exists when creating a new one (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • copyurl: Add --stdout flag to write to stdout (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • dedupe: Implement keep smallest too (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • hashsum: Add flag --base64 flag (landall)
    • lsf: Speed up on s3/swift/etc by not reading mimetype by default (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • lsjson: Add --no-mimetype flag (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rc: Add methods to turn on blocking and mutex profiling (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rcd
      • Adding group parameter to stats (Chaitanya)
      • Move webgui apart; option to disable browser (Xiaoxing Ye)
    • serve sftp: Add support for public key with auth proxy (Paul Tinsley)
    • stats: Show deletes in stats and hide zero stats (anuar45)
  • Bug Fixes
    • accounting
      • Fix error counter counting multiple times (Ankur Gupta)
      • Fix error count shown as checks (Cnly)
      • Clear finished transfer in stats-reset (Maciej Zimnoch)
      • Added StatsInfo locking in statsGroups sum function (Michał Matczuk)
    • asyncreader: Fix EOF error (buengese)
    • check: Fix --one-way recursing more directories than it needs to (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • chunkedreader: Disable hash calculation for first segment (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • config
      • Do not open browser on headless on drive/gcs/google photos (Xiaoxing Ye)
      • SetValueAndSave ignore error if config section does not exist yet (buengese)
    • cmd: Fix completion with an encrypted config (Danil Semelenov)
    • dbhashsum: Stop it returning UNSUPPORTED on dropbox (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • dedupe: Add missing modes to help string (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • operations
      • Fix dedupe continuing on errors like insufficientFilePersimmon (SezalAgrawal)
      • Clear accounting before low level retry (Maciej Zimnoch)
      • Write debug message when hashes could not be checked (Ole Schütt)
      • Move interface assertion to tests to remove pflag dependency (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Make NewOverrideObjectInfo public and factor uses (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • proxy: Replace use of bcrypt with sha256 (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • vendor
      • Update bazil.org/fuse to fix FreeBSD 12.1 (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Update github.com/t3rm1n4l/go-mega to fix mega "illegal base64 data at input byte 22" (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Update termbox-go to fix ncdu command on FreeBSD (Kuang-che Wu)
      • Update t3rm1n4l/go-mega - fixes mega: couldn't login: crypto/aes: invalid key size 0 (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Mount
    • Enable async reads for a 20% speedup (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Replace use of WriteAt with Write for cache mode >= writes and O_APPEND (Brett Dutro)
    • Make sure we call unmount when exiting (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Don't build on go1.10 as bazil/fuse no longer supports it (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • When setting dates discard out of range dates (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • VFS
    • Add a newly created file straight into the directory (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Only calculate one hash for reads for a speedup (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Make ReadAt for non cached files work better with non-sequential reads (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix edge cases when reading ModTime from file (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Make sure existing files opened for write show correct size (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Don't cache the path in RW file objects to fix renaming (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix rename of open files when using the VFS cache (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • When renaming files in the cache, rename the cache item in memory too (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix open file renaming on drive when using --vfs-cache-mode writes (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix incorrect modtime for mv into mount with --vfs-cache-modes writes (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • On rename, rename in cache too if the file exists (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)
  • Local
    • Make source file being updated errors be NoLowLevelRetry errors (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix update of hidden files on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Cache
    • Follow move of upstream library github.com/coreos/bbolt github.com/etcd-io/bbolt (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix fatal error: concurrent map writes (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Crypt
    • Reorder the filename encryption options (Thomas Eales)
    • Correctly handle trailing dot (buengese)
  • Chunker
    • Reduce length of temporary suffix (Ivan Andreev)
  • Drive
    • Add --drive-stop-on-upload-limit flag to stop syncs when upload limit reached (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --drive-use-shared-date to use date file was shared instead of modified date (Garry McNulty)
    • Make sure invalid auth for teamdrives always reports an error (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix --fast-list when using appDataFolder (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Use multipart resumable uploads for streaming and uploads in mount (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Log an ERROR if an incomplete search is returned (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Hide dangerous config from the configurator (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Dropbox
    • Treat insufficient_space errors as non retriable errors (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Jottacloud
    • Use new auth method used by official client (buengese)
    • Add URL to generate Login Token to config wizard (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add support whitelabel versions (buengese)
  • Koofr
    • Use rclone HTTP client. (jaKa)
  • Onedrive
    • Add Sites.Read.All permission (Benjamin Richter)
    • Add support "Retry-After" header (Motonori IWAMURO)
  • Opendrive
    • Implement --opendrive-chunk-size (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • S3
    • Re-implement multipart upload to fix memory issues (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --s3-copy-cutoff for size to switch to multipart copy (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add new region Asia Pacific (Hong Kong) (Outvi V)
    • Reduce memory usage streaming files by reducing max stream upload size (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --s3-list-chunk option for bucket listing (Thomas Kriechbaumer)
    • Force path style bucket access to off for AWS deprecation (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Use AWS web identity role provider if available (Tennix)
    • Add StackPath Object Storage Support (Dave Koston)
    • Fix ExpiryWindow value (Aleksandar Jankovic)
    • Fix DisableChecksum condition (Aleksandar Janković)
    • Fix URL decoding of NextMarker (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • SFTP
    • Add --sftp-skip-links to skip symlinks and non regular files (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Retry Creation of Connection (Sebastian Brandt)
    • Fix "failed to parse private key file: ssh: not an encrypted key" error (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Open files for update write only to fix AWS SFTP interop (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Swift
    • Reserve segments of dynamic large object when delete objects in container what was enabled versioning. (Nguyễn Hữu Luân)
    • Fix parsing of X-Object-Manifest (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Update OVH API endpoint (unbelauscht)
  • WebDAV
    • Make nextcloud only upload SHA1 checksums (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix case of "Bearer" in Authorization: header to agree with RFC (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add Referer header to fix problems with WAFs (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.50.2 - 2019-11-19

  • Bug Fixes
    • accounting: Fix memory leak on retries operations (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Drive
    • Fix listing of the root directory with drive.files scope (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix --drive-root-folder-id with team/shared drives (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.50.1 - 2019-11-02

  • Bug Fixes
    • hash: Fix accidentally changed hash names for DropboxHash and CRC-32 (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • fshttp: Fix error reporting on tpslimit token bucket errors (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • fshttp: Don't print token bucket errors on context cancelled (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Local
    • Fix listings of . on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Onedrive
    • Fix DirMove/Move after Onedrive change (Xiaoxing Ye)

v1.50.0 - 2019-10-26

  • New backends
  • New Features
    • encodings (Fabian Möller & Nick Craig-Wood)
    • build
      • Update to use go1.13 for the build (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Drop support for go1.9 (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Build rclone with GitHub actions (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Convert python scripts to python3 (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Swap Azure/go-ansiterm for mattn/go-colorable (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Dockerfile fixes (Matei David)
      • Add plugin support for backends and commands (Richard Patel)
    • config
      • Use alternating Red/Green in config to make more obvious (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • contrib
      • Add sample DLNA server Docker Compose manifest. (pataquets)
      • Add sample WebDAV server Docker Compose manifest. (pataquets)
    • copyurl
      • Add --auto-filename flag for using file name from URL in destination path (Denis)
    • serve dlna:
      • Many compatibility improvements (Dan Walters)
      • Support for external srt subtitles (Dan Walters)
    • rc
      • Added command core/quit (Saksham Khanna)
  • Bug Fixes
    • sync
      • Make --update/-u not transfer files that haven't changed (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Free objects after they come out of the transfer pipe to save memory (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix --files-from without --no-traverse doing a recursive scan (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • operations
      • Fix accounting for server-side copies (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Display 'All duplicates removed' only if dedupe successful (Sezal Agrawal)
      • Display 'Deleted X extra copies' only if dedupe successful (Sezal Agrawal)
    • accounting
      • Only allow up to 100 completed transfers in the accounting list to save memory (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Cull the old time ranges when possible to save memory (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix panic due to server-side copy fallback (Ivan Andreev)
      • Fix memory leak noticeable for transfers of large numbers of objects (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix total duration calculation (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • cmd
      • Fix environment variables not setting command line flags (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Make autocomplete compatible with bash's posix mode for macOS (Danil Semelenov)
      • Make --progress work in git bash on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix 'compopt: command not found' on autocomplete on macOS (Danil Semelenov)
    • config
      • Fix setting of non top level flags from environment variables (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Check config names more carefully and report errors (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Remove error: can't use --size-only and --ignore-size together. (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • filter: Prevent mixing options when --files-from is in use (Michele Caci)
    • serve sftp: Fix crash on unsupported operations (e.g. Readlink) (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Mount
    • Allow files of unknown size to be read properly (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Skip tests on <= 2 CPUs to avoid lockup (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix panic on File.Open (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix "mount_fusefs: -o timeout=: option not supported" on FreeBSD (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Don't pass huge filenames (>4k) to FUSE as it can't cope (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • VFS
    • Add flag --vfs-case-insensitive for windows/macOS mounts (Ivan Andreev)
    • Make objects of unknown size readable through the VFS (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Move writeback of dirty data out of close() method into its own method (FlushWrites) and remove close() call from Flush() (Brett Dutro)
    • Stop empty dirs disappearing when renamed on bucket based remotes (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Stop change notify polling clearing so much of the directory cache (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Azure Blob
    • Disable logging to the Windows event log (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • B2
    • Remove unverified: prefix on sha1 to improve interop (e.g. with CyberDuck) (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Box
    • Add options to get access token via JWT auth (David)
  • Drive
    • Disable HTTP/2 by default to work around INTERNAL_ERROR problems (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Make sure that drive root ID is always canonical (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix --drive-shared-with-me from the root with lsand --fast-list (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix ChangeNotify polling for shared drives (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix change notify polling when using appDataFolder (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Dropbox
    • Make disallowed filenames errors not retry (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix nil pointer exception on restricted files (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Fichier
    • Fix accessing files > 2GB on 32 bit systems (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • FTP
    • Allow disabling EPSV mode (Jon Fautley)
  • HTTP
    • HEAD directory entries in parallel to speedup (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --http-no-head to stop rclone doing HEAD in listings (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Putio
    • Add ability to resume uploads (Cenk Alti)
  • S3
    • Fix signature v2_auth headers (Anthony Rusdi)
    • Fix encoding for control characters (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Only ask for URL encoded directory listings if we need them on Ceph (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add option for multipart failure behaviour (Aleksandar Jankovic)
    • Support for multipart copy (庄天翼)
    • Fix nil pointer reference if no metadata returned for object (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • SFTP
    • Fix --sftp-ask-password trying to contact the ssh agent (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix hashes of files with backslashes (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Include more ciphers with --sftp-use-insecure-cipher (Carlos Ferreyra)
  • WebDAV
    • Parse and return Sharepoint error response (Henning Surmeier)

v1.49.5 - 2019-10-05

  • Bug Fixes
    • Revert back to go1.12.x for the v1.49.x builds as go1.13.x was causing issues (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix rpm packages by using master builds of nfpm (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix macOS build after brew changes (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.49.4 - 2019-09-29

  • Bug Fixes
    • cmd/rcd: Address ZipSlip vulnerability (Richard Patel)
    • accounting: Fix file handle leak on errors (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • oauthutil: Fix security problem when running with two users on the same machine (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • FTP
    • Fix listing of an empty root returning: error dir not found (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • S3
    • Fix SetModTime on GLACIER/ARCHIVE objects and implement set/get tier (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.49.3 - 2019-09-15

  • Bug Fixes
    • accounting
      • Fix total duration calculation (Aleksandar Jankovic)
      • Fix "file already closed" on transfer retries (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.49.2 - 2019-09-08

  • New Features
    • build: Add Docker workflow support (Alfonso Montero)
  • Bug Fixes
    • accounting: Fix locking in Transfer to avoid deadlock with --progress (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • docs: Fix template argument for mktemp in install.sh (Cnly)
    • operations: Fix -u/--update with google photos / files of unknown size (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rc: Fix docs for config/create /update /password (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Google Cloud Storage
    • Fix need for elevated permissions on SetModTime (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.49.1 - 2019-08-28

  • Bug Fixes
    • config: Fix generated passwords being stored as empty password (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rcd: Added missing parameter for web-gui info logs. (Chaitanya)
  • Googlephotos
    • Fix crash on error response (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Onedrive
    • Fix crash on error response (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.49.0 - 2019-08-26

  • New backends
  • New Features
    • Experimental web GUI (Chaitanya Bankanhal)
    • Implement --compare-dest & --copy-dest (yparitcher)
    • Implement --suffix without --backup-dir for backup to current dir (yparitcher)
    • config reconnect to re-login (re-run the oauth login) for the backend. (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • config userinfo to discover which user you are logged in as. (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • config disconnect to disconnect you (log out) from the backend. (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --use-json-log for JSON logging (justinalin)
    • Add context propagation to rclone (Aleksandar Jankovic)
    • Reworking internal statistics interfaces so they work with rc jobs (Aleksandar Jankovic)
    • Add Higher units for ETA (AbelThar)
    • Update rclone logos to new design (Andreas Chlupka)
    • hash: Add CRC-32 support (Cenk Alti)
    • help showbackend: Fixed advanced option category when there are no standard options (buengese)
    • ncdu: Display/Copy to Clipboard Current Path (Gary Kim)
    • operations:
      • Run hashing operations in parallel (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Don't calculate checksums when using --ignore-checksum (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Check transfer hashes when using --size-only mode (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Disable multi thread copy for local to local copies (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Debug successful hashes as well as failures (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rc
      • Add ability to stop async jobs (Aleksandar Jankovic)
      • Return current settings if core/bwlimit called without parameters (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Rclone-WebUI integration with rclone (Chaitanya Bankanhal)
      • Added command line parameter to control the cross origin resource sharing (CORS) in the rcd. (Security Improvement) (Chaitanya Bankanhal)
      • Add anchor tags to the docs so links are consistent (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Remove _async key from input parameters after parsing so later operations won't get confused (buengese)
      • Add call to clear stats (Aleksandar Jankovic)
    • rcd
      • Auto-login for web-gui (Chaitanya Bankanhal)
      • Implement --baseurl for rcd and web-gui (Chaitanya Bankanhal)
    • serve dlna
      • Only select interfaces which can multicast for SSDP (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add more builtin mime types to cover standard audio/video (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix missing mime types on Android causing missing videos (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • serve ftp
      • Refactor to bring into line with other serve commands (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Implement --auth-proxy (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • serve http: Implement --baseurl (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • serve restic: Implement --baseurl (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • serve sftp
      • Implement auth proxy (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix detection of whether server is authorized (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • serve webdav
      • Implement --baseurl (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Support --auth-proxy (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Bug Fixes
    • Make "bad record MAC" a retriable error (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • copyurl: Fix copying files that return HTTP errors (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • march: Fix checking sub-directories when using --no-traverse (buengese)
    • rc
      • Fix unmarshalable http.AuthFn in options and put in test for marshalability (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Move job expire flags to rc to fix initialization problem (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix --loopback with rc/list and others (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rcat: Fix slowdown on systems with multiple hashes (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rcd: Fix permissions problems on cache directory with web gui download (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Mount
    • Default --daemon-timout to 15 minutes on macOS and FreeBSD (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Update docs to show mounting from root OK for bucket based (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Remove nonseekable flag from write files (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • VFS
    • Make write without cache more efficient (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix --vfs-cache-mode minimal and writes ignoring cached files (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Local
    • Add --local-case-sensitive and --local-case-insensitive (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Avoid polluting page cache when uploading local files to remote backends (Michał Matczuk)
    • Don't calculate any hashes by default (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fadvise run syscall on a dedicated go routine (Michał Matczuk)
  • Azure Blob
    • Azure Storage Emulator support (Sandeep)
    • Updated config help details to remove connection string references (Sandeep)
    • Make all operations work from the root (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • B2
    • Implement link sharing (yparitcher)
    • Enable server-side copy to copy between buckets (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Make all operations work from the root (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Drive
    • Fix server-side copy of big files (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Update API for teamdrive use (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add error for purge with --drive-trashed-only (ginvine)
  • Fichier
    • Make FolderID int and adjust related code (buengese)
  • Google Cloud Storage
    • Reduce oauth scope requested as suggested by Google (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Make all operations work from the root (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • HTTP
    • Add --http-headers flag for setting arbitrary headers (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Jottacloud
    • Use new api for retrieving internal username (buengese)
    • Refactor configuration and minor cleanup (buengese)
  • Koofr
    • Support setting modification times on Koofr backend. (jaKa)
  • Opendrive
    • Refactor to use existing lib/rest facilities for uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Qingstor
    • Upgrade to v3 SDK and fix listing loop (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Make all operations work from the root (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • S3
    • Add INTELLIGENT_TIERING storage class (Matti Niemenmaa)
    • Make all operations work from the root (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • SFTP
    • Add missing interface check and fix About (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Completely ignore all modtime checks if SetModTime=false (Jon Fautley)
    • Support md5/sha1 with rsync.net (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Save the md5/sha1 command in use to the config file for efficiency (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Opt-in support for diffie-hellman-group-exchange-sha256 diffie-hellman-group-exchange-sha1 (Yi FU)
  • Swift
    • Use FixRangeOption to fix 0 length files via the VFS (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix upload when using no_chunk to return the correct size (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Make all operations work from the root (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix segments leak during failed large file uploads. (nguyenhuuluan434)
  • WebDAV
    • Add --webdav-bearer-token-command (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Refresh token when it expires with --webdav-bearer-token-command (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add docs for using bearer_token_command with oidc-agent (Paul Millar)

v1.48.0 - 2019-06-15

  • New commands
    • serve sftp: Serve an rclone remote over SFTP (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • New Features
    • Multi threaded downloads to local storage (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • controlled with --multi-thread-cutoff and --multi-thread-streams
    • Use rclone.conf from rclone executable directory to enable portable use (albertony)
    • Allow sync of a file and a directory with the same name (forgems)
      • this is common on bucket based remotes, e.g. s3, gcs
    • Add --ignore-case-sync for forced case insensitivity (garry415)
    • Implement --stats-one-line-date and --stats-one-line-date-format (Peter Berbec)
    • Log an ERROR for all commands which exit with non-zero status (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Use go-homedir to read the home directory more reliably (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Enable creating encrypted config through external script invocation (Wojciech Smigielski)
    • build: Drop support for go1.8 (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • config: Make config create/update encrypt passwords where necessary (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • copyurl: Honor --no-check-certificate (Stefan Breunig)
    • install: Linux skip man pages if no mandb (didil)
    • lsf: Support showing the Tier of the object (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • lsjson
      • Added EncryptedPath to output (calisro)
      • Support showing the Tier of the object (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add IsBucket field for bucket based remote listing of the root (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rc
      • Add --loopback flag to run commands directly without a server (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add operations/fsinfo: Return information about the remote (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Skip auth for OPTIONS request (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • cmd/providers: Add DefaultStr, ValueStr and Type fields (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • jobs: Make job expiry timeouts configurable (Aleksandar Jankovic)
    • serve dlna reworked and improved (Dan Walters)
    • serve ftp: add --ftp-public-ip flag to specify public IP (calistri)
    • serve restic: Add support for --private-repos in serve restic (Florian Apolloner)
    • serve webdav: Combine serve webdav and serve http (Gary Kim)
    • size: Ignore negative sizes when calculating total (Garry McNulty)
  • Bug Fixes
    • Make move and copy individual files obey --backup-dir (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • If --ignore-checksum is in effect, don't calculate checksum (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • moveto: Fix case-insensitive same remote move (Gary Kim)
    • rc: Fix serving bucket based objects with --rc-serve (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • serve webdav: Fix serveDir not being updated with changes from webdav (Gary Kim)
  • Mount
    • Fix poll interval documentation (Animosity022)
  • VFS
    • Make WriteAt for non cached files work with non-sequential writes (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Local
    • Only calculate the required hashes for big speedup (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Log errors when listing instead of returning an error (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix preallocate warning on Linux with ZFS (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Crypt
    • Make rclone dedupe work through crypt (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix wrapping of ChangeNotify to decrypt directories properly (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Support PublicLink (rclone link) of underlying backend (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Implement Optional methods SetTier, GetTier (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • B2
    • Implement server-side copy (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Implement SetModTime (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Drive
    • Fix move and copy from TeamDrive to GDrive (Fionera)
    • Add notes that cleanup works in the background on drive (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --drive-server-side-across-configs to default back to old server-side copy semantics by default (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --drive-size-as-quota to show storage quota usage for file size (Garry McNulty)
  • FTP
    • Add FTP List timeout (Jeff Quinn)
    • Add FTP over TLS support (Gary Kim)
    • Add --ftp-no-check-certificate option for FTPS (Gary Kim)
  • Google Cloud Storage
    • Fix upload errors when uploading pre 1970 files (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Jottacloud
    • Add support for selecting device and mountpoint. (buengese)
  • Mega
    • Add cleanup support (Gary Kim)
  • Onedrive
    • More accurately check if root is found (Cnly)
  • S3
    • Support S3 Accelerated endpoints with --s3-use-accelerate-endpoint (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add config info for Wasabi's EU Central endpoint (Robert Marko)
    • Make SetModTime work for GLACIER while syncing (Philip Harvey)
  • SFTP
    • Add About support (Gary Kim)
    • Fix about parsing of df results so it can cope with -ve results (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Send custom client version and debug server version (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • WebDAV
    • Retry on 423 Locked errors (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.47.0 - 2019-04-13

  • New backends
    • Backend for Koofr cloud storage service. (jaKa)
  • New Features
    • Resume downloads if the reader fails in copy (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • this means rclone will restart transfers if the source has an error
      • this is most useful for downloads or cloud to cloud copies
    • Use --fast-list for listing operations where it won't use more memory (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • this should speed up the following operations on remotes which support ListR
      • dedupe, serve restic lsf, ls, lsl, lsjson, lsd, md5sum, sha1sum, hashsum, size, delete, cat, settier
      • use --disable ListR to get old behaviour if required
    • Make --files-from traverse the destination unless --no-traverse is set (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • this fixes --files-from with Google drive and excessive API use in general.
    • Make server-side copy account bytes and obey --max-transfer (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --create-empty-src-dirs flag and default to not creating empty dirs (ishuah)
    • Add client side TLS/SSL flags --ca-cert/--client-cert/--client-key (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Implement --suffix-keep-extension for use with --suffix (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • build:
      • Switch to semver compliant version tags to be go modules compliant (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Update to use go1.12.x for the build (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • serve dlna: Add connection manager service description to improve compatibility (Dan Walters)
    • lsf: Add 'e' format to show encrypted names and 'o' for original IDs (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • lsjson: Added --files-only and --dirs-only flags (calistri)
    • rc: Implement operations/publiclink the equivalent of rclone link (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Bug Fixes
    • accounting: Fix total ETA when --stats-unit bits is in effect (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Bash TAB completion
      • Use private custom func to fix clash between rclone and kubectl (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix for remotes with underscores in their names (Six)
      • Fix completion of remotes (Florian Gamböck)
      • Fix autocompletion of remote paths with spaces (Danil Semelenov)
    • serve dlna: Fix root XML service descriptor (Dan Walters)
    • ncdu: Fix display corruption with Chinese characters (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add SIGTERM to signals which run the exit handlers on unix (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rc: Reload filter when the options are set via the rc (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • VFS / Mount
    • Fix FreeBSD: Ignore Truncate if called with no readers and already the correct size (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Read directory and check for a file before mkdir (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Shorten the locking window for vfs/refresh (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Azure Blob
    • Enable MD5 checksums when uploading files bigger than the "Cutoff" (Dr.Rx)
    • Fix SAS URL support (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • B2
    • Allow manual configuration of backblaze downloadUrl (Vince)
    • Ignore already_hidden error on remove (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Ignore malformed src_last_modified_millis (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Drive
    • Add --skip-checksum-gphotos to ignore incorrect checksums on Google Photos (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Allow server-side move/copy between different remotes. (Fionera)
    • Add docs on team drives and --fast-list eventual consistency (Nestar47)
    • Fix imports of text files (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix range requests on 0 length files (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix creation of duplicates with server-side copy (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Dropbox
    • Retry blank errors to fix long listings (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • FTP
    • Add --ftp-concurrency to limit maximum number of connections (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Google Cloud Storage
    • Fall back to default application credentials (marcintustin)
    • Allow bucket policy only buckets (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • HTTP
    • Add --http-no-slash for websites with directories with no slashes (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Remove duplicates from listings (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix socket leak on 404 errors (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Jottacloud
    • Fix token refresh (Sebastian Bünger)
    • Add device registration (Oliver Heyme)
  • Onedrive
    • Implement graceful cancel of multipart uploads if rclone is interrupted (Cnly)
    • Always add trailing colon to path when addressing items, (Cnly)
    • Return errors instead of panic for invalid uploads (Fabian Möller)
  • S3
    • Add support for "Glacier Deep Archive" storage class (Manu)
    • Update Dreamhost endpoint (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Note incompatibility with CEPH Jewel (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • SFTP
    • Allow custom ssh client config (Alexandru Bumbacea)
  • Swift
    • Obey Retry-After to enable OVH restore from cold storage (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Work around token expiry on CEPH (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • WebDAV
    • Allow IsCollection property to be integer or boolean (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix race when creating directories (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix About/df when reading the available/total returns 0 (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.46 - 2019-02-09

  • New backends
    • Support Alibaba Cloud (Aliyun) OSS via the s3 backend (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • New commands
    • serve dlna: serves a remove via DLNA for the local network (nicolov)
  • New Features
    • copy, move: Restore deprecated --no-traverse flag (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • This is useful for when transferring a small number of files into a large destination
    • genautocomplete: Add remote path completion for bash completion (Christopher Peterson & Danil Semelenov)
    • Buffer memory handling reworked to return memory to the OS better (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Buffer recycling library to replace sync.Pool
      • Optionally use memory mapped memory for better memory shrinking
      • Enable with --use-mmap if having memory problems - not default yet
    • Parallelise reading of files specified by --files-from (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • check: Add stats showing total files matched. (Dario Guzik)
    • Allow rename/delete open files under Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • lsjson: Use exactly the correct number of decimal places in the seconds (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add cookie support with cmdline switch --use-cookies for all HTTP based remotes (qip)
    • Warn if --checksum is set but there are no hashes available (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Rework rate limiting (pacer) to be more accurate and allow bursting (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Improve error reporting for too many/few arguments in commands (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • listremotes: Remove -l short flag as it conflicts with the new global flag (weetmuts)
    • Make http serving with auth generate INFO messages on auth fail (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Bug Fixes
    • Fix layout of stats (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix --progress crash under Windows Jenkins (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix transfer of google/onedrive docs by calling Rcat in Copy when size is -1 (Cnly)
    • copyurl: Fix checking of --dry-run (Denis Skovpen)
  • Mount
    • Check that mountpoint and local directory to mount don't overlap (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix mount size under 32 bit Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • VFS
    • Implement renaming of directories for backends without DirMove (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • now all backends except b2 support renaming directories
    • Implement --vfs-cache-max-size to limit the total size of the cache (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --dir-perms and --file-perms flags to set default permissions (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix deadlock on concurrent operations on a directory (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix deadlock between RWFileHandle.close and File.Remove (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix renaming/deleting open files with cache mode "writes" under Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix panic on rename with --dry-run set (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix vfs/refresh with recurse=true needing the --fast-list flag
  • Local
    • Add support for -l/--links (symbolic link translation) (yair@unicorn)
      • this works by showing links as link.rclonelink - see local backend docs for more info
      • this errors if used with -L/--copy-links
    • Fix renaming/deleting open files on Windows (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Crypt
    • Check for maximum length before decrypting filename to fix panic (Garry McNulty)
  • Azure Blob
    • Allow building azureblob backend on *BSD (themylogin)
    • Use the rclone HTTP client to support --dump headers, --tpslimit, etc. (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Use the s3 pacer for 0 delay in non error conditions (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Ignore directory markers (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Stop Mkdir attempting to create existing containers (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • B2
    • cleanup: will remove unfinished large files >24hrs old (Garry McNulty)
    • For a bucket limited application key check the bucket name (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • before this, rclone would use the authorised bucket regardless of what you put on the command line
    • Added --b2-disable-checksum flag (Wojciech Smigielski)
      • this enables large files to be uploaded without a SHA-1 hash for speed reasons
  • Drive
    • Set default pacer to 100ms for 10 tps (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • This fits the Google defaults much better and reduces the 403 errors massively
      • Add --drive-pacer-min-sleep and --drive-pacer-burst to control the pacer
    • Improve ChangeNotify support for items with multiple parents (Fabian Möller)
    • Fix ListR for items with multiple parents - this fixes oddities with vfs/refresh (Fabian Möller)
    • Fix using --drive-impersonate and appfolders (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix google docs in rclone mount for some (not all) applications (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Dropbox
    • Retry-After support for Dropbox backend (Mathieu Carbou)
  • FTP
    • Wait for 60 seconds for a connection to Close then declare it dead (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • helps with indefinite hangs on some FTP servers
  • Google Cloud Storage
    • Update google cloud storage endpoints (weetmuts)
  • HTTP
    • Add an example with username and password which is supported but wasn't documented (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix backend with --files-from and non-existent files (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Hubic
    • Make error message more informative if authentication fails (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Jottacloud
    • Resume and deduplication support (Oliver Heyme)
    • Use token auth for all API requests Don't store password anymore (Sebastian Bünger)
    • Add support for 2-factor authentication (Sebastian Bünger)
  • Mega
    • Implement v2 account login which fixes logins for newer Mega accounts (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Return error if an unknown length file is attempted to be uploaded (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add new error codes for better error reporting (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Onedrive
    • Fix broken support for "shared with me" folders (Alex Chen)
    • Fix root ID not normalised (Cnly)
    • Return err instead of panic on unknown-sized uploads (Cnly)
  • Qingstor
    • Fix go routine leak on multipart upload errors (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add upload chunk size/concurrency/cutoff control (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Default --qingstor-upload-concurrency to 1 to work around bug (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • S3
    • Implement --s3-upload-cutoff for single part uploads below this (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Change --s3-upload-concurrency default to 4 to increase performance (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --s3-bucket-acl to control bucket ACL (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Auto detect region for buckets on operation failure (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add GLACIER storage class (William Cocker)
    • Add Scaleway to s3 documentation (Rémy Léone)
    • Add AWS endpoint eu-north-1 (weetmuts)
  • SFTP
    • Add support for PEM encrypted private keys (Fabian Möller)
    • Add option to force the usage of an ssh-agent (Fabian Möller)
    • Perform environment variable expansion on key-file (Fabian Möller)
    • Fix rmdir on Windows based servers (e.g. CrushFTP) (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix rmdir deleting directory contents on some SFTP servers (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix error on dangling symlinks (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Swift
    • Add --swift-no-chunk to disable segmented uploads in rcat/mount (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Introduce application credential auth support (kayrus)
    • Fix memory usage by slimming Object (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix extra requests on upload (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix reauth on big files (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Union
    • Fix poll-interval not working (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • WebDAV
    • Support About which means rclone mount will show the correct disk size (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Support MD5 and SHA1 hashes with Owncloud and Nextcloud (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fail soft on time parsing errors (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix infinite loop on failed directory creation (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix identification of directories for Bitrix Site Manager (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix upload of 0 length files on some servers (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix if MKCOL fails with 423 Locked assume the directory exists (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.45 - 2018-11-24

  • New backends
    • The Yandex backend was re-written - see below for details (Sebastian Bünger)
  • New commands
    • rcd: New command just to serve the remote control API (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • New Features
    • The remote control API (rc) was greatly expanded to allow full control over rclone (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • sensitive operations require authorization or the --rc-no-auth flag
      • config/* operations to configure rclone
      • options/* for reading/setting command line flags
      • operations/* for all low level operations, e.g. copy file, list directory
      • sync/* for sync, copy and move
      • --rc-files flag to serve files on the rc http server
        • this is for building web native GUIs for rclone
      • Optionally serving objects on the rc http server
      • Ensure rclone fails to start up if the --rc port is in use already
      • See the rc docs for more info
    • sync/copy/move
      • Make --files-from only read the objects specified and don't scan directories (Nick Craig-Wood)
        • This is a huge speed improvement for destinations with lots of files
    • filter: Add --ignore-case flag (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • ncdu: Add remove function ('d' key) (Henning Surmeier)
    • rc command
      • Add --json flag for structured JSON input (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add --user and --pass flags and interpret --rc-user, --rc-pass, --rc-addr (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • build
      • Require go1.8 or later for compilation (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Enable softfloat on MIPS arch (Scott Edlund)
      • Integration test framework revamped with a better report and better retries (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Bug Fixes
    • cmd: Make --progress update the stats correctly at the end (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • config: Create config directory on save if it is missing (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • dedupe: Check for existing filename before renaming a dupe file (ssaqua)
    • move: Don't create directories with --dry-run (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • operations: Fix Purge and Rmdirs when dir is not the root (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • serve http/webdav/restic: Ensure rclone exits if the port is in use (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Mount
    • Make --volname work for Windows and macOS (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Azure Blob
    • Avoid context deadline exceeded error by setting a large TryTimeout value (brused27)
    • Fix erroneous Rmdir error "directory not empty" (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Wait for up to 60s to create a just deleted container (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Dropbox
    • Add dropbox impersonate support (Jake Coggiano)
  • Jottacloud
    • Fix bug in --fast-list handing of empty folders (albertony)
  • Opendrive
    • Fix transfer of files with + and & in (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix retries of upload chunks (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • S3
    • Set ACL for server-side copies to that provided by the user (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix role_arn, credential_source, ... (Erik Swanson)
    • Add config info for Wasabi's US-West endpoint (Henry Ptasinski)
  • SFTP
    • Ensure file hash checking is really disabled (Jon Fautley)
  • Swift
    • Add pacer for retries to make swift more reliable (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • WebDAV
    • Add Content-Type to PUT requests (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix config parsing so --webdav-user and --webdav-pass flags work (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add RFC3339 date format (Ralf Hemberger)
  • Yandex
    • The yandex backend was re-written (Sebastian Bünger)
      • This implements low level retries (Sebastian Bünger)
      • Copy, Move, DirMove, PublicLink and About optional interfaces (Sebastian Bünger)
      • Improved general error handling (Sebastian Bünger)
      • Removed ListR for now due to inconsistent behaviour (Sebastian Bünger)

v1.44 - 2018-10-15

  • New commands
    • serve ftp: Add ftp server (Antoine GIRARD)
    • settier: perform storage tier changes on supported remotes (sandeepkru)
  • New Features
    • Reworked command line help
      • Make default help less verbose (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Split flags up into global and backend flags (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Implement specialised help for flags and backends (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Show URL of backend help page when starting config (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • stats: Long names now split in center (Joanna Marek)
    • Add --log-format flag for more control over log output (dcpu)
    • rc: Add support for OPTIONS and basic CORS (frenos)
    • stats: show FatalErrors and NoRetryErrors in stats (Cédric Connes)
  • Bug Fixes
    • Fix -P not ending with a new line (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • config: don't create default config dir when user supplies --config (albertony)
    • Don't print non-ASCII characters with --progress on windows (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Correct logs for excluded items (ssaqua)
  • Mount
    • Remove EXPERIMENTAL tags (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • VFS
    • Fix race condition detected by serve ftp tests (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add vfs/poll-interval rc command (Fabian Möller)
    • Enable rename for nearly all remotes using server-side Move or Copy (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Reduce directory cache cleared by poll-interval (Fabian Möller)
    • Remove EXPERIMENTAL tags (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Local
    • Skip bad symlinks in dir listing with -L enabled (Cédric Connes)
    • Preallocate files on Windows to reduce fragmentation (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Preallocate files on linux with fallocate(2) (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Cache
    • Add cache/fetch rc function (Fabian Möller)
    • Fix worker scale down (Fabian Möller)
    • Improve performance by not sending info requests for cached chunks (dcpu)
    • Fix error return value of cache/fetch rc method (Fabian Möller)
    • Documentation fix for cache-chunk-total-size (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)
    • Preserve leading / in wrapped remote path (Fabian Möller)
    • Add plex_insecure option to skip certificate validation (Fabian Möller)
    • Remove entries that no longer exist in the source (dcpu)
  • Crypt
    • Preserve leading / in wrapped remote path (Fabian Möller)
  • Alias
    • Fix handling of Windows network paths (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Azure Blob
    • Add --azureblob-list-chunk parameter (Santiago Rodríguez)
    • Implemented settier command support on azureblob remote. (sandeepkru)
    • Work around SDK bug which causes errors for chunk-sized files (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Box
    • Implement link sharing. (Sebastian Bünger)
  • Drive
    • Add --drive-import-formats - google docs can now be imported (Fabian Möller)
      • Rewrite mime type and extension handling (Fabian Möller)
      • Add document links (Fabian Möller)
      • Add support for multipart document extensions (Fabian Möller)
      • Add support for apps-script to json export (Fabian Möller)
      • Fix escaped chars in documents during list (Fabian Möller)
    • Add --drive-v2-download-min-size a workaround for slow downloads (Fabian Möller)
    • Improve directory notifications in ChangeNotify (Fabian Möller)
    • When listing team drives in config, continue on failure (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • FTP
    • Add a small pause after failed upload before deleting file (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Google Cloud Storage
    • Fix service_account_file being ignored (Fabian Möller)
  • Jottacloud
    • Minor improvement in quota info (omit if unlimited) (albertony)
    • Add --fast-list support (albertony)
    • Add permanent delete support: --jottacloud-hard-delete (albertony)
    • Add link sharing support (albertony)
    • Fix handling of reserved characters. (Sebastian Bünger)
    • Fix socket leak on Object.Remove (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Onedrive
    • Rework to support Microsoft Graph (Cnly)
      • NB this will require re-authenticating the remote
    • Removed upload cutoff and always do session uploads (Oliver Heyme)
    • Use single-part upload for empty files (Cnly)
    • Fix new fields not saved when editing old config (Alex Chen)
    • Fix sometimes special chars in filenames not replaced (Alex Chen)
    • Ignore OneNote files by default (Alex Chen)
    • Add link sharing support (jackyzy823)
  • S3
    • Use custom pacer, to retry operations when reasonable (Craig Miskell)
    • Use configured server-side-encryption and storage class options when calling CopyObject() (Paul Kohout)
    • Make --s3-v2-auth flag (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix v2 auth on files with spaces (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Union
    • Implement union backend which reads from multiple backends (Felix Brucker)
    • Implement optional interfaces (Move, DirMove, Copy, etc.) (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix ChangeNotify to support multiple remotes (Fabian Möller)
    • Fix --backup-dir on union backend (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • WebDAV
    • Add another time format (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add a small pause after failed upload before deleting file (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add workaround for missing mtime (buergi)
    • Sharepoint: Renew cookies after 12hrs (Henning Surmeier)
  • Yandex
    • Remove redundant nil checks (teresy)

v1.43.1 - 2018-09-07

Point release to fix hubic and azureblob backends.

  • Bug Fixes
    • ncdu: Return error instead of log.Fatal in Show (Fabian Möller)
    • cmd: Fix crash with --progress and --stats 0 (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • docs: Tidy website display (Anagh Kumar Baranwal)
  • Azure Blob:
    • Fix multi-part uploads. (sandeepkru)
  • Hubic
    • Fix uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Retry auth fetching if it fails to make hubic more reliable (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.43 - 2018-09-01

  • New backends
    • Jottacloud (Sebastian Bünger)
  • New commands
    • copyurl: copies a URL to a remote (Denis)
  • New Features
    • Reworked config for backends (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • All backend config can now be supplied by command line, env var or config file
      • Advanced section in the config wizard for the optional items
      • A large step towards rclone backends being usable in other go software
      • Allow on the fly remotes with :backend: syntax
    • Stats revamp
      • Add --progress/-P flag to show interactive progress (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Show the total progress of the sync in the stats (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Add --stats-one-line flag for single line stats (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Added weekday schedule into --bwlimit (Mateusz)
    • lsjson: Add option to show the original object IDs (Fabian Möller)
    • serve webdav: Make Content-Type without reading the file and add --etag-hash (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • build
      • Build macOS with native compiler (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Update to use go1.11 for the build (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • rc
      • Added core/stats to return the stats (reddi1)
    • version --check: Prints the current release and beta versions (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Bug Fixes
    • accounting
      • Fix time to completion estimates (Nick Craig-Wood)
      • Fix moving average speed for file stats (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • config: Fix error reading password from piped input (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • move: Fix --delete-empty-src-dirs flag to delete all empty dirs on move (ishuah)
  • Mount
    • Implement --daemon-timeout flag for OSXFUSE (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix mount --daemon not working with encrypted config (Alex Chen)
    • Clip the number of blocks to 2^32-1 on macOS - fixes borg backup (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • VFS
    • Enable vfs-read-chunk-size by default (Fabian Möller)
    • Add the vfs/refresh rc command (Fabian Möller)
    • Add non recursive mode to vfs/refresh rc command (Fabian Möller)
    • Try to seek buffer on read only files (Fabian Möller)
  • Local
    • Fix crash when deprecated --local-no-unicode-normalization is supplied (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix mkdir error when trying to copy files to the root of a drive on windows (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Cache
    • Fix nil pointer deref when using lsjson on cached directory (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix nil pointer deref for occasional crash on playback (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Crypt
    • Fix accounting when checking hashes on upload (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Amazon Cloud Drive
    • Make very clear in the docs that rclone has no ACD keys (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Azure Blob
    • Add connection string and SAS URL auth (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • List the container to see if it exists (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Port new Azure Blob Storage SDK (sandeepkru)
    • Added blob tier, tier between Hot, Cool and Archive. (sandeepkru)
    • Remove leading / from paths (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • B2
    • Support Application Keys (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Remove leading / from paths (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Box
    • Fix upload of > 2GB files on 32 bit platforms (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Make --box-commit-retries flag defaulting to 100 to fix large uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Drive
    • Add --drive-keep-revision-forever flag (lewapm)
    • Handle gdocs when filtering file names in list (Fabian Möller)
    • Support using --fast-list for large speedups (Fabian Möller)
  • FTP
    • Fix Put mkParentDir failed: 521 for BunnyCDN (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Google Cloud Storage
    • Fix index out of range error with --fast-list (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Jottacloud
    • Fix MD5 error check (Oliver Heyme)
    • Handle empty time values (Martin Polden)
    • Calculate missing MD5s (Oliver Heyme)
    • Docs, fixes and tests for MD5 calculation (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add optional MimeTyper interface. (Sebastian Bünger)
    • Implement optional About interface (for df support). (Sebastian Bünger)
  • Mega
    • Wait for events instead of arbitrary sleeping (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --mega-hard-delete flag (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix failed logins with upper case chars in email (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Onedrive
    • Shared folder support (Yoni Jah)
    • Implement DirMove (Cnly)
    • Fix rmdir sometimes deleting directories with contents (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Pcloud
    • Delete half uploaded files on upload error (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Qingstor
    • Remove leading / from paths (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • S3
    • Fix index out of range error with --fast-list (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add --s3-force-path-style (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add support for KMS Key ID (bsteiss)
    • Remove leading / from paths (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Swift
    • Add storage_policy (Ruben Vandamme)
    • Make it so just storage_url or auth_token can be overridden (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Fix server-side copy bug for unusual file names (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Remove leading / from paths (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • WebDAV
    • Ensure we call MKCOL with a URL with a trailing / for QNAP interop (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • If root ends with / then don't check if it is a file (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Don't accept redirects when reading metadata (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Add bearer token (Macaroon) support for dCache (Nick Craig-Wood)
    • Document dCache and Macaroons (Onno Zweers)
    • Sharepoint recursion with different depth (Henning)
    • Attempt to remove failed uploads (Nick Craig-Wood)
  • Yandex
    • Fix listing/deleting files in the root (Nick Craig-Wood)

v1.42 - 2018-06-16

  • New backends
    • OpenDrive (Oliver Heyme, Jakub Karlicek, ncw)
  • New commands
    • deletefile command (Filip Bartodziej)
  • New Features
    • copy, move: Copy single files directly, don't use --files-from work-around
      • this makes them much more efficient
    • Implement --max-transfer flag to quit transferring at a limit
      • make exit code 8 for --max-transfer exceeded
    • copy: copy empty source directories to destination (Ishuah Kariuki)
    • check: Add --one-way flag (Kasper Byrdal Nielsen)
    • Add siginfo handler for macOS for ctrl-T stats (kubatasiemski)
    • rc
      • add core/gc to run a garbage collection on demand
      • enable go profiling by default on the --rc port
      • return error from remote on failure
    • lsf
      • Add --absolute flag to add a leading / onto path names
      • Add --csv flag for compliant CSV output
      • Add 'm' format specifier to show the MimeType
      • Implement 'i' format for showing object ID
    • lsjson
      • Add MimeType to the output
      • Add ID field to output to show Object ID
    • Add --retries-sleep flag (Benjamin Joseph Dag)
    • Oauth tidy up web page and error handling (Henning Surmeier)
  • Bug Fixes
    • Password prompt output with --log-file fixed for unix (Filip Bartodziej)
    • Calculate ModifyWindow each time on the fly to fix various problems (Stefan Breunig)
  • Mount
    • Only print "File.rename error" if there actually is an error (Stefan Breunig)
    • Delay rename if file has open writers instead of failing outright (Stefan Breunig)
    • Ensure atexit gets run on interrupt
    • macOS enhancements
      • Make --noappledouble --noapplexattr
      • Add --volname flag and remove special chars from it
      • Make Get/List/Set/Remove xattr return ENOSYS for efficiency
      • Make --daemon work for macOS without CGO
  • VFS
    • Add --vfs-read-chunk-size and --vfs-read-chunk-size-limit (Fabian Möller)
    • Fix ChangeNotify for new or changed folders (Fabian Möller)
  • Local
    • Fix symlink/junction point directory handling under Windows
      • NB you will need to add -L to your command line to copy files with reparse points
  • Cache
    • Add non cached dirs on notifications (Remus Bunduc)
    • Allow root to be expired from rc (Remus Bunduc)
    • Clean remaining empty folders from temp upload path (Remus Bunduc)
    • Cache lists using batch writes (Remus Bunduc)
    • Use secure websockets for HTTPS Plex addresses (John Clayton)
    • Reconnect plex websocket on failures (Remus Bunduc)
    • Fix panic when running without plex configs (Remus Bunduc)
    • Fix root folder caching (Remus Bunduc)
  • Crypt
    • Check the crypted hash of files when uploading for extra data security
  • Dropbox
    • Make Dropbox for business folders accessible using an initial / in the path
  • Google Cloud Storage
    • Low level retry all operations if necessary
  • Google Drive
    • Add --drive-acknowledge-abuse to download flagged files
    • Add --drive-alternate-export to fix large doc export
    • Don't attempt to choose Team Drives when using rclone config create
    • Fix change list polling with team drives
    • Fix ChangeNotify for folders (Fabian Möller)
    • Fix about (and df on a mount) for team drives
  • Onedrive
    • Errorhandler for onedrive for business requests (Henning Surmeier)
  • S3
    • Adjust upload concurrency with --s3-upload-concurrency (themylogin)
    • Fix --s3-chunk-size which was always using the minimum
  • SFTP
    • Add --ssh-path-override flag (Piotr Oleszczyk)
    • Fix slow downloads for long latency connections
  • Webdav
    • Add workarounds for biz.mail.ru
    • Ignore Reason-Phrase in status line to fix 4shared (Rodrigo)
    • Better error message generation

v1.41 - 2018-04-28

  • New backends
    • Mega support added
    • Webdav now supports SharePoint cookie authentication (hensur)
  • New commands
    • link: create public link to files and folders (Stefan Breunig)
    • about: gets quota info from a remote (a-roussos, ncw)
    • hashsum: a generic tool for any hash to produce md5sum like output
  • New Features
    • lsd: Add -R flag and fix and update docs for all ls commands
    • ncdu: added a "refresh" key - CTRL-L (Keith Goldfarb)
    • serve restic: Add append-only mode (Steve Kriss)
    • serve restic: Disallow overwriting files in append-only mode (Alexander Neumann)
    • serve restic: Print actual listener address (Matt Holt)
    • size: Add --json flag (Matthew Holt)
    • sync: implement --ignore-errors (Mateusz Pabian)
    • dedupe: Add dedupe largest functionality (Richard Yang)
    • fs: Extend SizeSuffix to include TB and PB for rclone about
    • fs: add --dump goroutines and --dump openfiles for debugging
    • rc: implement core/memstats to print internal memory usage info
    • rc: new call rc/pid (Michael P. Dubner)
  • Compile
    • Drop support for go1.6
  • Release
    • Fix make tarball (Chih-Hsuan Yen)
  • Bug Fixes
    • filter: fix --min-age and --max-age together check
    • fs: limit MaxIdleConns and MaxIdleConnsPerHost in transport
    • lsd,lsf: make sure all times we output are in local time
    • rc: fix setting bwlimit to unlimited
    • rc: take note of the --rc-addr flag too as per the docs
  • Mount
    • Use About to return the correct disk total/used/free (e.g. in df)
    • Set --attr-timeout default to 1s - fixes:
      • rclone using too much memory
      • rclone not serving files to samba
      • excessive time listing directories
    • Fix df -i (upstream fix)
  • VFS
    • Filter files . and .. from directory listing
    • Only make the VFS cache if --vfs-cache-mode > Off
  • Local
    • Add --local-no-check-updated to disable updated file checks
    • Retry remove on Windows sharing violation error
  • Cache
    • Flush the memory cache after close
    • Purge file data on notification
    • Always forget parent dir for notifications
    • Integrate with Plex websocket
    • Add rc cache/stats (seuffert)
    • Add info log on notification
  • Box
    • Fix failure reading large directories - parse file/directory size as float
  • Dropbox
    • Fix crypt+obfuscate on dropbox
    • Fix repeatedly uploading the same files
  • FTP
    • Work around strange response from box FTP server
    • More workarounds for FTP servers to fix mkParentDir error
    • Fix no error on listing non-existent directory
  • Google Cloud Storage
    • Add service_account_credentials (Matt Holt)
    • Detect bucket presence by listing it - minimises permissions needed
    • Ignore zero length directory markers
  • Google Drive
    • Add service_account_credentials (Matt Holt)
    • Fix directory move leaving a hardlinked directory behind
    • Return proper google errors when Opening files
    • When initialized with a filepath, optional features used incorrect root path (Stefan Breunig)
  • HTTP
    • Fix sync for servers which don't return Content-Length in HEAD
  • Onedrive
    • Add QuickXorHash support for OneDrive for business
    • Fix socket leak in multipart session upload
  • S3
    • Look in S3 named profile files for credentials
    • Add --s3-disable-checksum to disable checksum uploading (Chris Redekop)
    • Hierarchical configuration support (Giri Badanahatti)
    • Add in config for all the supported S3 providers
    • Add One Zone Infrequent Access storage class (Craig Rachel)
    • Add --use-server-modtime support (Peter Baumgartner)
    • Add --s3-chunk-size option to control multipart uploads
    • Ignore zero length directory markers
  • SFTP
    • Update docs to match code, fix typos and clarify disable_hashcheck prompt (Michael G. Noll)
    • Update docs with Synology quirks
    • Fail soft with a debug on hash failure
  • Swift
    • Add --use-server-modtime support (Peter Baumgartner)
  • Webdav
    • Support SharePoint cookie authentication (hensur)
    • Strip leading and trailing / off root

v1.40 - 2018-03-19

  • New backends
    • Alias backend to create aliases for existing remote names (Fabian Möller)
  • New commands
    • lsf: list for parsing purposes (Jakub Tasiemski)
      • by default this is a simple non recursive list of files and directories
      • it can be configured to add more info in an easy to parse way
    • serve restic: for serving a remote as a Restic REST endpoint
      • This enables restic to use any backends that rclone can access
      • Thanks Alexander Neumann for help, patches and review
    • rc: enable the remote control of a running rclone
      • The running rclone must be started with --rc and related flags.
      • Currently there is support for bwlimit, and flushing for mount and cache.
  • New Features
    • --max-delete flag to add a delete threshold (Bjørn Erik Pedersen)
    • All backends now support RangeOption for ranged Open
      • cat: Use RangeOption for limited fetches to make more efficient
      • cryptcheck: make reading of nonce more efficient with RangeOption
    • serve http/webdav/restic
      • support SSL/TLS
      • add --user --pass and --htpasswd for authentication
    • copy/move: detect file size change during copy/move and abort transfer (ishuah)
    • cryptdecode: added option to return encrypted file names. (ishuah)
    • lsjson: add --encrypted to show encrypted name (Jakub Tasiemski)
    • Add --stats-file-name-length to specify the printed file name length for stats (Will Gunn)
  • Compile
    • Code base was shuffled and factored
      • backends moved into a backend directory
      • large packages split up
      • See the CONTRIBUTING.md doc for info as to what lives where now
    • Update to using go1.10 as the default go version
    • Implement daily full integration tests
  • Release
    • Include a source tarball and sign it and the binaries
    • Sign the git tags as part of the release process
    • Add .deb and .rpm packages as part of the build
    • Make a beta release for all branches on the main repo (but not pull requests)
  • Bug Fixes
    • config: fixes errors on non existing config by loading config file only on first access
    • config: retry saving the config after failure (Mateusz)
    • sync: when using --backup-dir don't delete files if we can't set their modtime
      • this fixes odd behaviour with Dropbox and --backup-dir
    • fshttp: fix idle timeouts for HTTP connections
    • serve http: fix serving files with : in - fixes
    • Fix --exclude-if-present to ignore directories which it doesn't have permission for (Iakov Davydov)
    • Make accounting work properly with crypt and b2
    • remove --no-traverse flag because it is obsolete
  • Mount
    • Add --attr-timeout flag to control attribute caching in kernel
      • this now defaults to 0 which is correct but less efficient
      • see the mount docs for more info
    • Add --daemon flag to allow mount to run in the background (ishuah)
    • Fix: Return ENOSYS rather than EIO on attempted link
      • This fixes FileZilla accessing an rclone mount served over sftp.
    • Fix setting modtime twice
    • Mount tests now run on CI for Linux (mount & cmount)/Mac/Windows
    • Many bugs fixed in the VFS layer - see below
  • VFS
    • Many fixes for --vfs-cache-mode writes and above
      • Update cached copy if we know it has changed (fixes stale data)
      • Clean path names before using them in the cache
      • Disable cache cleaner if --vfs-cache-poll-interval=0
      • Fill and clean the cache immediately on startup
    • Fix Windows opening every file when it stats the file
    • Fix applying modtime for an open Write Handle
    • Fix creation of files when truncating
    • Write 0 bytes when flushing unwritten handles to avoid race conditions in FUSE
    • Downgrade "poll-interval is not supported" message to Info
    • Make OpenFile and friends return EINVAL if O_RDONLY and O_TRUNC
  • Local
    • Downgrade "invalid cross-device link: trying copy" to debug
    • Make DirMove return fs.ErrorCantDirMove to allow fallback to Copy for cross device
    • Fix race conditions updating the hashes
  • Cache
    • Add support for polling - cache will update when remote changes on supported backends
    • Reduce log level for Plex api
    • Fix dir cache issue
    • Implement --cache-db-wait-time flag
    • Improve efficiency with RangeOption and RangeSeek
    • Fix dirmove with temp fs enabled
    • Notify vfs when using temp fs
    • Offline uploading
    • Remote control support for path flushing
  • Amazon cloud drive
    • Rclone no longer has any working keys - disable integration tests
    • Implement DirChangeNotify to notify cache/vfs/mount of changes
  • Azureblob
    • Don't check for bucket/container presence if listing was OK
      • this makes rclone do one less request per invocation
    • Improve accounting for chunked uploads
  • Backblaze B2
    • Don't check for bucket/container presence if listing was OK
      • this makes rclone do one less request per invocation
  • Box
    • Improve accounting for chunked uploads
  • Dropbox
    • Fix custom oauth client parameters
  • Google Cloud Storage
    • Don't check for bucket/container presence if listing was OK
      • this makes rclone do one less request per invocation
  • Google Drive
    • Migrate to api v3 (Fabian Möller)
    • Add scope configuration and root folder selection
    • Add --drive-impersonate for service accounts
      • thanks to everyone who tested, explored and contributed docs
    • Add --drive-use-created-date to use created date as modified date (nbuchanan)
    • Request the export formats only when required
      • This makes rclone quicker when there are no google docs
    • Fix finding paths with latin1 chars (a workaround for a drive bug)
    • Fix copying of a single Google doc file
    • Fix --drive-auth-owner-only to look in all directories
  • HTTP
    • Fix handling of directories with & in
  • Onedrive
    • Removed upload cutoff and always do session uploads
      • this stops the creation of multiple versions on business onedrive
    • Overwrite object size value with real size when reading file. (Victor)
      • this fixes oddities when onedrive misreports the size of images
  • Pcloud
    • Remove unused chunked upload flag and code
  • Qingstor
    • Don't check for bucket/container presence if listing was OK
      • this makes rclone do one less request per invocation
  • S3
    • Support hashes for multipart files (Chris Redekop)
    • Initial support for IBM COS (S3) (Giri Badanahatti)
    • Update docs to discourage use of v2 auth with CEPH and others
    • Don't check for bucket/container presence if listing was OK
      • this makes rclone do one less request per invocation
    • Fix server-side copy and set modtime on files with + in
  • SFTP
    • Add option to disable remote hash check command execution (Jon Fautley)
    • Add --sftp-ask-password flag to prompt for password when needed (Leo R. Lundgren)
    • Add set_modtime configuration option
    • Fix following of symlinks
    • Fix reading config file outside of Fs setup
    • Fix reading $USER in username fallback not $HOME
    • Fix running under crontab - Use correct OS way of reading username
  • Swift
    • Fix refresh of authentication token
      • in v1.39 a bug was introduced which ignored new tokens - this fixes it
    • Fix extra HEAD transaction when uploading a new file
    • Don't check for bucket/container presence if listing was OK
      • this makes rclone do one less request per invocation
  • Webdav
    • Add new time formats to support mydrive.ch and others

v1.39 - 2017-12-23

  • New backends
    • WebDAV
      • tested with nextcloud, owncloud, put.io and others!
    • Pcloud
    • cache - wraps a cache around other backends (Remus Bunduc)
      • useful in combination with mount
      • NB this feature is in beta so use with care
  • New commands
    • serve command with subcommands:
      • serve webdav: this implements a webdav server for any rclone remote.
      • serve http: command to serve a remote over HTTP
    • config: add sub commands for full config file management
      • create/delete/dump/edit/file/password/providers/show/update
    • touch: to create or update the timestamp of a file (Jakub Tasiemski)
  • New Features
    • curl install for rclone (Filip Bartodziej)
    • --stats now shows percentage, size, rate and ETA in condensed form (Ishuah Kariuki)
    • --exclude-if-present to exclude a directory if a file is present (Iakov Davydov)
    • rmdirs: add --leave-root flag (lewapm)
    • move: add --delete-empty-src-dirs flag to remove dirs after move (Ishuah Kariuki)
    • Add --dump flag, introduce --dump requests, responses and remove --dump-auth, --dump-filters
      • Obscure X-Auth-Token: from headers when dumping too
    • Document and implement exit codes for different failure modes (Ishuah Kariuki)
  • Compile
  • Bug Fixes
    • Retry lots more different types of errors to make multipart transfers more reliable
    • Save the config before asking for a token, fixes disappearing oauth config
    • Warn the user if --include and --exclude are used together (Ernest Borowski)
    • Fix duplicate files (e.g. on Google drive) causing spurious copies
    • Allow trailing and leading whitespace for passwords (Jason Rose)
    • ncdu: fix crashes on empty directories
    • rcat: fix goroutine leak
    • moveto/copyto: Fix to allow copying to the same name
  • Mount
    • --vfs-cache mode to make writes into mounts more reliable.
      • this requires caching files on the disk (see --cache-dir)
      • As this is a new feature, use with care
    • Use sdnotify to signal systemd the mount is ready (Fabian Möller)
    • Check if directory is not empty before mounting (Ernest Borowski)
  • Local
    • Add error message for cross file system moves
    • Fix equality check for times
  • Dropbox
    • Rework multipart upload
      • buffer the chunks when uploading large files so they can be retried
      • change default chunk size to 48MB now we are buffering them in memory
      • retry every error after the first chunk is done successfully
    • Fix error when renaming directories
  • Swift
    • Fix crash on bad authentication
  • Google Drive
    • Add service account support (Tim Cooijmans)
  • S3
    • Make it work properly with Digital Ocean Spaces (Andrew Starr-Bochicchio)
    • Fix crash if a bad listing is received
    • Add support for ECS task IAM roles (David Minor)
  • Backblaze B2
    • Fix multipart upload retries
    • Fix --hard-delete to make it work 100% of the time
  • Swift
    • Allow authentication with storage URL and auth key (Giovanni Pizzi)
    • Add new fields for swift configuration to support IBM Bluemix Swift (Pierre Carlson)
    • Add OS_TENANT_ID and OS_USER_ID to config
    • Allow configs with user id instead of user name
    • Check if swift segments container exists before creating (John Leach)
    • Fix memory leak in swift transfers (upstream fix)
  • SFTP
    • Add option to enable the use of aes128-cbc cipher (Jon Fautley)
  • Amazon cloud drive
    • Fix download of large files failing with "Only one auth mechanism allowed"
  • crypt
    • Option to encrypt directory names or leave them intact
    • Implement DirChangeNotify (Fabian Möller)
  • onedrive
    • Add option to choose resourceURL during setup of OneDrive Business account if more than one is available for user

v1.38 - 2017-09-30

  • New backends
    • Azure Blob Storage (thanks Andrei Dragomir)
    • Box
    • Onedrive for Business (thanks Oliver Heyme)
    • QingStor from QingCloud (thanks wuyu)
  • New commands
    • rcat - read from standard input and stream upload
    • tree - shows a nicely formatted recursive listing
    • cryptdecode - decode crypted file names (thanks ishuah)
    • config show - print the config file
    • config file - print the config file location
  • New Features
    • Empty directories are deleted on sync
    • dedupe - implement merging of duplicate directories
    • check and cryptcheck made more consistent and use less memory
    • cleanup for remaining remotes (thanks ishuah)
    • --immutable for ensuring that files don't change (thanks Jacob McNamee)
    • --user-agent option (thanks Alex McGrath Kraak)
    • --disable flag to disable optional features
    • --bind flag for choosing the local addr on outgoing connections
    • Support for zsh auto-completion (thanks bpicode)
    • Stop normalizing file names but do a normalized compare in sync
  • Compile
    • Update to using go1.9 as the default go version
    • Remove snapd build due to maintenance problems
  • Bug Fixes
    • Improve retriable error detection which makes multipart uploads better
    • Make check obey --ignore-size
    • Fix bwlimit toggle in conjunction with schedules (thanks cbruegg)
    • config ensures newly written config is on the same mount
  • Local
    • Revert to copy when moving file across file system boundaries
    • --skip-links to suppress symlink warnings (thanks Zhiming Wang)
  • Mount
    • Re-use rcat internals to support uploads from all remotes
  • Dropbox
    • Fix "entry doesn't belong in directory" error
    • Stop using deprecated API methods
  • Swift
    • Fix server-side copy to empty container with --fast-list
  • Google Drive
    • Change the default for --drive-use-trash to true
  • S3
    • Set session token when using STS (thanks Girish Ramakrishnan)
    • Glacier docs and error messages (thanks Jan Varho)
    • Read 1000 (not 1024) items in dir listings to fix Wasabi
  • Backblaze B2
    • Fix SHA1 mismatch when downloading files with no SHA1
    • Calculate missing hashes on the fly instead of spooling
    • --b2-hard-delete to permanently delete (not hide) files (thanks John Papandriopoulos)
  • Hubic
    • Fix creating containers - no longer have to use the default container
  • Swift
    • Optionally configure from a standard set of OpenStack environment vars
    • Add endpoint_type config
  • Google Cloud Storage
    • Fix bucket creation to work with limited permission users
  • SFTP
    • Implement connection pooling for multiple ssh connections
    • Limit new connections per second
    • Add support for MD5 and SHA1 hashes where available (thanks Christian Brüggemann)
  • HTTP
    • Fix URL encoding issues
    • Fix directories with : in
    • Fix panic with URL encoded content

v1.37 - 2017-07-22

  • New backends
    • FTP - thanks to Antonio Messina
    • HTTP - thanks to Vasiliy Tolstov
  • New commands
    • rclone ncdu - for exploring a remote with a text based user interface.
    • rclone lsjson - for listing with a machine readable output
    • rclone dbhashsum - to show Dropbox style hashes of files (local or Dropbox)
  • New Features
    • Implement --fast-list flag
      • This allows remotes to list recursively if they can
      • This uses less transactions (important if you pay for them)
      • This may or may not be quicker
      • This will use more memory as it has to hold the listing in memory
      • --old-sync-method deprecated - the remaining uses are covered by --fast-list
      • This involved a major re-write of all the listing code
    • Add --tpslimit and --tpslimit-burst to limit transactions per second
      • this is useful in conjunction with rclone mount to limit external apps
    • Add --stats-log-level so can see --stats without -v
    • Print password prompts to stderr - Hraban Luyat
    • Warn about duplicate files when syncing
    • Oauth improvements
      • allow auth_url and token_url to be set in the config file
      • Print redirection URI if using own credentials.
    • Don't Mkdir at the start of sync to save transactions
  • Compile
    • Update build to go1.8.3
    • Require go1.6 for building rclone
    • Compile 386 builds with "GO386=387" for maximum compatibility
  • Bug Fixes
    • Fix menu selection when no remotes
    • Config saving reworked to not kill the file if disk gets full
    • Don't delete remote if name does not change while renaming
    • moveto, copyto: report transfers and checks as per move and copy
  • Local
    • Add --local-no-unicode-normalization flag - Bob Potter
  • Mount
    • Now supported on Windows using cgofuse and WinFsp - thanks to Bill Zissimopoulos for much help
    • Compare checksums on upload/download via FUSE
    • Unmount when program ends with SIGINT (Ctrl+C) or SIGTERM - Jérôme Vizcaino
    • On read only open of file, make open pending until first read
    • Make --read-only reject modify operations
    • Implement ModTime via FUSE for remotes that support it
    • Allow modTime to be changed even before all writers are closed
    • Fix panic on renames
    • Fix hang on errored upload
  • Crypt
    • Report the name:root as specified by the user
    • Add an "obfuscate" option for filename encryption - Stephen Harris
  • Amazon Drive
    • Fix initialization order for token renewer
    • Remove revoked credentials, allow oauth proxy config and update docs
  • B2
    • Reduce minimum chunk size to 5MB
  • Drive
    • Add team drive support
    • Reduce bandwidth by adding fields for partial responses - Martin Kristensen
    • Implement --drive-shared-with-me flag to view shared with me files - Danny Tsai
    • Add --drive-trashed-only to read only the files in the trash
    • Remove obsolete --drive-full-list
    • Add missing seek to start on retries of chunked uploads
    • Fix stats accounting for upload
    • Convert / in names to a unicode equivalent ()
    • Poll for Google Drive changes when mounted
  • OneDrive
    • Fix the uploading of files with spaces
    • Fix initialization order for token renewer
    • Display speeds accurately when uploading - Yoni Jah
    • Swap to using http://localhost:53682/ as redirect URL - Michael Ledin
    • Retry on token expired error, reset upload body on retry - Yoni Jah
  • Google Cloud Storage
    • Add ability to specify location and storage class via config and command line - thanks gdm85
    • Create container if necessary on server-side copy
    • Increase directory listing chunk to 1000 to increase performance
    • Obtain a refresh token for GCS - Steven Lu
  • Yandex
    • Fix the name reported in log messages (was empty)
    • Correct error return for listing empty directory
  • Dropbox
    • Rewritten to use the v2 API
      • Now supports ModTime
        • Can only set by uploading the file again
        • If you uploaded with an old rclone, rclone may upload everything again
        • Use --size-only or --checksum to avoid this
      • Now supports the Dropbox content hashing scheme
      • Now supports low level retries
  • S3
    • Work around eventual consistency in bucket creation
    • Create container if necessary on server-side copy
    • Add us-east-2 (Ohio) and eu-west-2 (London) S3 regions - Zahiar Ahmed
  • Swift, Hubic
    • Fix zero length directory markers showing in the subdirectory listing
      • this caused lots of duplicate transfers
    • Fix paged directory listings
      • this caused duplicate directory errors
    • Create container if necessary on server-side copy
    • Increase directory listing chunk to 1000 to increase performance
    • Make sensible error if the user forgets the container
  • SFTP
    • Add support for using ssh key files
    • Fix under Windows
    • Fix ssh agent on Windows
    • Adapt to latest version of library - Igor Kharin

v1.36 - 2017-03-18

  • New Features
    • SFTP remote (Jack Schmidt)
    • Re-implement sync routine to work a directory at a time reducing memory usage
    • Logging revamped to be more inline with rsync - now much quieter
      * -v only shows transfers
      * -vv is for full debug
      * --syslog to log to syslog on capable platforms
    • Implement --backup-dir and --suffix
    • Implement --track-renames (initial implementation by Bjørn Erik Pedersen)
    • Add time-based bandwidth limits (Lukas Loesche)
    • rclone cryptcheck: checks integrity of crypt remotes
    • Allow all config file variables and options to be set from environment variables
    • Add --buffer-size parameter to control buffer size for copy
    • Make --delete-after the default
    • Add --ignore-checksum flag (fixed by Hisham Zarka)
    • rclone check: Add --download flag to check all the data, not just hashes
    • rclone cat: add --head, --tail, --offset, --count and --discard
    • rclone config: when choosing from a list, allow the value to be entered too
    • rclone config: allow rename and copy of remotes
    • rclone obscure: for generating encrypted passwords for rclone's config (T.C. Ferguson)
    • Comply with XDG Base Directory specification (Dario Giovannetti)
      • this moves the default location of the config file in a backwards compatible way
    • Release changes
      • Ubuntu snap support (Dedsec1)
      • Compile with go 1.8
      • MIPS/Linux big and little endian support
  • Bug Fixes
    • Fix copyto copying things to the wrong place if the destination dir didn't exist
    • Fix parsing of remotes in moveto and copyto
    • Fix --delete-before deleting files on copy
    • Fix --files-from with an empty file copying everything
    • Fix sync: don't update mod times if --dry-run set
    • Fix MimeType propagation
    • Fix filters to add ** rules to directory rules
  • Local
    • Implement -L, --copy-links flag to allow rclone to follow symlinks
    • Open files in write only mode so rclone can write to an rclone mount
    • Fix unnormalised unicode causing problems reading directories
    • Fix interaction between -x flag and --max-depth
  • Mount
    • Implement proper directory handling (mkdir, rmdir, renaming)
    • Make include and exclude filters apply to mount
    • Implement read and write async buffers - control with --buffer-size
    • Fix fsync on for directories
    • Fix retry on network failure when reading off crypt
  • Crypt
    • Add --crypt-show-mapping to show encrypted file mapping
    • Fix crypt writer getting stuck in a loop
      • IMPORTANT this bug had the potential to cause data corruption when
        • reading data from a network based remote and
        • writing to a crypt on Google Drive
      • Use the cryptcheck command to validate your data if you are concerned
      • If syncing two crypt remotes, sync the unencrypted remote
  • Amazon Drive
    • Fix panics on Move (rename)
    • Fix panic on token expiry
  • B2
    • Fix inconsistent listings and rclone check
    • Fix uploading empty files with go1.8
    • Constrain memory usage when doing multipart uploads
    • Fix upload url not being refreshed properly
  • Drive
    • Fix Rmdir on directories with trashed files
    • Fix "Ignoring unknown object" when downloading
    • Add --drive-list-chunk
    • Add --drive-skip-gdocs (Károly Oláh)
  • OneDrive
    • Implement Move
    • Fix Copy
      • Fix overwrite detection in Copy
      • Fix waitForJob to parse errors correctly
    • Use token renewer to stop auth errors on long uploads
    • Fix uploading empty files with go1.8
  • Google Cloud Storage
    • Fix depth 1 directory listings
  • Yandex
    • Fix single level directory listing
  • Dropbox
    • Normalise the case for single level directory listings
    • Fix depth 1 listing
  • S3
    • Added ca-central-1 region (Jon Yergatian)

v1.35 - 2017-01-02

  • New Features
    • moveto and copyto commands for choosing a destination name on copy/move
    • rmdirs command to recursively delete empty directories
    • Allow repeated --include/--exclude/--filter options
    • Only show transfer stats on commands which transfer stuff
      • show stats on any command using the --stats flag
    • Allow overlapping directories in move when server-side dir move is supported
    • Add --stats-unit option - thanks Scott McGillivray
  • Bug Fixes
    • Fix the config file being overwritten when two rclone instances are running
    • Make rclone lsd obey the filters properly
    • Fix compilation on mips
    • Fix not transferring files that don't differ in size
    • Fix panic on nil retry/fatal error
  • Mount
    • Retry reads on error - should help with reliability a lot
    • Report the modification times for directories from the remote
    • Add bandwidth accounting and limiting (fixes --bwlimit)
    • If --stats provided will show stats and which files are transferring
    • Support R/W files if truncate is set.
    • Implement statfs interface so df works
    • Note that write is now supported on Amazon Drive
    • Report number of blocks in a file - thanks Stefan Breunig
  • Crypt
    • Prevent the user pointing crypt at itself
    • Fix failed to authenticate decrypted block errors
      • these will now return the underlying unexpected EOF instead
  • Amazon Drive
    • Add support for server-side move and directory move - thanks Stefan Breunig
    • Fix nil pointer deref on size attribute
  • B2
    • Use new prefix and delimiter parameters in directory listings
      • This makes --max-depth 1 dir listings as used in mount much faster
    • Reauth the account while doing uploads too - should help with token expiry
  • Drive
    • Make DirMove more efficient and complain about moving the root
    • Create destination directory on Move()

v1.34 - 2016-11-06

  • New Features
    • Stop single file and --files-from operations iterating through the source bucket.
    • Stop removing failed upload to cloud storage remotes
    • Make ContentType be preserved for cloud to cloud copies
    • Add support to toggle bandwidth limits via SIGUSR2 - thanks Marco Paganini
    • rclone check shows count of hashes that couldn't be checked
    • rclone listremotes command
    • Support linux/arm64 build - thanks Fredrik Fornwall
    • Remove Authorization: lines from --dump-headers output
  • Bug Fixes
    • Ignore files with control characters in the names
    • Fix rclone move command
      • Delete src files which already existed in dst
      • Fix deletion of src file when dst file older
    • Fix rclone check on crypted file systems
    • Make failed uploads not count as "Transferred"
    • Make sure high level retries show with -q
    • Use a vendor directory with godep for repeatable builds
  • rclone mount - FUSE
    • Implement FUSE mount options
      • --no-modtime, --debug-fuse, --read-only, --allow-non-empty, --allow-root, --allow-other
      • --default-permissions, --write-back-cache, --max-read-ahead, --umask, --uid, --gid
    • Add --dir-cache-time to control caching of directory entries
    • Implement seek for files opened for read (useful for video players)
      • with -no-seek flag to disable
    • Fix crash on 32 bit ARM (alignment of 64 bit counter)
    • ...and many more internal fixes and improvements!
  • Crypt
    • Don't show encrypted password in configurator to stop confusion
  • Amazon Drive
    • New wait for upload option --acd-upload-wait-per-gb
      • upload timeouts scale by file size and can be disabled
    • Add 502 Bad Gateway to list of errors we retry
    • Fix overwriting a file with a zero length file
    • Fix ACD file size warning limit - thanks Felix Bünemann
  • Local
    • Unix: implement -x/--one-file-system to stay on a single file system
      • thanks Durval Menezes and Luiz Carlos Rumbelsperger Viana
    • Windows: ignore the symlink bit on files
    • Windows: Ignore directory based junction points
  • B2
    • Make sure each upload has at least one upload slot - fixes strange upload stats
    • Fix uploads when using crypt
    • Fix download of large files (sha1 mismatch)
    • Return error when we try to create a bucket which someone else owns
    • Update B2 docs with Data usage, and Crypt section - thanks Tomasz Mazur
  • S3
    • Command line and config file support for
      • Setting/overriding ACL - thanks Radek Senfeld
      • Setting storage class - thanks Asko Tamm
  • Drive
    • Make exponential backoff work exactly as per Google specification
    • add .epub, .odp and .tsv as export formats.
  • Swift
    • Don't read metadata for directory marker objects

v1.33 - 2016-08-24

  • New Features
    • Implement encryption
      • data encrypted in NACL secretbox format
      • with optional file name encryption
    • New commands
      • rclone mount - implements FUSE mounting of remotes (EXPERIMENTAL)
        • works on Linux, FreeBSD and OS X (need testers for the last 2!)
      • rclone cat - outputs remote file or files to the terminal
      • rclone genautocomplete - command to make a bash completion script for rclone
    • Editing a remote using rclone config now goes through the wizard
    • Compile with go 1.7 - this fixes rclone on macOS Sierra and on 386 processors
    • Use cobra for sub commands and docs generation
  • drive
    • Document how to make your own client_id
  • s3
    • User-configurable Amazon S3 ACL (thanks Radek Šenfeld)
  • b2
    • Fix stats accounting for upload - no more jumping to 100% done
    • On cleanup delete hide marker if it is the current file
    • New B2 API endpoint (thanks Per Cederberg)
    • Set maximum backoff to 5 Minutes
  • onedrive
    • Fix URL escaping in file names - e.g. uploading files with + in them.
  • amazon cloud drive
    • Fix token expiry during large uploads
    • Work around 408 REQUEST_TIMEOUT and 504 GATEWAY_TIMEOUT errors
  • local
    • Fix filenames with invalid UTF-8 not being uploaded
    • Fix problem with some UTF-8 characters on OS X

v1.32 - 2016-07-13

  • Backblaze B2
    • Fix upload of files large files not in root

v1.31 - 2016-07-13

  • New Features
    • Reduce memory on sync by about 50%
    • Implement --no-traverse flag to stop copy traversing the destination remote.
      • This can be used to reduce memory usage down to the smallest possible.
      • Useful to copy a small number of files into a large destination folder.
    • Implement cleanup command for emptying trash / removing old versions of files
      • Currently B2 only
    • Single file handling improved
      • Now copied with --files-from
      • Automatically sets --no-traverse when copying a single file
    • Info on using installing with ansible - thanks Stefan Weichinger
    • Implement --no-update-modtime flag to stop rclone fixing the remote modified times.
  • Bug Fixes
    • Fix move command - stop it running for overlapping Fses - this was causing data loss.
  • Local
    • Fix incomplete hashes - this was causing problems for B2.
  • Amazon Drive
    • Rename Amazon Cloud Drive to Amazon Drive - no changes to config file needed.
  • Swift
    • Add support for non-default project domain - thanks Antonio Messina.
  • S3
    • Add instructions on how to use rclone with minio.
    • Add ap-northeast-2 (Seoul) and ap-south-1 (Mumbai) regions.
    • Skip setting the modified time for objects > 5GB as it isn't possible.
  • Backblaze B2
    • Add --b2-versions flag so old versions can be listed and retrieved.
    • Treat 403 errors (e.g. cap exceeded) as fatal.
    • Implement cleanup command for deleting old file versions.
    • Make error handling compliant with B2 integrations notes.
    • Fix handling of token expiry.
    • Implement --b2-test-mode to set X-Bz-Test-Mode header.
    • Set cutoff for chunked upload to 200MB as per B2 guidelines.
    • Make upload multi-threaded.
  • Dropbox
    • Don't retry 461 errors.

v1.30 - 2016-06-18

  • New Features
    • Directory listing code reworked for more features and better error reporting (thanks to Klaus Post for help). This enables
      • Directory include filtering for efficiency
      • --max-depth parameter
      • Better error reporting
      • More to come
    • Retry more errors
    • Add --ignore-size flag - for uploading images to onedrive
    • Log -v output to stdout by default
    • Display the transfer stats in more human readable form
    • Make 0 size files specifiable with --max-size 0b
    • Add b suffix so we can specify bytes in --bwlimit, --min-size, etc.
    • Use "password:" instead of "password>" prompt - thanks Klaus Post and Leigh Klotz
  • Bug Fixes
    • Fix retry doing one too many retries
  • Local
    • Fix problems with OS X and UTF-8 characters
  • Amazon Drive
    • Check a file exists before uploading to help with 408 Conflict errors
    • Reauth on 401 errors - this has been causing a lot of problems
    • Work around spurious 403 errors
    • Restart directory listings on error
  • Google Drive
    • Check a file exists before uploading to help with duplicates
    • Fix retry of multipart uploads
  • Backblaze B2
    • Implement large file uploading
  • S3
    • Add AES256 server-side encryption for - thanks Justin R. Wilson
  • Google Cloud Storage
    • Make sure we don't use conflicting content types on upload
    • Add service account support - thanks Michal Witkowski
  • Swift
    • Add auth version parameter
    • Add domain option for openstack (v3 auth) - thanks Fabian Ruff

v1.29 - 2016-04-18

  • New Features
    • Implement -I, --ignore-times for unconditional upload
    • Improve dedupecommand
      • Now removes identical copies without asking
      • Now obeys --dry-run
      • Implement --dedupe-mode for non interactive running
        • --dedupe-mode interactive - interactive the default.
        • --dedupe-mode skip - removes identical files then skips anything left.
        • --dedupe-mode first - removes identical files then keeps the first one.
        • --dedupe-mode newest - removes identical files then keeps the newest one.
        • --dedupe-mode oldest - removes identical files then keeps the oldest one.
        • --dedupe-mode rename - removes identical files then renames the rest to be different.
  • Bug fixes
    • Make rclone check obey the --size-only flag.
    • Use "application/octet-stream" if discovered mime type is invalid.
    • Fix missing "quit" option when there are no remotes.
  • Google Drive
    • Increase default chunk size to 8 MB - increases upload speed of big files
    • Speed up directory listings and make more reliable
    • Add missing retries for Move and DirMove - increases reliability
    • Preserve mime type on file update
  • Backblaze B2
    • Enable mod time syncing
      • This means that B2 will now check modification times
      • It will upload new files to update the modification times
      • (there isn't an API to just set the mod time.)
      • If you want the old behaviour use --size-only.
    • Update API to new version
    • Fix parsing of mod time when not in metadata
  • Swift/Hubic
    • Don't return an MD5SUM for static large objects
  • S3
    • Fix uploading files bigger than 50GB

v1.28 - 2016-03-01

  • New Features
    • Configuration file encryption - thanks Klaus Post
    • Improve rclone config adding more help and making it easier to understand
    • Implement -u/--update so creation times can be used on all remotes
    • Implement --low-level-retries flag
    • Optionally disable gzip compression on downloads with --no-gzip-encoding
  • Bug fixes
    • Don't make directories if --dry-run set
    • Fix and document the move command
    • Fix redirecting stderr on unix-like OSes when using --log-file
    • Fix delete command to wait until all finished - fixes missing deletes.
  • Backblaze B2
    • Use one upload URL per go routine fixes more than one upload using auth token
    • Add pacing, retries and reauthentication - fixes token expiry problems
    • Upload without using a temporary file from local (and remotes which support SHA1)
    • Fix reading metadata for all files when it shouldn't have been
  • Drive
    • Fix listing drive documents at root
    • Disable copy and move for Google docs
  • Swift
    • Fix uploading of chunked files with non ASCII characters
    • Allow setting of storage_url in the config - thanks Xavier Lucas
  • S3
    • Allow IAM role and credentials from environment variables - thanks Brian Stengaard
    • Allow low privilege users to use S3 (check if directory exists during Mkdir) - thanks Jakub Gedeon
  • Amazon Drive
    • Retry on more things to make directory listings more reliable

v1.27 - 2016-01-31

  • New Features
    • Easier headless configuration with rclone authorize
    • Add support for multiple hash types - we now check SHA1 as well as MD5 hashes.
    • delete command which does obey the filters (unlike purge)
    • dedupe command to deduplicate a remote. Useful with Google Drive.
    • Add --ignore-existing flag to skip all files that exist on destination.
    • Add --delete-before, --delete-during, --delete-after flags.
    • Add --memprofile flag to debug memory use.
    • Warn the user about files with same name but different case
    • Make --include rules add their implicit exclude * at the end of the filter list
    • Deprecate compiling with go1.3
  • Amazon Drive
    • Fix download of files > 10 GB
    • Fix directory traversal ("Next token is expired") for large directory listings
    • Remove 409 conflict from error codes we will retry - stops very long pauses
  • Backblaze B2
    • SHA1 hashes now checked by rclone core
  • Drive
    • Add --drive-auth-owner-only to only consider files owned by the user - thanks Björn Harrtell
    • Export Google documents
  • Dropbox
    • Make file exclusion error controllable with -q
  • Swift
    • Fix upload from unprivileged user.
  • S3
    • Fix updating of mod times of files with + in.
  • Local
    • Add local file system option to disable UNC on Windows.

v1.26 - 2016-01-02

  • New Features
    • Yandex storage backend - thank you Dmitry Burdeev ("dibu")
    • Implement Backblaze B2 storage backend
    • Add --min-age and --max-age flags - thank you Adriano Aurélio Meirelles
    • Make ls/lsl/md5sum/size/check obey includes and excludes
  • Fixes
    • Fix crash in http logging
    • Upload releases to github too
  • Swift
    • Fix sync for chunked files
  • OneDrive
    • Re-enable server-side copy
    • Don't mask HTTP error codes with JSON decode error
  • S3
    • Fix corrupting Content-Type on mod time update (thanks Joseph Spurrier)

v1.25 - 2015-11-14

  • New features
    • Implement Hubic storage system
  • Fixes
    • Fix deletion of some excluded files without --delete-excluded
      • This could have deleted files unexpectedly on sync
      • Always check first with --dry-run!
  • Swift
    • Stop SetModTime losing metadata (e.g. X-Object-Manifest)
      • This could have caused data loss for files > 5GB in size
    • Use ContentType from Object to avoid lookups in listings
  • OneDrive
    • disable server-side copy as it seems to be broken at Microsoft

v1.24 - 2015-11-07

  • New features
    • Add support for Microsoft OneDrive
    • Add --no-check-certificate option to disable server certificate verification
    • Add async readahead buffer for faster transfer of big files
  • Fixes
    • Allow spaces in remotes and check remote names for validity at creation time
    • Allow '&' and disallow ':' in Windows filenames.
  • Swift
    • Ignore directory marker objects where appropriate - allows working with Hubic
    • Don't delete the container if fs wasn't at root
  • S3
    • Don't delete the bucket if fs wasn't at root
  • Google Cloud Storage
    • Don't delete the bucket if fs wasn't at root

v1.23 - 2015-10-03

  • New features
    • Implement rclone size for measuring remotes
  • Fixes
    • Fix headless config for drive and gcs
    • Tell the user they should try again if the webserver method failed
    • Improve output of --dump-headers
  • S3
    • Allow anonymous access to public buckets
  • Swift
    • Stop chunked operations logging "Failed to read info: Object Not Found"
    • Use Content-Length on uploads for extra reliability

v1.22 - 2015-09-28

  • Implement rsync like include and exclude flags
  • swift
    • Support files > 5GB - thanks Sergey Tolmachev

v1.21 - 2015-09-22

  • New features
    • Display individual transfer progress
    • Make lsl output times in localtime
  • Fixes
    • Fix allowing user to override credentials again in Drive, GCS and ACD
  • Amazon Drive
    • Implement compliant pacing scheme
  • Google Drive
    • Make directory reads concurrent for increased speed.

v1.20 - 2015-09-15

  • New features
    • Amazon Drive support
    • Oauth support redone - fix many bugs and improve usability
      • Use "golang.org/x/oauth2" as oauth library of choice
      • Improve oauth usability for smoother initial signup
      • drive, googlecloudstorage: optionally use auto config for the oauth token
    • Implement --dump-headers and --dump-bodies debug flags
    • Show multiple matched commands if abbreviation too short
    • Implement server-side move where possible
  • local
    • Always use UNC paths internally on Windows - fixes a lot of bugs
  • dropbox
    • force use of our custom transport which makes timeouts work
  • Thanks to Klaus Post for lots of help with this release

v1.19 - 2015-08-28

  • New features
    • Server side copies for s3/swift/drive/dropbox/gcs
    • Move command - uses server-side copies if it can
    • Implement --retries flag - tries 3 times by default
    • Build for plan9/amd64 and solaris/amd64 too
  • Fixes
    • Make a current version download with a fixed URL for scripting
    • Ignore rmdir in limited fs rather than throwing error
  • dropbox
    • Increase chunk size to improve upload speeds massively
    • Issue an error message when trying to upload bad file name

v1.18 - 2015-08-17

  • drive
    • Add --drive-use-trash flag so rclone trashes instead of deletes
    • Add "Forbidden to download" message for files with no downloadURL
  • dropbox
    • Remove datastore
      • This was deprecated and it caused a lot of problems
      • Modification times and MD5SUMs no longer stored
    • Fix uploading files > 2GB
  • s3
    • use official AWS SDK from github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go
    • NB will most likely require you to delete and recreate remote
    • enable multipart upload which enables files > 5GB
    • tested with Ceph / RadosGW / S3 emulation
    • many thanks to Sam Liston and Brian Haymore at the Utah Center for High Performance Computing for a Ceph test account
  • misc
    • Show errors when reading the config file
    • Do not print stats in quiet mode - thanks Leonid Shalupov
    • Add FAQ
    • Fix created directories not obeying umask
    • Linux installation instructions - thanks Shimon Doodkin

v1.17 - 2015-06-14

  • dropbox: fix case insensitivity issues - thanks Leonid Shalupov

v1.16 - 2015-06-09

  • Fix uploading big files which was causing timeouts or panics
  • Don't check md5sum after download with --size-only

v1.15 - 2015-06-06

  • Add --checksum flag to only discard transfers by MD5SUM - thanks Alex Couper
  • Implement --size-only flag to sync on size not checksum & modtime
  • Expand docs and remove duplicated information
  • Document rclone's limitations with directories
  • dropbox: update docs about case insensitivity

v1.14 - 2015-05-21

  • local: fix encoding of non utf-8 file names - fixes a duplicate file problem
  • drive: docs about rate limiting
  • google cloud storage: Fix compile after API change in "google.golang.org/api/storage/v1"

v1.13 - 2015-05-10

  • Revise documentation (especially sync)
  • Implement --timeout and --conntimeout
  • s3: ignore etags from multipart uploads which aren't md5sums

v1.12 - 2015-03-15

  • drive: Use chunked upload for files above a certain size
  • drive: add --drive-chunk-size and --drive-upload-cutoff parameters
  • drive: switch to insert from update when a failed copy deletes the upload
  • core: Log duplicate files if they are detected

v1.11 - 2015-03-04

  • swift: add region parameter
  • drive: fix crash on failed to update remote mtime
  • In remote paths, change native directory separators to /
  • Add synchronization to ls/lsl/lsd output to stop corruptions
  • Ensure all stats/log messages to go stderr
  • Add --log-file flag to log everything (including panics) to file
  • Make it possible to disable stats printing with --stats=0
  • Implement --bwlimit to limit data transfer bandwidth

v1.10 - 2015-02-12

  • s3: list an unlimited number of items
  • Fix getting stuck in the configurator

v1.09 - 2015-02-07

  • windows: Stop drive letters (e.g. C:) getting mixed up with remotes (e.g. drive:)
  • local: Fix directory separators on Windows
  • drive: fix rate limit exceeded errors

v1.08 - 2015-02-04

  • drive: fix subdirectory listing to not list entire drive
  • drive: Fix SetModTime
  • dropbox: adapt code to recent library changes

v1.07 - 2014-12-23

  • google cloud storage: fix memory leak

v1.06 - 2014-12-12

  • Fix "Couldn't find home directory" on OSX
  • swift: Add tenant parameter
  • Use new location of Google API packages

v1.05 - 2014-08-09

  • Improved tests and consequently lots of minor fixes
  • core: Fix race detected by go race detector
  • core: Fixes after running errcheck
  • drive: reset root directory on Rmdir and Purge
  • fs: Document that Purger returns error on empty directory, test and fix
  • google cloud storage: fix ListDir on subdirectory
  • google cloud storage: re-read metadata in SetModTime
  • s3: make reading metadata more reliable to work around eventual consistency problems
  • s3: strip trailing / from ListDir()
  • swift: return directories without / in ListDir

v1.04 - 2014-07-21

  • google cloud storage: Fix crash on Update

v1.03 - 2014-07-20

  • swift, s3, dropbox: fix updated files being marked as corrupted
  • Make compile with go 1.1 again

v1.02 - 2014-07-19

  • Implement Dropbox remote
  • Implement Google Cloud Storage remote
  • Verify Md5sums and Sizes after copies
  • Remove times from "ls" command - lists sizes only
  • Add add "lsl" - lists times and sizes
  • Add "md5sum" command

v1.01 - 2014-07-04

  • drive: fix transfer of big files using up lots of memory

v1.00 - 2014-07-03

  • drive: fix whole second dates

v0.99 - 2014-06-26

  • Fix --dry-run not working
  • Make compatible with go 1.1

v0.98 - 2014-05-30

  • s3: Treat missing Content-Length as 0 for some ceph installations
  • rclonetest: add file with a space in

v0.97 - 2014-05-05

  • Implement copying of single files
  • s3 & swift: support paths inside containers/buckets

v0.96 - 2014-04-24

  • drive: Fix multiple files of same name being created
  • drive: Use o.Update and fs.Put to optimise transfers
  • Add version number, -V and --version

v0.95 - 2014-03-28

  • rclone.org: website, docs and graphics
  • drive: fix path parsing

v0.94 - 2014-03-27

  • Change remote format one last time
  • GNU style flags

v0.93 - 2014-03-16

  • drive: store token in config file
  • cross compile other versions
  • set strict permissions on config file

v0.92 - 2014-03-15

  • Config fixes and --config option

v0.91 - 2014-03-15

  • Make config file

v0.90 - 2013-06-27

  • Project named rclone

v0.00 - 2012-11-18

  • Project started

Bugs and Limitations

Limitations

Directory timestamps aren't preserved

Rclone doesn't currently preserve the timestamps of directories. This
is because rclone only really considers objects when syncing.

Rclone struggles with millions of files in a directory/bucket

Currently rclone loads each directory/bucket entirely into memory before
using it. Since each rclone object takes 0.5k-1k of memory this can take
a very long time and use a large amount of memory.

Millions of files in a directory tends to occur on bucket-based remotes
(e.g. S3 buckets) since those remotes do not segregate subdirectories within
the bucket.

Bucket based remotes and folders

Bucket based remotes (e.g. S3/GCS/Swift/B2) do not have a concept of
directories. Rclone therefore cannot create directories in them which
means that empty directories on a bucket based remote will tend to
disappear.

Some software creates empty keys ending in / as directory markers.
Rclone doesn't do this as it potentially creates more objects and
costs more. This ability may be added in the future (probably via a
flag/option).

Bugs

Bugs are stored in rclone's GitHub project:

Frequently Asked Questions

Do all cloud storage systems support all rclone commands

Yes they do. All the rclone commands (e.g. sync, copy, etc.) will
work on all the remote storage systems.

Can I copy the config from one machine to another

Sure! Rclone stores all of its config in a single file. If you want
to find this file, run rclone config file which will tell you where
it is.

See the remote setup docs for more info.

How do I configure rclone on a remote / headless box with no browser?

This has now been documented in its own remote setup page.

Can rclone sync directly from drive to s3

Rclone can sync between two remote cloud storage systems just fine.

Note that it effectively downloads the file and uploads it again, so
the node running rclone would need to have lots of bandwidth.

The syncs would be incremental (on a file by file basis).

Eg

rclone sync -i drive:Folder s3:bucket

Using rclone from multiple locations at the same time

You can use rclone from multiple places at the same time if you choose
different subdirectory for the output, e.g.

Server A> rclone sync -i /tmp/whatever remote:ServerA
Server B> rclone sync -i /tmp/whatever remote:ServerB

If you sync to the same directory then you should use rclone copy
otherwise the two instances of rclone may delete each other's files, e.g.

Server A> rclone copy /tmp/whatever remote:Backup
Server B> rclone copy /tmp/whatever remote:Backup

The file names you upload from Server A and Server B should be
different in this case, otherwise some file systems (e.g. Drive) may
make duplicates.

Why doesn't rclone support partial transfers / binary diffs like rsync?

Rclone stores each file you transfer as a native object on the remote
cloud storage system. This means that you can see the files you
upload as expected using alternative access methods (e.g. using the
Google Drive web interface). There is a 1:1 mapping between files on
your hard disk and objects created in the cloud storage system.

Cloud storage systems (at least none I've come across yet) don't
support partially uploading an object. You can't take an existing
object, and change some bytes in the middle of it.

It would be possible to make a sync system which stored binary diffs
instead of whole objects like rclone does, but that would break the
1:1 mapping of files on your hard disk to objects in the remote cloud
storage system.

All the cloud storage systems support partial downloads of content, so
it would be possible to make partial downloads work. However to make
this work efficiently this would require storing a significant amount
of metadata, which breaks the desired 1:1 mapping of files to objects.

Can rclone do bi-directional sync?

No, not at present. rclone only does uni-directional sync from A ->
B. It may do in the future though since it has all the primitives - it
just requires writing the algorithm to do it.

Can I use rclone with an HTTP proxy?

Yes. rclone will follow the standard environment variables for
proxies, similar to cURL and other programs.

In general the variables are called http_proxy (for services reached
over http) and https_proxy (for services reached over https). Most
public services will be using https, but you may wish to set both.

The content of the variable is protocol://server:port. The protocol
value is the one used to talk to the proxy server, itself, and is commonly
either http or socks5.

Slightly annoyingly, there is no standard for the name; some applications
may use http_proxy but another one HTTP_PROXY. The Go libraries
used by rclone will try both variations, but you may wish to set all
possibilities. So, on Linux, you may end up with code similar to

export http_proxy=http://proxyserver:12345
export https_proxy=$http_proxy
export HTTP_PROXY=$http_proxy
export HTTPS_PROXY=$http_proxy

The NO_PROXY allows you to disable the proxy for specific hosts.
Hosts must be comma separated, and can contain domains or parts.
For instance "foo.com" also matches "bar.foo.com".

e.g.

export no_proxy=localhost,127.0.0.0/8,my.host.name
export NO_PROXY=$no_proxy

Note that the ftp backend does not support ftp_proxy yet.

Rclone gives x509: failed to load system roots and no roots provided error

This means that rclone can't find the SSL root certificates. Likely
you are running rclone on a NAS with a cut-down Linux OS, or
possibly on Solaris.

Rclone (via the Go runtime) tries to load the root certificates from
these places on Linux.

"/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt", // Debian/Ubuntu/Gentoo etc.
"/etc/pki/tls/certs/ca-bundle.crt",   // Fedora/RHEL
"/etc/ssl/ca-bundle.pem",             // OpenSUSE
"/etc/pki/tls/cacert.pem",            // OpenELEC

So doing something like this should fix the problem. It also sets the
time which is important for SSL to work properly.

mkdir -p /etc/ssl/certs/
curl -o /etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt https://raw.githubusercontent.com/bagder/ca-bundle/master/ca-bundle.crt
ntpclient -s -h pool.ntp.org

The two environment variables SSL_CERT_FILE and SSL_CERT_DIR, mentioned in the x509 package,
provide an additional way to provide the SSL root certificates.

Note that you may need to add the --insecure option to the curl command line if it doesn't work without.

curl --insecure -o /etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt https://raw.githubusercontent.com/bagder/ca-bundle/master/ca-bundle.crt

Rclone gives Failed to load config file: function not implemented error

Likely this means that you are running rclone on Linux version not
supported by the go runtime, ie earlier than version 2.6.23.

See the system requirements section in the go install
docs
for full details.

All my uploaded docx/xlsx/pptx files appear as archive/zip

This is caused by uploading these files from a Windows computer which
hasn't got the Microsoft Office suite installed. The easiest way to
fix is to install the Word viewer and the Microsoft Office
Compatibility Pack for Word, Excel, and PowerPoint 2007 and later
versions' file formats

tcp lookup some.domain.com no such host

This happens when rclone cannot resolve a domain. Please check that
your DNS setup is generally working, e.g.

# both should print a long list of possible IP addresses
dig www.googleapis.com          # resolve using your default DNS
dig www.googleapis.com @8.8.8.8 # resolve with Google's DNS server

If you are using systemd-resolved (default on Arch Linux), ensure it
is at version 233 or higher. Previous releases contain a bug which
causes not all domains to be resolved properly.

Additionally with the GODEBUG=netdns= environment variable the Go
resolver decision can be influenced. This also allows to resolve certain
issues with DNS resolution. See the name resolution section in the go docs.

The total size reported in the stats for a sync is wrong and keeps changing

It is likely you have more than 10,000 files that need to be
synced. By default rclone only gets 10,000 files ahead in a sync so as
not to use up too much memory. You can change this default with the
--max-backlog flag.

Rclone is using too much memory or appears to have a memory leak

Rclone is written in Go which uses a garbage collector. The default
settings for the garbage collector mean that it runs when the heap
size has doubled.

However it is possible to tune the garbage collector to use less
memory by setting GOGC to a lower
value, say export GOGC=20. This will make the garbage collector
work harder, reducing memory size at the expense of CPU usage.

The most common cause of rclone using lots of memory is a single
directory with thousands or millions of files in. Rclone has to load
this entirely into memory as rclone objects. Each rclone object takes
0.5k-1k of memory.

License

This is free software under the terms of MIT the license (check the
COPYING file included with the source code).

Copyright (C) 2019 by Nick Craig-Wood https://www.craig-wood.com/nick/

Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal
in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights
to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:

The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
all copies or substantial portions of the Software.

THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM,
OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN
THE SOFTWARE.

Authors

Contributors

{{< rem email addresses removed from here need to be addeed to bin/.ignore-emails to make sure update-authors.py doesn't immediately put them back in again. >}}

Contact the rclone project

Forum

Forum for questions and general discussion:

GitHub repository

The project's repository is located at:

There you can file bug reports or contribute with pull requests.

Twitter

You can also follow me on twitter for rclone announcements:

Email

Or if all else fails or you want to ask something private or
confidential email Nick Craig-Wood.
Please don't email me requests for help - those are better directed to
the forum. Thanks!